Panel Components 2015 – 2016
Panel Components The Panel business area offers a wide range of electrical products for use in and on control panels. We are therefore able to offer our customers a single source for many of their control panel components.
Anthony Wrighton (left) – Business Area Manager
The Panel team in training
Introduction Beacons and sounders
2 8
Cable trunking
16
Cam switches
24
Climate control & lighting for enclosures
34
Control relays
52
Counters
58
Current transformers
66
Data recorders
82
Enclosures
88
Flexible busbars
108
GSM, SMS module
116
Logic controllers
122
Nano PLC
136
Panel meters
142
Power network & synchronisation meters
154
Power supplies
160
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
182
Relays
202
RS-485 network modules
218
Signal towers
224
Solid state interface relays
230
Solid state relays
240
Switch disconnectors
252
Temperature controllers
262
Terminals
284
Time switches
354
Timers
362
Transducers
374
Excellence in OEM Automatic UK markets and sells components for industrial automation, currently representing approximately 50 leading suppliers and acting as their local sales organisation in the UK. Customers come from all sectors of industrial automation and include machine builders, control panel builders, system integrators and selected strategic distributors. Value added link OEM offers a unique and extensive range of products from leading manufacturers
Supplier Together with an efficient logistics process and added value workshop, we help customers reduce the number of their suppliers. In order to support our sales process we have a local team of product specialists and sales/ marketing staff. This means we offer a high level of service to our customers. To become a competent and effective partner to our customers we have divided our product range into specialised business areas. In this way we combine the
Customer advantage of being specialised in small areas with the benefits of being part of a large organisation. Being a partner with OEM Automatic means you have access to our unique broad product range but in a specialised organisation. With our ability to see the whole value chain and total costs we aim to improve your competitive advantage and profitability. Our ambition is to make it easier for you to find the best and most cost-efficient solutions.
Specialised organisation 4 business areas – 1 partner
Panel
Machine & Safety
Electrical components for inside and outside control panels
Sensors, encoders, cable systems and machine safety components
2 | INTRODUCTION
Pressure & Flow
Motors
To measure and control pressure, AC/DC motors, geared motors, flow and level of liquids and gases electronic drives and linear solutions
Automation A strategic partnership OEM Automatic UK is a part of the OEM International group whose headquarters are in Tranas, Sweden. The companies within this group are leading suppliers of components and systems for industrial automation in the Nordic region, UK and Eastern Europe. FACTS: OEM Automatic UK • • • •
Founded in 1989 Turnover 2014 approx £10M More than 2000 customers More than 50 suppliers
Turku
Drammen
Parnu
Tranas Riga
Panevezys
Allerød
Leicester Warsaw
Prague Trnava
Budapest
Richard Armstrong – Managing Director INTRODUCTION
|3
Always close to Our head office and stock is located in Whetstone just south of Leicester so we are in an ideal central location to be as close as possible to our customers. Each of our sales engineers works with a limited range of products and this enables them to become experts in their field. They are available to visit customers at short notice to discuss and advise on technical or commercial issues. Competent sales and product staff
Customer support
Because of our specialised business areas all of our sales staff are experts in their particular field. This enables them to really understand the products and applications and assist customers on site with selecting the right product. A program of training with our suppliers runs throughout the year so they are always updated with the latest innovations and product knowledge. Our product specialists and product managers have the deepest knowledge of the products and are responsible for product range development and day to day contact with our suppliers. They also provide technical support for sales and customer support staff.
Our customer support team are there to offer a fast and efficient service to our customers when placing orders, checking delivery times/order status etc. They are in close contact with our product specialists who can answer technical queries and application specific questions. Product returns are handled in the customer support team and we aim to respond with actions within 3 days.
Efficient logistics Our warehouse in Whetstone aims to despatch all orders the same day if received before 16.30. Our warehouse personnel are responsible for despatching more than 25,000 orders per year and we are proud of our ability to get products to our customers safely and on time. We currently hold more than 8000 articles in stock so our customers can get standard products delivered the next day.
We are available from 08.30 until 17.00 Phone: 0116 2849900 Email: orders@uk.oem.se Fax: 0116 2841721 Web: www.oem.co.uk
Product information At www.oem.co.uk you will find full and detailed product information in our on-line catalogue. From this you have all the technical information and ordering codes and you can download PDF files if you wish. To support the information on the website each business area produces its own printed catalogue which is available on request. Three times per year we publish our customer magazine ‘Inside Automation’ which we mail to more than 15,000 contacts. This contains new product information, special offers and company news.
All orders received before 16.30 will be despatched same day
4 | INTRODUCTION
the customer issue 2 2014
Linear guides from stock pages 6 & 7
issue 3 2013
New fuse terminals from Contaclip page 5
High Omni-fin; power low stud flow terminals covered! page 8 9
Ă˜40mm signal tower
Product catalogues and brochures Each business area has its own dedicated product catalogue and brochures containing full technical information - an effective tool for our sales team and a helpful guide for you. Pages can be downloaded from our website: www.oem.co.uk
page 11
The NEW XC-Series worm geared motors page 11
High speed barcode reading page 7
Customer magazine Issued three times a year Inside Automation features the latest products and is focused on technical articles and applications.
Clear marketing communication Our trade magazine adverts and advertorials make product selection easy and is an effective aid to sales. The information alerts you to our new and current range.
INTRODUCTION
|5
Added value Often we can provide our customers with a little bit extra in addition to our standard off the shelf product. We call this service ‘Added Value’ and below are just a few examples: • Custom engraved legend plates • Cam switch assembly • DIN rail terminal assemblies • ‘Kits’ of parts bagged or boxed and labelled with customers own reference number • Pre-drilled enclosures • Custom printed terminal markers; cable markers; device and installation markers
6 | INTRODUCTION
Our suppliers Complete range of visual and audible signalling equipment from signal towers to EX telephones
Control & signalling devices including pushbuttons, cam switches and switch disconnectors
Innovative connection technology from DIN rail terminals to cable management products plus a full range of electronic devices
• Est. 1910 • Located in Vienna, Austria
• Est. 1924 • Located in Strasbourg, France • 10 year guarantee on all products
Automation control products including timers, control relays, counters & logic controllers and nano PLC’s
Market leading manufacturer of a complete range of solid state relays in all forms
• Est. 1921 • Located in Valance, France
• 40 yrs experience • Worldwide distributors • Manufacture in Mexico
• 30 yrs experience • Located Nummela, Finland
Complete range of high performance enclosing solutions in plastic, GRP, steel & stainless steel
Specialist manufacturer of counting devices and process control technology
A global manufacturer of industrial and power protection devices
• Est. 1958 • Located in Porvoo, Finland
• Est 1958 • Located in Schwenningen, Germany
Manufacturer of electrical measuring and control devices including transducers, meters, controllers and recorders
Leading manufacturer of DIN rail mount power supplies that are at the forefront of technology
Fully featured range of industrial plug in relays, sockets and accessories
• Est. 1953 • Located in Zielona Gora, Poland
• Est. 1980 • Located in Munich, Germany
• Est. 1962 • Manufacture in Madrid, Spain
Manufacturer of flexible copper busbars & earth braids
Market leading manufacturer of thermal management products for enclosures and control cabinets
Complete range of advanced temperature and process controllers across 3 different brands
• Located in Germany
• 30 years experience • Located in Germany
• 90 years experience • Located in Brighton, UK • Part of the Danaher Corporation
• Est. 1977 • Located in Hovelhof, Germany
Solid state interface relays with unique features that offer exceptional performance in tough industrial applications
• Est. 1904 • Located in Limoges, France • Worldwide distributors
INTRODUCTION
|7
BEACONS AND SOUNDERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
I series panel mount beacons
10
Q series surface mount beacons
11
G series surface mount beacons
12
E series visual/audible signalling
13
A series visual/audible signalling
14
CS1 visual/audible signalling
14
A series audible signalling
15
HPT/HTG audible signalling
16
E series panel mount buzzers
17
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
I series panel mount beacons • • • • •
IBL-IBM-IBS LED steady / flashing beacons ITL-ITM-ITS LED dual colour beacons Versatile panel mount beacon series Ø65, Ø45 & Ø30mm diameter Maintenance free – long lifetime
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
IBL
IBM
IBS
Type
ITL
ITM
ITS
Nominal voltage
Nominal current
Housing grey
Housing black
12 V AC/DC
80 mA
802 10C 404
802 50C 404
24 V AC/DC
60 mA
802 10C 405
802 50C 405
110/120 V AC
30 mA
802 10C 310
802 50C 310
230/240 V AC
31 mA
802 10C 313
802 50C 313
12 V AC/DC
62 mA
801 10C 404
801 50C 404
24 V AC/DC
37 mA
801 10C 405
801 50C 405
110/120 V AC
30 mA
801 10C 310
801 50C 310
230/240 V AC
30 mA
801 10C 313
801 50C 313
12 V AC/DC
45 mA
800 10C 404
800 50C 404
24 V AC/DC
26 mA
800 10C 405
800 50C 405
110/120 V AC
18 mA
800 10C 310
800 50C 310
230/240 V AC
19 mA
800 10C 313
800 50C 313
Nominal voltage
Nominal current
Housing grey
Housing black
24 V AC/DC
44 mA
802 3CC 405
802 7CC 405
110/120 V AC
41 mA
802 3CC 310
802 7CC 310
230/240 V AC
41 mA
802 3CC 313
802 7CC 313
24 V AC/DC
39 mA
801 3CC 405w
801 7CC 405
110/120 V AC
35 mA
801 3CC 310
801 7CC 310
230/240 V AC
34 mA
801 3CC 313
801 7CC 313
24 V AC/DC
30 mA
800 3CC 405
800 7CC 405
Accessories
Order number
Adapter M30.5mm
812 500 900
Fastening tool for 30 mm M22 panel mount products
812 400 900
C = colour code, 1=amber, 2=red, 4=transparent, 5=blue, 6=green, 7=yellow NOTE: when beacon is correctly mounted (rear orientation notch is on top position), the first colour code C defines the colour in the upper beacon half and the second colour C defines the colour in the lower beacon half.
10 | BEACONS
AND SOUNDERS
www.oem.co.uk
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
Q series surface mount beacons • LED steady / flashing beacon • Long lifetime, low current consumption & vibration proof • Suitable for process control, fire/gas alarm and marine applications • Versatile installation and mounting options
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
Description
LED steady/flashing beacon
QDS
Size 1 = Ø94mm
Light source
Nominal voltage
Voltage range
Nominal current
Order number
24 V AC/DC
+/- 10%
0.110
874 16C 405
48 V AC/DC
+/- 10%
0.065
874 16C 408
110/120 V AC
+/- 10%
0.060
874 16C 310
+/- 10%
0.060
874 16C 313
Max. 0.3
874 26C 408
Max. 0.7
874 26C 413
Max. 0.780
874 76C 408
Max. 0.210
874 76C 413
Max. 0.780
874 36C 408
Max. 0.210
874 36C 413
Max. 1.800
874 46C 408
Max. 0.350
874 46C 413
Max. 1.700
874 86C 408
Max. 0.400
874 86C 413
LED 10 Cd
230/240 V AC LED steady/flashing beacon
QDM
Size 2 = Ø132mm
LED multi strobe beacon
QBL
Size 3 = Ø184mm
LED steady/flashing beacon
QDL
Size 3 = Ø184mm
LED steady/flashing beacon
QDX
Size 3 = Ø184mm
LED multi strobe beacon
QBX
Size 4
= Ø228mm
24/48 V AC/DC
LED 10 Cd
110/240 V AC 24/48 V AC/DC
LED 250 Cd
110/240 V AC/DC 24/48 V AC/DC
LED 170 Cd
110/240 V AC/DC 24/48 V AC/DC
LED 300 Cd
110/240 V AC/DC 24/48 V AC/DC
LED 400 Cd
110/240 V AC/DC
16-60 V DC 16-53 V AC 80-265 V AC/DC 18-60 V DC 18-53 V AC 80-265 V AC/DC 18-60 V DC 18-53 V AC 80-265 V AC/DC 18-60 V DC 18-53 V AC 80-265 V AC/DC 18-60 V DC 18-53 V AC 80-265 V AC/DC
C =colour code, 1=amber, 2=red, 4=transparent, 5=blue, 6=green, 7=yellow
Accessories Type
Description
AMK
Mounting kit for combinations of multi tonee alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 010 900
AKV
Cable gland M20 x 1.5 For multi tone alarm sounders for A and/or Q
698 800 026
AG1
Flat gasket for size 1 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 021 900
AG2
Flat gasket for size 2 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 022 900
AG3
Flat gasket for size 3 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 023 900
AG4
Flat gasket for size 4 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 024 900
AB1
Metal bracket kit for size 1 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 031 900
AB2
Metal bracket kit for size 2 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 032 900
AB3
Metal bracket kit for size 3 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 033 900
AB4
Metal bracket kit for size 4 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 034 900
0116 284 9900
Order number
BEACONS AND SOUNDERS
| 11
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
G series surface mount beacons • • • • •
LED steady / flashing beacon Ø120 mm lens diameter Wide voltage range Shock and vibration proof Maintenance free For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
WLG
BKG
Denomination
Steady beacon
Flashing beacon
Light source
25 W bulb
25 W bulb
Nominal voltage V
Voltage range V
Nominal voltage A
Housing black
822 10C 900
822 50C 900
12 V AC/DC
832 10C 404
832 50C 404
24 V AC/DC
832 10C 405
832 50C 405
110/120 V AC
832 10C 310
832 50C 310
up to 250 V AC/DC
+/-10%
230/240 V AC
FLG
DLG
BLG
12 | BEACONS
Strobe beacon Xenon strobe
LED steady beacon
LED flashing beacon
AND SOUNDERS
5 J xenon tube
48 LEDs
48 LEDs
Order number Housing grey
832 10C 313
832 50C 313
12 V AC/DC
0.7
842 14C 404
842 54C 404
24 V AC/DC
0.32
842 14C 405
842 54C 405
110/120 V AC
0.2
842 13C 310
842 53C 310
230/240 V AC
0.1
842 13C 313
842 53C 313
24 V AC/DC
17-32 V DC
0.11
827 10C 405
827 50C 405
48 V AC/DC
34-62 V DC
0.085
827 10C 408
827 50C 408
110/120 V AC
0.06
827 10C 310
827 50C 350
230/240 V AC
0.06
827 10C 313
827 50C 313
24 V AC/DC
14-28 V DC
0.11
807 10C 405
807 50C 405
48 V AC/DC
30-52 V DC
0.085
807 10C 408
807 50C 408
110/120 V AC
0.06
807 10C 310
807 50C 310
230/240 V AC
0.06
807 10C 313
807 50C 313
www.oem.co.uk
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
E series visual/audible signalling • • • •
Universal panel mount buzzer with LED control light Ø65 mm – Ø45 mm diameter High brightness, maintenance free For mounting in 22.5 mm and 30.5 mm bore holes (with adapter) For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
Description
Nominal voltage
Nominal current (mA)
Grey housing
Black housing
12 V AC/DC
73
814 11C 404
814 51C 404
24V AC/DC
47
814 11C 405
814 51C 405
110/120 V AC
60
814 11C 310
814 51C 310
230/240 V AC
63
814 11C 313
814 51C 313
12 V AC/DC
35
813 11C 404
813 51C 404
24V AC/DC
58
813 11C 405
813 51C 405
110/120 V AC
42
813 11C 310
813 51C 310
230/240 V AC
40
813 11C 313
813 51C 313
12 V AC/DC
62
814 12C 404
814 51C 404
24V AC/DC
95
814 12C 405
814 51C 405
110/120 V AC
52
814 12C 310
814 51C 310
Panel mount buzzer LED control light EDG - EDM
230/240 V AC
52
814 12C 313
814 51C 313
tone and light separately switchable
12 V AC/DC
48
813 12C 404
813 51C 404
ELG
Panel mount buzzer LED control light ELG - ELM tone and light synchronised
ELM
EDG
EDM
24V AC/DC
73
813 12C 405
813 51C 405
110/120 V AC
51
813 12C 310
813 51C 310
230/240 V AC
51
813 12C 313
813 51C 313
Accessories
Order number
Adapter M30.5
812 500 900
Voltage range: nominal voltage +/- 10% C =colour code, 1=amber, 2=red, 4=transparent, 5=blue, 6=green, 7=yellow
0116 284 9900
BEACONS AND SOUNDERS
| 13
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
A series visual/audible signalling • Tone and light separately switchable • Optional customized tones / tone tables upon request For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
Description Multi-tone alarm sounder Ø94mm
ADS-P
ADS-T
with LED steady indicator 8 tones
Multi-tone alarm sounder Ø94mm with LED steady/flashing indicator 32 tones
Max sound pressure (dB A)
103
108
Nominal voltage
Voltage range
Nominal current (mA)
Order number
24 V DC
+/- 10%
0.12
875 06C 405
110/120 V AC
+/- 10%
0.065
875 06C 310
230/240 V AC
+/- 10%
0.0665
875 06C 313
24 V DC
+/- 10%
0.160
875 16C 405
110/120 V AC
+/- 10%
0.005
875 16C 310
230/240 V AC
+/- 10%
0.025
875 16C 313
C =colour code, 1=amber, 2=red, 4=transparent, 5=blue, 6=green, 7=yellow
Accessories Type
Description
AMK
Mounting kit for combinations of multi tonee alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
Order number 874 010 900
AKV
Cable gland M20 x 1.5 For multi tone alarm sounders for A and/or Q
698 800 026
AG1
Flat gasket for size 1 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 021 900
AB1
Metal bracket kit for size 1 multi-tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 031 900
CS1 – visual/audible signalling
• • • • • •
Cost effective LED flashing beacon with multitone siren 32 tones Tone type and volume selectable Low nominal current (11-37 mA) Quick fit installation by bayonet fixing Lateral cable entry possible For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type CS1
Nominal voltage 24 V DC
Nominal current (mA) 11 - 37
Voltage range (V) 18 - 35
Order number Housing red
Housing white
C111 62C 005
C11122C 005
C =colour code, 1=amber, 2=red, 4=clear, 5=blue
14 | BEACONS
AND SOUNDERS
www.oem.co.uk
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
A series – audible signalling • • • •
Comprehensive range of standard to high output alarm Versatile installation and mounting options Optional/customised tones/tone tables upon request Fit for plc applications (leakage, inrush current)
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
ASS-P
ASS-T
ASM
ASL
ASX
Description
Multi tone alarm sounder size 1, 8 tones
Multi tone alarm sounder size 1, 32 tones
Multi tone alarm sounder size 2, 32 tones
Multi tone alarm sounder size 3, 63 tones
Multi tone alarm sounder size 4, 63 tones
Max. sound pressure (dB A)
103
108
113
120
127
Nominal voltage
Voltage range
Nominal current (mA)
Order no. Housing red
24 V AC/DC
+/-10%
0.100
874 060 405
48 V AC/DC
+/-10%
0.075
874 060 408
110/120 V AC
+/-10%
0.040
874 060 310
230/240 V AC
+/-10%
0.040
874 060 313
24 V AC/DC
+/-10%
0.120
874 160 405
48 V AC/DC
+/-10%
0.090
874 160 408
110/120 V AC
+/-10%
0.042
874 160 310
230/240 V AC
+/-10%
0.022
874 160 313
24 V AC/DC
+/-10%
0.120
874 260 405
48 V AC/DC
+/-10%
0.090
874 260 408
110/120 V AC
+/-10%
0.042
874 260 310
230/240 V AC
+/-10%
0.022
874 260 313
24 V AC/DC
+/-10%
1.050
874 360 408
110/120 V AC
+/-10%
0.170
874 360 310
230/240 V AC
+/-10%
0.085
874 360 313
24-48 V AC/DC
+/-10%
2.000
874 460 408
110/120 V AC
+/-10%
0.350
874 460 310
230/240 V AC
+/-10%
0.170
874 460 313
Accessories Type
Denomination
Order number
AMK
Mounting kit for combinations of multi tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 010 900
AG4
Flat gasket for size 4 multi tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 024 900
AB4
Metal bracket kit for size 4 multi tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
874 034 900
AKV
Cable gland M20 x 1.5 for multi tone alarm sounders A and/or beacons Q
698 800 026
0116 284 9900
BEACONS AND SOUNDERS
| 15
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
HPT/HTG – audible signalling • Loud, well designed and robust electro-mechanical signal horns • Aluminium die-cast or impact resistant synthetic housing • Special models with telephone call current relay (HPT-R, HTG-R) • Large options voltages • HTG-L: special model with RILSAN-coating against galvanic corrosion version for vessels, seawater resistant etc.) For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
Nominal voltage
Nominal current (A)
Order number
Nominal current (A)
Order number
6 V AC
4.5
712 100 103
6 V AC
4.5
713 100 103
12 V AC
2.00
712 100 104
12 V AC
2.00
713 100 104
24 V AC
1.20
712 100 105
24 V AC
1.20
713 100 105
42 V DC
0.60
712 100 107
42 V DC
0.60
713 100 107
0.50
712 100 108
48 V AC
0.50
713 100 108
48 V AC
HPT
Hz
50
Nominal voltage
Hz
50
60 V AC
0.40
712 100 109
60 V AC
0.40
713 100 109
110 V AC
0.20
712 100 110
110 V AC
0.20
713 100 110
230 V AC
0.10
712 100 113
230 V AC
0.10
713 100 113
0.20
712 100 211
0.20
713 100 211
240 V AC
0.11
712 100 213
240 V AC
0.11
713 100 213
12 V DC
1.00
712 100 004
12 V DC
1.00
713 100 004
24 V DC
0.60
712 100 005
24 V DC
0.60
713 100 005
48 V DC
0.50
712 100 008
48 V DC
0.50
713 100 008
60 V DC
0.25
712 100 009
60 V DC
0.25
713 100 009
110 V DC
0.20
712 100 010
110 V DC
0.20
713 100 010
220 V DC
0.10
712 100 113
220 V DC
0.10
713 100 113
120 V AC
60
Models with telephone call current relay HPT-R
Type
HTG
120 V AC
60
Models with telephone call current relay
230 V AC
50
0.10
712 102 113
240 V AC
60
0.11
712 102 213
HTG-R
230 V AC
50
0.10
713 102 113
220 V DC
60
0.08
713 102 213
Models with RIL SAN-coating: Membrane galvanised and epoxy powder coated, screws A4 with solation and rubber washers for mounting avoiding galvanic corrosion, additional membrane sealing 110 V AC
HTG-L
16 | BEACONS
AND SOUNDERS
50
0.20
713 150 110
120 V AC
0.20
713 150 111
230 V AC
0.10
713 150 113
0.20
713 150 211
240 V AC
120 V AC
60
0.11
713 150 214
24 V AC
0.60
713 150 005
www.oem.co.uk
Beacons and sounders S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
E series – panel mount buzzers • • • •
High volume universal panel mount buzzers Ø65, Ø45, Ø30 mm diameter 3 well distinguishable tones selectable via terminal (ESG) Volume infinitely adjustable also in panel mount condition (ESG, ESM) • Wide voltage range • For mounting in 22.5 mm or 30.5 mm diameter holes (with adapter)
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m.c o.uk
Type
ESG
ESM
ESK
ESV
Description
Ø65
Ø45
Ø30
Ø30
Nominal voltage
Voltage range
Nominal current (mA)
Grey housing
Black housing
12-24 V AC/DC
8-24 V AC/DC
57
814 100 405
814 500 405
110/120 V AC
75-140 V AC
42
814 100 310
814 500 310
230/240 V AC
150-260 V AC
44
814 100 313
814 500 313
12-24 V AC/DC
8-24 V AC/DC
19
813 100 405
813 500 405
110/120 V AC
75-140 V AC
42
813 100 310
813 500 310 813 500 313
230/240 V AC
150-260 V AC
40
813 100 313
12-24 V AC/DC
10-24 V AC/DC
46
812 100 405
812 500 405
110/120 V AC
75-140 V AC
17
812 100 310
812 500 310
230/240 V AC
150-260 V AC
20
812 100 313
812 500 313
12-24 V AC/DC
10-24 V AC/DC
46
812 110 405
812 510 405
110/120 V AC
75-140 V AC
17
812 110 310
812 510 310
230/240 V AC
150-260 V AC
20
812 110 313
812 510 313
Accessories
Order number
Adapter M30.5mm
812 500 900
Fastening tool for 30 mm M22 panel mount products
812 400 900
0116 284 9900
BEACONS AND SOUNDERS
| 17
CABLE TRUNKING
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Advantages
20
Cable trunking VK
21
Halogen-free cable trunking VK-HF
21
Accessories
22
Cable trunking cutter
23
Dimensional drawings
23
Cable trunking
Advantages CONTA-CLIP offers a wide range of cable trunking for a variety of different installation applications. The trunking has excellent dimensional stability. They also feature tight fitting covers which are easy to snap on and off. The pegs have pre-determined breakage points so that the cable trunking can easily be modified for your cabling. They are available in various sizes and in a halogen-free version. • Material: Rigid lead-free PVC, flame retardant, in accordance with UL 94 V-0, • Self-extinguishing • Thermal stability: -20° C to +60° C. • Colour: grey (RAL 7030) • Delivered length: 2m, with cover • Customized lengths: on request • 90° cover contour • Colour: grey (RAL 7030)
Halogen-free cable trunking Halogen-free cable trunking is often installed in sensitive areas and public buildings such as in airports, railway stations, office buildings, high-rise buildings and hospitals. The halogen-free plastic used by CONTA CLIP is compliant with VDE 0472 part 815 and generates no toxic gases when burned. Thus it meets the special requirements for these applications. The pegs and the base have pre-determined breakage points so that the cable trunking can easily be modified for your cabling. Material: Halogen-free plastic in accordance with VDE 0472, part 815. No toxic gases in event of fire. Fulfils the requirements in F2 and I3 of the NF F 16-101 Railway Standards. (RAL 7035)
Optimally fitted cover is easy to put on and take off
Stamped out with no burrs so the installer cannot be injured and the cable cannot be damaged
Pre-determined breakage points on the pegs 20 | CABLE TRUNKING
www.oem.co.uk
Cable trunking
Cable trunking VK
Cable trunking VK • Material: Rigid lead-free PVC, flame retardant, in accordance with UL 94 V-0, • Self-extinguishing • Thermal stability: -20° C to +60° C. • 90° cover contour • Colour: grey (RAL 7030)
VK Order number
Pack Qty (m)
Nom. size (W x H mm)
Internal size (W x H mm)
17800.6
64
30 x 30
27 x 27
17801.6
68
25 x 40
22 x 37
17802.6
52
40 x 40
37 x 37
17803.6
40
60 x 40
56 x 37
17804.6
52
30 x 60
26 x 56
17805.6
48
40 x 60
36 x 56
17806.6
36
60 x 60
56 x 56
17807.6
30
80 x 60
76 x 56
17808.6
22
100 x 60
96 x 56
17809.6
20
120 x 60
115 x 56
17810.6
44
30 x 80
26 x 76
17811.6
40
40 x 80
36 x 76
17812.6
30
60 x 80
56 x 76
17813.6
24
80 x 80
76 x 76
VK Cover Order number
Pack Qty (m)
Nom. size (W x H mm)
Internal size (W x H mm)
Covers only
17814.6
22
100 x 80
96 x 76
17830.6
10
25
22
17815.6
16
120 x 80
115 x 76
17831.6
10
30
27
17816.6
32
25 x 100
22 x 96
17832.6
10
40
36
17817.6
24
40 x 100
36 x 96
17833.6
10
60
56
17818.6
28
60 x 100
56 x 96
17834.6
10
80
76
17819.6
20
80 x 100
76 x 96
17835.6
10
100
96
17820.6
16
100 x 100
96 x 96
17836.6
10
120
115
17821.6
8
150 x 100
145 x 96
17837.6
10
150
154
Halogen-free cable trunking VK-HF Cable trunking VK-HF • Material: Halogen-free plastic in accordance with VDE 0472, part 815 • No toxic gases in event of fire • Thermal stability: -25° C to +70° C. • 90° cover contour • Wire retaining lugs, starting with 60 mm height • Colour: grey (RAL 7035)
VK-HF Order number
Pack Qty (m)
Nom. size (W x H mm)
Internal size (W x H mm)
17840.6
64
30 x 30
27 x 27
17841.6
68
25 x 40
22 x 37
17843.6
40
60 x 40
56 x 37
17844.6
60
25 x 60
22 x 56
17845.6
48
40 x 60
36 x 56
17846.6
36
60 x 60
56 x 56
17847.6
32
80 x 60
76 x 56
17850.6
56
25 x 80
22 x 76
17851.6
40
40 x 80
36 x 76
VK-HF Cover Order number
Pack Qty (m)
Nom. size (W x H mm)
Internal size (W x H mm)
17852.6
36
60 x 80
56 x 76
17870.6
10
25
22
17853.6
24
80 x 80
76 x 76
17871.6
10
30
27
17854.6
24
100 x 80
96 x 76
17872.6
10
40
36
17857.6
24
40 x 100
36 x 96
17873.6
10
60
56
17858.6
32
60 x 100
56 x 96
17874.6
10
80
76
17860.6
10
100 x 100
96 x 100
17875.6
10
100
96
0116 284 9900
Covers only
CABLE TRUNKING
| 21
Cable trunking
Accessories Order guide
Versatile halogen-free cable trunking VK-FLEX-HF
Material: PP, halogen-free, flame retardant, in accordance with UL 94 V-0 Temperature range: -20°C to +70°C, self-adhesive Spiral tubing VK-SS
Order number
Pack Qty
Length (m)
Diameter (mm)
17880.6
100
0.5
10
17881.6
60
0.5
20
17882.6
36
0.5
30
17883.6
24
0.5
40
17885.0
30
30
4
17886.0
30
30
9
17887.0
30
30
16
Order number
Pack Qty
Accessories for
17889.0
400
VK, VK-HF
Order number
Pack Qty
Accessories for
17891.6
100
VK, VK-HF
Order number
Pack Qty
Accessories for
17892.6
50
VK-HF
Order number
Pack Qty
Diameter (mm)
Hole Ø req’d (mm)
17896.4
4000
3.5
3.5
17897.4
4000
5
5.2
17898.4
4000
6
6.2
17899.4
2000
6.5
6.5
Qty
Length (mm)
Weight (g)
1
255
153
Qty
Length (mm)
Weight (g)
1
2455
258
Material: PE, RoHS compliant. Temperature range: -50°C to +85°C Standard wire holder
Material: PS, RoHS compliant. Temperature range: -20°C to +60°C Retaining tab VK-HZ
Material: PS, RoHS compliant. Temperature range: -20°C to +60°C Wire and partitioning peg holder
Material: PS, RoHS compliant. Temperature range: -20°C to +60°C Expanding rivets SN-PA
Material: PA, RoHS compliant. Temperature range: -20°C to +60°C Setting tool SN-SW
Order number 17895.0
Notching pliers VK-AKZ
Order number 17894.0
22 | CABLE TRUNKING
www.oem.co.uk
Cable trunking
Cable trunking cutter The VKS cable trunking cutter is a tool that can cut trunking of up to 125 mm in width. The tool can be attached to a work bench or mounted at a workstation.
Features: • 90° precise-angle cutting • Quick, quiet and burr-free cutting • Minimal force needed for the cut • Maintenance-free
Cable trunking cutter VK-S Order number
Lever length (mm)
Length limit
Weight (kg)
Wall thickness (mm)
Channel width (mm)
500
1000 mm
9.1
2.5
125
3897.0
Accessories/replacements VK-S/EM Order number 3899.0
Replacement blade
Base holes (DIN)
Dimensional drawings VK Height | side profile
25 mm | 30 mm
40 mm
60 mm
80 mm
100 mm
Dimensional drawings VK-HF
from 80 mm
up to 60 mm
Base holes (DIN)
Height | side profile
25 mm | 30 mm
0116 284 9900
40 mm
60 mm
80 mm
100 mm
from 80 mm
up to 60 mm
CABLE TRUNKING
| 23
CAM SWITCHES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
General information
26
Miniature cam switch 10 A
27
PR12, 20 A
29
Technical information
32
Accessories
33
Cam switches
General information
Functional and attractive design Our most common cam switch series PR12 is for currents up to 20 A and is a compact switch with a number of technical and practical benefits. More detailed information is provided below.
Dust-tight contacts Dust-tight contacts that do not separate if the cams are changed. Protective flashing with lifts and ± screw. Open terminals upon delivery.
Options for front Three different screw mounting options with 48 x 48 mm legend plate and short handle in standard execution. Also available in 64 x 64 or 72 x 72 mm legend and large handle or pistol grip.
Dual springs Distinct positions thanks to dual position springs.
Hole pattern alternatives, screw assembly Screw assembly PR12 always supplied with Alt. 1 as standard with options to have Alt. 2 & Alt. 3 if required
One-hole mount (Ø22.5 mm) with 48 x 48 mm legend and short handle as standard. Also available with selector switch handle or key switch head.
Alt. 1
Alt. 2
Alt. 3
Our technical department can build and deliver customer-unique cam switches within 24 hours. 26 | CAM SWITCHES
www.oem.co.uk
Cam switches
Miniature cam switch 10 A
TECHNICAL DATA
Rated isolation voltage (Ith)
• Compact size • Breaks up to 10 A • Easy to install, one-hole mount, Ø22.5 mm or Ø16 mm • IP65 The miniature cam switch is a small compact circuit-breaker designed to fit in small spaces, with requirements for high breaking capacity. The miniature cam switch can break up to 10 A. Installation is simple due to one-hole mounting - fits
1pole 2 pole 3pole
1-2 3-4 7-8 5-6 9-10 11-12 13-14 15-16 19-20
0116 284 9900
1 X
2
3
X
Connection & links
Legend
10 A
Thermal rated current (AC15)
2.5 A
Rated power AC3 (kW)
3 x 230 V
1.8 kW
3 x 380 V
2.2 kW
Max. cable area
both Ø16 mm or Ø22 mm. The terminal screws are mounted at a 45° angle, which facilitates connection of cables after the circuit-breaker is installed. Delivered complete with handle & legend.
Function (x indicates contact closed)
500 V
Thermal rated current (AC21)
2x1.5 mm²
Enclosure class on front
IP65
Operating temperature
-20 °C to +50 °C
Approval
EN 60947-1, EN 60947-3, EN 60947-5-1, UL508
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order no.
Description
223501
Miniature cam switch 1-pole 0-1 A4
223502
Miniature cam switch 2-pole 0-1 A4
223503
Miniature cam switch 3-pole 0-1 A4
223504
Miniature cam switch 4-pole 0-1 A4
223505
Miniature cam switch 1-pole 1-0-2 C8
223506
Miniature cam switch 2-pole 1-0-2 C8
223507
Miniature cam switch 3-pole 1-0-2 C8
223508
Miniature cam switch 4-pole 1-0-2 C8
223511
Miniature cam switch 1-pole 1-2 D4
223512
Miniature cam switch 2-pole 1-2 D4
223513
Miniature cam switch 3-pole 1-2 D4
223514
Miniature cam switch 4-pole 1-2 D4
223515
Miniature cam switch1-pole 1-2-3 A4
223516
Miniature cam switch 2-pole 1-2-3 A4
223517
Miniature cam switch 3-pole 1-2-3 A4
X X X X X X X
CAM SWITCHES
| 27
Cam switches
Miniature cam switch 10 A
1pole 2 pole 3pole
Function (x indicates contact closed)
0
2
1 X
1-2 3-4
3
X
Connection & links
Legend
Order no.
Description
223521
Miniature cam switch 1-pole 0-1-2-3 A4
223522
Miniature cam switch 2-pole 0-1-2-3 A4
223523
Miniature cam switch 3-pole 0-1-2-3 A4
223525
Miniature cam switch 1-pole 1-2-3-4 A4
223526
Miniature cam switch 2-pole 1-2-3-4 A4
223527
Miniature cam switch, Voltmeter switch
223528
Miniature cam switch, Voltmeter switch for neutral conductors
223529
Miniature cam switch, Ammeter switch
223520
Application tool for miniature cam switch
X X
7-8 5-6 9-10 11-12 13-14 15-16
X X X X
19-20
1pole 2 pole
X
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 9-10 11-12 13-14 15-16
28 | CAM SWITCHES
1 X
2
3
4
X X X X X X X
www.oem.co.uk
Cam switches
PR12, 20 A
TECHNICAL DATA
Rated isolation voltage Thermal rated current
• Backward facing screw terminals delivered open • Easy to change switch function • Steel shaft as standard
690 V Ith
20 A
Rated breaking current
AC21
16 A
Rated power AC3
3x 380 V
4 kW
Max. cable area
2 x 4 mm²
Enclosure class on front
IP40 (IP65 as option)
Lifetime (without load)
1.25 x 106 operations
Operating temperature
-20 °C to +70 °C
CE-marked per
CEE24, and EN60947-1/A11
Approval
UL file E57817 For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oem . c o . u k
Connection & links
Switch
Impulse switch Spring return to 0
Switch
Type
0116 284 9900
Function * (X indicates contact closed)
Order number incl. legend & handle Legend*
Execution
Screw assembly (A)
One-hole mount (B)
1-pole
PR121101A8
PR12X1101A8
2-pole
PR121102A8
PR12X1102A8
3-pole
PR121103A8
PR12X1103A8
4-pole
PR121104A8
PR12X1104A8
1-pole
PR121101AR10
PR12X1101AR10
2-pole
PR121102AR10
PR12X1102AR10
1-pole
PR122201CR12
PR12X2201CR12
2-pole
PR122202CR12
PR12X2202CR12
1-pole
PR122201C8
PR12X2201C8
2-pole
PR122202C8
PR12X2202C8
3-pole
PR122203C8
PR12X2203C8
4-pole
PR122204C8
1-pole
PR122201C8
PR12X2201C8
2-pole
PR122202C8
PR12X2202C8
3-pole
PR122203C8
4-pole
PR122204C8
PR12X2204C8
1-pole
PR122251D4
PR12X2251D4
2-pole
PR122252D4
PR12X2252D4
3-pole
PR122253D4
PR12X2253D4
4-pole
PR122254D4
PR12X2254D4
1-pole
PR122251D4
PR12X2251D4
2-pole
PR122252D4
PR12X2252D4
3-pole
PR122253D4
PR12X2253D4
4-pole
PR122254D4
PR12X2254D4
1-pole
PR122301A8
PR12X2301A8
CAM SWITCHES
| 29
Cam switches
PR12, 20 A Connection & links
Function* (X indicates contact closed)
Legend*
Execution
Order number incl. legend & handle Screw assembly (A)
One-hole mount (B)
1-pole
PR122351A8
PR12X2351A8
1-pole
PR122401A8
PR12X2401A8
1-pole
PR122451A8
PR12X2451A8
1-pole
PR125201A8
PR12X5201A8
1-pole
PR125301A8
PR12X5301A8
1-pole
PR126503A1
PR12X6503A1
1-pole
PR126507A1
PR12X6507A1
Switch
Type
30 | CAM SWITCHES
www.oem.co.uk
Cam switches
PR12, 20 A
Type
Connection & links
Legend
Order number incl. legend & handle Screw assembly (A)
One hole mount (B)
Ammeter switch for measurement with three current transformers that have common connection points
PR128351A4
PR12X8151A4
Voltmeter switch for measurement in 3-phase systems between phases or between phase and neutral
PR128357C8
PR12X8357C8
Voltmeter switch for measurement in 3-phase systems between phases
PR128351A4
PR12X8351A4
Forward/reverse switch for 3-phase motor
PR129151C8
PR12X9151C8
Forward/reverse switch for 1-phase motor
PR129051C8
PR12X9051C8
PR129551A8
PR12X9551A8
PR129552A8
PR12X9552A8
Y/D-switch
Dahlander-switch
Many other standard switching schemes are available. Please enquire for further details.
0116 284 9900
CAM SWITCHES
| 31
Cam switches
Technical information Cam switch and miniature cam switch The choice of switch depends on the load to be controlled. Cam switches are normally designed for AC voltage. When using DC voltage, consideration must be taken to the calculation table below. Connection and disconnection without load AC20 per IEC 60 947-3 Cam switch
Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
PR160
10
20
25
32
40
63
80
200
250
Approved current (A)
Connection of resistive load includes certain overload AC21 per IEC 60 947-3 Cam switch
Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
PR160
10
16
20
25
32
50
80
160
200
Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
PR160
2.5
6
8
10
12
-
-
-
-
PR160
Approved current (A)
Connection of electromagnetic load AC15 per IEC 60 947-5-1 vid 230 V AC Cam switch Approved current (A)
Motors and other high inductive loads AC23 per IEC 60 947-3 Cam switch
Approved current (kW)
Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
3x230 V
1.8
4.0
5.5
7.5
11.0
15.0
18.5
-
-
3x400 V
3.0
7.5
11.0
11.0
11.0
22.0
25.0
-
-
3x500 V
-
5.5
11.0
11.0
11.0
25.0
25.0
-
-
3x690 V
-
4.0
10.0
10.0
11.0
18.5
22.0
-
-
Short-circuited motors. Connection and disconnection of starting current Reversing and counter-current braking AC3 per IEC 60 947-3 Cam switch
Approved current P (kW)
Approved current P (Hp)
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
3x230 V
3.0
4.0
4.0
5.5
11.0
15.0
-
PR160 -
3x400 V
4.0
7.5
7.5
11.0
18.5
22.0
-
-
3x500 V
5.5
7.5
7.5
11.0
18.5
22.0
-
-
3x690 V
3.0
7.5
7.5
11.0
18.5
22.0
-
-
3x230 V
4.0
5.5
5.5
7.5
15.0
20.0
-
3x400 V
5.5
10.0
10.0
15.0
25.0
30.0
-
3x500 V
7.5
10.0
10.0
15.0
25.0
30.0
-
-
3x690 V
4.0
10.0
10.0
15.0
25.0
30.0
-
-
Rated isolation voltage (V) AC23 per IEC 60 947-3 Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
UTE-VDE-CEI (V)
Cam switch
500
660
690
690
660
660
660
660
PR160 660
CSA (Canada) (V)
-
600
600
600
600
600
600
600
600
UL (USA) (V)
-
600
600
600
600
600
600
600
600
CEE 24 (V)
-
400
400
400
400
400
400
-
-
Max. over-current (A) for 1 second Cam switch
Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
PR160
Current (A)
300
300
400
420
800
1200
1500
2400
3000
PR125
PR160
Max. cable area (mm²) Cam switch
Mini cam
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
Single conductor
1.5
4.0
6(4)*
6(4)*
6
16
16
Ø8 mm connection for cable lug
Multi conductor cable
1.5
2.5
4
4
6
16
16
Ø8 mm connection for cable lug
* When using cable sleeve
32 | CAM SWITCHES
www.oem.co.uk
Cam switches
Resistive or low inductive loads
K 1.0 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3
Load breaking with 2 connections
Load breaking with 1 connection
0.2 0.1 24
48
60
95
120
220
440
Volt
For DC voltage, this table is used to calculate breaking capacity (A). DC1 Amps at 24 V DC Cam switch
MK
PR12
PR17
PR21
PR26
PR40
PR63
PR125
PR160
Amps (A)*
10
16
20
25
32
50
80
-
-
Accessories PR12
Order number PN50
Description Handle, small, grey/black, for 5 mm shaft
PN51
Handle, small, red/red, for 5 mm shaft
PN53
Handle, small, black/black, for 5 mm shaft
MN50
Handle, medium, grey/black, for 5 mm shaft
MN51
Handle, medium, red/red, for 5 mm shaft
MN53
Handle, medium, black/black, for 5 mm shaft
PC50
Handle, piston grip, small, grey/black, for 5 mm shaft
Order number
Description
CQ48
Legend plate holder 48x48 mm for PR12, fits WE40
Q040
Holder for IF9 legend
IF9
Function label non-engraved
WE40
Legend plate 48 x 48 mm, non-engraved
WE60
Legend plate 64 x 64 mm, non-engraved
We can engrave legend plates & function labels to your exact requirement. Please enquire for further details.
0116 284 9900
CAM SWITCHES
| 33
CLIMATE CONTROL AND LIGHTING FOR ENCLOSURES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Convection heaters
36
Fan heaters
39
Thermostats
41
Humidistats
44
Fans & filters
46
Ceiling filter fans
47
Ventilation caps
48
Accessories
49
Lighting & sockets
50
Climate control & lighting
Heating element 5-13 W RCE016/RC016
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage
110-250 V* AC/DC or 12-36 V AC/DC
Heat source
PTC-element
Heating element
Aluminium
Connection
• Compact • UL approved • Self regulating (PTC)
2x0,25 mm² silicone cable
Enclosure class
IP54
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvals *With voltages under 140V AC heating output reduced by about 10% For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Max. starting current
Dimensions
110-250 V AC
2A
45 x 10 Ø
12-36 V AC/DC
4.5 A
45 x 10 Ø
110-250 V AC
2.5 A
45 x 10 Ø
12-36 V AC/DC
6A
45 x 10 Ø
160 °C
110-250 V AC
2A
30 x 25 x 12.5
Description
Heating output
Max surface temp (at +20 °C amb. temp)
01622.0-00
Heating element PTC RCE 016
5W
142 °C
01624.0-00
Heating element PTC RCE 016
5W
142 °C
01623.0-00
Heating element PTC RCE 016
10 W
180 °C
01625.0-00
Heating element PTC RCE 016
10 W
180 °C
09008.0-01
Mounting clips for heater RCE (2 st./frp.)
Order number
Voltage
RCE016
NOTE: For Heater RCE automatically follows no mounting clips. These must be ordered separately on Part 09008.0-01. See above RC016 01602.0-00
Heating element PTC RC 016
8W
01602.0-03
Heating element PTC RC 016
8W
160 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
4A
30 x 25 x 12.5
01609.0-00
Heating element PTC RC 016
10 W
150 °C
110-250 V AC
2.5 A
50 x 25 x 12.5
01610.0-00
Heating element PTC RC 016
13 W
170 °C
110-250 V AC
4A
60 x 25 x 12.5
01610.0-01
Heating element PTC RC 016
13 W
170 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
11 A
60 x 25 x 12.5
Heating element 10-30 W HGK047
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage
Enclosure
• • • •
110-250 V AC/DC (max. 265 V)
Heat source
ynamic heating (PTC-element) D Compact Energy saving DIN rail clip
PTC-element Anodized aluminum profile
Connection
30 cm silicone cable 3x0.75 mm
Installation
Quick fastner for 35 mm DIN-rail
Enclosure class
IP44
Safety class
I (Earthed)
Approvals *Heating output at 20 °C (room temperature). during operation under 140 V heating output is reduced by about 10 %. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Heating output*
Max surface temp (at +20 °C amb. temp)
Voltage
Max. starting current
Dimensions
04700.0-00
Heating element PTC HGK 047
10 W
70 °C
110-250 V
1A
52 x 50 x 25
04701.0-00
Heating element PTC HGK 047
20 W
110 °C
110-250 V
2.5 A
60 x 50 x 25 70 x 50 x 25
04702.0-00
Heating element PTC HGK 047
30 W
120 °C
110-250 V
3A
04700.9-00
Heating element PTC HGK 047
10 W
70 °C
110-120 V
1A
52 x 50 x 25
04701.9-00
Heating element PTC HGK 047
20 W
110 °C
110-120 V
1.5 A
70 x 50 x 25
04702.9-00
Heating element PTC HGK 047
30 W
120 °C
110-120 V
1.5 A
100 x 50 x 25
*Other voltage and cable lengths on request.
36 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Heater 10-20 W CSK060
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage
120-240 V AC/DC* **
Heat source
PTC-element (temperature limiting semiconductors)
Surface temperature at side
• Dual isolated (does not require earthing) • Innovative design and small size • Low element surface temperature • DIN rail clip
<85 °C (185 °F), however, heats area above the heater
Connection
2-pole terminal For 2.5 mm² cable (Recommended torque 0.8 Nm)
Installation
Bracket for 35 mm DIN rail vertical mounting
Enclosure
Plastic per UL94 V-0, black colour
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvals * During operation under 140 V AC/DC, heating output reduced by about 10 %.** Other voltages upon request For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Description
Output
Max. starting current
Weight
Dimensions
06040.0-00
Order number
Heater CSK060
10 W
1.0 A
0.2 kg
98 x 38 x 75 mm
06030.0-00
Heater CSK060
20 W
2.5 A
0.3 kg
98 x 38 x 75 mm
Heating element 15-150 W HG140
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage*
12-36 V AC/DC 110-250 V AC/DC (max. 265 V)
Heat source
• • • •
PTC-element
Enclosure
Dynamic heating (PTC-element) Compact Energy saving Quick connection/installation
Anodized aluminum profile
Connection
3 quick clamps for 0.5-2.5 mm² cable
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
I (Earthed)
Approvals *Heating output at 20°C (room temperature).During operation under 140V, heating output reduced by about 10%.
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Description
Output
Max. temp. (at +20 °C amb. temp.)
Voltage
Max. starting current
Weight (gram)
Dimensions
14000.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
15 W
70 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
1.5 A
300
65 x 70 x 60
14001.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
30 W
80 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
3A
300
65 x 70 x 60
14003.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
45 W
110 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
3.5 A
300
65 x 70 x 60
14005.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
60 W
90 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
2.5 A
400
140 x 70 x 60
14006.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
75 W
105 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
4A
500
140 x 70 x 60
14007.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
100 W
130 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
4.5 A
500
140 x 70 x 60
14008.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
150 W
130 °C
110-250 V AC/DC
9A
700
220 x 70 x 60
Order number
110-250 V AC/DC
12-36 V AC/DC 14010.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
15 W
70 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
9A
300
65 x 70 x 60
14011.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
30 W
80 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
14 A
300
65 x 70 x 60
14012.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
45 W
110 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
8A
300
65 x 70 x 60
14013.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
60 W
90 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
10 A
400
140 x 70 x 60
14014.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
75 W
105 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
14 A
500
140 x 70 x 60
14015.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
100 W
130 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
16 A
500
140 x 70 x 60
14016.0-00
Heating element PTC HG 140
150 W
130 °C
12-36 V AC/DC
23 A
700
220 x 70 x 60
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
37
Climate control & lighting
Heater 50-150 W CS060
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage
120-250 V AC/DC* **
Heat source
PTC-element (temperature limiting semiconductors)
Surface temp. at side
• Dual isolated (does not require earthing) • Small size • Low element surface temperature • DIN rail clip
<80 °C (175 °F), however, heats area above the heater)
Installation
4-pole terminal For 2.5 mm² cable. (Recommended torque 0.8 Nm)
Installation
Bracket for 35 mm DIN-rail. Vertical mounting.
Enclosure
Plastic per UL94 V-0, black
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvals *For operation under 140 V AC/DC,heating output is reduced by about 10 %.** Other voltages upon request For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Output
Max. starting current
Temperature 50 mm above heater
Weight
Dimensions
06000.0-00
Heater CS060
50 W
2.5 A
86 °C (186,8 °F)
0.29 kg
110 x 60 x 90 mm
06010.0-00
Heater CS060
100 W
4.5 A
120 °C (248 °F)
0.30 kg
110 x 60 x 90 mm
06020.0-00
Heater CS060
150 W
8A
145 °C (293 °F)
0.44 kg
150 x 60 x 90 mm
Heater 50-150 W CSF060
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage
120-250 V AC/DC* **
Heat source
PTC-element (temperature limiting semiconductor)
Surface temp. at side
• Dual isolated (does not require earthing) • Thermostat attached with specified values • Low element surface temperature • DIN rail clip
<80 °C (175 °F), (however, heats area above the heater)
Connection
4-pole terminal For 2.5 mm² cable. (Recommended torque 0.8 Nm)
Installation
Bracket For 35 mm DIN-rail. Vertical mounting.
Enclosure
Plastic per UL94 V-0, black
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvalsw *For operation under 140 V AC/DC,heating output is reduced by about 10 %.** Other voltages upon request For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Temperature for closing
Max. starting current
Temperature 50 mm above heater
Dimensions
15 °C (59 °F)
5 °C (41 °F)
2.5 A
86 °C (186,8 °F)
110 x 60 x 90 mm
25 °C (77 °F)
15 °C (59 °F)
2.5 A
86 °C (186,8 °F)
110 x 60 x 90 mm
100 W
15 °C (59 °F)
5 °C (41 °F)
4.5 A
120 °C (248 °F)
110 x 60 x 90 mm
Heater CSF060
100 W
25 °C (77 °F)
15 °C (59 °F)
4.5 A
120 °C (248 °F)
110 x 60 x 90 mm
Heater CSF060
150 W
15 °C (59 °F)
5 °C (41 °F)
8A
145 °C (293 °F)
150 x 60 x 90 mm
Heater CSF060
150 W
25 °C (77 °F)
15 °C (59 °F)
8A
145 °C (293 °F)
150 x 60 x 90 mm
Description
Output
Temperature for opening
06001.0-00
Heater CSF060
50 W
06002.0-00
Heater CSF060
50 W
06011.0-00
Heater CSF060
06012.0-00 06021.0-00 06022.0-00
Order number
38 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Heating fan 150 W CS028/CSL028 • • • •
TECHNICAL DATA Heat source
PTC-element
Enclosure
Very compact design Quiet operation Dynamic heating DIN rail clip
Plastic, UL94 V0, black
Connection
2-pole terminal For 2.5 mm² cable (Recommended torque 0.8 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail or screw bracket
Surface temperature
Enclosure: max. 30 ˚C, Upper grill: 110 °C
Air capacity
13.8 m³/h / 45 m³/h (CSL028)
Axial fan
Mounted in ball bearings, 50,000 h at +40 °C
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvals For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Description
Heating output (at 20 °C)
Max. starting current
Voltage*
Dimensions
02800.0-00
Heating fan CS028, For DIN-rail
150 W
12
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
75 x 65 x 90
02800.0-01
Heating fan CS028, For screw mount
150 W
12
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
75 x 65 x 90
02811.0-00
Heating fan CSL028, For DIN-rail
250 W
9
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
90 x 85 x 111
02811.0-01
Heating fan CSL028, For screw mount
250 W
9
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
90 x 85 x 111
02810.0-00
Heating fan CSL028, For DIN-rail
400 W
15
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
90 x 85 x 111
02810.0-01
Heating fan CSL028, For screw mount
400 W
15
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
90 x 85 x 111
Order number
*Other voltages available on request.
Heating fan 100-400 W HVL031
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage*
220-230 V AC, 50-60 Hz, 24 V DC
Heating element
High output immersion heater
Heating element enclosure
• • • •
DIN rail clip Compact UL-approved High fan capacity
Aluminium die casting Heater: 3-pole terminal block for 2.5 mm² cable (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm) Fan: 2-pole terminal block for 2.5 mm² cable (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Connection
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail
Axial fan
Mounted in ball bearings. 50,000 h lifetime at +25 °C
Air capacity
100/150 W: 35 m³/h free blowing 200/300/400 W: 108 m³/h free blowing
Thermostat
Upon fan stop
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
I (Earthed)
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Heating output
Operating voltage
Weight
Dimensions
03102.0-00
Heating fan HVL 031
100 W
220-230 V AC
530 g
80 x 112 x 47
03103.0-00
Heating fan HVL 031
150 W
220-230 V AC
570 g
80 x 112 x 47
03113.0-00
Heating fan HVL 031
200 W
220-230 V AC
860 g
119 x 151 x 47
03114.0-00
Heating fan HVL 031
300 W
220-230 V AC
860 g
119 x 151 x 47
03115.0-00
Heating fan HVL 031
400 W
220-230 V AC
860 g
119 x 151 x 47
03102.0-01
Heating fan HVL 031
100 W
24 V DC
550 g
80 x 112 x 47
*Other voltages available on request.
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
39
Climate control & lighting
Heating fan 250-400 W HGL046 • • • •
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage* Heat source
220-240 V AC, 50-60 Hz or 24 V DC Resistor element with integrated safety thermostat
Max. surface temp.
Compact High heating output Long lifetime Maintenance-free
Approx. 75 °C
Air volume
AC: 45 m³/h (50 Hz), DC: 54 m³/h
Enclosure
Anodized aluminum profile
Connection
3-pole terminal block for 2.5 mm² cable (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
I (Earthed)
Approvals * At operating below 140 V AC / DC Heating output is reduced by about 10%. Other ** voltage on request For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Voltage*
Heating output
Weight (kg)
Dimensions
Heating fan HGL 046
230 V AC, 50-60 Hz
250 W
1.1
182 x 85 x 100
04641.0-00
Heating fan HGL 046
230V AC, 50-60 Hz
400 W
1.4
222 x 85 x 100
04640.1-00
Heating fan HGL 046
24 V DC
250 W
1.0
182 x 85 x 100
04640.0-00
*Other voltages upon request
Heating fan 350-550 W CR027
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage
• Integrated thermostat • Indication light on front • Modern design
220-230 V AC, 50-60 Hz, 100-120 V AC 50-60 Hz
Heat source
PTC-element
Enclossure
Plastic UL 94 VO
Connection
2-pole terminal block for 2.5 mm² cable (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastner For 35 mm DIN-rail
Temp. regulation
Setting range 0 °C to +60 °C
Thermostat Axial fan
Upon fan stop Mounted in ball bearings. 50,000 h lifetime at +25 °C
Air capacity
475 W: 35 m³/h 550 W: 45 m³/h
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (Double insulated)
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Voltage
Heating output (at 20 °C)
Starting current
Weight
Dimensions
02700.0-00
Heating fan CR 027
220-230 V
475 W
11 A
900 g
165 x 100 x 128
02701.0-00
Heating fan CR 027
220-230 V
550 W
13 A
1.1 kg
165 x 100 x 128
02700.9-00
Heating fan CR 027
100-120 V AC
400 W
14 A
900 g
165 x 100 x 128
02701.9-00
Heating fan CR 027
100-120 V AC
510 W
15 A
1.1 kg
165 x 100 x 128
40 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Heating fan 700-950 W CR030/CR130
TECHNICAL DATA Heat source
Aluminium
Enclosure
• Compact design • Dual enclosure • Integrated thermostat or hygrostat
Plastic, UL94 V0, svart
Connection
3-pole terminal For 2.5 mm² cable
Installation
Screw bracket
Thermostat
Upon fan stop
Storage temperature
-45 °C to +70 °C
Air capacity
160 m³/h
Axial fan
Mounted in ball bearings, 50,000 h at +25 °C
Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oem . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Voltage
Heating output
Setting range
Dimensions
03051.0-00
With thermostat
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
950 W
0 °C to 60 °C
168 x 145 x 100
03051.0-02
With hygrostat
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
950 W
65 % RH
168 x 145 x 100
03059.9-00
With thermostat
120 V AC, 50/60 Hz
700 W
0 °C to 60 °C
168 x 145 x 100
TYPE CR030 for base of enclosures
TYPE CR130 for wall fixing 13051.0-00
With thermostat
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
950 W
0 °C to 60 °C
182 x 160 x 67
13051.0-02
With hygrostat
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
950 W
65 % RH
182 x 160 x 67
13059.9-00
With thermostat
120 V AC, 50/60 Hz
700 W
0 °C to 60 °C
182 x 160 x 67
Thermostat FTO011/FTS011
TECHNICAL DATA Hysteresis
± 5°C to ± 7°C
Sensing
Bi-metal
Contact type
• • • • •
Small size Preset values Simple installation Innovative design Tamper proof
Instantaneous contact NO or NC
Breaking capacity
240 V AC 5(1.6) ADC 30 W
Closing capacity
16 A starting current
Enclosure
UL94 VO, light grey
Connection
2-pole terminal block 2.5 mm² (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.8 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail. Can also be easily fitted on the exit cover grill
Enclosure class
IP20
Electrical lifetime
>100,000 cycles
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Description
Contact
Temperature for opening
Temperature for closing
Dimensions
01160.0-00
Order number
Thermostat FTO011
Opening (NC)
15 °C/59 °F (±5K)
5 °C/41 °F (±5K)
47 x 33 x 33 mm
01160.0-01
Thermostat FTO011
Opening (NC)
25 °C/77 °F (±5K)
15 °C/59 °F (±5K)
47 x 33 x 33 mm
Order number
Description
Contact
Temperature for opening
Temperature for opening
Dimensions
01161.0-00
Thermostat FTS011
Closing (NO)
50 °C/122 °F (±6K)
40 °C/104 °F (±7K)
47 x 33 x 33 mm
01161.0-01
Thermostat FTS011
Closing (NO)
60 °C/140 °F (±6K)
50 °C/122 °F (±7K)
47 x 33 x 33 mm
01161.0-02
Thermostat FTS011
Closing (NO)
35 °C/95 °F (±6K)
25 °C/77 °F (±7K)
47 x 33 x 33 mm
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
41
Climate control & lighting
Duel thermostat FTD011
TECHNICAL DATA Hysteresis
± 5°C to ± 7°C
Bi-metal
Sensing Contact type
• Two thermostats in one housing • Small format • Preset values • Simple installation • Tamper proof
Instantaneous contact NC/NO or NO/NO
Breaking capacity
240 V AC 5 (1.6) A DC 30 W
Closing capacity
16 A starting current
Enclosure
Plastic UL94 VO, light grey
Connection
2-pole terminal block 2.5 mm² (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.8 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail. Can also be easily fitted on the exit cover grill
Enclosure class
IP20
Electrical lifetime
>100.000 cycles
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Temperature, opening(NC)
Temperature,closing (NC)
Temperature,closing (NO)
Temperature,opening (NO)
Dimensions
01163.0-00
Thermostat FTD011
15 °C/59 °F (±5K)
5 °C/41 °F (±5K)
50 °C/122 °F (±6K)
40 °C/104 °F (±7K)
47 x 67 x 33
01163.0-01
Thermostat FTD011
25 °C/77 °F (±5K)
15 °C/59 °F (±5K)
60 °C/140 °F (±6K)
50 °C/122 °F (±7K)
47 x 67 x 33
Description
Temperature, closing (NO)
Temperature, opening (NO)
Temperature, closing (NO)
Temperature, opening (NO)
Dimensions
Thermostat FTD011
50 °C/122 °F (±6K)
40 °C/104 °F (±7K)
60 °C/140 °F (±6K)
50 °C/122 °F (±7K)
47 x 67 x 33
Order number 01164.0-00
TECHNICAL DATA
Thermostat KTO 011/KTS 011
Hysteresis
7 °C ±4 °C
Sensing
Bi-metal
Contact type
• Simple installation • Wide regulation range 0 °C to +60 °C • UL-approved
Instantaneous contact NC or NO
Breaking capacity
250 V AC: 10 A resistive load, 2 A inductive load (cosϕ=0.6) DC: 30 W
Closing capacity
16 A starting current
Enclosure
Plastic UL94 VO
Connection
2-pole terminal block 2.5 mm² (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail. Can also be easily snapped in place on the exit cover grill
Regulating range*
0 °C to +60 °C
Enclosure class
IP20
Electrical lifetime
>100,000 cycles
Approvals * Other regulating ranges, such as -10 °C to +50 °C, +20 °C to +80 °C upon request. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Dimensions
01140.0-00
Thermostat KTO 011, 0 °C to +60 °C, 1 NC-contact
60 x 33 x 43
01141.0-00
Thermostat KTS 011, 0 °C to +60 °C , 1 NO-contact
60 x 33 x 43
01146.9-00
Thermostat KTO 011, 0 °C to +60 °C, 1 NC-contact
60 x 33 x 43
01147.9-00
Thermostat KTS 011, 0 °C to +60 °C , 1 NO-contact
60 x 33 x 43
42 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Dual thermostat ZR011
TECHNICAL DATA Hysteresis
• Compact • Separately adjustable max. and min. temp • High breaking capacity
7 °C ±4 °C
Sensing
Bi-metal
Contact
Instantaneous contacts NO+NC
Breaking capacity
6 A 250 V AC, DC: 30 W
Closing capacity
16 A starting current
Enclosure
Plastic UL94 VO
Connection
4-pole screw terminal block (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail
Regulating range*
0 °C to +60 °C
Operating/storage temps.
-45 °C to +80 °C
Enclosure class
IP20
Contact resistance
<10 mΩ
Electrical lifetime
>100,000 cycles
Approvals * Other regulating ranges, such as -10 °C to +50 °C, +20 °C to +80 °C upon request. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order number 01172.0-00
Description
Dimensions
Thermostat ZR011, 0-60 °C, 1 NC & 1 NO, separate contacts
67 x 50 x 46
Thermostat FZK011
TECHNICAL DATA Hysteresis
• • • •
Low hysteresis Simple installation Change-over contact High breaking capacity
4 °C±1.5 °C*
Breaking capacity
NC: 10 A (4) 250 V AC DC 30 WNO: 5 A (2) 250 V AC. DC 30 W
Closing capacity
16 A starting current
Enclosure
Plastic UL94 V-O
Connection
4-pole terminal block 2.5 mm² (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail
Regulating range
0 °C to +60 °C
Enclosure class
IP20
Electrical lifetime
>100,000 cycles
Approvals * If the output resister RF is connected to 230 V AC per the figure below, hysteresis is reduced to 0.5 °±1.5 °.
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Description
Voltage
Dimensions
01170.0-00
Order no.
Thermostat FZK 011 0-60 °C. 1 change-over contact
230 V AC
67 x 50 x 38
01170.9-01
Thermostat FZK 011 0-60 °C. 1 change-over contact
120 V AC
67 x 50 x 38
01170.0-02
Thermostat FZK 011 -20 to +35 °C. 1 change-over contact
230 V AC
67 x 50 x 38
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
43
Climate control & lighting
Thermostat ET011
TECHNICAL DATA Hysteresis
±3 °C
Operating voltage
24 V DC (±4 V)
Temperature range*
0 °C to +60 °C
Sensor element
• Fully electronic • Low hysteresis • Floating contact
PTC
Contact type
Floating, change-over contact
Lifetime
>100 000 cycles
Max. breaking capacity
16 A, 24 V DC. (resistive load)
Connection
Screw terminal block, max. 2.5 mm². (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Clips For 35 mm DIN-rail
Enclosure
Plastic UL94 V-0
Safety class
IP20
Approvals *Other temperature ranges upon request. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number 01190.0-00
Description
Dimensions
Electronic thermostat ET011 0 °C to +60 °C. Floating change-over contact
67 x 50 x 46
Electronic hygrotherm ETF012 • • • •
TECHNICAL DATA
Temperature & humidity regulation LED indication of active values High breaking capacity DIN rail clip
Hysteresis (temperature)
2 °C (±1 °C)
Hysteresis (humidity)
4 % (±1 %) rF
Reaction time, moisture
Approx. 160 sec.
Contact type
Change-over relay
Contact resistance
<10 mΩ
Electrical lifetime
>100,000 cycles
Breaking capacity
240 V AC, 10 A (resistive load)120 V AC, 10 A (resistive load) 240 V AC, 3 A (inductive load, cosϕ=0.6) 120 V AC, 3 A (inductive load, cosϕ=0.6) 24 V DC, 4 A
Closing capacity
30 A AC
Connection
5-pole terminal block for 2.5 mm² cable
Installation
Snap bracket for 35 mm DIN rail
Storage temperature
-20 °C to +80 °C
Enclosure
Plastic, UL94 V0
Enclosure class
IP20
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order no.
Description
Voltage
Temperature
Humidity (rF)
Dimensions
01230.0-00
Electronic hygrotherm ETF012
230 V AC
0-60 °C
50-90 %
77 x 60 x 43
01230.9-00
Electronic hygrotherm ETF012
120 V AC
32-140 °F
50-90 %
77 x 60 x 43
01230.9-01
Electronic hygrotherm ETF012
120 V AC
0-60 °C
50-90 %
77 x 60 x 43
44 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Mechanical hygrostat MFR012
TECHNICAL DATA
• Simple installation • Change-over contact • High breaking capacity
Setting range
35 – 95 % RH
Hysteresis at 50 % RH
4 % RH (+/-3 %)
Contact type
Change-over relay Resistive load 5 A, 230 V AC Inductive load cosj = 0.8 0.2 A 230 V AC Inductive load L/R 0.3 ms 1 A up to 50 V DC
Breaking capacity Minimum switching capacity
100 mA 20 V AC/DC
Electrical lifetime
> 50,000 cycles
Permissable air velocity
15 m/sec
Enclosure
Plastic
Enclosure class
IP20
Connection
3-pole terminal block 2.5 mm² (recommended tightening torque for terminal screws: 0.5 Nm)
Installation
Quick fastner For 35 mm DIN-rail
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order number 01220.0-00
Description
Humidity (RH)
Dimensions
Hygrostat MFR012 1 change-over contact
35-95 %
67 x 50 x 38
Electronic hygrostat EFR012 • • • •
TECHNICAL DATA
Adjustable or pre-set RH Compact High breaking capacity Simple mounting, quick installation
Hysteresis at 50% RH
5% RH (± 3% RH)
Contact type
Change-over relay
Electrical lifetime
> 50 000 cycles
Breaking capacity max.
230 V AC 8 A (resistive load) 230 V AC 0.2 A (inductive load cosϕ=0.8) DC 100 W at 24 V DC
Optical indicator
LED
Connection
5-pole terminal for 2.5 mm cable
Installation
Snap bracket for 35 mm DIN-rail
Enclosure
Plastic, UL94 V0
Enclosure class
IP20
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Voltage
Humidity (RH)
Dimensions
01245.0-00
Hygrostat EFR 012 CO-contacts
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
40-90% RH
65 x 42 x 38
01246.0-00
Hygrostat EFR 012 CO-contacts
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
65% RH pre-set
65 x 42 x 38
01246.0-01
Hygrostat EFR 012 CO-contacts
230 V AC, 50/60 Hz
50% RH pre-set
65 x 42 x 38
01245.9-00
Hygrostat EFR 012 CO-contacts
120 V AC, 50/60 Hz
40-90% RH
65 x 42 x 38
01246.9-00
Hygrostat EFR 012 CO-contacts
120 V AC, 50/60 Hz
65% RH pre-set
65 x 42 x 38
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
45
Climate control & lighting
Filter fans FF018
TECHNICAL DATA
• • • •
Quick installation Minimal installation depth Low noise level IP55 as standard
Type
01800
01801
01802
01804
01803
01805
Air volume Free blowing
21 m³/h
55 m³/h
102 m³/h
200 m³/h
300 m³/h
550 m³/h
With exit filter
16 m³/h
42 m³/h
68 m³/h
125 m³/h
230 m³/h
315 m³/h
Power consumption
80 mA
100 mA
100 mA
320 mA
400 mA
300 mA
Outputconsumption
13 W
15 W
15 W
45 W
60 W
64 W
Cut-outs (mm)
97 x 97 +0.4
125 x 125 +0.4
176 x 176 +0.4
176 x 176 +0.4
250 x 250 +0.4
250 x 250 +0.4
-30 °C to +70 °C
-30 °C to +70 °C
-30 °C to +70 °C
-30 °C to +70 °C
-30 °C to +70 °C
-30 °C to +70 °C
220-230 V AC, 50 Hz
220-230 V AC, 50 Hz
220-230 V AC, 50 Hz
220-230 V AC, 50 Hz
220-230 V AC, 50 Hz
220-230 V AC, 50 Hz
Operating temperature Operating voltage** Lifetime
50000 h at +25 °C
Safety class
I (Earthed)
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Air volume (with exit filter)
01800.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC
21 m³/h
01800.1-00
Filter fan 230 V AC. EMC-version
21 m³/h
01801.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC
55 m³/h
01801.1-00
Filter fan 230 V AC. EMC-version
55 m³/h
01802.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC
102 m³/h
01802.1-00
Filter fan 230 V AC. EMC-version
102 m³/h
01803.1-00
Filter fan 230 V AC. EMC-version (4 pcs. fans)
300 m³/h
01804.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC
200 m³/h
01804.1-00
Filter fan 115 V AC
200 m³/h
01803.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC (4 pcs. fans)
300 m³/h
01805.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC
550 m³/h
11800.0-00
Exhaust hood 97X97 mm
11800.1-00
Exhaust hood 97X97 mm, EMC-version
11801.0-00
Exhaust hood 125x125 mm, standard to 01801.0-00
11801.1-00
Exhaust hood 125x125 mm, EMC-version
11802.0-00
Exhaust hood 176x176 mm
11802.1-00
Exhaust hood 176x176 mm, EMC-version
11803.0-00
Exhaust hood 250x250 mm
11803.1-00
Exhaust hood 250x250 mm, EMC-version
Filter fan for outdoor use
TECHNICAL DATA
FF018
Operating voltage Air volume (free blowing) Current/power consumption
• Lockable cover • Filter replaceable from outside • Protected against the elements
Noise level (1 m distance)
230 V AC, 50 Hz 20 m³/h 100 mA/15 W 40 dB (A) per DIN EN ISO 9614-2
Hole pattern
125 x 125 mm +0.4 mm
Filter mat
F5 (filtering degree 98 %)
Enclosure class Safety class
IP55 I (Earthed|)
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
01821.0-00
Filter fan 230 V AC 20 m³/h. For outdoor use
01821.0-02
Filter fan 120 V AC 23 m³/h. For outdoor use
11821.0-00
Exit filter 125 x 125 mm. For outdoor use
46 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Roof filter fan RFP018
TECHNICAL DATA Connection
3-pole terminal block for 2.5 mm², tightening torque 0.8 Nm max.
Enclosure
Plastic, UL94 V-0, light grey, UV durability per UL746C (f1) Axial, mounted in ball bearings 50,000 hours lifetime at +25 °C, 65 % RH
Fan
• Very low noise level • Minimal construction depth • Operationally reliable with long lifetime • Simple installation
G3 per DIN EN 779, filtering degree 85 %, temperature resistant to 100 °C, self-extinguishing class F1
Filter mat Temperature range Operation/storage
-45 to +70 °C (-49 to +158 °F)
Enclosure class
IP32 with filter mat G3 per DIN EN779. Filtering 85 %
Safety class
I (Earthed)
Approvals
RoHS
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oem . c o . u k
Roof filter fan Order no.RFP018
Operating voltage
Air volume freeblowing with G3 filter
Air volume freeblowing without filter
Power consumption
Noise level dB (A)
Construction depth in the enclosure (mm)
Weight (kg) 3.3
01860.0-00
230 V AC, 50 Hz
300 m³/h
400 m³/h
68 W
55
52
01861.0-00
230 V AC, 50 Hz
500 m³/h
650 m³/h
64 W
67
107
2.6
01860.0-02
120 V AC, 60 Hz
345 m³/h
460 m³/h
60 W
55
52
3.3
01861.0-02
120 V AC, 60 Hz
575 m³/h
748 m³/h
85 W
67
107
2.6
Roof exit filter REP118 Order no.
11860.0-00
11
1.0
Filter mat Order no. FM086 01860.0-00
Roof filter RFF018
Description
Size (mm)
Filter G3, 3 pcs. per carton
282x282
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage*
230 V AC, 50 Hz 350 m³/h (with filter G3) freeblowing 500 m³/h without filter mat
Air volume
• Very low noise level • Minimum mounting depth • Ease of Installation
Fan
Ball bearing. 50,000 hours Lifetime at +25 ° C, 65% RH
Noise level (1 m distance)
45 dB(A)
Enclosure class
IP54 with filter mat G3 (IP33 without filter mat)
Approvals
* Other voltages on request. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oem . c o . u k
Order number 01850.0-00
Description Ceiling exhaust hood with filters
11850.0-00
Ceiling exhaust hood with filters
08613.0-00
Filter mat 282 x 282 mm. 3 pcs. in carton
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
47
Climate control & lighting
Drainage device DD 084
• • • •
TECHNICAL DATA Mounting
High degree of protection Good drainage performance Easy to install Robust, weather and UV light protected housing
M50 x 1.5 nut (wrench size 60mm, housing 50mm)
Torque
6Nm max
Material
Plastic UL94 V-0, umbra grey
Water entry height
0mm (at 0.5mm wall thickness)
Sealing
Sealing gasket NBR
Water flow through
approx 200 ml/h at a water column of 5mm
Fitting position
Vertical, lowest point
Operating temperature
-45° to +70°C
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number 08410.0-00
Description
Dimensions
Drainage device
Ø 60 x 49.5 mm
TECHNICAL DATA
Ventilation housing DA284 DA284
Type
Plastic housing UL
Plastic housing UL
Plastic housing
Stainless steel cover
M40x1.5 thread with nut
M12x1.5 thread with nut
M40x1.5 thread with nut
M40x1.5 thread with nut
Polyamid 6, light grey
Stainless steel V2A (DIN 1.4404 7 AISI 316 L)
Installation
• High enclosure class - IP66 • Double-acting membrane • Stainless steel housing for the food industry
Material
Plastic UL94 V-0, light grey
Filter
Waterproof membrane 1200 l/h at pressure >70 mbar
Air capacity Operating temp
120 l/h at pressure >70 mbar
1200 l/h at pressure >70 mbar
-45 °C to +70 °C
Enclosure class
1200 l/h at pressure >70 mbar
-40 °C to +80 °C IP66
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
28400.0-00
Ventilation housing DA284, polyamide (2 pcs)
28401.0-00
Ventilation housing DA284, stainless steel (1 pc)
28400.0-01
Ventilation housing DA284, polyamide (1 pc)
Pressure compensation device DA 084 • High degree of protection • Easy to install
TECHNICAL DATA Mounting
PG 29 thread with union nut
Torque
5Nm (max 10Nm)
Material
Plastic UL94 V-0, light grey, weather proof and UV light resistant to UL746C (f1)
Sealing
Sealing gasket NBR
Air interface
Approx 1.5cm2
Fitting position Operating temperature
Vertical* -45° to +70°C
*Protection type is restricted to IP54 if fitting position of DA 084 is not vertical
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number 08400.0-03
48 | CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING
Description
Dimensions
Pressure compensation device
Ø 65.5 x 30.5 mm
www.oem.co.uk
Climate control & lighting
Door contact DS013
TECHNICAL DATA Material/Enclosure
Plastic UL94 V-0, grey/black
Max. switching capacity
• • • •
Adjustable positioning without tools High switching capacity (10A) Double strain relief Suitable for LED025
250VAC, 10 A 4-pole spring clamp with strain relief clamping torque max. 0.5 Nm
Connection Lifetime
VDE:> 10,000 cycles UL> 6000 cycles
Mounting
Screw mounting (M5)
Operating temperature
-20 to +85 °C (-4 to +185 °F)
Storage temperature
-20 to +85 °C (-4 to +185 °F)
Work / storage humidity
max. 90% RH (non-condensing)
Enclosure class
IP20
Approvals Approvals pending
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oem . c o . u k Order no.
Suitable wire size
Contact
Dimensions
02540.0-00
Round wire, stranded (with ferrule) 0.75 mm² to 1.0 mm²
Change-over (NC/NO)
87 x 64 x 30
02540.0-01
Round wire, stranded (with ferrule) 0.75 mm² to 1.5 mm²
Normally closed (NC)
87 x 64 x 30
02540.1-00
Round wire, stranded (with ferrule) 0.75 mm² to 1.5 mm²
Normally open (NO)
87 x 64 x 30
Outlet with quick connection SD035 • Din rail clips • Push clamps • With or without fuse holder
Order no.
TECHNICAL DATA Rated voltage
250 V AC max.
Rated current
16 A max. without fuse holder 6.3 A with fuse folder
Connection
3 push clamps for cable ≤2.5 mm²
Installation
Quick fastener for 35 mm DIN rail
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Description
Dimensions
With fuse holder
03500.0-00
Electrical outlets for DIN rail, Germany/Nordic countries/Russia standard
92 x 62 x 48
03501.0-00
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, France/Poland standard
92 x 62 x 48
03502.0-00
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, Switzerland standard r
92 x 62 x 48
03503.0-00
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, UK standard
92 x 62 x 48
03504.0-00
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, USA/Canada standard
92 x 62 x 48
03505.0-00
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, Italy standard
92 x 62 x 48
Without fuse holder
03500.0-01
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, Germany/Nordic countries/Russia standard
92 x 62 x 48
03501.0-01
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, France/Poland standard
92 x 62 x 48
03502.0-01
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, Switzerland standard
92 x 62 x 48
03503.0-01
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, UK standard (4)
92 x 62 x 48
03504.0-01
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, USA/Canada standard
92 x 62 x 48
03505.0-01
Electrical outlet for DIN rail, Italy standard
92 x 62 x 48
0116 284 9900
CLIMATE CONTROL & LIGHTING |
49
Lighting Cabinet LED lighting LED025
TECHNICAL DATA
Material/Enclosure
Plastic, transparent
Operating voltage
24-48 V DC (min. 20 V DC max. 60 V DC) or100-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz (min. 90 V AC max. 265 V AC)
Power consumption
• • • • •
LED lighting Very long lifetime Wide voltage range Quick connection PIR sensor option
Max. 5 W (=75 W light bulb)
Luminance
900 lm
Lifetime, lamp
60,000 hrs at 20 °C (68 °F)
Light type
LED, angle of light 120°, Colour tone: daylight, Colour temperature: 6500 K (Kelvin)
Mounting
Magnetic, screw or clip 2-pole quick-connectorAC: max. 2.5 A/240 V AC, connection: whiteDC: max. 2.5 A/60 V DC, connection: blue
Connection Enclosure class
IP20
Safety class
II (double insulated)
Approvalss
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order no.
Description
Magnetic fixing
Screw fixing
Clip fixing
02540.0-00
02540.0-01
02540.0-03
02540.1-00
02540.1-01
02540.2-00
02540.2-01
02541.0-00 02541.1-00
Dimensions Magnetic fixing
Screw fixing
Clip fixing
Cabinet lighting LED025 100-230 V AC, on/off switch
351 x 34 x 32
351 x 36 x 52
351 x 42 x 40
02540.1-03
Cabinet lighting LED025 24-48 V DC, on/off switch
351 x 34 x 32
351 x 36 x 52
351 x 42 x 40
02540.2-03
Cabinet lighting LED025 12 V DC, on/off switch
351 x 34 x 32
351 x 36 x 52
351 x 42 x 40
02541.0-01
02541.0-03
Cabinet lighting LED025 100-230 V AC, PIR sensor
351 x 39 x 32
351 x 41 x 52
351 x 47.3 x 40
02541.1-01
02541.1-03
Cabinet lighting LED025 24-48 V DC, PIR sensor
351 x 39 x 32
351 x 41 x 52
351 x 47.3 x 40
Cabinet lighting SL025
TECHNICAL DATA Operating voltage Power consumption
• Quick installation • Low energy fluorescent lamp • Integrated outlet
230 V AC, 120 V AC (other voltage upon request, such as 48 V DC and 24 V DC) 11 W (=75 W light bulb) at 230 V AC13 W (=90 W light bulb) at 120 V
Luminance
900 lm
Lifetime, lamp
5000 h
Lamp
Low energy lamp, 2G7 socket
Connection
3-pole screw terminal block for 2.5 mm² cable
Operating/storage temperature
-30 °C to +60 °C
Enclosure class
IP20
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order no.
Description
Dimensions
02523.0-00
Cabinet lighting SL025, 230 V AC, UK outlet
345 x 91 x 40
02523.0-03
Cabinet lighting SL025, 230 V AC, IR sensor, UK outlet
345 x 91 x 40
02527.0-00
Cabinet lighting SL025, 230 V AC, no outlet
345 x 91 x 40
02523.1-05
Cabinet lighting SL025, 230 V AC, with magnetic bracket, UK outlet
345 x 91 x 40
02523.1-04
Cabinet lighting SL025, 230 V AC, IR sensor with magnetic bracket, UK outlet
345 x 91 x 40
02527.1-15
Cabinet lighting SL025, 230 V AC, IR sensor with magnetic bracket, no outlet
345 x 91 x 40
Other models, e.g., without outlet, upon request.
50 | LIGHTING
www.oem.co.uk
Lighting
Cabinet lighting KL025
TECHNICAL DATA Light source
Compact fluorescent lamp 230 V
Output
11 W (=75 W light bulb)
Supply voltage
• • • •
Industrially designed Strong magnet – easy installation Low energy fluorescent lamp Integrated outlet
230 V
Outlet
Protective earth. Max. 16 A
Connection
3-pole screw terminal block 2.5 mm² with strain relief
Installation
Magnetic bracket. Holding force approx. 20 kp on painted steel plate
Enclosure
Plastic
Enclosure class
IP20
Connection
3-pole terminal block 2.5 mm²
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order no.
Description
Dimensions
02510.0-00
Cabinet lighting KL025 230 V/50 Hz, with magnetic bracket and UK outlet
355 x 65 x 70
02500.0-07
Cabinet lighting KL025 230 V/50 Hz, with magnetic bracket, no outlet
355 x 65 x 70
02505.9-01
Cabinet lighting KL025 120 V/60 Hz, with magnetic bracket, no outlet
355 x 65 x 70
09520.0-00
Lamp lens in transparent plastic
Please note all lamps are supplied without the lens
Please note lamps require lamp lens
Hand lamp DL026
TECHNICAL DATA Light source
Energy conserving lamp, socket E27
Output
20 W (=100 W light bulb)
Supply voltage
• Industrially designed • Flexible • High luminance
230 V
Connection
2 m cable with plug
Installation
Self-adhesive mounting bases
Enclosure class
IP20
Approvals
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order no.
Description
Dimensions
02610.0-00
Hand lamp with wall bracket and hanging hook 230 V AC
337 x 84 x 68
02614.0-00
Hand lamp with wall bracket and hanging hook 24 V DC
337 x 84 x 68
0116 284 9900
LIGHTING |
51
CONTROL RELAYS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Phase control
54
Level control
55
Current control
56
Voltage control
57
Control relays
Phase control
Phase failure (presence) Phase sequence Phase balance & level of asymmetry Adjustment of voltage thresholds (over & under-voltage) • Adjustable time delay • • • •
Type
Regeneration
Sequence/ asymmetry
Over-voltage/under-voltage
Timing
Changeover output relay
Housing width (mm)
Meas. range (self-powered) 50/60 Hz
84 873 021
MWS2
No
Yes/no
No/no
No
2x5A
17.5
183 to 484 VAC
84 873 022
MWG
70%
Yes/no
No/no
No
1x5A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
84 873 023
MWU
70%
Yes/no
No/-20 to -2%
0.1 s to 10 s
1x5A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
84 873 024
MWA
70%
Yes/5 to 15%
No/no
0.1 s to 10 s
1x5A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
84 873 025
MWUA
70%
Yes/5 to 15%
±2 to ±20%
0.1 s to 10 s
1x5A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
87 873 026
HWUA
No
Yes/5 to 15%
+2 to +20%/-20 to -2%
0.3 s to 30 s
2x5A
35
194 to 528 VAC
84 873 029
MWS
No
Yes/no
No/no
No
1x8A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
84 873 034
EWS2
No
Yes/no
No/no
No
2x8A
22.5
194 to 484 VAC
84 873 220
H3US
No
No/no
+2 to +20%/-20 to -2%
0.3 s to 30 s
2x5A
35
194 to 528 VAC
84 873 222
M3US
No
No/no
+2 to +20%/-20 to -2%
0.3 s to 30 s
1x5A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
84 903 020 (A)
EMWS
No
Yes/no
No/no
No
1x5A
17.5
183 to 528 VAC
No
No/no
+2 to +20%/-20 to -2%
0.3 s to 30 s
2x5A
35
96 to 332 VAC
Part number Phase failure
Loss of phase and neutral 84 873 221
H3USN
54 | CONTROL RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Control relays
Level control
Part number
• Automation of filling & emptying cycles • High or low level control • Check for presence of a conductive or non-conductive liquid by resistive probe or discrete sensor • Adjustable time delay
Timing
Changeover output relay
Housing width (mm)
Supply
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
22.5
24 to 240 VAC/VDC
1 or 2/250 Ω to 1 MΩ
0.1 s to 5 s
1x8A
22.5
24 to 240 VAC/VDC
1 or 2/250 Ω to 1 MΩ
0.1 s to 5 s
2x5A
35
24 to 240 VAC/VDC
Yes/yes
1 or 2/none
0.1 s to 5 s
1x5A
35
24 to 240 VAC/VDC
Digital
No/yes
1/none
0.1 s to 5 s
1x5A
17.5
24 to 240 VAC/VDC
24 VAC
Type
Probe
Emptying/filling
84 870 200
ENR
Resistive
Yes/yes
84 870 210
ENRM
Resistive
Yes/yes
84 870 700
HNM
Resistive
Yes/yes
84 870 710
HNE
Digital or PNP/NPN
84 870 720
MNS
Level/measurement range
Modular housing
Industrial housing 84 870 501
FN
Resistive
Yes/yes + alarm
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
2x8A
45
84 870 502
FN
Resistive
Yes/yes + alarm
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
2x8A
45
48 VAC
84 870 503
FN
Resistive
Yes/yes + alarm
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
2x8A
45
120 VAC
84 870 504
FN
Resistive
Yes/yes + alarm
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
2x8A
45
230 VAC
84 870 803
FN LS
Resistive
Yes/yes + alarm
2/250 Ω to 5 KΩ
No
2x8A
45
230 VAC
84 870 301
LN
Resistive
No/yes
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 8-pin base
24 VAC
84 870 303
LN
Resistive
No/yes
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 8-pin base
120 VAC
84 870 304
LN
Resistive
No/yes
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 8-pin base
230 VAC
84 870 306
LN
Resistive
No/yes
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 11-pin base
24 VAC
84 870 308
LN
Resistive
No/yes
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 11-pin base
120 VAC
84 870 309
LN
Resistive
No/yes
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 11-pin base
230 VAC
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 11-pin base
24 VAC
Plug-in housing
84 870 401
L2N
Resistive
Combined with monitoring of wells
84 870 403
L2N
Resistive
Combined with monitoring of wells
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 11-pin base
120 VAC
84 870 404
L2N
Resistive
Combined with monitoring of wells
2/5 KΩ to 100 KΩ
No
1x8A
39 Plug-in 11-pin base
230 VAC
0116 284 9900
CONTROL RELAYS
| 55
Control relays
Current control
• AC current treshold adjustable from 1 to 20 A AC (30 Hz to 400 Hz) via button on front • Relay output 5 A - 250 V AC - 1 N/O contact Multivoltage power supply : 100 to 230 V AC 50-60 Hz • 24 V AC / DC • 17.5 mm casing clips on symmetrical DIN rail
Part number
Type
Measurement range
Supply voltage
84 871 020
EIL
2 – 500 mA
24 V DC
84 871 021
EIL
2 – 500 mA
24 V AC
84 871 022
EIL
2 – 500 mA
48 V AC
84 871 023
EIL
2 – 500 mA
120 V AC
84 871 024
EIL
2 – 500 mA
230 V AC
84 871 030
EIH
0.1 - 10 A
24 V DC
84 871 031
EIH
0.1 - 10 A
24 V AC
84 871 032
EIH
0.1 - 10 A
48 V AC
84 871 033
EIH
0.1 - 10 A
120 V AC
84 871 034
EIH
0.1 - 10 A
230 V AC
84 871 040
EIT
10 - 100 A with current transformer
24 V DC
84 871 041
EIT
10 - 100 A with current transformer
24 V AC
84 871 042
EIT
10 - 100 A with current transformer
48 V AC
84 871 043
EIT
10 - 100 A with current transformer
120 V AC
84 871 044
EIT
10 - 100 A with current transformer
230 V AC
56 | CONTROL RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Control relays
Voltage control
• Voltage monitoring • 2 relays to cover 6 ranges of measurement: 0.2V to 600V • Automatic recognition AC/DC Frequency up to 500 Hz
Part number
Type
Measurement range
Supply voltage
84 872 020
EUL
0.2 – 60 V
24 V DC
84 872 021
EUL
0.2 – 60 V
24 V AC
84 872 023
EUL
0.2 – 60 V
120 V AC
84 872 024
EUL
0.2 – 60 V
230 V AC
84 872 030
EUH
15 - 600 V
24 V AC
84 872 031
EUH
15 - 600 V
24 V AC
84 872 033
EUH
15 - 600 V
120 V AC
84 872 034
EUH
15 - 600 V
230 V AC
0116 284 9900
CONTROL RELAYS
| 57
COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Pulse counters
60
Hour meters
62
Multifunction devices
64
Application specific devices
65
Accessories
65
Counters and process devices
Pulse Counters – Electronic
• • • • • •
Range
LCD/LED display 6.7 or 8 digit Battery or AC/DC control Adding / subtracting and difference counting Adding of fast or slow pulses 0-99999999 service counter version available
Part no.
Function
Input A
Input B
Input switch level
Power supply
Dimensions
6.130.012.850
Adding or subtracting
0-0.7VDC NPN
0-0.7 V DC NPN
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.130.012.852
Adding or subtracting
4-30VDC PNP
0-0.7 V DC NPN
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.130.012.853
Adding or subtracting
10-260VAC/DC
10-260 V AC/DC
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.131.012.850
Count direction or difference counter
0-0.7VDC NPN
0-0.7 V DC NPN
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.131.012.851
Count direction or difference counter
4-30VDC PNP
0-0.7 V DC NPN
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.131.012.853
Difference counter
10-260VAC/DC
10-260 V AC/DC
-
Battery
48 x 24
LCD counters
Codix130
Codix 131
LED counters Codix 140
6.140.012.300
Adding Counter 0-9999999
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30VDC PNP
-
-
10-30VDC
48 x 24
Codix 142
6.142.011.300.005k.00
Service Counter 0-9999999
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30VDC PNP
-
-
10-30VDC
48 x 24
6.520.012.300
Adding
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30VDC PNP
-
Standard (HTL)
10-30VDC
48 x 24
6.520.012.3A0
Adding
"
-
4-30VDC
10-30VDC
48 x 24
Codix 520
Codix 540
6.540.012.000
Adding
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30VDC PNP
-
Standard (HTL)
90-260VAC
96 x 48
6.540.012.0A0
Adding
"
-
4-30VDC
90-260VAC
96 x 48
6.540.012.300
Adding
"
-
Standard (HTL)
10-30VDC
96 x 48
6.540.012.3A0
Adding
"
-
4-30VDC
10-30VDC
96 x 48
60 | COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
www.oem.co.uk
Counters and process devices
Pulse Counters – Electromechanical
• • • • •
Range
4-7 digit displays AC or DC control Panel or PCB mount options High shock resistance versions Long service life
Part no.
Mounting
Number of digits
Power supply
Dimensions
1.710.200.012
Panel mount
7
12 V DC
30 x 20
1.710.200.013
Panel mount
7
24 V DC
30 x 20
1.100.200.032
Panel mount
4
12 V DC
26 x 15
1.100.200.033
Panel mount
4
24 V DC
26 x 15
1.100.200.051
Panel mount
4
24 V AC
26 x 15
1.100.200.054
Panel mount
4
115 V AC
26 x 15
1.100.200.056
Panel mount
4
230 V AC
26 x 15
1.130.900.032
PCB mount
7
12 V DC
-
1.130.900.033
PCB mount
7
24 V DC
-
1.130.900.051
PCB mount
7
24 V AC
-
1.130.900.054
PCB mount
7
115 V AC
-
1.130.900.056
PCB mount
7
230 V AC
-
1.150.510.012.550
Panel mount
5
12 V DC
34 x 23
1.150.510.013.550
Panel mount
5
24 V DC
34 x 23
1.150.510.051.550
Panel mount
5
24 V AC
34 x 23
1.150.510.054.550
Panel mount
5
115 V AC
34 x 23
1.150.510.056.550
Panel mount
5
230 V AC
34 x 23
1.740.500.012.550
Panel mount
7
12 V DC
34 x 23
1.740.500.013.550
Panel mount
7
24 V DC
34 x 23
1.740.500.051.550
Panel mount
7
24 V AC
34 x 23
1.740.500.054.550
Panel mount
7
115 V AC
34 x 23
1.740.500.056.550
Panel mount
7
230 V AC
34 x 23
1.180.110.012
Panel mount
4
12 V DC
37 x 28
1.180.110.013
Panel mount
4
24 V DC
37 x 28
1.180.110.061
Panel mount
4
24 V AC
37 x 28
1.180.110.064
Panel mount
4
115 V AC
37 x 28
1.180.110.066
Panel mount
4
230 V AC
37 x 28
1.340.110.012
Panel mount
6
12 V DC
37 x 26
1.340.110.013
Panel mount
6
24 V DC
37 x 26
1.340.110.061
Panel mount
6
24 V AC
37 x 26
1.340.110.064
Panel mount
6
115 V AC
37 x 26
1.340.110.066
Panel mount
6
230 V AC
37 x 26
Micro counters K47.20
K04.20
AK07
Mini counters
W15.51
W17.50
Standard counters BK14.11
MK16.11
0116 284 9900
COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
| 61
Counters and process devices
Hour meters – Electronic
• • • •
Range
Part no.
LCD display 7 or 8 Digit Battery or 10-30 V DC dontrol Service timer options
Time/range function
Input
Input switch level
Power supply
Dimensions
LCD hour meters
Codix 135
6.135.012.850
9999 h 59 min 59 sec or 9999999.9 sec
4-30 V DC NPN
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.135.012.851
9999 h 59 min 59 sec or 9999999.9 sec
4-30 V DC PNP
-
Battery
48 x 24
6.135.012.853
9999 h 59 min 59 sec or 9999999.9 sec
10-260 V AC/DC
-
Battery
48 x 24
LED hour meters Codix 141
6.141.012.300
99999.99 h
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30 V DC PNP
10-30 V DC
48 x 24
Codix 143
6.143.011.300.005k.00
99999.99 h / service counter
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30 V DC PNP
10-30 V DC
48 x 24
6.523.011.300
h, min, sec or hh.mm.ss
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30 V DC PNP
Standard (HTL)
10-30 V DC
48 x 24
6.523.011.3A0
h, min, sec or hh.mm.ss
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30 V DC PNP
4-30 V DC
10-30 V DC
48 x 24
6.523.012.300
h, min, sec or hh.mm.ss
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30 VDC PNP
Standard (HTL)
10-30 V DC
48 x 24
6.523.012.3A0
h, min, sec or hh.mm.ss
4-30VDC NPN / 40-30 V DC PNP
4-30 V DC
10-30 V DC
48 x 24
Codix 523
62 | COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
www.oem.co.uk
Counters and process devices
Hour meters – Electromechanical
• • • • •
Range
Rolling drum display 6, 7 or 8 digit display AC / DC control High shock versions available Run indicator options available
Part no.
Mounting
Time range
Power supply
Dimensions
HK47.20
3.060.200.383
Panel mount
99999.99 h
4.5-35 V DC
30 x 20
HK47.80
3.060.800.383
PCB mount
99999.99 h
4.5-35 V DC
30 x 20
H57
HR47
HR76.2
0116 284 9900
3.220.401.351
Panel mount
99999.99 h
10-30 V DC
48 x 48
3.220.401.074
"
"
100-130 V AC ( 50HZ )
48 x 48
3.220.401.084
"
"
100-130 V AC ( 60HZ )
48 x 48
3.220.401.381
"
"
100-130 V DC
48 x 48
3.220.401.075
"
"
187-264 V AC ( 50HZ )
48 x 48
3.220.401.085
"
"
187-264 V AC ( 60HZ )
48 x 48
3.474.901.084
Panel mount
AC- 99999.99 h DC- 999999.9 h
187-264 V AC (50HZ) W/ run indicator
Ø 50.5
3.474.901.075
"
"
100-130 V AC (60HZ) W/ run indicator
Ø 50.5
3.474.901.373
"
"
10-80 V DCW/O run indicator
Ø 50.5
3.474.911.373
"
"
10-80 V DC W/ run indicator
Ø 50.5
0.135.200.301
Panel mount
99999.9 h
115 V AC
Ø 50.5
0.135.200.302
"
"
230 V AC
Ø 50.5
0.135.200.373
"
"
10-80 V DC
Ø 50.5
COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
| 63
Counters and process devices
Multifunction devices
• • • •
Range
6 digit LCD or LED display AC or DC control RS232/422/485 interfaces options Analogue output units available
Part no.
Functions
Output
Input switch level
Power supply
Codix 544
See key A below
Pulse counter, position display, tachometer and timer.
No output/Optocoupler
Standard (HTL) or 4-30 V DC
90-260 V AC or 10-30 V DC
Codix 907/908
See key B below
Pulse counter, preset counter, timer, position display, tachometer
Relay
4-30 V DC
115/230 V AC or 10-30 V DC
Codix 923/924
See key C below
Pulse counter, preset counter, position display and batch counter
Relay / Optocoupler
Standard (HTL) or 4-30 V DC
24/100-230 V AC or 10-30 V DC
Codix 716/717
See key D below
Pulse counter, preset counter, tachometer and timer with RS232/422/485 Interface option
Relay / Optocoupler
-
100-230 V AC/10-30 V DC
2 optocoupler outputs
-
17-260 V AC/DC
Analogue output (0-10 V, +10- -10 V, 0-20 mA or 4-20 mA)
-
17-260 V AC/DC
0.571.011.E00
Pulse counter, preset counter, tachometer, short time meter, sop watch, frequency display with RS232/485 interface option"
Codix 571 0.571.012.E90
A: Order code
6.544
.
01
X
.
a a) Output 1 = optocoupler 2 =no output1
B: Order code
6.90
a) Number of presets 7 = 1 preset 8 = 2 presets
X
.
01
b
c
X
b
c
b) O utputs 0 = relays
6.92
X
.
X
0
.
0
a a) Number of presets 6 = 1 preset 7 = 2presets1
.
X
A
d
e
0
c) LCD version 0 = no back lighting 1) = green back lighting 4) = 2 colour negative red/green backlighting
1
a) Number of presets b) O utputs 3= 1 preset 0 = relays 4 = 2, 4, 6 presets, 1 = optocouplers (only a = 4)
6.71
0
c) Input switiching level 0 = Standard (HTL) A = 4 … 30 V DC output
0
a
D: Order code
X
b) Power supply 0 = 90…260 V AC 3 = 10 … 30 V DC output
a
C: Order code
X
b) O utputs 0 = relays 1 = optocouplers
64 | COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
X
X
b
c
.
X
X
X
d
e
f
d) P ower supply 0 = 230 V AC 1 = 115 V AC 3 = 10…30 V DC
c) LCD options 0 = no back lighting 1) = green back lighting 2) = LED look, negative red backlighting 3 = multicolour, negative red/green backlighting
1
X b
.
X
XX
C
d
.
e) Input trigger level A = 4…40 V DC
d) P ower supply 0 = 100…240 V AC +/- 10% 1 = 24 V AC +/- 10% 3 = 10…30 V DC
e) Input trigger level f) Version 0 = Standard level (HTL) 0 = Standard 923/924 A = 4…30 V DC level B=6 optocoupler outputs 924-6 (only b = 1) C = 4 relay outputs 924-4 (only b = 0)
Ex e
c) Power supply 0 = 100…240 V AC +/- 10% 3 = 10…30 V DC1 5 V input level: order code: 7.XXX.01X.XXX.9382
d) Interface 00 = none 05 = RS232 06 = RS422 07 = RS485
e) Optional (only for a = 7, b = 0, d = 00) Ex-proof housing acc. to explosion proof class EEx D IIC T6 with encapsulated cable 2 x 3 m, various mounting parts, PTB approval certificate
www.oem.co.uk
Counters and process devices
Application specific devices
• • • • • Range
LED display AC / DC control SSI position display Set point adjuster Strain gauge display
Part no.
Description
Specifications
Power supply
Dimensions
6.533.012.300
0-12v or 0-24mA analogue signal generator
-
10-30 V DC
48 x2 4
0.570.011.E00
Display for use with SSI absolute encoders with RS232/485 interface option
2 optocoupler outputs
17-260 V AC/DC
96 x 48
0.570.012.E90
Display for use with SSI absolute encoders with RS232/485 interface option
Analogue outputs
17-260 V AC/DC
96 x 48
0.570.012.E05
Display for use with SSI absolute encoders with RS232/485 interface option
Serial interface, RS232/485
17-260 V AC/DC
96 x 48
0.570.010.305
Display for use with SSI absolute encoders with RS232/485 interface option
2 relay outputs and RS232/485
17-260 V AC/DC
96 x 48
Codix 566
See key below
Display for use with all common strain gauge inputs
-
10-30 V DC or 90-260 V AC
96 x 48
A: Order code
6.56
0
Codix 533
Codix 570
6
.
a a) Input type 6 = strain-guage inputs1
b) O utputs 0 = Relays
1
0 b
.
X c
c) P ower supply 0 = 90 …260 V AC 3 = 10…30 V DC
0
X d d) F urther outputs (optional) 0 = none 9 = analogue output (only for DC version)
Accessories A full range of accessories are available for the Kubler counter and process meter range, please contact for further details
Adapters: bezel adapter, slip on bezel, front bezel
Sealing covers and transparent covers
Socket boxes
Blind housings and terminal covers
0116 284 9900
COUNTERS AND PROCESS DEVICES
| 65
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
General information
68
Wound primary series LCTM
69
Round conductor series LCTR
70
LCTB 45
71
LCTB 50
72
LCTB 62
73
LCTB 74
74
LCTB 86
75
LCTB 100
76
LCTB 104
77
LCTB 140
78
LCTB 225
79
Split core series LCTS
80
Accessories
81
Current transformers
Low voltage current transformers Current transformers are used for the measurement of electric alternating currents. When current in a circuit (primary current) is too high to directly apply to measuring instruments, a current transformer produces a reduced current (secondary current) accurately proportional to the current in the circuit, which can be conveniently connected to measuring and recording instruments. A current transformer also isolates the measuring instruments from what may be very high voltage in the monitored circuit. Relationship between primary and secondary currents is called rated transformation ratio.
Features • Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Wide range of supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters. • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, the conductor, a current bar. • Shields designed to seal connections. General specification • Applicable standard: IEC/EN 60044 -1, BS 3938, IS 2705 -1 • Case: 10% glass filled polycarbonate, flame retardant grades classified • UL 94V-0 • Connection: Two connection on each side. M4 screws with self lifting clamp strap. • Insulation class E (120°C max) • Maximum system voltage: 0,72 kV • Operating frequency: 50 Hz • Rated primary rating: 1 A…7500 A • Rated secondary output: 5 Aw or 1 A • Rated burden: 1, 1.25, 1.5, 2.5, 3.75, 5, 7.5, 10, 12.5, 15, 20, 30, 45, 60, 100 VA • Accuracy class: 0.2, 0.2S – for laboratory and power measurement • Accuracy class: 0.5 – for accurate measuring • Accuracy class: 1 – for general measurement, for analog meters • Ambient temperature: -20°C …+45°C • Storage temperature: -50°C…+80°C • Thermal short circuit current (Ith): 40 x In for wound type • 60 x In for bus bar type • Dynamic short circuit current (Idyn): 2.5xIth • Instrument security factor (FS): 2.5, 5, 10
68 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
Wound primary series LCTM
TECHNICAL DATA
LCTM 62/W (40)
LCTM 74/W (45)
Width
62mm
74mm
Depth
40mm
45mm
1 A...25 A
1 A...60 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2; 0.5; 1
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTM 62/W (40)
0116 284 9900
Dimensions LCTM 74/W (45)
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 69
Current transformers
Round conductor series LCTR TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter
LCTR 45/14 (40)
LCTR 50/14 (30)
LCTR 50/14 (50)
LCTR 62/R (40)
Ø 14mm
Ø 14mm
Ø 14mm
Ø 22mm
Width
40mm
31mm
51mm
40mm
Depth
45mm
50mm
50mm
62mm
30 A...300 A
40 A...300 A
30 A...300 A
50 A...600 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
0.2; 0.5; 1
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTR 45/14 (40)
Dimensions LCTR 50/14 (30)
Dimensions LCTR 50/14 (50)
Dimensions LCTR 62/R
70 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
LCTB 45 Busbar series
LCTB 45/21 (40)
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter
Ø 20mm
Busbar
20 x 10
Width
40 mm
Depth
45 mm
Primary winding
50 A...400A
Secondary winding
1 A, 5 A
Accuracy class
0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m . c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 45
0116 284 9900
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 71
Current transformers
LCTB 50 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter
LCTB 50/21 (30)
LCTB 50/30 (30)
LCTB 50/21 (50)
LCTB 50/30 (50)
Ø 21mm
Ø 26mm
Ø 21mm
Ø 26mm
20 x 10
30 x 10
20 x 10
30 x 10
20 x15
Busbar
20 x 15
20 x 20
20 x 20
2 x 20 x 10
2 x 20 x 10
Width
31mm
31mm
51mm
51mm
Depth
50mm
50mm
50mm
50mm
40 A...400 A
75 A...600 A
50 A...400 A
50 A...600 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www. o e m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 50/21 (30)
Dimensions LCTB 50/21 (50)
72 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
Dimensions LCTB 50/30 (30)
Dimensions LCTB 50/30 (50)
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
LCTB 62 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter Busbar
LCTB 62/20 (40)
LCTB 62/30 (40)
LCTB 62/30 (50)
LCTB 62/40 (40)
-
Ø 30mm
Ø 28mm
Ø 31mm
20 x 12
30 x 10
30 x 10
40 x 10 2 x 30 x 10
2 x 15 x 6
2 x 25 x 6
-
Width
40mm
40mm
50mm
40mm
Depth
62mm
62mm
62mm
62mm
50 A...400 A
50 A...800 A
40 A...800 A
100 A...800 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
0116 284 9900
Dimensions LCTB 62/20 (40)
Dimensions LCTB 62/30 (40)
Dimensions LCTB 62/30 (50)
Dimensions LCTB 62/40 (40)
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 73
Current transformers
LCTB 74 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter Busbar
LCTB 74/20 (45)
LCTB 74/30 (45)
LCTB 74/40 (45)
LCTB 74/50 (45)
Ø 20mm
Ø 26mm
Ø 35mm
Ø 41mm
20 x 10
30 x 15
40 x 12
50 x 12 2 x 40 x 10
-
2 x 20 x 10
2 x 30 x 15
Width
45mm
45mm
45mm
45mm
Depth
74mm
74mm
74mm
74mm
30 A...400 A
30 A...800 A
40 A...1000 A
100 A...1000 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www. o e m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 74/20 (45)
Dimensions LCTB 74/30 (45)
Dimensions LCTB 74/40 (45)
Dimensions LCTB 74/50 (45)
74 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
LCTB 86 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter Busbar
LCTB 86/40 (45)
LCTB 86/50 (45)
LCTB 86/60 (45)
Ø 36mm
Ø 46mm
Ø 51mm
40 x 10
50 x 12
60 x 12
2 x 30 x 15
2 x 40 x 15
2 x 50 x 15
Width
45mm
45mm
45mm
Depth
86mm
86mm
86mm
50 A...1000 A
100 A...1250 A
50 A...600 A
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 86/40 (45)
Dimensions LCTB 86/50 (45)
Dimensions LCTB 86/60 (45)
0116 284 9900
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 75
Current transformers
LCTB 100 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA
LCTB 100/100 V (45)
LCTB 100/130 V (45)
Busbar
41 x 103
38 x 128
Width
45mm
45mm
Depth
100mm
100mm
400 A...2500 A
400 A...3200 A
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2; 0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www. o e m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 100/100 (45)
76 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
Dimensions LCTB 100/130 (45)
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
LCTB 104 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter
Busbar
LCTB 104/60 (45)
LCTB 104/80 (45)
Ø 54mm
Ø 65mm
60 x 12
80 x 12
2 x 50 x 15
2 x 60 x 15
2 x 40 x 20
2 x 50 x 25
Width
45mm
45mm
Depth
104mm
104mm
100 A...1600 A
200 A...2000 A
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 104/60 (45)
0116 284 9900
Dimensions LCTB 104/80 (45)
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 77
Current transformers
LCTB 140 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA Hole diameter Busbar
LCTB 140/80 (45)
LCTB 140/100H (45)
LCTB 140/100V (45)
Ø 72mm
Ø 86mm
Ø 86mm
LCTB 140/130V (45) -
80 x 30
100 x 30
100 x 30
70 x 130
2 x 60 x 25
2 x 80 x 25
2 x 80 x 25
2 x 70 x 30
2 x 70 x 30
Width
45mm
45mm
45mm
45mm
Depth
140mm
140mm
140mm
140mm 400 A...5000 A
Primary winding
200 A...2000 A
200 A...4000 A
200 A...3000 A
Secondary zzz
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
Accuracy class
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m . c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 140/80 (45)
Dimensions LCTB 140/100H (45)
Dimensions LCTB 140/100V (45)
Dimensions LCTB 140/130V (45)
78 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
LCTB 225 Busbar series
TECHNICAL DATA
LCTB 225/125 (50)
LCTB 225/167 (50)
Busbar
124 x 93
166 x 65
Width
50mm
50mm
Depth
225mm
225mm
600 A...6000 A
1000 A...7500 A
Primary winding Secondary winding Accuracy class
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
0.2S; 0.2; 0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTB 225/125 (50)
0116 284 9900
Dimensions LCTB 225/167 (50)
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 79
Current transformers
Split core series LCTS TECHNICAL DATA Window dims
LCTS 93/30SC (40)
LCTS 125/50SC (40)
LCTS 155/80SC (40)
LCTS 195/80SC (64) 82 x 162mm
23 x 33mm
85 x 54mm
85 x 122mm
Width
40mm
40mm
40mm
64mm
Depth
93mm
125mm
155mm
195mm
Primary winding
100 A...400 A
250 A...2000 A
250 A...3000 A
500 A...5000 A
Secondary winding
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
1 A, 5 A
Accuracy class
0.5; 1; 3
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
0.5; 1
F or m or e in f or m a tion , visit ou r we bsite , www.oe m. c o . u k
• Wide range of accuracy classes: 0.2S, 0.2, 0.5, 1 • Supported primary currents, the dimensions of rails, the length of casing and hole diameters • Multiple mounting methods, including wall mounting, 35mm DIN rail, conductor, current bar • Shields to seal connections
Dimensions LCTS 93/30SC (40)
Dimensions LCTS 125/50SC, 155/80SC, 195/80SC
Side view
80 | CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
Front view
www.oem.co.uk
Current transformers
Accessories
Terminal cap Terminal
• Thread cutting screw 8 x 35mm • Thread cutting screw 8 x 45mm • Thread cutting screw 8 x 75mm • Wall mounting clamp • Swivel
Thread cutting screw
• Shoe for self tapping M4 screw Swivel
Core
Order code
Transformer type
0904-130-123
LCTR 50 (30), LCTB 50 (30)
0904-130-002
LCTR 45, LCTB 45
Shoe for self tapping screw DIN rail plate
LCTM 62W LCTM 74W
Case
LCTR 62 0904-130-124
LCTB 62
Wall mounting clamp
LCTB 74 LCTB 86 LCTB 100 LCTB 104
Kit order code 0904-130-140
0904-130-141
0904-130-142
0904-130-143
0904-130-144
0904-130-145
0904-130-146
0904-130-147
0116 284 9900
Description
No. of pcs.
Transformer type LCTR 45, LCTB 45, LCTM 62W, LCTM 74W
Wall mounting clamp
2
Thread cutting screw 8 x 35mm
2
Wall mounting clamp
2
Swivel
2
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
2
Thread cutting screw 8 x 45mm
2
Wall mounting clamp
2
Swivel
2
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
2
Thread cutting screw 8 x 45mm
4
Wall mounting clamp
2
Swivel
4
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
4
Thread cutting screw 8 x 75mm
4
Wall mounting clamp
2
Swivel
4
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
4
Thread cutting screw 8 x 75mm
1
Thread cutting screw 8 x 45mm
5
Wall mounting clamp
2
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
6
Thread cutting screw 8 x 75mm
6
Wall mounting clamp
2
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
6
Thread cutting screw 8 x 35mm
6
Wall mounting clamp
2
Shoe for self tapping M4 screw
4
LCTR 50, LCTB 50
LCTR 62, LCTB 62, LCTB 74, LCTB 86
LCTB 104
LCTB 140
LCTB 140/130 V
LCTB 225
LCTB 100/100 V, LCT 100/130 V
CURRENT TRANSFORMERS
| 81
DATA RECORDERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
KD7 screen recorder
84
KD8 screen recorder
86
N30B panel recorder
87
SM61 data logger with www server
87
Data recorders
KD7 screen recorder
• • • •
LCD TFT 5.7’’ screen with IP65 touch panel ETHERNET communication with www and FTP server Up to 24 measuring channels RS-232, RS-485 and USB serial interfaces
The KD7 recorder is applied as a data acquisition station in measuring systems. It suits applications to measure, visualize and supervise technical process parameters in various industrial branches, e.g. in pharmacy, food, chemical. It can be also used as an autonomous measuring and recording device.
KD7 recorder complies with the regulation 21 CFR Part 11, regulation for electronic records and signatures issued by Food and Drug Administration (FDA).
KD7 recorder has the following features:
• Easy and intuitive servicing based on the graphical Windows and touch panel • Communication interfaces: RS-232, RS-485 MODBUS Master and Slave, MODBUS Slave TCP/IP (NEW), ETHERNET 10 Base-T, USB 1.1 Device • Exchange configuration data between the recorder and PC through the USB interface or the CompactFlash card
• HTTP server (www) enables to carry out through the www browser, the preview of the recorder current state and the sampling • Mathematical functions • Archiving and visualisation of measuring data transmitted to KD7 from external devices via RS-485 MODBUS or Ethernet
MEASURING INPUTS and OUTPUTS Depending on the model, KD7 has:
SECURITY To ensure the recorder is secure in the network, each customer can individually login, password protect and configure the access rights to the recorder archive memory.
• 6 or 12 galvanically isolated analog measuring channels • 16 measuring channels for data transmitted through communication interfaces • 16 or 32 alarms and 8 or 16 digital inputs • 4 or 8 analog outputs DATA PRESENTATION To illustrate the process run, the customer can choose many forms of data presentation:
• • • •
linear, bar trends, and circular digital and analog indicators statistics Each channel has the possibility to assign settings as: colour, name, range and presentation view
PC SOFTWARE KD7 SETUP, KD ARCHIVING, KD CHECK and KD CONNECT programs are destined for KD7 recorder servicing: The KD7 SETUP program is used to configure the KD7 recorder. KD ARCHIVING is the program used for visualization, printout and exporting data. Data can be recorded in CSV or binary format with digital signature. KD CHECK is used for verification of the signature in the archive KD CONNECT provides the communication between PC and the KD7 recorder through the USB link. It enables the acquisition of archived data from the recorder, writing and erasing data on the CF card.
DATA ARCHIVING For data archiving KD7 recorder has:
• exchangeable external memory (CompactFlash card), from 16 MB up to 4 GB • 6 MB internal memory with data support
84 | DATA RECORDERS
www.oem.co.uk
Data recorders
KD7 screen recorder Part no. key
Screen recorder KD7 - X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
0
Measuring inputs (Slot 1): without measuring inputs
0
6 programmable measuring inputs
1
6 standard measuring inputs: 0..10 V
2
6 standard measuring inputs: 0..20 mA
3
6 standard measuring inputs: 4..20 mA 6 standard measuring inputs: 3 x 0..10 V + 3 x 0..20 mA 6 standard measuring inputs: 3 x 0..10 V + 3 x 4..20 mA
4
3 programmable measuring inputs
7
5 6
Measuring inputs (Slot 2): See Table 1 Table 1
Interface measuring input: with RS-485 interface measuring input
Measuring inputs (Slot 2):
1
without measuring inputs
0
0
6 programmable measuring inputs
1
8 alarms (NO relays) + 8 alarms (OptoMos)
1
6 standard measuring inputs: 0..10 V
2
8 alarms (NC relays) + 8 alarms (OptoMos)
2
6 standard measuring inputs: 0..20 mA
3
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..5 mA
3
4
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..20 mA
4
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 4..20 mA
5
6 standard measuring inputs: 4..20 mA 6 standard measuring inputs: 3 x 0..10 V + 3 x 0..20 mA 6 standard measuring inputs: 3 x 0..10 V + 3 x 4..20 mA
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..5 V
6
3 programmable measuring inputs
7
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..10 V
7
Digital signals/analog outputs (Slot 3): without digital signals and analog outputs
5 6
Digital signals/analog outputs (Slot 4): See Table 2 Interfaces:
Table 2
USB
1
Digital signals/analog outputs (Slot 4):
USB + Ethernet + RS-485 (2)
2
without digital signals and analog outputs
0
USB + Ethernet + RS-232
3
8 alarms (NO relays) + 8 alarms (OptoMos)
1
8 alarms (NC relays) + 8 alarms (OptoMos)
2
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..5 mA
3
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..20 mA
4
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 4..20 mA
5
Memory for measuring data: with a 4 GB CF card 1
6
Supply: 90..253 V a.c.
1
Recorder firmware: without mathematical functions 2
0
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..5 V
6
with mathematical functions
1
8 digital inputs + 4 analog outputs: 0..10 V
7
Softwares servicing the recorder from PC: KD Connect, KD Check
1
KD Connect, KD Check, KD Archive, KD7 Setup
2
Example of order: The code: KD7-1-1-1-0-0-1-6-1-1-1-8 means: KD7 recorder, (Slot 1) with 6 programmable measuring inputs, (Slot 2) with 6 programmable measuring inputs, with RS-485 interface measuring input, (Slot 3) without digital and analog outputs, (Slot 4) without digital signals and analog outputs, with USB interface, with a 4GB CF memory card, supply: 90..253V a.c., with mathematical functions, with KD connect and KD Check softwares, without extra quality inspection requirements.
0116 284 9900
1. CF card with the lowest capacity from currently accessible cards on the market 2. A key for the activation of mathematical functions can be ordered separately
DATA RECORDERS
| 85
Data recorders
KD8 screen recorder
• Intuitive servicing - LCD TFT 5.7’’ screen, with touch panel • IP65 protection grade on the front panel • 3 or 6 analog programmable measuring inputs • RS-485 and USB serial interfaces
The KD8 recorder is applied as a data acquisition station in measuring systems. It suits applications to measure, visualize and supervise technical process parameters in various industrial branches, e.g. in pharmacy, food, chemical. It can be also used as an autonomous measuring and recording device KD8 recorder complies with the regulation 21 CFR Part 11, regulation for electronic records and signatures issued by Food and Drug Administration (FDA) MEASURING INPUTS and OUTPUTS
SECURITY To ensure the recorder is secure in the network, each customer can individually login, password protect and configure the access rights to the recorder archive memory. PC SOFTWARE KD8 SETUP, KD ARCHIVING, KD CHECK and KD CONNECT programs are destined for KD8 recorder servicing:
Depending on the model, KD8 has:
• 3 or 6 galvanically isolated analog measuring channels • 6 or 12 alarm outputs (2 for each channel) • 4 or 8 digital inputs DATA PRESENTATION To illustrate the process run, the customer can choose many forms
• the KD8 SETUP program is used to configure the KD8 recorder • the KD ARCHIVING program is designed for visualization, printout and export to CSV format, data recorded in the binary format with digital signature, obtained from the recorder • the KD CONNECT program provides the communication between PC and the KD8 recorder through the USB link. It enables the acquisition of archived data from the recorder, writing and erasing data on the CF card • the KD CHECK program is used for verification of the digital signature in archive
of data presentation:
• linear, bar trends, and circular • digital and analog indicators • statistics • each channel has the possibility to assign settings as: colour, name, range and presentation view DATA ARCHIVING For data archiving KD8 recorder has:
• exchangeable external memory (CompactFlash card) • 6 MB internal memory with data support
Screen recorder KD8 - X
X
X
X
00
0
Measuring inputs: 3 programmable measuring inputs
1
6 programmable measuring inputs
2
Alarms and binary inputs: without alarms and binary inputs
0
alarms (NO relays) + binary inputs 1
1
Supply: 90..253 V a.c.
1
Softwares servicing the recorder from PC: KD Connect, KD Check
1
KD Connect, KD Check, KD Archive, KD8 Setup
2
1. For each 3 measuring inputs, 6 alarms and 4 logic inputs are installed 86 | DATA RECORDERS
www.oem.co.uk
Data recorders
N30B panel recorder
• Data display with RS485 recorder • Modbus master/slave • 5 digit (14mm) 3 colour programmable display with highlighted unit • Data archiving on SD card/PC in MySQL database • 21 point scaling
Technical data Input: RS-485: Memory capacity: Internal: Memory card: Outputs: Relay: Analog: OC output: Digital interface: RS-485: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
Modbus RTU x2 up to 100 channels, 10 groups, 10 registers in each 308000 records Up to 4GB (512 mb 34 560 000 records) 2 x relays, NO contacts, 250 V ac/0.5 A ac 2 x relays, CO contacts, 250 V ac/0.5 A ac – optional Current programmable 0/4…20 mA – optional Voltage programmable 0…10 V – optional OC type, passive, npm, 30 V dc/30 mA – optional MODBUS RTU Master/Slave 96 x 48 x 93mm IP65 front 85…253 V ac; 90…320 V dc, 20…40 V ac, 20…60 V dc
Part number key Digital panel meter Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac, 90…320 V dc 20…40 V ac, 20…60 V dc Additional outputs: none OC output, RS-485 (port 2), analog outputs
N30B
X
X
XX
00
E
0
1 2 0 1
OC output, RS-485 (port 2), analog outputs switched-over relay outputs
2
Unit: unit code acc. to the table 1 on page 150
XX
SM61 data logger with www server • Visualisation of current and archived data according to customer configuration (synoptic maps, charts, tables) by any web browser • Readout up to 2500 values from slave devices (up to 100 devices, each 25 registers) • User-friendly application for data configuration • Built-in FTP and web servers • Alarms or binary inputs for control of archiving
Technical data Interface: Port 1: RS-485, RS-232 Communication for PC, HMI and Modbus Master devices: Port 2: RS-485 Slave device input Ethernet 10/100 Base-T: TCP/IP, HTTP, ICMP, DHCP, ARP, Modbus TCP, FTP Inputs: RS-485 Modbus Digital 2 x binary – optional Outputs: Relay: 2 x relays, NO contacts, 250 V ac/0.5 A ac optional Dimensions: 45 x 120 x 100 mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac; 90…300 V dc, 20…40 V ac, 20…60 V dc 0…16 V ac, 10…20 V dc
0116 284 9900
Part number key Data logger with server Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac, 90…300 V dc 20…40 V ac, 20…60 V dc 10…16 V ac, 10…20 V dc Additional inputs/outputs: 2 relay outputs 2 binary inputs
SM61
X
X
00
E
0
1 2 3 1 2
DATA RECORDERS
| 87
ENCLOSURES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Choosing an enclosure
90
Customised enclosure solutions
91
Cubo D – Small thermoplastic enclosures
92
Cubo S – Small thermoplastic enclosures
94
Cubo O – Medium thermoplastic enclosures
97
Cubo W – Wall cabinets
101
Cubo E – Steel cabinets
102
Cubo F – Steel terminal enclosures
103
Cubo N – GRP enclosures
105
Cubo X – EX rated steel enclosures
107
Enclosures
Choosing an enclosure Material Ensto enclosures are available in a variety of materials for all applications, selecting the right material for your application is essential.
3) Polyester-painted mild steel – This material has high impact resistance and a high degree of protection.
1) Polycarbonate – This material is suitable for outdoor use and demanding conditions. It is light with good resistance to chemicals and high impact resistance.
4) Stainless steel (AISI 304) – High impact, corrosion and UV radiation resistance. Suitable for industrial environments including the food industry.
2) ABS – This material is cost-effective, light with good chemical resistance and easy to machine.
5) Acid-proof steel (AISI 316) – Extremely high resistance to corrosion, perfect for use in harsh environments including offshore applications.
Remember… Enclosures should be selected with their proposed contents and location in mind. It is important to consider whether further components are likely to be added at a later stage and if so whether or not the dimensions
are adequate. The enclosure dimensions quoted by Ensto are always external dimensions, so it is important to remember that the internal mounting space available is always smaller than the actual enclosure.
Safety classification IP classes, EN 60529
IK classes, EN 62262
1st NUMERAL IP
2nd NUMERAL IP
Protection against intrusion
Protection against liquids
0: No protection
1: Protection against objects max. 50 mm
0: No protection
1: Protection against vertically falling water drops
2: Protection against objects max. 12 mm
3: Protection against objects max. 2.5 mm
2: Protection against rain drops falling in max. 15° angle
3: Protection against rain drops falling in max. 60° angle
4: Protection against solid objects max. 1 mm
5: Protection against dust, limited intrusion acceptable all directions
4: Protection against water drops falling from all directions
5: Protection against low pressure sprue water from all directions*
6: Protection against jet water under pressure *
7: Protection against water intrusion under submersion at 15 cm to 1 m depth
8: Protection against water intrusion under long term submersion under pressure
* Minor intrusion acceptable
6: Total protection against dust
90 | ENCLOSURES
Blow energy/J
IK code
< 1 2 5 10
IK 01 - 05 IK 06 IK 07 IK 08 IK 09
20
IK 10
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Customised enclosures Ensto is an international group and family owned company specialising in the development, manufacture and marketing of electrical systems and supplies. Headquartered in Finland, Ensto employs 1,300 people in Europe and Asia.
the CuboLink tool, design work is now easier and faster. CuboLink offers a fast, flexible design process using existing, proven design templates and complete parts list, allowing us to create customer-specific designs easily.
We can now offer you or your customer customised enclosures better and faster than ever before. Using Enstoâ&#x20AC;&#x2122;s Cubostics concept and in particular
Ensto offers the broadest range of enclosures on the market. Now with the Cubostics concept and the CuboLink tool, we can also offer the easiest and most effective way to design and order customised enclosures.
Stage 1
Stage 2
Using the Ensto CuboLink tool along with our Sales Engineers, design your own customised enclosure.
Once your enclosure design is complete, you can review your CAD drawings and 3D model.
Stage 3
Stage 4
Your drawings are then passed to the factory in Finland and your customised enclosure is manufactured.
Finally your fully customised enclosure is delivered direct to your door.
0116 284 9900
ENCLOSURES
| 91
Enclosures
Cubo D enclosures
• • • • •
53 x 55 x 36mm to 230 x 300 x 111mm
IP66/67 rated Standard colour RAL7035 Grey or transparent lid Polycarbonate for outdoor use (UL approved) ABS for indoor use
Introduction The Ensto Cubo D range is designed for demanding OEM use and is manufactured in high quality Polycarbonate or ABS.
The standard colour is grey RAL 7035 with the lid available in either grey or transparent.
General specification Material Degree of protection EN 60529 Impact resistance EN 50102 (+35ºC/-25ºC) Operating temperature Flammability UL 94 Standard colour Transparent cover
Polycarbonate
ABS
IP 66/67
IP 66/67
IK 08/IK 08
IK 07/IK 06
-50ºC to +100ºC
-40ºC to +60ºC
V-2
HB
Grey RAL 7035
Grey RAL 7035
Polycarbonate
Polycarbonate
Cover gasket
PUR (polyurethane)
PUR (polyurethane)
Cover screws
Stainless steel, DIN X6CR17
Stainless steel, DIN X6CR17
FI, GL, UL, cUL, GOST
FI, GL, GOST
Certificates
Order guide Dimensions (W x H x D)
ABS grey lid
ABS transparent lid
Polycarbonate grey lid
Polycarbonate transparent lid
Size 53 x 55 x 36 mm
DABP050504G
DABP050504T
DPCP050504G
DPCP050504T
Size 53 x 63 x 36 mm
DABP050704G
DABP050704T
DPCP050704G
DPCP050704T
Size 80 x 82 x 56 mm
DABP080806G
DABP080806T
DPCP080806G
DPCP080806T
Size 80 x 82 x 86 mm
DABP080809G
DABP080809T
DPCP080809G
DPCP080809T
Size 80 x 120 x 56 mm
DABP081206G
DABP081206T
DPCP081206G
DPCP081206T
Size 80 x 120 x 86 mm
DABP081209G
DABP081209T
DPCP081209G
DPCP081209T
Size 80 x 160 x 56 mm
DABP081606G
DABP081606T
DPCP081606G
DPCP081606T
Size 80 x 160 x 86 mm
DABP081609G
DABP081609T
DPCP081609G
DPCP081609T
Size 120 x 122 x 56 mm
DABP121206G
DABP121206T
DPCP121206G
DPCP121206T
Size 120 x 122 x 86 mm
DABP121209G
DABP121209T
DPCP121209G
DPCP121209T
Size 120 x 160 x 91 mm
DABP121609G
DABP121609T
DPCP121609G
DPCP121609T
Size 120 x 200 x 86 mm
DABP122009G
DABP122009T
DPCP122009G
DPCP122009T
Size 150 x 200 x 76 mm
DABP152008G
DABP152008T
DPCP152008G
DPCP152008T
Size 160 x 240 x 91 mm
DABP162409G
DABP162409T
DPCP162409G
DPCP162409T
Size 160 x 240 x 121 mm
DABP162412G
DABP162412T
DPCP162412G
DPCP162412T
Size 230 x 300 x 86 mm
DABP233009G
DABP233009T
DPCP233009G
DPCP233009T
Size 230 x 300 x 111 mm
DABP233011G
DABP233011T
DPCP233011G
DPCP233011T
92 | ENCLOSURES
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo D – accessories
• Mounting plates • DIN rail • Hinges • Screw sets
Order guide Galvanized steel mounting plates
Part number 55 x 65 x 1.5 mm
DMP0808
65 x 93 x 1.5 mm
DMP0812
65 x 133 x 1.5 mm
DMP0816
95 x 105 x 1.5 mm
DMP1212
105 x 132 x 1.5 mm
DMP1216
105 x 172 x 1.5 mm
DMP1220
133 x 172 x 1.5 mm
DMP1520
145 x 213 x 1.5 mm
DMP1624
210 x 285 x 1.5 mm
Galvanized steel DIN rail
Hinges & screws
DR15016.4
Length 48 mm, width 15 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR15038.4
Length 68 mm, width 15 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR15058.4
Length 106 mm, width 15 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR15096.4
Length 146 mm, width 15 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR15136.4
Length 68 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35058.4
Length 106 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35096.4
Length 146 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35136.4
Length 170 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35160.4
Length 186 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35176.4
Length 225 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35215.4
Length 285 mm, width 35 mm, DIN 46277/3
DR35275.4
Hinge pair, size 28 x 28 mm
DSHI1
Fastening lug, set of 4
DFL1
Cover plug
DCP1
Cover screw, short, 3 x 18/10 mm
DLS1
Screw set, 2 short cover screws and 2 mounting screws
DLSA1.02
Screw set, 4 short cover screws and 4 mounting screws
DLSA1.04
Screw set, 6 short cover screws and 4 mounting screws
DLSA1.06
Screw set, 6 long cover screws and 4 mounting screws
DLSA2.06
Cover screws, long, for 162412 and 233011
0116 284 9900
DMP2330
Length 26 mm, width 15 mm, DIN 46277/3
DLS2
Cover screws, TORX TX20, 3x18/10 mm
DLS3
Mounting screws, 3 x 7 mm
DMS1
ENCLOSURES
| 93
Enclosures
Cubo S enclosures
• • • • • •
75 x 125 x 75mm to 175 x 250 x 150mm
IP66/67 rated Standard colour RAL 7035 Grey or transparent lid Polycarbonate for outdoor use (UL approved) ABS for indoor use Available with pre-pressed PG or metric knock-outs
Introduction The Ensto Cubo S range is a series of small to medium size enclosures manufactured in high quality Polycarbonate or ABS. The standard colour
is RAL 7035 with the lid available in grey or transparent. Cubo S is also available with pre-pressed knock-outs.
General specification Material Degree of protection EN 60529 Impact resistance EN 50102 (+35ºC/-25ºC) Operating temperature Flammability UL 94 Standard colour Transparent cover Cover gasket Cover screws Certificates
Polycarbonate
ABS
IP 66/67 IK 08/IK 08 -50ºC to +100ºC V-2…5VA Grey RAL 7035 Polycarbonate PUR (polyurethane) Polyamide FI, GL, UL, cUL, GOST
IP 66/67 IK 07/IK 06 -40ºC to +60ºC HB Grey RAL 7035 Polycarbonate PUR (polyurethane) Polyamide FI, GL, GOST
Order guide Dimensions (W x H x D)
ABS grey lid
Polycarbonate grey lid
ABS transparent lid
Polycarbonate transparent lid
75 x 125 x 35 mm
SABP081304LG
SPCP081304LG
SABP081304LT
SPCP081304LT
75 x 125 x 50 mm
SABP081305LG
SPCP081305LG
SABP081305LT
SPCP081305LT
75 x 125 x 60 mm
SABP081306G
SPCP081306G
SABP081306T
SPCP081306T
75 x 125 x 75 mm
SABP081308G
SPCP081308LG
SABP081308T
SPCP081308LT
75 x 125 x 75 mm
SABP081308LG
SPCP081308G
SABP081308LT
SPCP081308T
75 x 125 x 100 mm
SABP081310G
SPCP081310LG
SABP081310T
SPCP081310LT
75 x 125 x 100 mm
SABP081310LG
SPCP081310G
SABP081310LT
SPCP081310T
75 x 125 x 125 mm
SABP081313G
SPCP081313G
SABP081313T
SPCP081313T
100 x 100 x 35 mm
SABP101004LG
SPCP101004LG
SABP101004LT
SPCP101004LT
100 x 100 x 60 mm
SABP101006G
SPCP101006G
SABP101006T
SPCP101006T
125 x 125 x 35 mm
SABP131304LG
SPCP131304LG
SABP131304LT
SPCP131304LT
125 x 125 x 50 mm
SABP131305LG
SPCP131305LG
SABP131305LT
SPCP131305LT
125 x 125 x 60 mm
SABP131306G
SPCP131306G
SABP131306T
SPCP131306T
125 x 125 x 75 mm
SABP131308G
SPCP131308G
SABP131308T
SPCP131308T
125 x 125 x 75 mm
SABP131308LG
SPCP131308LG
SABP131308LT
SPCP131308LT
125 x 125 x 100 mm
SABP131310G
SPCP131310G
SABP131310T
SPCP131310T
125 x 125 x 100 mm
SABP131310LG
SPCP131310LG
SABP131310LT
SPCP131310LT
125 x 125 x 125 mm
SABP131313G
SPCP131313G
SABP131313T
SPCP131313T
125 x 175 x 35 mm
SABP131804LG
SPCP131804LG
SABP131804LT
SPCP131804LT
125 x 175 x 50 mm
SABP131805LG
SPCP131805LG
SABP131805LT
SPCP131805LT
125 x 175 x 60 mm
SABP131806G
SPCP131806G
SABP131806T
SPCP131806T
125 x 175 x 75 mm
SABP131808LG
SPCP131808LG
SABP131808LT
SPCP131808LT
125 x 175 x 75 mm
SABP131808G
SPCP131808G
SABP131808T
SPCP131808T
125 x 175 x 100 mm
SABP131810LG
SPCP131810LG
SABP131810LT
SPCP131810LT
125 x 175 x 100 mm
SABP131810G
SPCP131810G
SABP131810T
SPCP131810T
125 x 175 x 125 mm
SABP131813LG
SPCP131813G
SABP131813LT
SPCP131813LT
125 x 175 x 125 mm
SABP131813G
SPCP131813LG
SABP131813T
SPCP131813T
125 x 175 x 150 mm
SABP131815G
SPCP131815G
SABP131815T
SPCP131815T
125 x 250 x 125 mm
SABP132513G
SPCP132513G
SABP132513T
SPCP132513T
175 x 175 x 75 mm
SABP181808G
SPCP181808G
SABP181808T
SPCP181813T
175 x 175 x 100 mm
SABP181810G
SPCP181810G
SABP181810T
SPCP181808T
175 x 175 x 125 mm
SABP181813G
SPCP181813G
SABP181813T
SPCP181810T
175 x 175 x 150 mm
SABP181815G
SPCP181815G
SABP181815T
SPCP181815T
175 x 250 x 75 mm
SABP182508G
SPCP182508G
SABP182508T
SPCP182508T
175 x 250 x 100 mm
SABP182510G
SPCP182510G
SABP182510T
SPCP182510T
175 x 250 x 150 mm
SABP182515G
SPCP182515G
SABP182515T
SPCP182515T
94 | ENCLOSURES
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo S enclosures with knockouts
75 x 125 x 60mm to 175 x 250 x 150mm
• IP66/67 rated • Standard colour RAL 7035 • Grey or transparent lid • Polycarbonate
Order guide Dimensions (W x H x D)
Metric knockouts grey lid
Metric knockouts transparent lid
PG knockouts grey lid
PG knockouts transparent lid
75 x 125 x 60 mm 75 x 125 x 75 mm 75 x 125 x 100 mm 75 x 125 x 125 mm 100 x 100 x 60 mm 125 x 125 x 60 mm 125 x 125 x 75 mm 125 x 125 x 100 mm 125 x 125 x 125 mm 125 x 175 x 60 mm 125 x 175 x 75 mm 125 x 175 x 100 mm 125 x 175 x 125 mm 125 x 175 x 150 mm 125 x 250 x 125 mm 175 x 175 x 75 mm 175 x 175 x 100 mm 175 x 175 x 125 mm 175 x 175 x 150 mm 175 x 250 x 75 mm 175 x 250 x 100 mm 175 x 250 x 150 mm
SPCM081306G
SPCM081306T
SPCK081306G
SPCK081306T
SPCM081308G
SPCM081308T
SPCK081308G
SPCK081308T
SPCM081310G
SPCM081310T
SPCK081310G
SPCK081310T
SPCM081313G
SPCM081313T
SPCK081313G
SPCK081313T
SPCM101006G
SPCM101006T
SPCM131306G
SPCM131306T
SPCK131306G
SPCK131306T
SPCM131308G
SPCM131308T
SPCK131308G
SPCK131308T
SPCM131310G
SPCM131310T
SPCK131310G
SPCK131310T
SPCM131313G
SPCM131313T
SPCK131313G
SPCK131313T
SPCM131806G
SPCM131806T
SPCK131806G
SPCK131806T
SPCM131808G
SPCM131808T
SPCK131808G
SPCK131808T
SPCM131810G
SPCM131810T
SPCK131810G
SPCK131810T
SPCM131813G
SPCM131813T
SPCK131813G
SPCK131813T
SPCM131815G
SPCM131815T
SPCK131815G
SPCK131815T
SPCM132513G
SPCM132513T
SPCM181808G
SPCM181808T
SPCK181808G
SPCK181808T
SPCM181810G
SPCM181810T
SPCK181810G
SPCK181810T
SPCM181813G
SPCM181813T
SPCK181813G
SPCK181813T
SPCM181815G
SPCM181815T
SPCK181815G
SPCK181815T
SPCM182508G
SPCM182508T
SPCK182508G
SPCK182508T
SPCM182510G
SPCM182510T
SPCK182510G
SPCK182510T
SPCM182515G
SPCM182515T
SPCK182515G
SPCK182515T
0116 284 9900
ENCLOSURES
| 95
Enclosures
Cubo S – accessories
• • • •
Mounting plates DIN rail Lugs & inserts Screw sets
Order guide Galvanized steel mounting plates
Part number 48 x 98 x 1.5 mm
SMP0813
78 x 78 x 1.5 mm
SMP1010
98 x 98 x 1.5 mm
SMP1313
98 x 148 x 1.5 mm
SMP1318
98 x 223 x 1.5 mm
SMP1325
148 x 148 x 1.5 mm
SMP1818
148 x 223 x 1.5 mm
Galvanized steel DIN rail
Lugs & inserts
DR35040.4
length 100 mm, width 35 mm
DR35090.4
length 150 mm, width 35 mm
DR35140.4
Fastening lug, set of 4 pcs
SBI1
Insert M2, set of 4 pcs, M2
SBIA1.04 SBS40
Mounting screws, for plates and rails
SMS1
Cover plug, short, for 25 mm cover, PE
SCP08
Cover plug, long, for 50 mm cover, PE Cover plug, short, for 75/100 mm covers Screw set, 4 short cover screws for 10 mm cover and 4 mounting screws Cover screw, short, 11 x 35 mm Cover screw, long, for 50 mm covers
SCP10 SCP1315 SLSA23.04 SLS35 SLS60
Screw set, 4 short cover screws and 4 mounting screws
SLSA35.04
Screw set, 4 long cover screws and 4 mounting screws
SLSA60.04
Cover screw’s wing head part, 11 x 17 mm
96 | ENCLOSURES
SFL1
Insert for pods, brass, M2 Spacer, incl. M3 x 5 screw, 40 mm
Screw sets
SMP1825
length 50 mm, width 35 mm
SLW1
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo O enclosures
• • • • • •
200 x 200 x 132mm to 400 x 600 x 187mm
IP66/67 rated Standard colour RAL 7035 Grey or transparent lid Polycarbonate for outdoor use (UL approved) ABS for indoor use Available with pre-pressed metric knock-outs
Introduction The Ensto Cubo O range is a series of medium to large size enclosures manufactured in high quality Polycarbonate or ABS. The standard colour
is RAL 7035 with the lid available in grey or transparent. Cubo O is also available with pre-pressed metric knock-outs.
General specification Material: Degree of protection EN 60529: Impact resistance EN 50102 (+35ºC/-25ºC): Operating temperature: Flammability UL 94: Standard colour: Transparent cover: Cover gasket: Cover screws: Certificates:
Polycarbonate
ABS
IP 66/67 IK 08/IK 08 -50ºC to +100ºC V-2…5VA Grey RAL 7035 Polycarbonate PUR (polyurethane) Polyamide
IP 66/67 IK 07/IK 06 -40ºC to +60ºC HB Grey RAL 7035 Polycarbonate PUR (polyurethane) Polyamide
FI, GL, UL, cUL, GOST
FI, GL, GOST
Order guide Dimensions (W x H x D)
ABS grey lid
ABS transparent lid
Polycarbonate grey lid
Polycarbonate transparent lid
200 x 200 x 132 mm
OABP202013G
OABP202013T
OPCP202013G
OPCP202013T
200 x 300 x 132 mm
OABP203013G
OABP203013T
OPCP203013G
OPCP203013T
200 x 400 x 132 mm
OABP204013G
OABP204013T
OPCP204013G
OPCP204013T
300 x 300 x 132 mm
OABP303013G
OABP303013T
OPCP303013G
OPCP303013T
300 x 400 x 132 mm
OABP304013G
OABP304013T
OPCP304013G
OPCP304013T
300 x 600 x 132 mm
OABP306013G
OABP306013T
OPCP306013G
OPCP306013T
400 x 400 x 132 mm
OABP404013G
OABP404013T
OPCP404013G
OPCP404013T
400 x 600 x 132 mm
OABP406013G
OABP406013T
OPCP406013G
OPCP406013T
200 x 200 x 185 mm
OABP202018G
OABP202018T
OPCP202018G
OPCP202018T
200 x 300 x 185 mm
OABP203018G
OABP203018T
OPCP203018G
OPCP203018T
200 x 400 x 185 mm
OABP204018G
OABP204018T
OPCP204018G
OPCP204018T
300 x 300 x 185 mm
OABP303018G
OABP303018T
OPCP303018G
OPCP303018T
300 x 400 x 185 mm
OABP304018G
OABP304018T
OPCP304018G
OPCP304018T
300 x 600 x 185 mm
OABP306018G
OABP306018T
OPCP306018G
OPCP306018T
400 x 400 x 187 mm
OABP404018G
OABP404018T
OPCP404018G
OPCP404018T
400 x 600 x 185 mm
OABP406018G
OABP406018T
OPCP406018G
OPCP406018T
0116 284 9900
ENCLOSURES
| 97
Enclosures
Cubo O enclosures with knockouts
• IP66/67 rated • Standard colour RAL 7035 • Grey or transparent lid • Polycarbonate
200 x 200 x 132mm to 400 x 600 x 185mm
Order guide Dimensions (W x H x D)
Metric knockouts grey lid
Metric knockouts transparent lid
300 x 300 x 132 mm
OPCM303013G
OPCM303013T
300 x 400 x 132 mm
OPCM304013G
OPCM304013T
300 x 600 x 132 mm
OPCM306013G
OPCM306013T
300 x 300 x 185 mm
OPCM303018G
OPCM303018T
300 x 400 x 185 mm
OPCM304018G
OPCM304018T
300 x 600 x 185 mm
OPCM306018G
OPCM306018T
Flange knockout grey lid
Flange knockout transparent lid
200 x 200 x 132 mm
CPCF202013G
CPCF202013T
200 x 300 x 132 mm
CPCF203013G
CPCF203013T
200 x 400 x 132 mm
CPCF204013G
CPCF204013T
300 x 300 x 132 mm
CPCF303013G
CPCF303013T
300 x 400 x 132 mm
CPCF304013G
CPCF304013T
300 x 600 x 132 mm
CPCF306013G
CPCF306013T
400 x 400 x 132 mm
CPCF404013G
CPCF404013T
400 x 600 x 132 mm
CPCF406013G
CPCF406013T
200 x 200 x 185 mm
CPCF202018G
CPCF202018T
200 x 300 x 185 mm
CPCF203018G
CPCF203018T
200 x 400 x 185 mm
CPCF204018G
CPCF204018T
300 x 300 x 185 mm
CPCF303018G
CPCF303018T
300 x 400 x 185 mm
CPCF304018G
CPCF304018T
300 x 600 x 185 mm
CPCF306018G
CPCF306018T
400 x 400 x 187 mm
CPCF404018G
CPCF404018T
400 x 600 x 185 mm
CPCF406018G
CPCF406018T
98 | ENCLOSURES
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo O – accessories
• Mounting plates • Din rail • Screw sets
Order guide Galvanized steel mounting plates
Part number 160 x 160 x 1.5 mm
OMP2020
160 x 260 x 1.5 mm
OMP2030
160 x 360 x 1.5 mm
OMP2040
300 x 300 x 1.5 mm
OMP3030
300 x 400 x 1.5 mm For kWh meter 300 x 400 x 1.5 mm 300 x 600 x 1.5 mm For kWh meter 300 x 600 x 1.5 mm 400 x 400 x 1.5 mm For kWh meter 400 x 400 x 1.5 mm 400 x 600 x 1.5 mm
Galvanized steel DIN rail
Screw sets
OMP3060 KWHP3060 OMP4040 KWHP4040 OMP4060
For kWh meter 400 x 600 x 1.5 mm
KWHP4060
For 200 mm side, width 35 mm
DR35150.5
For 600 mm side/middle with front panel, width 35 mm
DR35240.5
For 300 mm side, width 35 mm
DR35250.5
For 600 mm side/middle with front panel, width 35 mm
DR35340.5
For 400 mm side, width 35 mm
DR35350.5
For 600 mm side, width 35 mm
DR35550.5
Slotted/cross head, sealable Screw set, 4 slotted/cross head cover screws
OLS42 OLSA42.4
Screw set, 6 slotted/cross head cover screws
OLSA42.6
Screw set, 4 slotted/cross head cover screws and 4 mounting scr ews
OLSA42.04
Screw set, 6 slotted/cross head cover screws and 8 mounting screws
OLSA42.06
Slotted/cross head, dark grey Noryl Slotted/cross head for 600 mm modular cover
OLS42N OLS32
Springloaded, cross head
PLS63
Hinged cover screw, slotted/cross head, blue, polyamide
OLSH1
Hinged cover screw, wing head, blue, polyamide
OLWH1
Wing head Screw set, 4 wing head cover screws
OLW55 OLWA55.4
Screw set, 6 wing head cover screws
OLWA55.6
Screw set, 4 wing head cover screws and 4 mounting screws
OLWA55.04
Screw set, 6 wing head cover screws and 8 mounting screws
OLWA55.06
DIN 3 head Screw set, 4 DIN 3 head cover screws
OLT42 OLTA42.4
Screw set, 6 DIN 3 head cover screws
OLTA42.6
Screw set, 4 DIN 3 head cover screws and 4 mounting screws
OLTA42.04
Screw set, 6 DIN 3 head cover screws and 8 mounting screws
OLTA42.06
Screw set, 4 DIN 3 head cover screws and 4 mounting screws + key
OLTA42.041
Key for DIN head screw OLT42
0116 284 9900
OMP3040 KWHP3040
OLT42KEY
ENCLOSURES
| 99
Enclosures
Cubo O – accessories continued
• Grey & transparent covers • Extension frames • Miscellaneous accessories
Order guide Covers & extension frames Dimensions
ABS grey
Polycarbonate grey
Polycarbonate transparent
Polycarbonate grey extension frames
200 x 200 x 30 mm
OABG202003L
OPCG202003L
OPCT202003L
OPCP202006E
200 x 300 x 30 mm
OABG203003L
OPCG203003L
OPCT203003L
OPCP203006E
200 x 400 x 30 mm
OABG204003L
OPCG204003L
OPCT204003L
OPCP204006E
300 x 300 x 30 mm
OABG303003L
OPCG303003L
OPCT303003L
OPCP303006E
300 x 400 x 30 mm
OABG304003L
OPCG304003L
OPCT304003L
OPCP304006E
300 x 600 x 30 mm
OABG306003L
OPCG306003L
OPCT306003L
OPCP306006E
400 x 400 x 30 mm
OABG404003L
OPCG404003L
OPCT404003L
OPCP404006E
400 x 600 x 30 mm
OABG406003L
OPCG406003L
OPCT406003L
OPCP406006E
Miscellaneous accessories Description
Part number
Description
Part number
Cover plate for flange openings, F1 size excl. gasket, PC/ABS
F1151
30 mm spacer, set of 4 pcs
OBS30.04
Cover plate for flange openings, F2 size incl. PUR gasket, PC
F2251
Fastening lugs, set of 4 pcs, stainless steel
TPV21176 OCS22.46
Threaded bushing, 4xOTS1 + 4xOLS42
OTSA1.04
Customizing template, clear PET, 300 x 400 x 6 mm
Mounting screw, for rails and plates
OMS1
Extension frame screw, ø 17 x 67
OES1
Brass insert, for mounting pod, M3
OBI1
Extension frame screws, a set of 4 pcs
OESA1.04 OESA1.06
Brass insert, M3, set of 4 OBI1
OBIA1.04
Extension frame screws, a set of 6 pcs
Cover plug, PE, 11 x ø 15/17 mm
OCP1
Hinge pair, incl. mounting instruction
OHI1
15 mm spacer, incl. M5 screw, steel
OBS15
Hinge pair, incl. 2 cover plugs
OHICP1
15 mm spacer, set of 4 pcs 20 mm spacer, incl. M5 screw, steel 20 mm spacer, set of 4 pcs 30 mm spacer, incl. M5 screw, steel
100 | ENCLOSURES
OBS15.04
Fastening lug, set of 4 pcs
OFL1
OBS20
Corner elevator, incl. M5 bolt, 19/19 x 14 mm
OEL1
OBS20.04
Corner elevator, set of 4 OEL1
OELA1.04
OBS30
Threaded bushing, for cover screw when cover mounted on the back
OTS1
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo W Cabinets
• • • • •
200 x 200 x 132mm to 400 x 600 x 187mm
IP 66/67 rated Standard colour RAL 7035 Grey or transparent lid Polycarbonate for outdoor use (UL approved) Pre-assembled with hinges and latches
Introduction The Ensto Cubo W range is a series of wall mounted cabinets manufactured in high quality Polycarbonate. The standard colour is RAL 7035 with the lid available in grey or transparent.
Cubo W comes pre-assembled with hinges and quick release latches which are padlockable.
General specification Material: Degree of protection EN 60529: Impact resistance EN 50102 (+35ºC/-25ºC): Operating temperature: Flammability UL 94: Standard colour: Transparent cover: Cover gasket: Certificates:
Polycarbonate IP 66/67 IK 08/IK 08 -50ºC to +100ºC V-2…5VA Grey RAL 7035 Polycarbonate PUR (polyurethane) FI, GL, UL, cUL, GOST
Order guide Polycarbonate grey lid
Polycarbonate transparent lid
200 x 200 x 132 mm
Dimensions (W x H x D)
WPCP202013G
WPCP202013T
200 x 300 x 132 mm
WPCP203013G
WPCP203013T
200 x 400 x 132 mm
WPCP204013G
WPCP204013T
300 x 300 x 132 mm
WPCP303013G
WPCP303013T
300 x 400 x 132 mm
WPCP304013G
WPCP304013T
300 x 600 x 132 mm
WPCP306013G
WPCP306013T
400 x 400 x 132 mm
WPCP404013G
WPCP404013T
400 x 600 x 132 mm
WPCP406013G
WPCP406013T
200 x 200 x 185 mm
WPCP202018G
WPCP202018T
200 x 300 x 185 mm
WPCP203018G
WPCP203018T
200 x 400 x 185 mm
WPCP204018G
WPCP204018T
300 x 300 x 185 mm
WPCP303018G
WPCP303018T
300 x 400 x 185 mm
WPCP304018G
WPCP304018T
300 x 600 x 185 mm
WPCP306018G
WPCP306018T
400 x 400 x 187 mm
WPCP404018G
WPCP404018T
400 x 600 x 185 mm
WPCP406018G
WPCP406018T
0116 284 9900
ENCLOSURES
| 101
Enclosures
Cubo E Cabinets
• IP 66 rated • Polyester painted steel RAL 7035 • Stainless steel AISI 304 (AISI 316 available on request) • Pre-assembled with hinges and 3mm DIN lock • Mounting plate included
200 x 200 x 150mm to 1000 x 1200 x 300mm
Introduction The Ensto Cubo E range is a series of wall mounted cabinets manufactured in polyester painted (RAL 7035) mild steel or unpainted (AISI 304) stainless steel. On request the enclosures can be
manufactured in AISI 316 acid-proof steel. All doors include a 3mm DIN lock and the polyester painted cabinets come with a gland plate with the stainless steel cabinets having plain sides.
General specification Material: Degree of protection EN 60529: Impact resistance EN 50102 (+35ºC/-25ºC): Standard colour: Cover gasket: Certificates:
Polyester painted steel
Unpainted stainless steel
IP 66 IK 09 Grey RAL 7035 PUR (polyurethane) FI, GL, GOST
IP 66 IK 08/IK 08 AISI 304. Unpainted PUR (polyurethane) FI, GL, GOST
Order guide Polyester painted steel
Unpainted stainless steel
200 x 300 x 150mm
EFEF203015
ESSP203015
300 x 200 x 150mm
EFEF302015
ESSP302015
300 x 300 x 150mm
EFEF303015
ESSP303015
300 x 300 x 200mm
EFEF303020
ESSP303020
300 x 400 x 200mm
EFEF304020
ESSP304020
400 x 300 x 150mm
EFEF403015
ESSP403015
400 x 300 x 200mm
EFEF403020
ESSP403020
400 x 400 x 200mm
EFEF404020
ESSP404020
400 x 400 x 300mm
EFEF404030
ESSP404030
400 x 500 x 200mm
EFEF405020
ESSP405020
400 x 600 x 200mm
EFEF406020
ESSP406020
400 x 600 x 300mm
EFEF406030
ESSP406030
500 x 500 x 200mm
EFEF505020
ESSP505020
500 x 500 x 300mm
EFEF505030
ESSP505030
500 x 600 x 300mm
EFEF506030
ESSP506030
600 x 400 x 200mm
EFEF604020
ESSP604020
600 x 400 x 300mm
EFEF604030
ESSP604030
600 x 600 x 200mm
EFEF606020
ESSP606020
600 x 600 x 300mm
EFEF606030
ESSP606030
600 x 800 x 200mm
EFEF608020
ESSP608020
600 x 800 x 300mm
EFEF608030
ESSP608030
600 x 1000 x 300mm
EFEF6010030
ESSP6010030
600 x 1200 x 300mm
EFEF6012030
ESSP6012030
800 x 600 x 300mm
EFEF806030
ESSP806030
800 x 800 x 200mm
EFEF808020
ESSP808020
800 x 800 x 300mm
EFEF808030
ESSP808030
800 x 1000 x 300mm
EFEF8010030
ESSP8010030
800 x 1200 x 300mm
EFEF8012030
ESSP8012030
1000 x 800 x 300mm
EFEF1008030
ESSP1008030
1000 x 1000 x 300mm
EFEF10010030
ESSP10010030
1000 x 1000 x 300mm
EFEF10012030
ESSP10012030
102 | ENCLOSURES
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo F terminal enclosures 150 x 150 x 80mm to 800 x 400 x 120mm
• IP 66 rated • Polyester painted steel RAL 7035 • Stainless steel AISI 304 (AISI 316 available on request) • Includes supports for DIN-rails/mounting plates as standard
Introduction The Ensto Cubo F terminal enclosures are available in polyester painted steel, colour grey RAL 7035 or unpainted stainless steel AISI 304. AISI 316 acid-proof steel is available on special request. All enclosures
include supports for DIN-rails/mounting plates and come with plain sides as standard.
General specification Material: Degree of protection EN 60529: Impact resistance EN 50102 (+35ºC/-25ºC): Standard colour: Cover screws: Cover gasket: Certificates:
Polyester painted steel
Unpainted stainless steel
IP 66 IK 09 Grey RAL 7035 Stainless steel AISI 304 PUR (polyurethane) FI, GL, GOST
IP 66 IK 09 AISI 304. Unpainted Stainless steel AISI 304 PUR (polyurethane) FI, GL, GOST
Order guide Polyester painted steel
Unpainted stainless steel
Mounting plate
150 x 150 x 80mm
Dimensions (W x H x D)
FFUP151508
FSUP151508
FMP1515
150 x 150 x 120mm
FFUP151512
FSUP151512
FMP1515
200 x 200 x 80mm
FFUP202008
FSUP202008
FMP2020
200 x 200 x 120mm
FFUP202012
FSUP202012
FMP2020
300 x 150 x 80mm
FFUP301508
FSUP301508
FMP3015
300 x 150 x 120mm
FFUP301512
FSUP301512
FMP3015
300 x 200 x 80mm
FFUP302008
FSUP302008
FMP3020
300 x 200 x 120mm
FFUP302012
FSUP302012
FMP3020
300 x 300 x 80mm
FFUP303008
FSUP303008
FMP3030
300 x 300 x 120mm
FFUP303012
FSUP303012
FMP3030
400 x 200 x 80mm
FFUP402008
FSUP402008
FMP4020
400 x 200 x 120mm
FFUP402012
FSUP402012
FMP4020
400 x 300 x 80mm
FFUP403008
FSUP403008
FMP4030
400 x 300 x 120mm
FFUP403012
FSUP403012
FMP4030
400 x 400 x 80mm
FFUP404008
FSUP404008
FMP4040
400 x 400 x 120mm
FFUP404012
FSUP404012
FMP4040
500 x 200 x 80mm
FFUP502008
FSUP502008
FMP5020
500 x 200 x 120mm
FFUP502012
FSUP502012
FMP5020
500 x 300 x 80mm
FFUP503008
FSUP503008
FMP5030
500 x 300 x 120mm
FFUP503012
FSUP503012
FMP5030
600 x 200 x 80mm
FFUP602008
FSUP602008
FMP6020
600 x 200 x 120mm
FFUP602012
FSUP602012
FMP6020
600 x 300 x 80mm
FFUP603008
FSUP603008
FMP6030
600 x 300 x 120mm
FFUP603012
FSUP603012
FMP6030
600 x 400 x 80mm
FFUP604008
FSUP604008
FMP6040
600 x 400 x 120mm
FFUP604012
FSUP604012
FMP6040
800 x 200 x 80mm
FFUP802008
FSUP802008
FMP8020
800 x 200 x 120mm
FFUP802012
FSUP802012
FMP8020
800 x 400 x 80mm
FFUP804008
FSUP804008
FMP8040
800 x 400 x 120mm
FFUP804012
FSUP804012
FMP8040
0116 284 9900
ENCLOSURES
| 103
Enclosures
Cubo E & F – accessories
• Rain shelters • DIN rails • Miscellaneous accessories
Order guide Rain shelters - painted
Rain shelters - stainless steel
For enclosure
Part number
For enclosure
Part number
EFEF203015
ERS2015A
ESSP203015
ERS2015B
EFEF30xx15
ERS3015A
ESSP30xx15
ERS3015B
EFEF403015
ERS4015A
ESSP403015
ERS4015B
EFEF30xx20
ERS3020A
ESSP30xx20
ERS3021B
EFEF40xx20
ERS4020A
ESSP40xx20
ERS4021B
EFEF505020
ERS5020A
ESSP505020
ERS5021B
EFEF60xx20
ERS6020A
ESSP60xx20
ERS6021B
EFEF808020
ERS8020A
ESSP808020
ERS8021B
EFEF40xx30
ERS4030A
ESSP40xx30
ERS4031B
EFEF50xx30
ERS5030A
ESSP50xx30
ERS5031B
EFEF60xx30
ERS6030A
ESSP60xx30
ERS6031B
EFEF80xx30
ERS8030A
ESSP80xx30
ERS8031B
EFEF100xx30
ERS10030A
ESSP100xx30
ERS10031B
Galvanized steel DIN rails
Miscellaneous accessories
For base, 200 mm side, pair
DR3520B
For base, 300 mm side, pair
DR3530B
For base, 400 mm side, pair
DR3540B
For base, 500 mm side, pair
DR3550B
For base, 600 mm side, pair
DR3560B
For base, 800 mm side, pair
DR3580B
For base, 1000 mm side, pair
DR35100B
For door, 200 mm side, pair
DR3520D
For door, 300 mm side, pair
DR3530D
For door, 400 mm side, pair
DR3540D
For door, 500 mm side, pair
DR3550D
For door, 600 mm side, pair
DR3560D
For door, 800 mm side, pair
DR3580D
For door, 1000 mm side, pair
DR35100D
Triangular lock with 11 mm key Lock with wing handle, width 50 mm Lock incl. 2 keys Black swing handle for three point locking Door stopper, set (galvanized steel) Door grounding, M6>M6, 2.5 mm²
EKL1 EH1 EDS2 EG200
Fastening lugs, 20 mm high, set of 4 pcs
EFFL2.20
Fastening lugs, 50 mm high, set of 4 pcs
EFFL2.50
Counter part for fastening lugs, set of 4 pcs
104 | ENCLOSURES
ED10 ED10M6
EFLM4
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo N – GRP enclosures 250 x 300 x 140mm to 600 x 800 x 300mm
• • • •
IP66 rated Fibreglass reinforced polyester High temperature resistance Available with plain sides or with polycarbonate window
General specification Conformity Technical information: Degree of protection: Impact resistance: Flammability rating: Material Base/cover: Lock: Gasket:
IP66 IK10, models with window IK07 UL 746C 5V Fibreglass reinforced polyester Double bit DIN 3.0mm PUR (polyurethane) Knockout alternatives Plain sides/customer specific knockouts
Standard colour Base: Cover:
Grey RAL 7035 Grey RAL 7035
Order guide Dimensions (W x H x D)
Plain sides
Plain sides & 3 point closing handle
Plain sides with polycarbonate window
250 x 300 x 140
NGRP253014
300 x 400 x 200
NGRP304020
NGRP304020P3SH
NGRW304020
400 x 400 x 200
NGRP404020
NGRP404020P3SH
NGRW404020
400 x 500 x 200
NGRP405020
NGRP405020P3SH
NGRW405020
400 x 600 x 230
NGRP406023
NGRP405023P3SH
NGRW406023
500 x 600 x 230
NGRP506023
NGRP506023P3SH
NGRW506023
600 x 800 x 300
NGRP608030
NGRP608030P3SH
NGRW608030
0116 284 9900
NGRW253014
ENCLOSURES
| 105
Enclosures
Cubo N – GRP – accessories
• • • •
Mounting plates Modular device chassis Internal door kits Wall mounting kits
Order guide Mounting plates GRP
Part number
Galvanized steel
Part number
213 x 268 x 4
NGRMP2530
207 x 268 x 4
NMP2530
260 x 358 x 4
NGRMP3040
254 x 358 x 2
NMP3040
360 x 358 x 4
NGRMP4040
354 x 358 x 2
NMP4040
360 x 458 x 4
NGRMP4050
354 x 458 x 2
NMP4050
360558 x 4
NGRMP4060
354 x 558 x 2
NMP4060
460 x 558 x 4
NGRMP5060
454 x 558 x 2
NMP5060
556 x 754 x 4
NGRMP6080
558 x 754 x 2
NMP6080
Chassis for modular devices - IP20 Description
Part number
300 x 400 mm wall cabinets, 2 DIN openings for 12 modules
NMC3040.24
400 x 400 mm wall cabinets, 2 DIN openings for 18 modules
NMC4040.36
400 x 500 mm wall cabinets, 3 DIN openings for 18 modules
NMC4050.54
400 x 600 mm wall cabinets, 3 DIN openings for 18 modules
NMC4060.54
500 x 600 mm wall cabinets, 3 DIN openings for 23 modules
NMC5060.69
600 x 800 mm wall cabinets, 4 DIN openings for 29 modules
NMC6080.116
Internal door kit - GRP For wall cabinet
Dimensions
300 x 400
258 x 366
NID3040
400 x 400
358 x 366
NID4040
400 x 500
358 x 466
NID4050
400 x 600
358 x 566
NID4060
500 x 600
458 x 566
NID5060
600 x 800
558 x 766
NID6080
Wall mounting lugs & locks
Set of 4 plastic locks
NFL1
Key lock with a wrench
NKL1
Padlocking accessory, AISI 304
106 | ENCLOSURES
Part number
NPD3041
www.oem.co.uk
Enclosures
Cubo X EX rated enclosures
• • • •
50 x 150 x 90mm to 500 x 800 x 200mm
IP66/67 rated AISI 316L & 304 Stainless steel RAL7035 painted mild steel Customised units available
General specification Material alternatives Polyester painted mild steel: Stainless steel AISI 304: Stainless steel AISI 316L: Product alternatives: Empty enclosures/cabinets: Standard: Customised: Junction boxes: Universal combo box:
For dry environments For demanding environments For extremely demanding environments (e.g. offshore/marine) Gas and dust area components Use a code key to create your own enclosure or use the ones already created for easy ordering Choose different features beyond the code key Gas and dust area products. The amount of used terminals calculated with maximum power dissipation method Used together with any Ex D enclosure as for example a junction box
Variations Cover fastening:
Material: Surface treatment: Sizing:
Earthing: Mounting: Technical information Degree of protection: Ambient temperature: Conformity: Approvals/certificate:
Version 1: cover screws Version 2: tight hinges and cover screws on the opposite side Version 3: tight hinges and locks Version 4: cover screws and hinges that enables free movement of the cover Stainless steel AISI 316L (1.5mm) Stainless steel AISI 304 (1.5mm) Mild steel coated RAL7035 (1.5mm) Natural Brushed Polyester painted (custom colour available) Width: 150-1000mm Height: 150-2000mm Depth: 90-400mm Internal earth bolt as standard External earth bolts (M6) Welded fastening lugs, horizontal/vertical IP66/IP67 (IP66 with flanges installed) -55°C to 160°C/100°C/85°C DNV 11 ATEX 98909U IECEx DNV 11,0005U POCC FLI605.B03815 Rostechnadzor (RTN) Permit CNEx12. 1219U EN/IEC 60079-0, -7, -31
Standards: Marking gas: Marking dust:
Ex II 2 G Ex e IIC Gb Ex II 2 D Ex tb IIIC Db IP66/67 or IP66
Order guide Standard sizes with plain sides Dimensions
Stainless steel
Painted mild steel
150 x 150 x 90
X1ANP151509
X1FEP151509
150 x 200 x 100
X1ANP152010
X1FEP152010
200 x 200 x 100
X1ANP202010
X1FEP202010
200 x 300 x 120
X1ANP203012
X1FEP203012
200 x 400 x 150
X1ANP204015
X1FEP204015
300 x 300 x 150
X1ANP303015
X1FEP303015
400 x 300 x 150
X1ANP403015
X1FEP403015
400 x 400 x 200
X1ANP404020
X1FEP404020
400 x 600 x 200
X1ANP406020
X1FEP406020
500 x 800 x 200
X1ANP508020
X1FEP508020
With flange openings
Flange on bottom
Flange on bottom
Flange on bottom & both sides
Flange on bottom & both sides
Stainless Steel
Painted Mild Steel
Stainless steel
Painted mild steel
400 x 300 x 150
X2ANP403015G1
X2FEP403015G1
X2ANP403015G2
X2FEP403015G2
400 x 400 x 200
X2ANP404020G1
X2FEP404020G1
X2ANP404020G2
X2FEP404020G2
Dimension
400 x 600 x 200
X2ANP406020G1
X2FEP406020G1
X2ANP406020G2
X2FEP406020G2
500 x 800 x 200
X2ANP508020G1
X2FEP508020G1
X2ANP508020G2
X2FEP508020G2
0116 284 9900
ENCLOSURES
| 107
FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Ultraflexx ultra flexible busbar
110
Isoflexx laminated busbar
112
MBS Earth braids
114
Flexible busbars
Ultraflexx ultra flexible busbar
• CSA: 25mm² to 240mm² • Rated current: up to 1200A with two parallel conductors • Insulation: UL94 VO chlorine and fluorine free • Voltage: 1000V AC, 1500V DC • Dielectric strength: 20kV/mm
Introduction ULTRAFLEXX busbar has a very high flexibility; this is due to the braided construction. The conductor ends are press welded and pre-drilled, therefore no crimps or clamps are required and contact resistance is at a minimum.
This busbar is available in lengths of 100mm to 1000m as standard. Custom lengths & hole sizes available on request. UL/CSA approved. The ultimate flexible solution!
Ordering guide 160 amp Part number 62150323 62150523 62151023 62151523 62151923 62152323 62152823 62153323 62153523 62153823 62154023 62154523 62155023 62155523 62156023 62156523 62156823 62157523 62158023
Type
Cross section mm²
Width mm
Length mm
Hole centres mm
Hole size
UFLX 25-100-8/10 ULFX 25-150-8/10 ULFX 25-200-8/10 ULFX 25-250-8/10 ULFX 25-300-8/10 ULFX 25-350-8/10 ULFX 25-400-8/10 ULFX 25-450-8/10 ULFX 25-500-8/10 ULFX 25-550-8/10 ULFX 25-600-8/10 ULFX 25-650-8/10 UFLX 25-700-8/10 UFLX 25-750-8/10 UFLX 25-800-8/10 UFLX 25-850-8/10 UFLX 25-900-8/10 UFLX 25-950-8/10 UFLX 25-1000-8/10
25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25 25
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
113 163 223 272 322 372 422 472 522 572 622 672 722 772 822 872 922 972 1022
100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 650 700 750 800 850 900 950 1000
M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10
Hole centres mm
Hole size
* Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
250 amp Part number 62250323 62250523 62251023 62251523 6 2251923 6 2252323 6 2252823 6 2253323 62253523 6 2253823 6 2254023 6 2254523 6 2255023 6 2255523 6 2256023 6 2256523 6 2256823 62257523 6 2258023
Type
Cross section mm²
UFLX 50-100-8/10 50 UFLX 50-150-8/10 50 UFLX 50-200-8/10 50 UFLX 50-250-8/10 50 UFLX 50-300-8/10 50 UFLX 50-350-8/10 50 UFLX 50-400-8/10 50 UFLX 50-450-8/10 50 UFLX 50-500-8/10 50 UFLX 50-550-8/10 50 UFLX 50-600-8/10 50 UFLX 50-650-8/10 50 UFLX 50-700-8/10 50 UFLX 50-750-8/10 50 UFLX 50-800-8/10 50 UFLX 50-850-8/10 50 UFLX 50-900-8/10 50 UFLX 50-950-8/10 50 UFLX 50-1000-8/10 50 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
110 | FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
Width mm 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
Length mm 115 175 225 275 325 375 425 475 522 575 625 675 725 775 825 875 925 975 1025
100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 650 700 750 800 850 900 950 1000
M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10 M8/10
www.oem.co.uk
Flexible busbars
Ordering guide 390 amp Part number 62550333 62550533 62551033 62551533 62551933 62552333 62552833 62553333 62553533 62553833 62554033 62554533 62555033 62555533 62556033 62556533 62556833 62557533 62558033
Type
Cross section mm²
UFLX 100-100-10 100 UFLX 100-150-10 100 UFLX 100-200-10 100 UFLX 100-250-10 100 UFLX 100-300-10 100 UFLX 100-350-10 100 UFLX 100-400-10 100 UFLX 100-450-10 100 UFLX 100-500-10 100 UFLX 100-550-10 100 UFLX 100-600-10 100 UFLX 100-650-10 100 UFLX 100-700-10 100 UFLX 100-750-10 100 UFLX 100-800-10 100 UFLX 100-850-10 100 UFLX 100-900-10 100 UFLX 100-950-10 100 UFLX 100-1000-10 100 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
Width mm
Length mm
Hole centres mm
Hole size
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
125 175 225 275 325 375 425 475 525 575 625 675 725 775 825 875 925 975 1025
100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 650 700 750 800 850 900 950 1000
M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10
Width mm
Length mm
Hole centres mm
Hole size
32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32
130 180 230 280 330 380 430 480 530 580 630 680 730 780 830 880 930 980 1030
100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 650 700 750 800 850 900 950 1000
M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10
Width mm
Length mm
Hole centres mm
Hole size
32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32
130 180 230 280 330 380 430 480 530 580 630 680 730 780 830 880 930 980 1030
100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 550 600 650 700 750 800 850 900 950 1000
M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10 M10
450 amp Part number 62650333 62650533 62651033 62651533 62651933 62652333 62652833 62653333 62653533 62653833 62654033 62654533 62655033 62655533 62656033 62656533 62656833 62657533 62658033
Type
Cross section mm²
UFLX 120-100-10 120 UFLX 120-150-10 120 UFLX 120-200-10 120 UFLX 120-250-10 120 UFLX 120-300-10 120 UFLX 120-350-10 120 UFLX 120-400-10 120 UFLX 120-450-10 120 UFLX 120-500-10 120 UFLX 120-550-10 120 UFLX 120-600-10 120 UFLX 120-650-10 120 UFLX 120-700-10 120 UFLX 120-750-10 120 UFLX 120-800-10 120 UFLX 120-850-10 120 UFLX 120-900-10 120 UFLX 120-950-10 120 UFLX 120-1000-10 120 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
700 amp Part number 62850333 62850533 62851033 62851533 62851933 62852333 62852833 62853333 62853533 62853833 62854033 62854533 62855033 62855533 62856033 62856533 62856833 62857533 62858033
Type
Cross section mm²
UFLX 240-100-10 240 UFLX 240-150-10 240 UFLX 240-200-10 240 UFLX 240-250-10 240 UFLX 240-300-10 240 UFLX 240-350-10 240 UFLX 240-400-10 240 UFLX 240-450-10 240 UFLX 240-500-10 240 UFLX 240-550-10 240 UFLX 240-600-10 240 UFLX 240-650-10 240 UFLX 240-700-10 240 UFLX 240-750-10 240 UFLX 240-800-10 240 UFLX 240-850-10 240 UFLX 240-900-10 240 UFLX 240-950-10 240 UFLX 240-1000-10 240 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
0116 284 9900
FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
| 111
Flexible busbars
Isoflexx laminated busbar
• • • • •
CSA: 22mm² to 1200mm² Rated current: 130A to 3725A Laminate thickness: 0.5mm to 1mm Material: CU 99.99999 pure Operating temperature: -50°C to 180°C
Introduction ISOFLEXX busbar can be bent into acute angles and has a small bending radius; this saves space in the enclosures. Without the need for extra fixings, ISOFLEXX can be easily bolted to main busbars. Available in lengths of 250mm to 2000mm as standard.
ISOFLEXX busbar can also be customised, including cutting, bending and drilled/punched as required. Insulation: high quality PVC or halogen free silicon UL/CSA approved.
Ordering guide 32 - 100mm wide
9 - 24mm wide Part number 11311000 11311020 11311420 11311030 11311040 11311060 11311070 11311080 11311550 11311560 11311570 11311580 11311590 11311600 11311530 11311440 11311450 11311460 11311470 11311480 11311490
112 | FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
Dimensions
Cross section mm²
Current A
3x9x0.8 6x9x0.8 9x9x0.8 3x13x0.5 6x13x0.5 4x15.5x0.8 6x15.5x0.8 10x15.5x0.8 2x20x1 3x20x1 4x20x1 5x20x1 6x20x1 10x20x1 2x24x1 3x24x1 4x24x1 5x24x1 6x24x1 8x24x1 10x24x1
21.6 43.2 64.8 19.5 39 49.6 74.4 124 40 60 80 100 120 200 48 72 96 120 144 192 240
130 196 238 144 215 267 335 439 250 315 370 424 472 661 267 367 428 369 541 642 743
Part number 11311360 11311370 11311500 11311430 11311510 11311520 11311390 11311130 11311690 11311140 11311150 11311160 11311680 11311170 11311180 11311190 11311610 11311200 11311210 11311650 11311220 11311660 11311230 11311240 11311250 11311700 11311260 11311270 11311280
Dimensions
Cross section mm²
Current A
2x32x1 3x32x1 4x32x1 5x32x1 6x32x1 8x32x1 10x32x1 5x40x1 6x40x1 8x40x1 10x40x1 5x50x1 6x50x1 8x50x1 10x50x1 5x63x1 6x63x1 8x63x1 10x63x1 4x80x1 5x80x1 6x80x1 8x80x1 10x80x1 5x100x1 6x100x1 8x100x1 10x100x1 12x100x1
64 96 128 160 192 256 320 200 240 320 400 250 300 400 500 315 378 504 630 320 400 480 640 800 500 600 800 1000 1200
384 477 556 634 700 829 959 762 TBA 983 1131 927 TBA TBA 1357 1099 1253 1361 1569 1269 1423 1537 1766 1995 1729 TBA 2136 2407 2625
www.oem.co.uk
Flexible busbars
Accessories High current clamps
Part number 90010600 90010610 90010620
Twisting tool
Bending tool
Drilling jig
Pressure plates
Flat clamps
Type HSSK 80 HSSK 100 HSSK 120
Din rail fixings for 32mm Isoflexx
Part number 90080400 90080110
80 100 120
Part number 90090110
Type
Description
KSH50 KSH51
Complete clamp Lower clamp only
Type
Width (mm)
Approx. weight (Kg)
VD
480 x 80 x 40
1.6
Part number 90090100
Type
Width (mm)
Approx. weight (Kg)
BV100
780 x 280 x 290
24
Part number 90080100 90080110 90080120 90080130
Type
Width (mm)
Drill hole (mm)
BL16 BL20 BL24 BL32
16 20 24 32
6/8 8/10/12 8/10/12 10/12
Part number 90080300 90080310 90080320 90080330 90080340
Type
Clamp size W X H (mm)
DP32/1 DP40/1 DP40/2 DP50/1 DP50/2
3 x 30 40 x 40 40 x 80 50 x 50 50 x 80
Part number 90010200 90010310 90010210 90010320 90010220 90010330 90010230 90010340 90010240 90010350 90010360 90010250 90010370 90010380 90010260 90010280 90010300
0116 284 9900
Clamp siz W x H (mm)
No. holes 1 1 2 1 2
Type
Inner dims A x B (mm x mm)
Outer dims C x D (mm x mm)
FAK 16 x 16 FAK 16 x 32 FAK 20 x 20 FAK 20 x 40 FAK 25 x 25 FAK 25 x 50 FAK 32 x 32 FAK 32 x 63 FAK 40 x 40 FAK 40 x 53 FAK 40 x 80 FAK 50 x 50 FAK 50 x 80 FAK 50 x 100 FAK 60 x 63 FAK 80 x 80 FAK 100 x 100
16 x 16 16 x 32 20 x 20 20 x 40 25 x 25 25 x 50 32 x 32 32 x 63 40 x 40 40 x 53 40 x 80 50 x 50 50 x 80 50 x 100 60 x 63 80 x 80 100 x 100
35 x 35 35 x 52 40 x 40 40 x 60 45 x 45 45 x 70 52 x 50 52 x 82 60 x 60 60 x 82 70 x 110 70 x 70 80 x 110 80 x 130 80 x 82 120 x 120 140 x 140
Screw length 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 32 35 20 35 35 32 35 35
FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
| 113
Flexible busbars
MBS Earth braids
• • • • •
CSA: 6mm2 - 50mm2 Available tinned or copper bare Press welded ends, no additional ferrules required Custom lengths and hole sizes available on request Quick and easy to install, no preparation required
Introduction Earth braids from SPS, type MBS, are unique on the market as the ends of the braids are press welded under water in a special procedure. This procedure has several advantages: • no use of tin-lead solder • no use of cable shoes • minimal transition resistance, therefore low heating • soft thermal transition • no annealing through heating • no mechanical slot • low difference of strength in transition area • homogeneous structure in connecting area
The earth braids are produced of highly flexible E-Cu braids with a single wire dimension of 0.15mm, Cu bare or tinned. The braids can be used as earth braids as well as highly flexible transmission elements, if connections with low transfer and connection resistance are needed. Earth braids can be supplied with insulation. Other dimensions and cross sections up to 95mm² on request.
Ordering guide 6mm²
Cross section 6mm² Tinned Part number 330 100 11 330 150 11 330 200 11 330 250 11 330 300 11 330 500 11
Type
Hole diameter
MBS 6-100-6 M6 MBS 6-150-6 M6 MBS 6-200-6 M6 MBS 6-250-6 M6 MBS 6-300-6 M6 MBS 6-500-6 M6 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
100 150 200 250 300 500
13 13 13 13 13 13
50 50 50 50 50 50
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
100 150 200 250 300 500
13 13 13 13 13 13
80 80 80 80 80 80
10mm² Tinned Part number 331 100 11 331 150 11 331 200 11 331 250 11 331 300 11 331 500 11
Type
Hole diameter
MBS 10-100-6 M6 MBS 10-150-6 M6 MBS 10-200-6 M6 MBS 10-250-6 M6 MBS 10-300-6 M6 MBS 10-500-6 M6 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
114 | FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
www.oem.co.uk
Flexible busbars
Ordering guide 16mm²
Cross section 16mm² Tinned Part number 332 100 11 332 150 11 332 200 11 332 250 11 332 300 11 332 500 11
Type
Hole diameter
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
MBS 16-100-6 MBS 16-150-6 MBS 16-200-6 MBS 16-250-6 MBS 16-300-6 MBS 16-500-6
M6 M6 M6 M6 M6 M6
100 150 200 250 300 500
15 15 15 15 15 15
120 120 120 120 120 120
100 150 200 250 300 500
15 15 15 15 15 15
120 120 120 120 120 120
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
100 150 200 250 300 500
23 23 23 23 23 23
150 150 150 150 150 150
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
100 150 200 250 300 500
23 23 23 23 23 23
180 180 180 180 180 180
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
100 150 200 250 300 500
23 23 23 23 23 23
195 195 195 195 195 195
Length mm
Width mm
Current A
100 150 200 250 300 500
28 28 28 28 28 28
250 250 250 250 250 250
332 100 22 332 150 22 332 200 22 332 250 22 332 300 22 332 500 22
MBS 16-100-8 M8 MBS 16-150-8 M8 MBS 16-200-8 M8 MBS 16-250-8 M8 MBS 16-300-8 M8 MBS 16-500-8 M8 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
25mm²
Cross section 25mm² Tinned Part number 333 100 33 333 150 33 333 200 33 333 250 33 333 300 33 333 500 33
Type
Hole diameter
MBS 25-100-10 M10 MBS 25-150-10 M10 MBS 25-200-10 M10 MBS 25-250-10 M10 MBS 25-300-10 M10 MBS 25-500-10 M10 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
30mm²
Cross section 30mm² Tinned Part number 334 100 33 334 150 33 334 200 33 334 250 33 334 300 33 334 500 33
Type
Hole diameter
MBS 30-100-10 M10 MBS 30-150-10 M10 MBS 30-200-10 M10 MBS 30-250-10 M10 MBS 30-300-10 M10 MBS 30-500-10 M10 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
35mm²
Cross section 35mm² Tinned Part number 335 100 33 335 150 33 335 200 33 335 250 33 335 300 33 335 500 33
Type
Hole diameter
MBS 35-100-10 M10 MBS 35-150-10 M10 MBS 35-200-10 M10 MBS 35-250-10 M10 MBS 35-300-10 M10 MBS 35-500-10 M10 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
50mm²
Cross section 50mm² Tinned Part number 336 100 44 336 150 44 336 200 44 336 250 44 336 300 44 336 500 44
Type
Hole diameter
MBS 50-100-12 M12 MBS 50-150-12 M12 MBS 50-200-12 M12 MBS 50-250-12 M12 MBS 50-300-12 M12 MBS 50-500-12 M12 * Custom lengths & holes sizes available on request and may carry a MOQ
0116 284 9900
FLEXIBLE BUSBARS
| 115
GSM, SMS REPORTING MODULE
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
General information
118
Inputs/outputs
119
Log function
119
OTA (Over the air) configuration
120
Smartphone app
120
GSM portal
212
GSM-PRO
GSM-PRO communication module • • • •
SMS and E-mail support TS35 or direct mounting Analog input as standard Status LED’s
TypeCat. no. Size (L x W x H) with TS 35 x 7.5 without antenna
GSM-PRO 88 x 95 x 77 mm
Input specifications
CONTA-CLIP's GSM-PRO module offers a remote control and maintenance solution which allows you to monitor and control decentralized facilities. The GSM-PRO module informs you when the process reaches a userdefined status or limit value. Digital and analogue inputs values can also be transmitted via e-mail or SMS (text message). The digital relay outputs can be switched using an SMS sent from the decentralized control room or from the service technician. Thus the process can be monitored and controlled remotely. Monitoring and controlling the GSM-PRO module is even easier when you use our iPhone or Android App. If you are using multiple modules and you need a complete overview of all modules in the field at a glance, then CONTA-CLIP's portal software provides another helpful solution. All of the module inputs, output and associated functions can be easily configured using the module software included in the delivery.
8 multi-function analog/digital inputs Resolution / accuracy (0..10 V)
0..10 V / 24 V DC (10..30 V DC) 20 mV / ±(20 mV+0,3%*)
Output specifications
4 relay outputs
4 x CO Contact, 250 V ~
Rated current
5A
GSM data
Frequency
850/900/1800/1900 MHz
Transmit power Antenna
Class 4 (2 W@850/900 MHz), Class 1 (1 W@1800/1900 MHz) 50 Ohm impedance, SMA connector
General data
Module power supply
10..30 V DC
Module current (max)
275 mA DC @ 24V DC
Backup power
Internal maintenance free supercap capacitor
The wide-range input makes it possible to operate the GSM-PRO with supply voltages from 10 to 30 V DC. So the I/O module can also be used in mobile applications, such as those for the transportation sector. Order number
Eight multi-function inputs
Decription
Quantity
GSM-PRO
GSM-PRO module
1
GSM-ANT
Stubby antenna
1
GSM-SMA-3M
External antenna 3m cable
1
GSM-SMA-5M
External antenna 5m cable
1
GSM-SMA-10M
External antenna 10m cable
1
GSM-SMA-ECO
Economy external antenna 3m cable
1
USB cable
1
Portal software key**
1
GSM-USB GSM-PORTAL-KEY **
** The portal software can be downloaded at www.conta-clip.de. The software is free for up to two GSM-PRO modules. If you are monitoring more modules, you can order a software key using this order number.
• • • • •
Stay up-to-date with just one SMS or E-mail message OTA (over-the-air) capabilities Log functionality: Free smart phone apps Portal software
Four digital outputs
118 | GSM-PRO
www.oem.co.uk
GSM-PRO
Inputs
Outputs
The GSM-PRO module features eight multi-function inputs. The input module may be selected as either digital (24 V DC) or analogue (0 to 10V), so that many different signal levels can be connected.
The GSM-PRO module features four change-over relay outputs rated at 250V/5A. The versatility of the outputs enables machine and facility functions to be controlled even when you are not on-site.
A designated person or group from the built-in address book will then be notified with an SMS or e-mail message if a specified status changes on the input side. The software allows you to easily specify the notification status, the person or group to be notified, and the content of the SMS. You can also query the current status of the process or machine simply by sending a query SMS message. The query message can specify specific inputs or all inputs.
The status of one or more outputs can be queried with a single SMS text message. When a process requires a control pulse, the outputs can also be controlled with an SMS. An output can also be activated simply by calling it up when using the call-in function. If an output only needs to be controlled for a specific duration (to issue a reset pulse, for example), then the output can be activated for a period between 1 and 36,000 seconds using an SMS or phone call to activate the impulse-ON contact function.
Analogue inputs
It is also possible to link an output internally to a digital input. So as soon as the input switches to “one”, an SMS or e-mail is sent out and the corresponding output is switched.
The required measurement units can be custom defined on the analogue inputs (kg, bar, etc.). You can then monitor an analogue process and have an SMS message sent out depending on various circumstances: • When an input exceeds a defined maximum limit, • When an input is below a defined maximum limit, • When an input returns to a normal state within the specified limits.
E-mail E-mails are sent directly from the GSM-PRO module via an SMTP server to the recipient. The software also allows you to set up your own server. Just a single SMS or phone call is sufficient for controlling your facility or machine when you are not on site.
Log function The extensive log functionality of the GSM-PRO module allows you to log events that have taken place at a facility or a machine over a defined period of time.
Event log This log function of the module keeps track of a variety of activities and events. The following events are logged:#
• The threshold limit on an analogue input (AI) has been reached • Rising and falling edges of the digital inputs (DI) • Incoming messages • Outgoing messages • Data transfers • OTA updates
Logs for the analogue inputs When analogue signals are being used in a process, the GSM-PRO features an AI Log function which allows you to log any process values from the analogue input which have a specified frequency. In this way you can compile a history of the process that can help you later to optimize the process. The logging frequency can be configured in steps from 5 to 60 minutes. Both log files can be transferred to the PC using a USB cable. Or, using the OTA functions, you can have the log files automatically sent to your e-mail address.
Run-time counter How many hours has the motor been running? Is the unit due for servicing or maintenance? The run-time counter for the GSM-PRO module‘s I/Os simplify control. As soon as an input or output is activated, the time is registered and added to a pre-set time interval. The counter value of an input or output can be queried at any time with an SMS. Or the current counter readings can be added to the module‘s periodic status messages.
0116 284 9900
GSM-PRO
| 119
GSM-PRO
OTA (Over the Air configuration) In many systems or machines, some parameters or user entries may need to be changed after the installation is completed. In such cases you may also need to change parameters on the GSM-PRO module. The GSM-PRO module features OTA (over-the-air) functions for just such instances. This functionality allows you to change parameters without having to be on site. The initial configuration process must always take place via a direct USB connection between the GSM-PRO module and the PC. When the APN settings are specified during this initial configuration, it is still possible to access the module later via OTA and change the configuration. Whether youâ&#x20AC;&#x2122;re adding a new phone number of a user, a new I/O setting, a change in the module name or any other change: the settings on all GSM-PRO modules can easily be changed from remote locations.
OTA firmware updates The GSM-PRO module can also update its firmware using OTA, so modules with different versions can always be kept up to date. The newest software can be installed remotely. You can also add new functions and configure them without being on site. OTA firmware update can be triggered with an SMS that is sent to the GSM-PRO module containing a specific code. This setting allows the user to have complete control of whether or when an update will be installed.
Smartphone app CONTA-CLIPâ&#x20AC;&#x2DC;s new iPhone and Android smartphone apps for the GSMPRO modules provide a simple and fast solution so that you can get an overview of each distributed system and application. These apps can show you the status of all inputs and outputs from one or more GSM-PRO modules.
120 | GSM-PRO
They also allow you some control over the process. Module outputs can be controlled easily and directly using this app. The app buttons provide an intuitive control interface (for controlling the heating, a motor, water pump, etc.).
www.oem.co.uk
GSM-PRO
GSM portal It is often quite helpful to have one overall view of the status of all modules used in the field. The new GSM-PRO portal software from CONTA-CLIP offers you precisely this possibility.
This software is very easy to install and configure. All modules in the field can now be easily monitored and run from a single local site or control panel.
The GSM-PRO portal can be installed on any Windows PC (XP, Vista, or W7). The field modules use port forwarding to communicate with the portal software so that they can be monitored and controlled. Specific IP addresses and ports must first be configured on the GSM-PRO modules in the field and in the portal software in order to enable this functionality. Pre-installed modules can also be integrated later into the portal by using OTA configuration.
Once the portal software is started on the PC, all modules are quickly registered. They are then listed in alphabetical order on the portal. The portal displays an overview of registered GSM-PRO modules, which already shows the status of all detected inputs and outputs. Any state changes to the inputs or outputs are marked yellow in the overview. So even when many modules are registered with the portal, changes to any one module are easily visible. In addition to this monitoring function, the outputs of all field modules can be controlled directly. By clicking the mouse on the corresponding button in the portal software, a broadcast signal is sent out and the selected outputs are activated.
When a module is selected, a window opens showing detailed information about that particular module. The specific names of the I/Os are displayed along with the standardized abbreviations of the GSM-PRO module. All module outputs can be controlled by simply clicking on the corresponding portal buttons. The â&#x20AC;&#x153;Events Logâ&#x20AC;? lists all actions and I/Os for the module. This log can also be easily exported. The GSM-PRO portal provides a clear, versatile monitoring and control system for GSM-PRO modules. It can be easily implemented without any prior programming knowledge.
0116 284 9900
GSM-PRO
| 121
LOGIC CONTROLLERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Introduction
124
Smart range
125
Essential range
125
Digital extension modules
130
Analogue extension and communication modules
131
Power supplies
132
Remote display and HMI
133
Accessories
134
Technical specification
135
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 introduction What is a Logic Controller? A logic controller is a programmable module which is used to control small automation systems or small installations. The logic controller is a plural solution in a control system since it contains solutions that can replace a number of products; timers, counters, control relays,
temperature controllers, impulse relays etc. The logic controller operates as the brains of an application. It is capable of retrieving information and triggering actions; it can be adapted to suit the needs of customer applications.
Temperature Controllers
Control Relays
Counters
Millenium 3 features
Timers
User friendly and ergonomic • Panel, DIN-rail or consumer unit mountable for simple installation • Wide accessory range; touch screens, sensors and power supplies • Blue screen display (Smart version) for improved legibility • Wide operating temperature range; -20°c to +70°c Low-cost • Wiring time reduced by programming with M3 software • Several automation functions contained in a single product Communication and expansion • Communication products to enable remote supervision or send alarms, data etc • Expandable versions to maintain future project development Simple to use • Simple function block based programming (ladder programming also available)
124 | LOGIC CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Logic controllers
The Smart Range
• • • • • • • •
Compact and expandable versions Backlit blue LCD display Operating temperature up to 70°c Supply voltage; 12VDC to 230VAC Memory; 700 Blocks Up to 50 I/O Can be linked together to create a network Modbus communication available
• • • • •
Compact and expandable versions Backlit green LCD display Operating temperature up to 55°c Supply voltage; 12 and 24VDC Memory; 350 block for compact version, 700 blocks for expandable version
Exclusive Smart Range function blocks Of a library of 120 function blocks, 19 are exclusive to Millenium 3 Smart and are dedicated to industry-specific applications, communication and complex calculations.
The Essential Range
0116 284 9900
LOGIC CONTROLLERS
| 125
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – smart range with display
• • • • • • •
Highly visible blue LCD display Allows full use of extensive function block library Expandable and non expandable models User definable front panel Application specific functions Digital, analogue and potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs
Dimensions CD20/CB20/XD26 CD12/CB12/XD10
Ordering guide Compact range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
Power supply
88974041
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 Relay 8A
24VDC
88974042
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5A (including 1 PWM)
24VDC
88974043
CD12
8 digital
4 Relay 8A
100-240VAC
88974044
CD12
8 digital
4 Relay 8A
24VAC
88974045
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 Relay 8A
12VDC
88974046
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5A (including 1 PWM)
12VDC
88974051
CD20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 Relay 8A
24VDC
88974052
CD20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 solid state 0.5A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
88974053
CD20
12 digital
8 Relay 8A
100-240VAC
88974054
CD20
12 digital
8 Relay 8A
24VAC
88974055
CD20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 Relay 8A
12VDC
Expandable range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
Power supply
88974141
XD10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 Relay 8A
24VDC
88974142
XD10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5A (including 1 PWM)
24VDC
88974143
XD10
6 digital
4 Relay 8A
100-240VAC
88974144
XD10
6 digital
4 Relay 8A
24VAC
88974161
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
24VDC
88974162
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
88974163
XD26
16 digital
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
100-240VAC
88974164
XD26
16 digital
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
24VAC
88974165
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
12VDC
88974166
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
12VDC
126 | LOGIC CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – smart range without display
• • • • •
Allows full use of extensive function block library Expandable and non expandable models Application specific functions Digital, analogue and potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs
Dimensions CD20/CB20/XD26 CD12/CB12/XD10
Ordering guide Compact range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
88974021
CB12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
Power supply 24VDC
88974023
CB12
8 digital
4 relays 8 A
100-240VAC
88974024
CB12
8 digital
4 relays 8 A
24VAC
88974026
CB12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
12VDC
88974031
CB20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 relays 8 A
24VDC
88974033
CB20
12 digital
8 relays 8 A
100-240VAC
88974034
CB20
12 digital
8 relays 8 A
24VAC
Power supply
Expandable range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
88974131
XB10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
24VDC
88974132
XB10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
24VDC
88974133
XB10
6 digital
4 relays 8 A
100-240VAC
88974134
XB10
6 digital
4 relays 8 A
24VAC
88974151
XB26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
24VDC
88974152
XB26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
88974153
XB26
16 digital
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
100-240VAC
88974154
XB26
16 digital
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
24VAC
88974155
XB26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
12VDC
0116 284 9900
LOGIC CONTROLLERS
| 127
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – essential range with display
• • • • • •
Cost effective solution Green LCD Display Expandable and non expandable models User definable front panel Digital, analogue and potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs
Dimensions CD20/CB20/XD26 CD12/CB12/XD10
Ordering guide Compact range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
88970041
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
Power supply 24VDC
88970042
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
24VDC
88970045
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
12VDC
88970865
CD12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
12VDC
88970051
CD20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 relays 8 A
24VDC
88970052
CD20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
88970055
CD20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 relays 8 A
12VDC
Power supply
Expandable range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
88970141
XD10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
24VDC
88970142
XD10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
24VDC
88970161
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
24VDC
88970162
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
88970165
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
12VDC
88970814
XD26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
12VDC
128 | LOGIC CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – essential range without display
• • • •
Cost effective solution Expandable and non expandable models Digital, analogue and potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs
Dimensions CD20/CB20/XD26 CD12/CB12/XD10
Ordering guide Compact range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
88970021
CB12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
Power supply 24VDC
88970840
CB12
8 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
12VDC
88970031
CB20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 relays 8 A
24VDC
88970806
CB20
12 digital (including 6 analogue)
8 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
Power supply
Expandable range Part number
Type
Inputs
Outputs
88970131
XB10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 relays 8 A
24VDC
88970132
XB10
6 digital (including 4 analogue)
4 solid state 0.5 A (including 1 PWM)
24VDC
88970151
XB26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
24VDC
88970152
XB26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 solid state 0.5 A (including 4 PWM)
24VDC
88970155
XB26
16 digital (including 6 analogue)
10 relays (8 x 8 A relay and 2 x 5 A relay)
12VDC
0116 284 9900
LOGIC CONTROLLERS
| 129
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – digital extension modules
• • • •
For XD10 and XD26 expandable Milleniums only One XR digital extension per Millenium Can be used with XE10 expandable extension Power supplied via the controller at the same voltage as the inputs
Dimensions XR06 XR10/XR14/XE10
Ordering guide Type
Input
Output
Ordering code
XR06
4 inputs 24vdc
2 relay outputs
88 970 211
4 inputs 100-240vac
2 relay outputs
88 970 213
4 inputs 24vac
2 relay outputs
88 970 214
4 inputs 12vdc
2 relay outputs
88 970 215
XR10
XR14
6 inputs 24vdc
4 relay outputs
88 970 221
6 inputs 100-240vac
4 relay outputs
88 970 223
6 inputs 24vac
4 relay outputs
88 970 224
6 inputs 12vdc
4 relay outputs
88 970 225
8 inputs 24vdc
6 relay outputs
88 970 231
8 inputs 100-240vac
6 relay outputs
88 970 233
8 inputs 24vac
6 relay outputs
88 970 234
8 inputs 12vdc
6 relay outputs
88 970 235
• XE expandable extension for use with above extensions • Offers a further 10 I/O XE10
130 | LOGIC CONTROLLERS
6 inputs 24vac
4 relay outputs
88 970 324
6 inputs 100-240vac
4 relay outputs
88 970 323
6 inputs 24vdc
4 relay outputs
88 970 321
www.oem.co.uk
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – analogue & communication modules Analogue extension module
• 10-bit analogue extension • 2 inputs/2 outputs Type
Input
Output
Voltage
Ordering code
XA04
2 analogue
2 analogue
24Vdc
88 970 241
Communication modules
• Field bus with Modbus RS-485 protocol (XN03) • TCP Modbus on Ethernet (XN05) • For 24vdc controller only Type
Designation
Voltage
Ordering code
XN03
Modbus (slave)
24Vdc
88 970 250
XN05
Ethernet (slave)
24Vdc
88 970 270
XN07
Master
24Vdc
88 974 250
• Interface module for use with STN and GSM modem’s • 12-24 vdc Type
Designation
Voltage
Ordering code
COM
Modem interface
12-24Vdc
88 970 117
• Modem via a line network (STN) • Remotely download, modify and interrogate all controller functions Type
Designation
Voltage
Ordering code
MOD
STN modem
12-24Vdc
88 970 118
• Modem via a wireless network (GSM) • For isolated installations • Remotely download, modify and interrogate all controller functions
0116 284 9900
Type
Designation
Voltage
Ordering code
MOD
GSM modem
12-24Vdc
88 970 119 LOGIC CONTROLLERS
| 131
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – power supplies
• • • • • •
12 & 24 Vdc versions Automatic surge & short circuit protection Switch mode technology LED indication DIN rail housing Same profile as the programmable controller units
General specification Input voltage: 100 to 240Vac single phase (+20%/-15%) Supply frequency range: 50/60 Hz (+4%/-6%) Output voltage (V): Adjustable from 100 to 120% Primary switch mode electronic Technology: power supply Short circuit protection: Yes Overload protection: Yes
Reset after overload Automatic Status indication LED at the output Mounting DIN rail EN 50022 IEC EN 60950-1 Conformity to standards IEC EN 61000-6-2 IEC EN 61000-6-1 IEC EN 61000-6-3 Certifications CE, UL-CSA, TüV
Dimensions
Ordering guide Type PS5 -20W PS12 - 25W PS24 - 7.5W PS24 - 15W PS24 - 30W PS24 - 60W
132 | LOGIC CONTROLLERS
Output voltage 5 V DC (4,75 V ––> 6,25 V) 12 V DC (11,4 V ––> 15 V) 24 V DC (22,8 V ––> 28,8 V) 24 V DC (22,8 V ––> 28,8 V) 24 V DC (22,8 V ––> 28,8 V) 24 V DC (22,8 V ––> 28,8 V)
Nominal power 20 W 25 W 7,5 W 15 W 30 W 60 W
Nominal output current 4A 2.1A 0.3A 0.6A 1.2A 2.5A
Ordering code 88950305 88950306 88950303 88950304 88950307 88950302
www.oem.co.uk
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – remote display and HMI
• Universal screen compatible with any Millenium 3 logic controller • Set and parameterise your application data in advance • Backlit LCD screen with 4 lines of 18 characters and keypad with 6 keys or 10 keys and 4 LEDs • Direct communication with the Millenium 3 via the programming port • Plug and play: no additional software (the function keys and LEDs are controlled by the Millenium 3 Soft SLIn/ SLOut FBD functions) • Check bit for controlling communication
Ordering guide Part number
Type
Designation
88970410
RD
Remote LCD screen/keypad
88970412
RD
Kit with remote LCD screen/keypad + 3 m cable (88970102)
88970411
RD
Remote LCD screen/keypad + 4 function keys + 4 LEDs
88970413
RD
Kit with remote LCD screen/keypad + 4 function keys + 4 LEDs + 3 m cable (88970102)
Millenium 3 – remote display and HMI
• 4.3’‘ & 7”TFT-LCD compact resistive touch panels, 65536 colours, LED backlight • Wide viewing angle: 70° horizontally and vertically • Fan-less cooling system • Text, data, graphic and animation display • Processing of alarms and recipes • 400 M Hz core logic, 64 MB RAM • 128 MB flash memory storage • Direct communication via the Millenium 3 programming port • Programmable with user-friendly EB software • RS232/RS485 serial port (4.3” only) • 2 RS232/RS485 serial ports, USB 1.1 port, USB 2.0 port (7” only) • SD card slot (7” only)
Ordering guide Part number
Type
Designation
Size
88970492
RD
MTP6/50 user kit (fixing brackets, MTP-M3 cable)
4.3”
88970494
RD
MTP8/50 user kit (fixing brackets, MTP-M3 cable)
4.3”
88970501
PA
MTP6/50-MTP8/70 programming kit - USB-MiniUSB connection (EB /helpfile CD, USB-MiniUSB cable)
88970502
PA
MTP8/50-MTP8/70 programming kit - Ethernet crossover connection (EB/ helpfile CD, RJ45 crossover cable)
88970496
RD
MTP8/70 user kit (MTP8/70, fixing brackets, MTP-M3 cable)
88970501
RD
MTP6/50-MTP8/70 programming kit - USB-MiniUSB connection (EB /helpfile CD, USB-MiniUSB cable)
88970502
RD
MTP8/50-MTP8/70 programming kit - Ethernet crossover connection (EB/helpfile CD, RJ45 crossover cable)
0116 284 9900
7”
Programming
Connection
USB-MiniUSB cable
Direct connection M3-MTP Modbus RS232/RS485 serial port
Ethernet RJ45 crossover cable
Direct connection M3-MTP Modbus RS232/RS485 serial port, Ethernet TCP/IP port
USB-MiniUSB cable /Ethernet RJ45 crossover cable
Direct connection M3-MTP2 Modbus RS232/RS485 serial ports, USB port, Ethernet port
LOGIC CONTROLLERS
| 133
Logic controllers
Millenium 3 – accessories
• Connection accessories • Programming tools and software • Faceplates • Communication accessories
Ordering guide Connection accessories Type
Description
88970102
Part number
PA
3 m serial link cable : PC-Millenium 3
88970109
PA
USB cable 3 m : PC-Millenium 3
88970123
PA
1,80 m serial link cable : DB9 M / DB9 F
88970510
PA
500 mm serial link cable Millenium 3-DB9 M
Programming tools & software Type
Description
88970111
Part Number
M3 Soft
Multilingual programming software containing specific library functions (CD-ROM)
88970116
M3 Alarm
Alarm management software (CD-ROM)
88970108
PA
ROM memory cartridge
Faceplate adaptors Part number
Type
Description
MA
IP67 sealed faceplate for the following products : - XD10 or CD12
MA
IP67 sealed faceplate for the following products : XD10 + XR06 or XN03 or XN05 or XA04 CD20 or XD26 XD10 + XN03 or XN05 + XR06 or XA04- XD10 + XR10 or XR14
MA
IP67 sealed faceplate for the following products : XD26 + XR06 or XN03 or XN05 or XA04- XD10 + XN03 XA04 + XR10 or XR14- XD10 + XE10 + XR06 or XA04 XD26 + XN03 or XN05 + XR06 or XA04- XD26 + XR10 XR14- XD10 + XE10 + XR10 or XR14 - XD26 + XE10 + XR06 XA04- XD26 + XN03 or XN05 + XR10 or XR14
88970809
MA1
IP40 faceplate : CD12 or XD10
88970810
MA1
IP40 faceplate : CD20 or XD26
89750160 89750161
89750162
Communication accessories Part number 88970125
Description RJ45 tee joint wiith 20cm cable
88970126
EOL ferrules RC120 Ω 1nF (pack of 2)
88970127
RJ45 wiring kit ( 2 tees, 2 ferrules 1 x 4 pair FTP cable, 3m)
134 | LOGIC CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Logic controllers
Technical specification General characteristics
24 Vac input
Earthing Depending on the part number ; refer to the quick reference guide supplied with the product IP 40 on front panel Protection IP 20 on terminal block Certifications UL,CSA,GL pending Conformity to standards IEC/EN 61131-2 (Zone B), IEC/EN 61000-6-2, IEC/EN 61000-6-3, IEC/EN 61000-6-4 Programming method SFC/function blocks/ladder logic Program size CB,CD,XD :typically 250 blocks Program memory Flash EEPROM Removable memory EEPROM 368 bits/200 words Data memory backed up for 10 years LCD display Display with 4 lines of 18 characters Real-time clock Drift <12 min/year at 25 °C) 6 s/month (at 25°C with user- definable correction of drift) Data retention :10 years (lithium battery) Storage temperature -40 to +70°C Operating temperature -20 to +40°C Relative humidity -no 95 %max. condensation acc.to IEC/EN 60068-2-3 &IEC/EN 60068-2-30
Input voltage 24 Vac (+20% -15%) Supply frequency range 50/60 Hz (+4 %/-6 %) Input impedance 4.6 kΩ ≥14 Vac Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 Drop out voltage at logic state 0 ≤5 Vac Status indicator On LCD screen for CD and XD
100...240 Vac power supply Operating voltage 100 - 240 Vac (+10%-15%) Supply frequency range 50/60 Hz (+4 %/-6 %) Operating limits 85 - 264 Vac Immunity from micro power cuts 10ms CB12-CD12-XD10 :7 VA Max. absorbed power CB20-CD20-EC20 :11 VA XD10 with extension -XD26 :12VA XD26 with extension :17 VA
24 Vac power supply Operating voltage 24 Vac (+20%-15%) Supply frequency range 50/60 Hz (+4 %/-6 %) 20.4 - 28.8 Vac Operating limits Immunity from micro power cuts 10ms Max. absorbed power CB12-CD12-XD10 :4VA CB20-CD20 :6 VA XD10 with extension -XD26 :7.5VA XD26 with extension :10VA
24 Vdc power supply Operating voltage 24 Vdc (+25%-20%) 19.2 - 30 Vdc Operating limits Immunity from micro power cuts 1ms Max. absorbed power CB12-CD12-CD20 with solid state outputs XD10 with solid state outputs :3W XD26 with solid state outputs :5W CB20-CD20 with relay outputs XD26 with relay outputs :6 W XD10 with extension :8 W XD26 with extension :10 W
12 Vdc power supply Operating voltage 12 Vdc (+20%-13%) Operating limits 10.4 - 14.4 Vdc Immunity from micro power cuts 1ms Max. absorbed power CD12 : 1.5W CD20 : 2.5W
100 - 240 Vac input Input voltage Supply frequency range Input impedance Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 Drop out voltage at logic state 0 Response time Status indicator
0116 284 9900
100 - 240 Vac (+10% -15%) 50/60 Hz (+4 %/-6 %) 350 KΩ ≥79 V AC ≤40 V AC 50 ms On LCD screen for CD and XD
Analogue input (24 Vdc models only) CB12-CD12-XD10 4 inputs from IB to IE CB20-CD20-XD26 6 inputs from IB to IG Measurement range 0 to 10 V or 0 to power supply voltage 10 bits Resolution Conversion time Controller cycle time 30 Vdc Max. input voltage Input impedance (KΩ) >12 kΩ Precision at 25ºC ±5% Precision at 55ºC ±6.2 % Potentiometer control 2.2 kΩ/0.5 W
24 Vdc input Current drain 24 Vdc (+25% -20%) Input current 0.75 mA/2.2 mA max 7.4 kΩ Input impedance Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 ≥15 Vdc Drop out voltage at logic state 0 ≤5 Vdc Galvanic isolation No Sensor type Contact - 3 wire PNP On LCD screen for CD and XD Status indicator
12 Vdc input Input voltage 12 Vdc (+20% -13%) Input current 0.9 mA/2 mA max 6.45 kΩ Input impedance Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 ≥5.6 Vdc Drop out voltage at logic state 0 ≤2.4 Vdc Galvanic isolation No Sensor type Contact - 3 wire PNP On LCD screen for CD and XD Status indicator
Analogue input (12 Vdc models only) CB12-CD12-XD10 4 inputs from IB to IE CB20-CD20-XD26 6 inputs from IB to IG 0 to 10 V or 0 to power supply voltage Measurement range Resolution 10 bits Controller cycle time Conversion time Max. input voltage 14.4 Vdc Input impedance (KΩ) 14 kΩ Precision at 25ºC ±5% ±6.2 % Precision at 55ºC Potentiometer control 2.2 kΩ/0.5 W
Relay outputs Max. breaking voltage 250 Vac/150 Vac Breaking current CB-CD-XD10-XR06-XR10 :8 A XD26 :8 x 8 A relays, 2 x 5 A relays XR14 :4 x 8 A relays, 2 x 5 A relays Service life 10.000.000 operations Min. load 10mA/12 Vdc Response time 10ms Status indicator On LCD screen for CD and XD
TOR /PWM solid state output PWM solid state outputs CD12-XD10 :O4 CD20-XD26 :O4 <O7 Breaking voltage 19.2-28.8 V DC Breaking current 0.625 A Min. load 1 mA Max. incandescent load 0.1A Leakage 0.1mA/24 Vdc Response time 1ms Insulation no PWM frequency 14 Hz to 1806 Hz (configurable) PWM cyclic ratio 0 to 100 % (256 steps) PWM precision at 120 Hz <5% (20% to 85%) load at 10mA PWM precision 500Hz <10%(20% to 80%) load at 10mA Status indicator On LCD screen for CD and XD LOGIC CONTROLLERS
| 135
NANO PLC
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Product overview
138
Controllers, extensions and interfaces
139
Programming software and remote access
140
Dimensions and part numbers
141
Nano PLC
more than just a Nano-PLC em4 is a leading edge device supported by best-in-class tools that enables you to create and implement the smartest automation applications
lab
soft
web
app
partners community
remote Fully connected nano-PLC includes all em4 lab functionalities
alert Nano-PLC that can alert you via SMS or email
local The em4 for standalone use or local are network
3 high-tech designs that are easy to integrate in your machine Glossy black
Glossy white
Robust
Ready to use accessories • USB interface • RS485 Modbus interface • MTP touch panels
Compact and expandable • up to 46 I/Os with the same nano-PLC
Accuracy and performance • Measure precisely your high end industrial sensors with the most accurate configurable analog inputs embedded in a nano-PLC (including 4-20 mA) • The inherent performance allows you to upgrade your machine over time: • More eficiency (the 32 bit processor calculation) • More memory availablee for your application (up to 1000 function blocks) • More control (50 μs per function block)
138 | NANO PLC
www.oem.co.uk
Nano PLC
Controllers, extensions and interfaces EM4 – Local/Remote/Alert • • • • • • • • •
26 I/O 24 VDC (-15% +20%) power supply Highly visible HMI 4 configurable digital inputs for encoder (20 kHz), or high speed count (60 kHz) 12 digital/analog inputs including 4(0-10 V, 0-20, 4-20mA) 2 static PWM outputs 8 relay outputs (2 x 6 A, 6 x 8 A) Large memory (100 FB ) Programmable locally with an USB interface Optional Interface for Modbus RS485 slave
Digital and analogue extensions Up to two same or different expansions can be added to the base station to expand up to 46 I/OS • Digital; 6 digital/analog configurable inputs (0-10V or potentiometer) 4 relay outputs (2 x 6 A and 2 x 8 A) • Analogue; 6 digital/analog configurable inputs (0-10 V, 0-20 mA, 4-20 mA) with a good accuracy for industrial sensors 4 static outputs (2x Digital/PWM and 2x 0-10 V) allowing controlling analog actuators (controlled valve, controlled pump...)
Interfaces Modbus RS485 slave interface Control or supervise one or several em4 via Modbus RS485 USB interface Connect em4 soft or other application via USB port
0116 284 9900
NANO PLC
| 139
Nano PLC
Programming software and remote access EM4 – “Soft” software • Easy-to-use – quick, simple and intuitive programming that requires no specialist knowledge ,a simulation mode that represents PLC operation and a debug mode to test the application program in the field • Application-oriented – create and save custom macros, read a Millenium 3 application program and save it in em4 format, use our complete range of basic and dedicated function blocks,and discover our new range of remote management and maintenance function blocks • Technical details – use the easy FBD/SFC programming language with a large library of standard and specific powerful FB’s • New remote function blocks – include event management for pushing alert messages, Log data for recording a history of values, XBin, XWin for remotely adjusting set points, XBout, XWout for reading remotely data values • Windows XP, Seven, and Windows 8 compatible
EM4 – “Web” • • • • • •
Manage your EM4 fleet, online, anywhere in the world Manage your access rights, as well as our customers's Download your application program or firmware Monitor and control your devices – track them on a map Display your data history Receive event notifications by email or SMS
EM4 – “App” • Mobile complement to the "em4 web" platform, the em4 mobile app is the ultimate way to control and monitor your em4 from your smartphone • This is a free application, included in your em4 remote PLC. It uses a fully secured and optimized infrastructure to ensure total protection of your data.Simply scan the QR on the product, log in, and instantly begin monitoring and controlling your device.
140 | NANO PLC
www.oem.co.uk
Nano PLC
Ordering EM4 – Local/Remote/Alert
em4 alert B26 24VDC-2GS Glossy White
88981153
em4 remote B26 24VDC-2GC Glossy Black
88981154
em4 remote B26 24VDC-2GC Glossy White
88981106
Starter Kit em4 local B26 24VDC Glossy Black
88981107
Starter Kit em4 local B26 24VDC Glossy White
88981116
Starter Kit em4 alert B26 24VDC-2GS Glossy Black
88981117
Starter Kit em4 alert B26 24VDC-2GS Glossy White
88981156
Starter Kit em4 remote B26 24VDC-2GC Glossy Black
88981157
Starter Kit em4 remote B26 24VDC-2GC Glossy White
88980180
Evaluation Case em4 local B26 24VDC GB
88980181
Evaluation Case em4 alert B26 24VDC-2GS GB
88980185
Evaluation Case em4 remote B26 24VDC-2GC GB
88982213
em4 extension E10A 24VDC Glossy Black
88982214
em4 extension E10A 24VDC Glossy White
88980110
em4 interface USB Black
88980111
em4 interface USB interface White
88980120
em4 interface RS485 24VDC Modbus S Black
88980121
em4 interface RS485 24VDC Modbus S White
88980150
em4 Set of I/O Simulator for B26 24VDC
88980160
Antenna 3M Standard
88980161
Antenna 3M Int/Ext Flat
88980162
Antenna 10M Ext
88980170
USB cable 3M B Type
88980140
em4 soft (USB key)
48.7 / 1.91 62.6 / 2.46 64.8 / 2.55
90 / 3.54
88981114
108.1 / 4.25
em4 alert B26 24VDC-2GS Glossy Black
mm inch
B26 2GC Glossy 124.6 / 4.90 87.6 / 3.45 43.2 / 1.70
64.8 / 2.55
48.7 / 1.91 60.4 / 2.38
90 / 3.54
em4 local B26 24VDC Glossy White
88981113
45 / 1.77
88981104
124.6 / 4.90 87.6 / 3.45 43.2 / 1.70
45 / 1.77
em4 local B26 24VDC Glossy Black
99.4 3.91
88981103
0116 284 9900
B26 2GC Robust
Product Description
99.4 3.91
Part no
108.1 / 4.25
• • • •
80 / 3.15
•
26 I/O 24 VDC (-15% +20%) power supply Highly visible HMI 4 configurable digital inputs for encoder (20 kHz), or high speed count (60 kHz) 12 digital/analog inputs including 4(0-10 V, 0-20, 4-20mA) 2 static PWM outputs 8 relay outputs (2 x 6 A, 6 x 8 A) Large memory (100 FB ) Programmable locally with an USB interface Optional Interface for Modbus RS485 slave
80 / 3.15
• • • •
mm inch
NANO PLC
| 141
PANEL METERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Moving coil meters
144
Moving iron meters
146
Shunts
147
N24/25 series indicators
148
N20/N20Z indicators with outputs
148
N30U/N30O programmable displays with outputs
150
N30H/N30P programmable displays with outputs
151
NA3, NA5/6 bargraph displays
152
NA5/NA6 programmable bargraph meter
153
B
Panel meters
Moving coil meters
• • • •
DC current and voltage measurement DIN sizes 48, 72, 96 and 144mm Red pointer option Built in rectifier option
Technical data Accuracy class: Direct current range: Direct voltage range: Red pointer option:
Protection degree: - case - terminals Operating temperature: Material:
1.5 1 mA to 30 A 60 mV to 1000 V MA17 & MA19 on request
IP50 (IP65 on request) IP20 with protective cover -20 to 60 deg C Thermoplastic case with glass front
Dimensions a
e
f
g
d
k
c
a
58
Type EA16 EA17 EA19 EA12
b
22
a
b
48 72 96 144
4 4 405
c
d
e
f
48
68 92 137
5 5 5 6
10 10 10 10
45 48
g
h
2035 68 32.5 92 55.5 138
c
Part number key Moving coil meters Din size: 48 x 48 72 x 72 96 x 96 144 x 144 Protection degree: IP50 (standard) IP65 Meter type: ammeter direct (select code from table) voltmeter direct (select code from table) ammeter 4-20mA Scale options: normal red mark blank scale no unit no range no range or unit scale 0 - 20% Scale colour: white black without scale Red pointer: no pointer red pointer Panel mounting angle: 90 degrees (standard) Please enquire for other options
144 | PANEL METERS
XXXX
X
XXXX
X
X
XXXX
X
MA16 MA17 MA19 MA12 N I XXXX XXXX A900 0 B C D E F H 0 1 2 0000 0001 0 X
www.oem.co.uk
Panel meters
Ammeter codes Ammeter Direct input range connection with scale 100mA 150mA 250mA 400mA 500mA 600mA 1A 1.5A 2.5A 4A 5A 6A 10A 15A 20A 25A 30A 40A 50A 60A 80A 100A 150A 200A 250A 300A 400A 500A 600A 800A 1000A 1500A 2000A 3000A 4000A 5000A 10000A
E114 E115 E116 E117 E118 E119 E201 E202 E203 E204 E205 E206 E207 E208
CT 1A Secondary with scale
CT 5A Secondary with scale
E212 E213
CT 1A Secondary with scale overload x 2
CT 5A Secondary with scale overload x 2
Direct Connection with scale overload x 6
CT 1A Secondary with scale overload x 6
CT 5A Secondary with scale overload x 6
G307 G308 G309 G310 G311 G312 G313
H407
F114 F116 F117
E301
E305
E405
E307 E308 E309
E407 E408 E409
E311 E312 E313 E314 E315 E316 E317 E318 E319 E320 E321
E411 E412 E413 E414 E415 E416 E417 E418
E210 E211
Direct Connection with scale overload x 2
F119 F201 F202 F203 F204 F205 F206 F207 F208 F209 F210 F211 F212 F213
E420 E421 E422 E423 E424 E450 E451 E452 E454 E455 E456 E459
E323 E324 E350 E351 E354
F305
F405
F307 F308 F309 F310 F311 F312 F313 F314 F315 F316 F317 F318 F319 F320 F321 F322 F323 F324 F350 F351 F352 F354 F355
F407 F408 F409 F411 F412 F413 F414 F415 F416 F417 F418
G201 G202 G203 G204 G205 G206 G207 G208 G209 G210 G211
G316 G317 G318 G319 G320
F420 F421 F422 F423 F424 F450 F451 F452 F454 F455
H410 H411 H412 H413 H414 H415 H416 H417 H418 H419 H420 H421
Voltmeter codes Voltmeter input range
Direct connection with scale
Voltmeter input range
Direct connection with scale
6V
E605
150V
E612
10V
E606
250V
E613
15V
E607
300V
E620
25V
E608
400V
E614
40V
E609
500V
E615
50V
E621
600V
E616
60V
E610
800V
E617
100V
E611
1000V
E618
120V
E622
0116 284 9900
PANEL METERS
| 145
Panel meters
Moving iron meters
• • • •
AC current and voltage measurement DIN sizes 48, 72, 96 and 144mm Red pointer option IP50 standard (IP65 on request)
Technical data Accuracy class: Frequency: Direct current range: Direct voltage range: Overload current option: Red pointer option:
Protection degree: - case - terminals Operating temperature: Material:
1.5 50/60 Hz 100 mA to 100 A (25A EA16) 6V to 1000 V (600 V EA16) x 2 or x 6 overload EA17 & EA19 on request
IP50 (IP65 on request) IP20 with protective cover -20 to 60 deg C Thermoplastic case with glass front
Dimensions a
e
f
g
d
k
c
a
58
Type EA16 EA17 EA19 EA12
b
22
a 48 72 96 144
b 4 4 405
c
d
e
f
68 92 137
5 5 5 6
48 45 45 48
10 10 10 10
g
h
2035 68 32.5 92 55.5 138
c
Part number key Moving iron meters Din size: 48 x 48 72 x 72 96 x 96 144 x 144 Protection degree: IP50 (standard) IP65 Meter type: ammeter with scale (select code from table) ammeter CT 1A secondary no scale ammeter CT 5A secondary no scale ammeter CT 1A secondary no scale overload ammeter CT 5A secondary no scale overload ammeter CT 1A secondary no scale overload ammeter CT 5A secondary no scale overload voltmeter with scale (select code from table) voltmeter VT 100V secondary no scale voltmeter VT 110V secondary no scale Scale options: normal red mark blank scale no unit no range no range or unit scale 0 - 20% Scale colour: white black Red pointer: no pointer red pointer Panel mounting angle: 90 degrees (standard) Please enquire for other options
146 | PANEL METERS
XXXX
X
XXXX
X
XXXX
X
X
EA16 EA17 EA19 EA12 N I
x x x x
2 2 6 6
XXXX E3 E4 F3 F4 G3 H4 XXXX E7 E8 0 B C D E F H 0000 1000 0 1 0 X
www.oem.co.uk
Panel meters
Ammeter codes Ammeter input range
Direct connection with scale
Direct connection AC rectifier with scale
Ammeter input range
Direct connection with scale
Shunt 50mV with scale
100µA
A0009
1A
A201
AB01
AE01
150µA
A0010
1.5A
A202
AB02
AE02
250µA
A0011
P011
2.5A
A203
AB03
AE03
400µA
A0012
P012
4A
A204
AB04
AE04
600µA
A0013
P013
5A
A205
1mA
A101
P101
6A
A206
AB06
AE06
1.5mA
A102
P102
10A
A207
AB07
AE07
2.5mA
A103
P103
15A
A208
AB08
AE08
4mA
A104
P104
20A
A209
AB09
5mA
A105
25A
A210
AB10
6mA
A106
P106
40A
AB12
10mA
A107
P107
50A
AB13
15mA
A108
P108
60A
AB14
20mA
A109
100A
AB16
25mA
A110
P110
150A
40mA
A111
P111
200A
AB18
60mA
A113
P113
250A
AB19
100mA
A114
P114
400A
AB21
150mA
A115
P115
600A
AB23
AE23
250mA
A116
P116
1kA
AB50
AE50
400mA
A117
P117
1.5kA
AB51
AE51
600mA
A119
P119
2.5kA
AB53
AE53
AA07
AA17
Shunt 60mV with scale
Shunt 75mV with scale
Shunt 100mV with scale
Shunt 150mV with scale
AE09 AD10
AE10 AE12 AE14
AC16
AD16
AB17
AD17
AE16
AC19
AD19
AE19
AC21
AD21
AE21
AE17
Voltmeter codes Voltmeter input range
Direct connection with scale
60mV 75mV
Direct connection AC rectifier with scale
Voltmeter input range
Direct connection with scale
Direct connection AC rectifier with scale
A505
15V
A607
P607
A511
25V
A608
P608
100mV
A506
40V
A609
P609
150mV
A507
60V
A610
P610
250mV
A508
100V
A611
P611
400mV
A509
150V
A612
P612
600mV
A510
250V
A613
P613
1V
A601
300V
A620
1.5V
A602
P602
400V
A614
P614
2.5V
A603
P603
500V
A615
P615
4V
A604
P604
600V
A616
P616
6V
A605
P605
800V
A617
10V
A606
P606
1000V
A618
Shunts • Extension of DC current measuring ranges of moving-coil ammeters • Accuracy class 0.5 • Shunts of 1…15 kA ranges • 50 mV, 60 mV, 75 mV, 100 mV & 150 mV versions available
0116 284 9900
PANEL METERS
| 147
Panel meters
N24/N25 series
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs fixed:
Digital panel meter
N24T/N25T:
Pt100, J, K type
N24S/N25S:
0/4…20 mA; 0…60mV dc, 0…10 V; ±60 mV; ±10 V dc
N24H/N25H:
±100 V dc; ±250 V dc; 400V dc; 1 A; 5 A; 0-100 V dc; 0-250 V dc
N24Z/N25Z:
100 V ac; 250 V ac; 400 V ac; 1 A; 5A; 20…500Hz
Outputs: For N24/N25:
24V ± 5% 30 mA: S, T versions – optional
Dimensions:
96 x 48 x 64mm
Protection level:
IP65 front
Supply voltage:
230 V ac; 110 V ac 24 V ac; 85…253 V ac/dc; 20…40 V ac/dc
N20 series
Technical data
N XX
Digits: 24 4 25 5 Kind of input signal: standard: voltage, current temperature: thermocouples, resistance thermometers ac signals dc signals: high voltage and current Input signal: See table 2 on page 150 Supply voltage: 230 V ac 110 V ac 24 V ac 85…253 V ac/dc with supply output 24V/30mA* 20…40 V ac/dc with supply output24V/30mA* Unit: See table 3 on page 150
X
X
X
XX 00
E
0
00
8
S T Z H X 1 2 3 4 5 XX
• DC voltage, DC current, temperature or resistance input • 3 colour display red, green and orange, 5 digit (14mm) • 2 OC alarm outputs
Part number key
Inputs fixed:
Digital panel meter
Current:
0/4…20 mA, ±20 mA
Voltage:
0…60 mV; 0-10 V; ± 10 V dc
Temperature:
Pt100, J, K type
Outputs:
2 x OC alarm outputs
N20:
Output for supply external transducers 24V ± 5% 30 mA
Readout field:
5-digit three-colour LED display digit height: 14mm, colours: green, orange, red, indication range: -19999…99999
Dimensions:
96 x 48 x 64mm (with terminals)
Protection level:
IP 65 front
Supply voltage:
85…253 V ac/dc; 20…40 V ac/dc
148 | PANEL METERS
• DC voltage, DC current, temperature or resistance input • AC voltage or AC current input option (Z) • 4 digit (20mm) or 5 digit (14mm)
Input: Pt100: - 50…400°C Thermocouple J: - 50…1200°C Thermocouple K: - 50…1370°C 0…20 mA 4…20 mA ± 20 mA 0…60 mV 0…10 V ± 10 V Supply voltage: 85…253 ac/dc 20…40 ac/dc Unit: See table 1 on page 150
N20
X
X
XX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 XX
www.oem.co.uk
Panel meters
N20Z series
Technical data Inputs fixed: Current: Voltage: Frequency: Outputs: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
Part number key 1A, 5A ac 100 V; 250 V; 400 V ac 20…500 Hz 2 x OC alarm outputs 96 x 48 x 64mm (with terminals) IP 65 front 85…253 V ac; 20…40 V ac
N30U Universal meter
Technical data Inputs programmable: Temperature: Current: Voltage: Outputs: Relay output: Analog output: OC output: Auxiliary supply: Digital interface: RS-485: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
0116 284 9900
• AC voltage, AC current or frequency input • 3 colour display red, green and orange, 5 digit (14mm) • 2 OC alarm outputs
Digital panel meter
N20Z
Input: 100 V 250 V 400 V 1A 5A frequency 20…500 Hz Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac (45…65 Hz) or dc 20…40 V ac (45…65 Hz) or dc Unit: See table 1 on page 150
X
X
XX
00
8
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 XX
• Inputs for temperature, resistance, current and voltage • 5 digit (14mm) 3 colour programmable display with highlighted unit • 2 relay alarm outputs as standard (plus 2 optional) • RS485 and analogue output option • 21 point scaling Part number key
Pt100, Pt500, Pt1000, J, K, N, E, R, S type 400Ω, 4000Ω, 0/4…20 mA, ±20 mA 0-10V, -10 - 60 mV dc 2 x relays, NO contacts 250 V ac/ 0,5 A ac 2 x relays, CO contacts 250 V ac/0,5 A ac – optional Current programmable, 0/4…20mA – optional Voltage programmable, 0…10V – optional OC type, passive npn, 30V dc/30mA – optional 24 V dc/ 30mA – optional
Digital panel meter Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc Additional outputs: lack RS-485, analog outputs RS-485, analog outputs swiched-over relay outputs AL3, AL4 Unit: See table 1 on page 150
N30U
X
X
XX
00
8
1 2 0 1 2 XX
MODBUS RTU – optional 96 x 48 x 93mm IP65 front 85…253 V ac/dc; 20…40 V ac, 20…60 V dc
PANEL METERS
| 149
Panel meters
N30O pulses/frequency meter
Technical data
• Inputs for counting DC pulses to measure frequency and rotational speed • 5 digit (14mm) 3 colour programmable display with highlighted unit • 2 relay alarm outputs as standard (plus 2 optional) • 21 point scaling Part number key
Inputs programmable: voltage 5…36VDC: Number of pulses Cntr – 100 kHz Frequency < 10 kHz – 100 kHz Frequency > 10 kHz – 1 MHz Rotational speed – 100 kHz Period t<10s – 100 kHz Period t>10s – 100 kHz Worktime counter Encoder Outputs: Relay output: 2 x relays; NO contacts; 250 V ac/ 0,5 A ac 2 x relays; CO contacts; 250 V ac/ 0,5 A ac – optional Analog output: Current programmable 0/4…20 mA – optional Voltage programmable 0…10V – optional OC output: OC type, passive npn, 30 V dc/30 mA – optional Auxiliary supply: 24 V dc/30 mA – optional Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU – optional Dimensions: 96 x 48 x 93mm Protection level: IP65 front 85…253 V ac/dc; 20…40 V ac/dc Supply voltage:
N20/N30 tables
Digital panel meter
N30O
Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc Additional outputs: lack RS-485, analog outputs RS-485, analog outputs change-over relay outputs AL3, AL4 Unit: See table 1 below.
X
X
XX 00
E
0
1 2 0 1 2 XX
N24/N25 tables
Table 1. Code of the highlighted unit:
Table 2. Meter type:
Code
Unit
Code
Unit
Code
Unit
No
S
T
Z
H
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
lack of V A mV kV mA kA W kW MW var kvar Mvar VA kVA MVA kWh MWh kvarh Mvarh
20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
kVAh MVAh Hz kHz
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50m 51 52 53 54 55 56
pcs imp rps m/s l/s turns/min rpm mm/min m/min l/min 3/min pcs/h m/h km/h m3/h kg/h l/h
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
0…20 mA 4…20 mA 0…60 mA 0…10 V ± 60 mV ± 10 V
Pt100: -50…150 °C Pt100: -50…400 °C Thermocouple J Thermocouple K
100 V ac 250 V ac 400 V ac 1 A ac 5 A ac 20…500 Hz
±100 V dc ±250 V dc ±400 V dc ±1 A dc ±5 A dc 0…50 V dc 0…200 V dc
XX
on order
150 | PANEL METERS
kΩ °C °F K % %RH pH kg bar m l s h m3 obr
Table 3. Codes of highlighted unit: N24/N25 Code
Unit
Code
Unit
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07
lack of unit ˚C % A V mV mA kA
08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15
kV turns rpm bar Pa kPa MPa on order
www.oem.co.uk
Panel meters
N30H high DC meter
Technical data Inputs programmable: Current: 1 A; 5A Voltage: 100 V dc; 500 V dc; Outputs: Relay output: 2 x relays, NO contacts, 250 V ac/0,5 A ac 2 x relays, CO contacts 250 V ac/0,5 A ac – optional Analog output: Current programmable, 0/4…20mA – optional Voltage programmable, 0…10V load – optional OC output: OC type, passive npn, 30V dc/30mA – optional Auxiliary supply: 24 V dc/30mA – optional Digital Interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU – optional External features: 96 x 48 x 93mm Dimensions: Protection level: IP65 front Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc; 20…40 V ac, 20…60 V dc
N30P power meter
Technical data Inputs: Voltage: 100 V; 400 V Current: 1 A; 5 A Measuring ranges: Measured value, current, voltage, frequency, active power, reactive power, apparent power, cofficient PF, tangents ϕ, ϕ, active energy, reactive energy, apparent energy Outputs: Relay output: 2 x relays, NO contacts, 250 V ac/0.5 A ac 2 x relays, CO contacts 250 V ac/0.5 A ac – optional Analog output: Current programmable 0/4…20 mA – optional Voltage programmable 0…10 V – optional Energy pulse output: OC type, passive Output pulse: 5000 imp./kWh – optional Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU – optional Dimensions: 96 x 48 x 93mm Protection level: IP65 front Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc; 20…40 V ac/dc
0116 284 9900
• Inputs for higher levels of DC current and DC voltage • 5 digit (14mm) 3 colour programmable display red, green and orange with highlighted unit • 2 relay alarm outputs as standard (plus 2 optional) • 21 point scaling Part number key Digital panel meter
N30H
Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc Additional outputs: lack RS-485, analog outputs RS-485, analog outputs change-over relay outputs AL3, AL4 Unit: See table 1 on page 150
X
X
XX
00
8
1 2 0 1 2 XX
• Inputs for single phase AC current/voltage and measures all network parameters • 5 digit (14mm) 3 colour programmable display red, green and orange with highlighted unit • 2 relay alarm outputs as standard (plus 2 optional)
Part number key Digital panel meter Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc Additional outputs: lack pulse output RS-485, analog outputs pulse output RS-485, analog outputs change-over relay outputs AL3, AL4 Unit: See table 1 on page 150
N30P
X
X
XX
00
8
1 2 0 1 2 XX
PANEL METERS
| 151
Panel meters
NA3 digital meters with bargraph
• • • •
3 or 7-colour bargraph Signalling of set alarm value overflow Current or voltage analog output Communication in SCADA systems (RS485/Modbus interface RTU and ASCII)
Technical data Meter: Inputs programmable: Outputs: Analogue output: Relay output:
Open collector: Digital interface: External features: Readout field: NA3-F: NA3-B: NA3-D: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
NA3 type – horizontal, 1-measuring channel in 3 options: with bargraph, with bargraph and display, only with display NA5 type – vertical, 1-measuring channel, with bargraph and display NA6 type – vertical, 2-measuring channels, with 2 bargraphs and 2 displays Pt100, Pt500, Pt1000, J, K, N, E, R, S, T type 400Ω, 4000Ω (NA5), 0…20 mA, 0…2/5A 0…60 mV, 0…10/600 V dc Current programmable 0/4…20 mA – optional Voltage programmable 0…10 V – optional 1 or 2 relays NOC contacts, 250 V ac/5A – optional
Passive, OC type – optional RS-485, MODBUS ASCII, RTU – optional
4 LED displays with 7 segments, digits of 7mm high, indication range -1999…9999 multicoloured bargraph as above 4 LED displays with 7 segments, digits of 14mm high, 3 alarm diodes, indication range as above 96 x 24 x 125mm IP40 front 95…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc
Part number key Digital panel meter
NA3
Meter verson: with a bargraph and digital display with a bargraph with a digital display Bargraph colour: without bargraph (NA3D) 3 colour (R, G, R + G) 7 colour (R, G, B, R + G, R + B, G + B, R + G + B) Display colour: without display red green blue Input signal: universal input Analog output: lack current programmable 0/4…20 mA voltage programmable 0…10 V Additional output: lack RS-485, digital output + 1 relay RS-485, digital output + 1 output of OC type 2 relays 2 outputs of OC type Supply voltage: 85…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc
152 | PANEL METERS
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
0
00
0
F B D 0 T M 0 R G B U 0 1 2 0 1 2 3 4 1 2
www.oem.co.uk
Panel meters
NA5/NA6 programmable bargraph meter
• Universal input for temperature, resistance, voltage & current • Fully programmable from front panel buttons • One or two channel • Digital display & multicolour LED bargraph
Technical data Inputs programmable: Pt100, Pt500, Pt1000, J, K, N, E, R, S, T type 0…10kΩ, ± 40 mA, ± 5 A, ± 300 mV, ± 600 V dc Outputs: Analogue outputs: Current programmable 0/4…20 mA – optional Voltage programmable 0…10 V – optional Relay outputs: 4 relays: NO contacts 250 Vac, 5A – optional
8 outputs of OC type: Digital outputs: Memory parameters: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
Passive, OC type with npn transistor - optional RS-485, MODBUS, ASCII, RTU – optional NA5, NA6: 750 samples (channel 1 or 2) NA5, NA6: 48 x 144 x 100mm (with terminals) NA5, NA6: IP 50 - front 95…230…253 V ac/dc: 20…24…40 V ac/dc
Part number key Digital panel meter
NA5
Bargraph colour: 3 colours (R, G, R + G) 7 colours (R, G, B, R + G, R + B, G + B, R + G + B) Display colour: without display red green blue Input signal: universal input Analogue output signal: without analogue output current programmed, 0/4…20 mA voltage programmed, 0…10 V Digital output signal: without output RS-485 digital output Additional outputs: without output 4 relay outputs 8 OC outputs Supply: 95…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc
0116 284 9900
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
T M 0 R G B U 0 1 2 0 1 0 4 8 1 2
0 00 0
Digital panel meter
NA6
Bargraph colour: 3 colours (R, G, R + G) 7 colours (R, G, B, R + G, R + B, G + B, R + G + B) Display colour (on channels 1 and 2): without LED displays red - red red - green red - blue green - red green - green green - blue blue - red bue - green blue - blue Input signal: universal input Analogue output signal: without output current programmed, 0/4…20 mA voltage programmed, 0…10 V Digital output signal: without output RS-485 digital output Additional outputs: without output 4 relays outputs 8 OC outputs Supply: 95…253 V ac/dc 20…40 V ac/dc
X XX X
X
X
X
X
0 00 0
T M 00 RR GG BB GR GG GB BR BG BB U 0 1 2 0 1 0 4 8 1 2
PANEL METERS
| 153
POWER NETWORK AND SYNCHRONISATION METERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
N14 power network meter
156
ND10 power network meter
156
ND20 advanced power network meter
157
N10/N10A advanced power network meter
157
ND1 3-phase power quality analyser and recorder
158
KS3 synchronising unit
158
N27D 1-Phase rail mount network meter
160
N27P 1-phase rail mount power network meter
160
N43 3-phase rail mounted network meter
160
Power network and synchronisation meters
N14 power network meter
Technical data Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement: Voltage: Current: Power: Outputs: Relay outputs: Impulse energy output: Digital interface: RS-485: Display: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
Part number key N14 1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V, 3 x 400/690V* Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, mean ph to ph Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, in Neutral wire Active, reactive, apparent, 3 -ph power, 15 min active power. 4 - quadrant power & energy measurement Power factor, ph angle, tg φ, freq, 3-ph active & reactive energy 1 x relay, NO contacts OC passive, impulse constant 5000imp/kWh
Current input In: 1 A (X/1) 5 A (X/5) Voltage input (phase/phase-to-phase) Un: 3 x 57, 7/100 V 3 x 230/400 V 3 x 400/690 V** Version: standard input voltage 3 x 110/ 190 V custom-made ** Version only for direct measurement
X
X
XX
8
1 2 1 2 3 00 01 XX
MODBUS RTU LED 3 x 3, 14mm digits 96 x 96 x 77mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 40…400Hz
ND10 power network meter
• Measurement of basic power network parameters in a 4-wire balanced or unbalanced system • Meter supply from measurement circuit • Interface RS-485 Modbus slave (option) • 2 alarm outputs
Part number key
Technical data Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement: Voltage: Current: Power: Harmonics: Outputs: Relay outputs: Impulse energy output: Digital interface: RS-485: Display: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
• Measurement of power network parameters in 3 or 4 wire balanced or unbalanced systems • Interface RS-485 Modbus slave as standard • Configurable alarm output and current and voltage ratios
ND10 1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V, 3 x 290/500V Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, mean ph to ph Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, in neutral wire Active, reactive, apparent, 3 -ph power, 15 min active power. 4 - quadrant power & energy measurement Power factor, ph angle, tg φ, freq, 3-ph active & reactive energy THD, voltage & current
Current input In: 1 A (X/1) 5 A (X/5) Voltage input (phase/ phase-to-phase) Un: 3 x 57.7/100 V 3 x 230/400 V 3 x 290/500 V Digital output: without RS485 interface with RS485 interface
X
X
X
00
E
0
1 2 1 2 3 0 1
2 x relay, NO contacts 0.5A, 230V a.c OC passive, impulse constant 5000… 20000 imp/kWh MODBUS RTU - optional LCD 3.5” monochrome backlit 96 x 96 x 77mm IP65 front Supplied from measuring circuit
156 | POWER NETWORK AND SYNCHRONISATION METERS
www.oem.co.uk
Power network and synchronisation meters
ND20 power network meter
Part number key
Technical data Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement: Voltage: Current: Power: Energy: Harmonics: Outputs: Relay outputs: Analog output: Impulse energy output: Digital interface: RS-485: Display: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
ND20 1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, mean ph to ph Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, in neutral wire Active, reactive, apparent, 3 -ph power, 15 min active power. 4 - quadrant power & energy measurement Power factor, ph angle, tg φ, freq, 3-ph active & reactive energy THD, voltage & current up to 21st 1 x relay, NO contacts 0.5A, 230V a.c 1 x 0/4…20mA OC passive, impulse constant 1000…20000 imp/kWh
X
X
X
X
00
E
0
1 2 1 2 0 1 1 2
• Measurement and conversion of power network parameters in 3 or 4-wire balance or unbalanced systems • Measurement and visualisation of several scores of power network quantities, current and voltage harmonics • Digital RS-485 Modbus protocol • Programmable selection of parameter pages Part number key
Technical data
0116 284 9900
Current input In: 1 A (X/1) 5 A (X/5) Voltage input (phase/phase-to-phase) Un: 3 x 57.7/100 V 3 x 230/400 V Analog current output: without analog output with programmable output 0(4) … 20 mA Supply voltage: 85…253 V d.c. or a.c. (40…400 Hz) 20…40 V d.c. or a.c. (40…400 Hz)
MODBUS RTU LCD 3 .5” monochrome - backlit 96 x 96 x 77mm IP65 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 40…400Hz, 20…40V a.c/d.c, 40…400Hz
N10/N10A meter
Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement: Voltage: Current: Power Harmonics: Outputs: Relay outputs: Analog output: Impulse energy output: Digital interface: RS-485: Display: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
• Measurement of power network parameters in 2, 3 or 4-wire balanced or unbalanced systems • High accuracy class • Interface RS-485 Modbus slave as standard • Analogue output • Configurable analogue, alarm and pulse outputs (energy)
N10/N10A 1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, mean ph to ph Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, in neutral wire Active, reactive, apparent, 3 -ph power, 15 min active power. 4 - quadrant power & energy measurement power factor, ph angle, tg φ, freq, 3-ph active, reactive & apparent energy THD, voltage & current up to 25th 3 x relay, NO contacts (1 x relay N10A) 1 x 0/4…20mA (3 x ±5mA N10A) OC passive, impulse constant 1000…9999 imp/kWh (N10 only)
Current input In: 1 A (X/1) 5 A (X/5) Input phase voltage Un: 100 V 400 V Digital output: without interface with RS-485 interface Display: red green
X
X
X
X
0
00
8
1 2 1 2 0 1 1 2
MODBUS RTU - optional LED 4 x 5, 14mm digits red or green 144 x 144 x 77mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c POWER NETWORK AND SYNCHRONISATION METERS
| 157
Power network and synchronisation meters
ND1 3-phase power quality analyser and recorder
• Measurement and recording of over 300 electric energy quality parameters • 5 instruments in 1; 3-ph analyser, transducer, recorder, webserver and controller • Analysis of current and voltage harmonics up to the 51st • User friendly interface based on Windows
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs: Current: Voltage: Logic Measurement Voltage: Current: Power Harmonics Outputs: Relay outputs Analog outputs Auxiliary supply Digital interface RS-485 Ethernet Data storage Display Dimensions Protection level Supply voltage:
ND1 1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V, 3 400/690V 12 x 0/5…24V d.c Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, mean ph to ph Phase, mean 3-ph, ph to ph, in neutral wire Active, reactive, apparent, 3 -ph power, 15 min active power. 4 - quadrant power & energy measurement power factor, ph angle, tg φ, freq, 3-ph active, reactive & apparent energy voltage dips, voltage swells, voltage assymmetry, flicker parameters energy tarriffs x 4 THD, voltage & current up to 51st
X
Current input: 1 1A 2 5A Voltage input: 57.7/100 V 230/400 V 400/690 V NOTE: Each ND1 analyser is equiped with 6 alarms (electromecanic outputs, 12 logic inputs and Ethernet interface.
X
00
E
0
1 2 3 relays), 4 analog
6 x relay, NO contacts 4 x 0/4…20mA 2 x 24V d.c/30mA 2 x MODBUS RTU - 1 x master, 1 x slave 10 Base-T, RJ45, Modbus TCP/IP, Webserver, HTTP, NTP, FTP Compact flash card - 4GB measurment and logging of energy quality acc. to EN 50160 LCD TFT 5.7” colour touch screen, 320 x 240 pixels 144 x 144 x 155mm IP65 front 85…253V a.c/d.c
KS3 synchronising unit
Technical data Inputs: Voltage: 100V, 110V, 230, 400V Frequency: 15…500Hz Measurement: Voltage: -20…0…20% Frequency: -10…0…10% Phase shift: 0…360° Outputs: Relay outputs: 2 x relay, NO contacts (SYNC/ALARM) Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU Display: 4 x 5, 14mm LED digits (KS3.1), synchroscope circle 72 x LED, volt & freq meter 68 x LED (KS3-2) Dimensions: 144 x 144 x 77mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c/d.c, 40…400Hz, 18…30V a.c/d.c
158 | POWER NETWORK AND SYNCHRONISATION METERS
• Designed to automatically synchronise 3-phase generators connected in parallel with power networks of 50/60Hz • Measurement through voltage transformers • Measurement and visulisation of phase, frequency and voltage differences • Measurement of minimum and maximum voltage and frequency values Part number key KS3 Kind of display: LED digits bargraphs (diode lines) Input voltages: 100 V 110 V 240 V 400 V Digital output: without interface with RS-485 interface Supply voltage: 85…250 V d.c./a.c. 24 V d.c./a.c.
X
XX
X
X
00
8
1 2 01 02 03 04 0 1 0 1
www.oem.co.uk
Power network and synchronisation meters
N27D 1-Phase rail mount network meter
Technical data
• Measurement of true RMS AC voltage, AC current, active power and frequency • Direct 63A connection • Modular housing (3 module wide) with acc. to EN 62208
Inputs: Current: 63A Voltage: 500V Measurement: True RMS voltage, RMS current, frequency, active power Display: OLED 53 x 110 x 60mm Dimensions: Protection level: IP00 front Supply voltage: 230V a.c ±10%, 45…65Hz
Part number key N27D
00
E
0
N27P 1-phase rail mount power network meter
Technical data
• Measurement of 1-phase network parameters • Universal input 63A direct or CT • Programmable analogue and relay outputs • Modular housing (3 modules wide) with acc. to EN 62208 Part number key N27P
X
Current measuring range: 1 A/5 A a.c 32 A/63 A a.c. Outputs: 2 relays 1 relay and 1 analog 0/4…20mA
X
00
E
0
1 2 1 2
N43 3-phase rail mounted network meter
Technical data
• Measurement of power network parameters in 3 or 4-wire balanced or unbalanced system • Universal input 63A direct or CT • Configurable alarm outputs and transformer ratios • Modular housing (6 modules wide) with acc. to EN 62208 Part number key N43 Current input In: 1 A/5 A (X/1; X/5) 63 A Voltage input (phase/phase-to-phase) Un: 3 x 57.7/100 V 3 x 230/400 V 3 x 290/500 V Auxiliary supply: 85…253 V a.c., 90…300 V d.c. 20…40 V a.c., 20…60 V d.c.
0116 284 9900
Inputs: Current: 1A/5A, 32A/63A Voltage: 100V/400V Measurement: Voltage, current, frequency, active power, reactive power, apparent power, power factor, Tan φ, φ, active energy, reactive energy Outputs: 1 or 2 x relay, NO contacts Relay outputs: Current: 0/4…20mA - optional Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU USB: 1.2/1.2 programming port Display: OLED Dimensions: 53 x 110 x 60mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c, 40…400Hz, 90…300V d.c
X
X
X
1 2
00
E
0
Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement: Voltage: Current: Power: Harmonics: Outputs: Relay outputs: Impulse energy output: Digital interface: RS-485: Display: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) or 63A direct 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V, 3 x 290/500V Phase, ph to ph, ph to neutral - RMS Phase, ph to ph, ph to neutral - RMS Active, reactive, apparent Active & reactive energy Power factor & frequency THD, voltage & current 3 x relay, NO contacts O/C passive, impulse constant 5000… 20000 imp/kWh MODBUS RTU LCD 3.5” monochrome backlit 105 x 110 x 60mm IP50 front 85…253V a.c, 40…400Hz, 90…300V d.c 20…40V a.c, 40…400Hz, 20…60V d.c
1 2 3 1 2 POWER NETWORK AND SYNCHRONISATION METERS
| 159
POWER SUPPLIES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Introduction
162
1 Phase 24V 5-10A Piano
164
1 Phase 24V 0.6-5A
165
1 Phase 24V 3-5A
166
1 Phase 24V 10-40A
167
2 & 3 Phase 24V 4.2-10A
168
3 Phase 24V 20-40A
169
1 Phase 12V 1.3-15A
170
1 Phase 48V 1-20A
171
3 Phase 48V 5-20A
172
1 & 3 Phase (other voltages)
173
DC-UPS
174
Buffer modules
177
Redundancy modules
178
DC-DC converters
179
ASI & accessories
180
Special versions
181
Power supplies Introduction Company Puls Puls is a privately owned German company with over 20 years experience in the manufacture of DIN rail switch mode power supplies. They lead the way using innovation and cutting edge technology to produce the smallest, most efficient units available on the market. They have become one of the largest manufacturers in the world with all production taking place in their own factories to ensure the highest level of quality control.
• Specialist manufacturer with 100% focus on PSU’s • Reliability is a guiding principle • High focus on continuous product development • Ecological thinking Efficiency & long lifetime Puls power supplies are characterised by high efficiency, small size, low power consumption and long life time. Energy savings can in many cases exceed the purchase cost after just a few years of operation. All components are of the highest quality which helps achieve excellent MTBF values.
• • • •
Long lifetime and high reliability Lower temperature in the panel Energy saving Lower operating costs
Robust input circuit to protect against external interference It is difficult to completely protect against problems caused by poor power supply networks. With Puls every unit is designed with a robust primary input circuit that can withstand disruptions, voltage spikes and short interruptions. All Puls power supplies are approved to VDE0160 (protection against transients).
• • •
Protection against mains transients Long hold up times protect against short interruptions Active inrush current protection (Dimension)
162 | POWER SUPPLIES
Compact dimensions Thanks to clever circuit design and high efficiency Puls has continuously managed to reduce the housing size of each successive series. The picture shows a Silverline single phase 20A unit which was introduced in 1998 with a width of 230mm. Sitting on top is the latest C series single phase 20A unit with a width of just 65mm which is over a 70% reduction in size in less than 15 years!
• • • •
Save valuable panel space Patented robust DIN rail clip Light weight units Shock & vibration resistant www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies
erie
S
S
Large power reserves for difficult loads The Dimension family has two different power reserve functions to help overcome higher current demands. These can be used to overcome short term, higher start up currents and avoid the need to over specify the power supply rating.
Series Q The Q series has a bonus power feature that allows up to 50% additional output current for up to 4 seconds. After this time the current returns to nominal but the bonus power can be used again after a short recovery period.
erie
Series C The C series has a power reserve feature that allows up to 25% more output current. If the ambient temperature does not exceed 40°C this can be taken continuously or for shorter periods at higher temperatures.
Common to both Q & C series are powerful short circuit currents. This typically helps MCB protection devices on the secondary side to successfully trip in the event of a fault. Keep in mind longer cable runs can dramatically reduce short circuit current and here we recommend using electronic fuses for protection.
Worldwide approvals Puls has all international approvals usually required for export purposes. In addition there are also CB certificates and marine approvals. Several products also have additional classifications such as ATEX, NEC class 2 and SEMI F47. These help to provide security and simplifies export to other countries.
Puls + a little bit more Continuous product development from Puls also brings many other small technical advantages:
+
• • • • • • •
Comprehensive and reliable data Reliable DIN rail mount clip Active inrush current protection Specific MTBF values for each model Robust connection terminals Small ventilation holes Latest technology
The Puls family
Piano
Miniline
Piano is the latest series and features an excellent price to performance ratio
Compact units for lower current applications
Dimension C-series
The standard series with very high reliability but slightly fewer features
Dimension Q-series
Dimension DC-UPS
The premium series featuring “state of the art” technology
Back up system with intelligent battery monitoring
• Output current 5A & 10A
• Output current from 0.6A to 5A
• Output current from 3A to 20A
• Output current from 3A to 40A
• Load current 10A & 20A options
• Compact size
• From 22.5mm wide
• High performance
• DC OK relay
• Single battery concept on 10A unit
• Economical – fewer features
• Multiple output voltage options
• Compact housing
• 50% bonus power
• Constant output voltage regardless
• Screw & screwless terminals
• 20% power reserve
• Screwless terminals
• Screw connection terminals
0116 284 9900
of battery level • Multiple diagnostics & status outputs POWER SUPPLIES
| 163
Power supplies Piano series The Piano series offers compact units that meet the essential industrial requirements of today’s applications. The excellent relationship between performance and price opens up many new possibilities without compromising on quality or reliability. The robust housing is made of reinforced polycarbonate that can withstand ambient temperatures up to 70°C. The power supply can even operate at this temperature with a derating of the output current and in addition the units have good resistance against shock and vibration. Many industrial applications require only a 230 V AC input. By removing the wide range / auto switching input options the circuitry is greatly simplified which brings advantages for reliability. efficiency and cost.
1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 5 A
Supply voltage AC
220-240 V AC -15/+10 %
Supply voltage DC
No
Input current at 230 V AC
• • • •
39mm wide Efficiency 90.5% DC-OK relay Cost effective
1.12 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
5A
Efficiency at 230 V AC
90.5 %
Operating temperature (without derating output)
-10 to +55 °C
Approvals
UL 60950-1
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
39 x 124 x 124
EMC
Class A
Part number
Input voltage
Output data
PIC120.242C
230 V AC
24-28 V DC/5 A
PIC120.241C
230 V AC
24-28 V DC/5 A DC-OK output
1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 10 A
Supply voltage AC
220-240 V AC -15/+10 %
Supply voltage DC
No
Input current at 230 V AC
• • • •
49mm wide Efficiency 91.2% DC-OK relay Cost effective
2.2 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
10 A
Efficiency at 230 V AC
91.2 %
Operating temperature (without derating output) Approvals
-10 to +55 °C UL 60950-1
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
49 x 124 x 124
EMC
Class A
Part number
Input voltage
Output data
PIC240.241C
230 V AC
24-28 V DC/10 A DC-OK output
164 | POWER SUPPLIES
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies 1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 0.6 A. 1.3 A & 2.5 A
• • • •
From 22.5mm wide AC & DC input voltage High efficiency Low no load current
Model
ML15.241
ML30.241
ML60.241
Supply voltage AC
85-264 V AC
85-264 V AC
85-264 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-375 V DC
88-375 V DC
88-375 V DC
Input current 120/230 V AC
0.28/0.17 A
0.54/0.3 A
0.98/0.58 A
Output voltage Output current nominal Efficiency at 230 V AC Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
24-28 V DC
24-28 V DC
24-28 V DC
0.63 A (15 W)
1.3 A (30 W)
2.5 A (60 W)
85.1 %
89.4 %
89.7 %
22.5 x 75 x 91
22.5 x 75 x 91
45 x 75 x 91
UL508 listed, UL60950-1, GL. ABS, CB-scheme
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
ML15.241
85-264 V AC/88-375 V DC
24-28 V DC
0.6 A
ML30.241
85-264 V AC/88-375 V DC
24-28 V DC
1.3 A
ML60.241
85-264 V AC/88-375 V DC
24-28 V DC
2.5 A
1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 5 A
Model
• • • •
72mm wide Screw terminals High efficiency up to 90.4% NEC Class 2 version
ML120.241
Supply voltage AC
100-120 V/ 220-240 V AC
Supply voltage DC
218-377 V DC. + to L & - to N terminal
Input current at 120/230 V AC
1.82/1.07 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current nominal Efficiency at 230 V AC Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
5 A (120 W) 3.8 A (NEC-Class 2) 90.4 % 72.5 x 75 x 103 UL508 listed, UL60950-1 recognized, GL, Gost, CB-scheme
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
ML120.241
115/230 V AC
24-28 V DC
5A
115/230 V AC. NEC Class-2
24-28 V DC
3.8 A
ML120.241.Class 2
0116 284 9900
Output current
POWER SUPPLIES
| 165
Power supplies 1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 3.4 A & 5 A
Model
QS3.241
QS5.241
Supply voltage AC
100-240 V AC ±15 %
100-240 V AC ±15 %
Supply voltage DC
110-300 V DC ±20 %
110-300 V DC ±20 %
1.42/0.82 A
1.10/0.62 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
3.4 A (80 W)
5 A (120 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds at 24V DC
5 A (120 W)
7.5 A (180 W)
Efficiency 120 V AC/230 V AC
88.7/90 %
91.6/92.7 %
S
Input current 120/230 V AC
erie
• • • •
50% bonus power Up to 92.7% efficiency High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
DC-OK
No
Yes
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
32 x 124 x 102
40 x 124 x 117
Approvals
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
QS3.241
100-240 V AC/100-240 V DC
24 V DC
3.4 A
QS5.241
100-240 V AC/93-345 V DC
24 V DC
5A
1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 3 A & 5 A
S
UL508 listed, UL60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme
erie
• • • •
Model
20% power reserve Up to 90.2% efficiency Slimline Standard version with high reliability
CS3.241
CS5.241
Supply voltage AC
90-264 V AC
100-120/200-240 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-375 V DC
N/A
Input current 120 V/230 V
1.24/0.68 A
2.05/1.23 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
3.3 A (80 W)
5 A (120 W)
Power reserve up to 45 °C
No
6A
88/89.8 %
89.4/90.2 %
Efficiency 120/230 V AC Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
32 x 124 x 102
32 x 124 x 117
Approvals
Part number
UL508 listed, UL60950-1, GL, ABS, CB-scheme
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
CS3.241
90-264 V AC/88-375 V DC
24-28 V DC
3A
CS5.241
115/230 V AC
24-28 V DC
5A
166 | POWER SUPPLIES
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies 1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 10 A & 20 A
Model Supply voltage AC Supply voltage DC
• • • •
erie
20% power reserve Up to 94% efficiency Slimline (20 A=65 mm) Standard version with high reliability
CPS20.241 100-264 V AC
No
No - use CPS20.241-D1
3.73/2.25 A
4.36/2.33 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
10 A (240 W)
20 A (480 W)
Power reserve up to 45 °C
12 A (288 W)
24 A (576 W)
Efficiency at 120/230 V AC
91/91.6 %
92.7/94.0 %
Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
-25 to +60 °C 60 x 124 x 117
65 x 124 x 127
UL508 listed, UL60950-1, GL, ABS, CB-scheme
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
CS10.241
115/230 V AC
24-28 V DC
10 A
CPS20.241
100-264 V AC
24-28 V DC
20 A
1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 10 A & 20 A
Model
QS10.241
QS20.241
Supply voltage AC
85-276 V AC
85-276 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-187 V DC
88-187 V DC
2.2/1.2 A
4.56/2.48 A
Input current 120/230 V AC
S
• • • • erie
50% bonus power Up to 93.9% efficiency HIgh short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
10 A (240 W)
20 A (480 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds at 24V DC
15 A (360 W)
30 A (720 W)
Efficiency 120 V AC/230 V AC
92.6/93.5 %
92.4/93.9 %
Yes
Yes
DC-OK relay Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
60 x 124 x 117
82 x 124 x 127
Approvals Part number
UL 508 listed, UL60950-1, CSA C22.2 No.107 listed, GL. ABS. Semi F-47 CB-scheme
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
QS10.241
100-240 V AC/88-187 V DC
24-28 V DC
10 A
QS20.241
100-240 V AC/88-187 V DC
24-28 V DC
20 A
1 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 40 A
Supply voltage AC Input current 230 V AC
S
S
Input current 120/230 V AC
CS10.241 100-120/200-240 V AC
erie
• • • •
50% bonus power Active inrush current limiter High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
100-240 V AC 4.5 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
40 A (960 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds at 24V DC
60 A (1 440 W)
Efficiency at 230 V AC
94.6 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) DC-OK relay Approvals
125 x 124 x 127 Yes UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme, Class 1, Div 2
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
QS40.241
100-240 V AC
24-28 V DC
40 A
0116 284 9900
POWER SUPPLIES
| 167
Power supplies 2 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 4.2 A
Supply voltage AC Input current at 400 V AC Output voltage
• • • •
380 – 480 V AC Space saving Efficiency up to 90 % Version for NEC-Class 2
Output current. 24 V DC Efficiency 400/480 V AC Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
380-480 V AC ±15 % 0.46 A 24-28 V DC 4.2 A (100 W). 3.75 A (NEC-Class 2) 89.5/89 % -10 to +60 °C 72.5 x 75 x 103 UL 508 listed, UL60950-1, GL, ABS
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
ML100.200
380-480 V AC
24-28 V DC
4.2 A
ML90.200
380-480 V AC
24-28 V DC
3.75 A. NEC-Class 2
2 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
S
Output current 5 A
erie
Supply voltage AC
• • • •
Output current
20 % power reserve 90.4 % efficiency Integral primary fuses Standard version with high reliability
380-480 V AC
Input current 400/480 V AC
0.75/0.68 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
5 A (120 W)
Power reserve up to 45 °C
6 A (144 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC
90.4 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
40 x 124 x 117 UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
CT5.241
380-480 V AC
24-28 V DC
5A
3 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 10 A
Supply voltage AC
S
Input current 400/480 V AC
erie
• • • •
20 % power reserve 92.8 % efficiency Integral primary fuses Standard version with high reliability
380-480 V AC 0.7/0.6 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
10 A (240 W)
Power reserve up to 45 °C
12 A (288 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC
92.8 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
62 x 124 x 117
Approvals
UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF4, CB-scheme
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
CT10.241
380-480 V AC
24-28 V DC
10 A
168 | POWER SUPPLIES
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies 3 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 20 A
Supply voltage AC
323-552 V AC
S
Input current 400/480 V AC
erie
• • • •
50 % bonus power 95 % efficiency High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
20 A (480 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds at 24V DC
30 A (720 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC
QT20.241
95 %
DC-OK relay
Yes
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
0.79/0.65 A
Output voltage
65 x 124 x 127 UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
3-phase 380-480 V AC
24-28 V DC
20 A
3 phase 24 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 40 A
Supply voltage AC
323-552 V AC
S
Input current 400/480 V AC
erie
• • • •
Active inrush current limiter High short circuit current Integral primary fuses Maximum performance for demanding applications
24-28 V DC
Output current at 24 V DC
40 A (960 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds at 24V DC
QT40.241
Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
S
110 x 124 x 127 UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme, Class 1, Div 2
Output voltage
Output current
24-28 V DC
40 A
TECHNICAL DATA Model Supply voltage AC
Semi regulated Ideal for motor & solenoid loads High short circuit current Alternative to using transformer
XT40.241
XT40.242
360-440 V AC
432-528 V AC
Input current
1.65 A
1.4 A
Output voltage
24.1 V
24.1 V
Output current at 24 V DC
40 A (960 W)
40 A (960 W)
Bonus power for up to 15 seconds
50 A (1200 W)
50 A (1200 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC
95.5 %
95.5 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
96 x 124 x 159
96 x 124 x 159
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
Yes -25 to +60 °C
Input voltage
Output current 40 A
erie
95.3 %
DC-OK relay
3-phase 380-480 V AC
3 phase 24 V DC
• • • •
60 A (1 440 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC
Approvals
Part number
1.65/1.35 A
Output voltage
UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme, Class 1, Div 2
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
XT40.241
400 V AC semi regulated
24 V DC
40 A
XT40.242
480 V AC semi regulated
24 V DC
40 A
0116 284 9900
POWER SUPPLIES
| 169
Power supplies 1 phase 12 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 1.3 A. 2.5 A & 4.2 A
• • • •
From 22.5 mm wide AC & DC supply voltage High efficiency Screwless terminals (ML30, ML50)
Model
ML15.121
ML30.102
ML50.102
Supply voltage AC
85-264 V AC
85-264 V AC
85-264 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-375 V DC
85-375 V DC
85-375 V DC
Input current at 100/230 V AC
0.34/0.17 A
<0.6/<0.25 A
<1/<0.6 A
Output voltage
12-15 V DC
10-12 V DC
12-15 V DC
82.5 %
84 %
90 %
1.3 A (15 W)
2.5 A (30 W)
4.2 A (50 W)
Efficiency at 230 V AC Output current at 12 V DC Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
-10 to +60 °C 22.5 x 75 x 91
45 x 75 x 91
45 x 75 x 91
UL 508 listed, UL 60950, CB-scheme, GL (GL: only ML15.121)
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
ML15.121
85-264 V AC/88-375 V DC
12-15 V DC
1.3 A
ML30.102
85-264 V AC/85-375 V DC
10-12 V DC
2.5 A
ML50.102
85-264 V AC/85-375 V DC
12-15 V DC
4A
1 phase 12 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 4.5 A & 7.5 A
• • • •
Model
High efficiency Parallel connection allowed Space saving Screwless terminals (ML100)
ML60.121
ML100.102
Supply voltage AC
85-264 V AC
85-132/184-264 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-375 V DC
220-375 V DC
Input current at 120/230 V AC
0.91/0.54 A
<1.9/<0.9 A
Output voltage Output current at 12 V DC Efficiency at 230 V AC
7.5 A (90 W)
87.2 %
88.5 %
Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
12-15 V DC 4.5 A (60 W)
-10 to +60 °C 45 x 75 x 91
72.5 x 75 x 103
UL508 listed, UL60950, GL, ABS. CB-scheme, NEC Class 2 (CB & NEC Ej ML100.102)
Input voltage
Output voltage
ML60.121
85-264 V AC/85-375 V DC
12-15 V DC
4A
ML100.102
115/230 V AC
12-15 V DC
7.5 A
1 phase 12 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
S
Output current 15 A
erie
• • • •
50 % bonus power Up to 91.8 % efficiency High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
Supply voltage AC
85-276 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-187 V DC
Input current at 120/230 V AC
1.65/0.93 A
Output voltage
12-15 V DC
Output current at 12 V DC
15 A (180 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds 12 V DC
22.5 A
Efficiency at 230 V AC
91.8 %
DC-OK relay Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number QS10.121
170 | POWER SUPPLIES
Output current
Yes -25 to +60 °C 60 x 124 x 117 UL508 listed, UL60950, GL, ABS, CB-scheme, SEMI F47
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
85-276 V AC/88-187 V DC
12-15 V DC
15 A
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies 1 phase 48 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 1 A & 2.1 A
Model
ML50.105
ML100.105
85-264 V
85-132/184-264 V
Supply voltage DC
85-375 V
220-375 V
Input current at 115/230 V AC
<1/<0.6 A
2.1/1 A
48-56 V DC
48-56 V DC
1A
2.1 A
90 %
91 %
Operating temperature (without derating output)
-10 to +60 °C
-10 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
45 x 75 x 91
73 x 75 x 103
Supply voltage AC
• • • •
High efficiency AC & DC supply voltage Space saving Screwless terminals
Output voltage Output current at 48 V DC Efficiency
Approvals
Part number
UL 508 listed, UL60950-1, ML100.105 also GL, ABS.
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
ML50.105
85-264 V AC/85-375 V DC
48-56 V DC
1A
ML100.105
115/230 V AC/220-375 V DC
48-56 V DC
2.1 A
1-phase 48 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
S
Output current 5 A & 10 A
erie
• • • •
Model
50 % bonus power Up to 91.8 % efficiency High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
QS10.481
QS20.481
Supply voltage AC
85-276 V AC
85-276 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-187 V DC
88-187 V DC
Input current 120/230 V AC
2.22/1.22 A
4.56/2.48 A
Output voltage
48-56 V DC
48-55 V DC
Output current at 48 V DC
5 A (240 W)
10 A (480 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds 48 V DC
7.5 A
15 A
Efficiency at 230 V AC
92 %
94.3%
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
60 x 124 x 117
82 x 124 x 127
Approvals
Part number
UL508 listed, UL60950-1, GL, ABS
Input voltage
Output voltage
QS10.481
85-276 V AC/88-187 V DC
48-56 V DC
5A
QS20.481
85-276 V AC/88-187 V DC
48-56 V DC
10 A
1 phase 48 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 20 A
Supply voltage AC Input current 230 V AC
S
Output voltage
erie
Output current
• High short circuit current • 50 % bonus power • Maximum performance for demanding applications • Active inrush current limiter
170-264 V AC 4.6 A 48-54 V DC
Output current at 48 V DC
20 A (960 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds 48 V DC
30 A (1440 W)
Efficiency at 230 V AC DC-OK relay Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
95 % Yes -25 to +60 °C 125 x 124 x 127 UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, GL, ABS, SEMIF47, CB-scheme
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
QS40.484
170-264 V AC
48-54 V DC
20 A
0116 284 9900
POWER SUPPLIES
| 171
Power supplies 3 phase 48 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 5 A
Supply voltage AC
323-576 V AC
Supply voltage DC
450-780 V DC
S
Input current at 400 V
erie
• • • •
20 % power reserve 92.8 % efficiency Small size Standard version with high reliability
0.7 A
Output voltage
48-56 V DC
Output current at 48 V DC
5 A (240 W)
Power reserve up to 45 °C
6 A (288 W)
Efficiency 400 V AC Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
92.8 % -25 to +60 °C 62 x 124 x 117 UL508 listed, UL60950-1, GL
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
CT10.481
380-480 V AC
48-56 V DC
5A
3 phase 48 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 10 A
Supply voltage AC
S
• • • • erie
50 % bonus power Up to 93 % efficiency High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
323-552 V AC
Input current 400/480 V AC
0.79/0.65 A
Output voltage
48-55 V DC
Output current at 48 V DC
10 A (480 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds 48 V DC
15 A (720 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC
95.4 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
65 x 124 x 127 UL508 listed, UL 60950, CB-scheme, GL, ABS
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
QT20.481
380-480 V AC
48-55 V DC
10 A
3 phase 48 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 20 A
Supply voltage AC Input current 400/480 V AC
S
• • • • erie
Up to 93 % efficiency High short circuit current Integral primary fuses Maximum performance for demanding applications
323-576 V AC 1.65/1.35 A
Output voltage
48-54 V DC
Output current at 48 V DC
20 A (960 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds at 48 V DC
30 A (1440 W)
Efficiency at 400 V AC DC-OK relay Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
95.4 % Yes -25 to +60 °C 110 x 124 x 127 UL 508 Listed, UL 60950-1, GL, Class 1, Div 2
Part number
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
QT40.481
380-480 V AC
48-54 V DC
20 A
172 | POWER SUPPLIES
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies 1 phase 5 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 3 A & 5 A
• • • •
Model
High efficiency From 22.5 mm wide AC & DC input voltage Screwless terminals (ML30.101)
ML15.051
ML30.101
Supply voltage AC
85-264 V AC
85-264 V AC
Supply voltage DC
85-375 V DC
85-370 V DC
Input current at 120/230 V AC
0.28/0.17 A
<0.6/<0.35 A
Output voltage
5-5.5 V DC
5-5.5 V DC
77.2 %
>80 %
Output current at 5 V DC
3A
5A
Operating temperature (without derating output)
-10 to +60 °C
-10 to +60 °C
22.5 x 75 x 91
45 x 75 x 97
Efficiency at 230 V AC
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
UL 508 listed, UL 60950, CSA, CB-scheme, GL, ABS
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
ML15.051
100-240 V AC/100-300 V DC
5 V DC
3A
ML30.101
100-240 V AC/85-370 V DC
5 V DC
5A
1 phase ±12 V DC
TECHNICAL DATA
Output current 4.2 A
• • • •
High Efficiency AC & DC input voltage Jumper for 12 or 15 V Screwless terminals
Supply voltage AC
85-264 V AC
Supply voltage DC
85-375 V DC
Input current at 100/230 V AC
<0.65/<0.4 A
Output voltage
±12-15 V DC
Efficiency Output current at 12 V DC Operating temperature
ML30.106
1 phase 30 V DC Output current 8 A
S
• • • •
45 x 75 x 91 UL 508 listed, UL 60950, CSA, CB-scheme, GL, ABS
Input voltage
Output voltage
Output current
100-240 V AC/85-375 V DC
±12 V DC
4.2 A
3 phase 36 V DC Output current13 A
50 % bonus power Up to 94.8 % efficiency High short circuit current Maximum performance for demanding applications
erie
TECHNICAL DATA Model
QS10.301
QT20.361
Supply voltage AC
100-240 V AC ±15 %
323-552 V AC
Supply voltage DC
88-187 V DC
No
Input current
2.22/1.22 A
0.79/0.65 A
Output voltage
28-32 V DC
36-42 V DC
Output current at 30/36 V DC
8 A (240 W)
13.3 A (480 W)
Bonus power for 4 seconds 30/36 V DC
12 A (360 W)
20 A (720 W)
Efficiency
93.5 %
94.8 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
60 x 124 x 117
65 x 124 x 127
Approvals
Part number
-10 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
86 % 2.8 A (+12 V). 1.4 A (-12 V)
UL508 listed, UL 60950, GL
Input voltage
Output voltage
QS10.301
100-240 V AC/110-150 V DC
30 V DC
8A
QT20.361
380-480 V AC
36 V DC
13 A
0116 284 9900
Output current
POWER SUPPLIES
| 173
Power supplies DC-UPS Puls DC UPS systems provide great flexibility and reliability and are very simple to install. A complete DC UPS system consists of a control unit, battery and power supply with appropriate power for the application. During a loss of supply voltage the battery is automatically connected through the control unit to provide a continuous output voltage to the connected loads. The controller requires only one 12 V battery (10 A unit only) which converts the battery voltage to 22.3 V DC. This saves the expense of a second battery and avoids the problems associated with the need for matched batteries. The controller also ensures the output voltage is constant and does not follow the battery voltage as it discharges. Battery capacity used by the DC-UPS is therefore 100% compared to two batteries connected in series where one of the batteries is never fully charged. Two relay outputs indicate status; module ready (battery capacity> 85%) and module active (buffer mode). The controller also monitors the battery condition and another relay output activates when replacement is necessary.
DC-UPS
UB20.241 can handle 20 A continuous load current and is meant for applications with higher power needs. Batteries between 3.9 Ah to 130 Ah can be connected which gives greater flexibility in achieving the required backup times. This controller requires two series connected 12 V DC batteries but still features advanced battery control and monitoring. Using a centre pin connection the controller is able to monitor and charge each battery separately. This ensures maximum battery lifetime is still achieved.
TECHNICAL DATA
24 V/10 A External battery 3.9-40 Ah
• • • •
Input voltage
24 V DC
Battery voltage
Only needs 1 x 12 V battery Optimised battery charging Status relay outputs Adjustable maximum back up time
12 V DC
Output voltage (normal mode)
24 V DC (supply -0.23 V)
Output voltage (buffer mode)
22. 25 V DC ±1 % at max. load
Output current (buffer mode)
10 A (15 A for 5 s)
Output current (normal mode) 24 V Charging time
15 A 5 h for 7 Ah battery. 17 h for 26 Ah battery 6.3 mins at10 A
Buffer time with 7Ah battery Operating temperature
20.5 mins at 5 A -25 to +70 °C (power reduction with 0.43 A/º over 60 ºC)
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number UB10.241
Description
Output
DC-UPS controller for battery 3.9-40 Ah
24 V DC/10 A
DC-UPS
TECHNICAL DATA
24 V/10 A External battery 17-130 Ah
• • • •
Input voltage
Only needs 1 x 12 V battery Optimised battery charging Longer back up times Status relay outputs
174 | POWER SUPPLIES
12 V DC
Output voltage (normal mode)
24 V DC (supply -0.23 V)
Output voltage (buffer mode)
22. 25 V DC ±1 % at max. load
Output current (buffer mode)
10 A (15 A for 5 s)
Output current (normal mode) 24 V Charging time Buffer time with 26 Ah battery
15 A 9 h for 26 Ah battery 34 h for 100 Ah battery Min. 99 mins at 5 A. Typ. 130 mins at 5 A Min. 39 mins at 10 A. Typ. 55 mins at 10 A Min. 62 h at 0.5 A. Typ. 82 h at 0.5 A Min. 3 h at 10 A. Typ. 4 h at 10 A
Operating temperature
-25 to +50 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
49 x 124 x 117
Approvals
UB10.242
24 V DC
Battery voltage
Buffer time with 100 Ah battery
Part number
49 x 124 x 117 UL508 listed, UL 60950, CB-scheme, GL, ABS
UL508 listed, UL 60950-1, CB-scheme
Description
Output
DC-UPS controller for battery 17-130 Ah.
24 V DC/10 A
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies DC-UPS
TECHNICAL DATA
12 & 24 V/10 A External battery 3.9-40 Ah
Input voltage
24 V DC
Battery voltage
12 V DC
Output voltage (normal mode)
24 V DC (supply -0.23 V)
Output voltage (buffer mode)
• • • •
Only needs 1 x 12 V battery Dual outputs 12 & 24 V DC Status relay outputs Optimised battery charging
Output current (buffer mode)
Output current (normal mode)
22. 25 V DC ±1 % at max. load/12 V DC ± 2 % 24 V output
10 A (7 A if 12 V output fully loaded)
12 V output
5A
24 V output
15 A (12.3 A if 12 V output fully loaded)
12 V output
5A
Charging time
5 h for 7 Ah battery. 17 h for 26 Ah battery Min. 5.3 mins at 10 A
Buffer time with 7 Ah battery
Typ. 6.3 mins at 10 A Typ. 20.5 mins at 5 A
Operating temperature
-25 to +70 °C (power reduction with 6 W/º over 50ºC)
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number UB10.245
49 x 124 x 117 UL508 listed, UL 60950, CB-scheme
Description
Output
DC-UPS controller for battery 3.9-40 Ah
12 & 24 V DC/12 A
DC-UPS
TECHNICAL DATA
24 V/10 A Integral battery 5 Ah
Input voltage
• 5 Ah High power battery • Compact size with easy change battery compartment • Status relay outputs • Only 1 x 12 V battery required & included
24 V DC
Output voltage (normal mode)
24 V DC
Output voltage (buffer mode)
22.3 V DC ±1 % at max. load
Output current (normal mode)
15 A
Output current (buffer mode)
10 A (15 A for 5 s)
Buffer time
5 A min. 13 min. 10 A min. 5 min
Charging time Battery
3h 12 V DC maintenance free VRLA. 5 Ah high power
Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
0 to +40 °C 123 x 124 x 119 UL508 listed, UL 60950, GL, ABS, CB-scheme
Part number
Description
Output
UBC10.241
DC-UPS controller with integral 5 Ah battery
24 V DC/10 A
DC-UPS
TECHNICAL DATA
24 V/20A External batteries (x2) 3.9-130 Ah
Input voltage Battery voltage
• Seperate control of each battery • Status relay outputs • Selectable output voltage in buffer mode • Temperature compensated charging
Output voltage (normal mode)
24 V DC
Output voltage (buffer mode)
Switchable 22.5. 24. 25 or 26 V DC (Input voltage must be 0.8 V higher than selected output)
Output current at (normal mode) Output current (buffer mode)
Charging time
0116 284 9900
20 A (30 A for 4 seconds then output reverts to hick up mode) 70 mA 8 h for 12 Ah fully discharged battery
Buffer time with 2 x 7 Ah battery
Min. 4 min at 20 A. Typ. 5.12 min at 20 A
Buffer time with 2 x 12 Ah battery
Min. 11.53 min at 20 A. Typ. 14.51 min at 20 A
Approvals
UB20.241
25 A (If input greater than 28 A then 25 A fuse required)
Input current (not charging)
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
Part number
24 V DC 2x12 V in series
46 x 124 x 127 UL508 listed, UL 60950, GL, ABS, CB-scheme
Description
Output
DC-UPS controller for battery 3.9-130 Ah.
24 V DC/20 A POWER SUPPLIES
| 175
Power supplies Battery holder modules & batteries For 10 & 20 A DC UPS: with 7, 12 & 24 Ah battery
• • • •
For 20 A DC-UPS
7 Ah DIN rail mount Cables included Heavy duty terminals Easy and quick to change batteries
For 10 A DC-UPS
Battery modules use maintenance free VRLA batteries (valve regulated lead acid) and are charged at Puls before delivery. Battery modules can be ordered with (UZK) or without a battery (UZO). All battery modules from Puls support the 1-Battery-Concept. The 24 V battery modules are equippped with a centre-tap protected against over-current and with an
integrated temperature sensor. Users who opt for using their own batteries and who still want to take advantage of the PULS-1-Battery-Concept, can use the sensor board with a PT 1000 temperature sensor and centre-tap fuse.
Part number
Description
UZB12.051
12 V, 5 Ah battery replacement for UBC10.241
90 x 106 x 70 mm
Dimensions
UZB12.071
12 V, 7 Ah battery replacement for UZK12.071, UZK24.071
151 x 98 x 65 mm
UZB12.121
12 V, 12 Ah battery replacement for UZK24.121
151 x 98 x 98 mm
UZB12.261
12 V, 26 Ah battery replacement for UZK12.261
175 x 125 x 166 mm
UZK12.071
12 V, 7 Ah battery module with battery for UB10
155 x 124 x 112 mm
UZK12.261
12 V, 26 Ah battery module with battery for UB10
214 x 179 x 158 mm
UZK24.071
24 V, 7 Ah battery module with battery for UB20
137 x 186 x 143 mm
UZK24.121
24 V, 12 Ah battery module with battery for UB20
203 x 186 x 143 mm
UZO12.07
Same as the UZK12.071 battery module without battery
155 x 124 x 112 mm
UZO12.26
Same as the UZK12.261 battery module without battery
214 x 179 x 158 mm
UZO24.071
Same as the UZK24.071 battery module without battery
137 x 186 x 143 mm
UZO24.121
Same as the UZK24.121 battery module without battery
203 x 186 x 143 mm
UZS24.100
Sensorboard with PT 1000 temperature sensor and centre-tap fuse
23 x 15 x 110 mm
Typical buffer times The table below shows typical buffer times of standard battery modules. The aging effect during operation is not included. We recommend calculating a buffer time reduction of 30 – 50% for the life of the batteries Buffer current UBC10.241
0.5 A
1A
3A
5A
7A
10 A
15 A
20 A
3h 30 min
2h
30 min
16 min 15s
11 min
6 min 15s
5s
-
UBC10 + 12 V, 7 Ah battery
5h
2h 30 min
40 min
21 min 30s
13 min
6 min 45s
5s
-
UBC10 + 12 V, 26 Ah battery
22h
12h
3h 40 min
2h 10 min
1h 30 mini
55 min
5s
-
UBC10 + 12 V, 65 Ah battery
54h
30h
10h 30 min
6h
4h
2h 45 min
5s
-
UBC10 + 12 V, 100 Ah battery
84h
46h
16h 12 min
9h
6h
4h 7 min
5s
-
UBC10 + 24 V, 7 Ah battery
11h 35 min
6h 8 min
1h 58 min
1h 4 min
42 min
26 min
13 min
8 min
UBC10 + 24 V, 12 Ah battery
20h
10h 30 min
3h 20 min
1h 50 min
1h 12 min
45 min
23 min
15 min
176 | POWER SUPPLIES
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies Buffer module Buffer modules work in a similar way to a DC UPS system and can bridge short power failures or voltage fluctuations with a 24V DC output for a certain period. EDLC supercaps or electrolytic capacitors are used as the energy source which allows operation at high or low temperatures. Unlike the required replacement of batteries in a typical DC UPS system, a regular replacement of the capcitors is not necessary. In buffer mode, the output voltage is regulated and the change from normal to buffer mode is without interuption. All buffer modules are protected against overload and short circuit.
Buffer module
TECHNICAL DATA
For 24 V DC
Input
24 V DC
Output voltage (buffer mode)
Alt: 1
22.5 V DC Default
Alt: 2
Vnom -1 V DC
Output current (buffer mode) max.
200 ms at 22.5 V DC/20 A 3.6 s at 22.5 V DC/1 A
Buffer time
• Bridges temporary power failure • Buffers 24 V DC at 20 A for 200 ms • Status outputs • Maintenance free
20 A
Status outputs
Module ready, module active, external shutdown
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Part number
64 x 124 x 102 UL 508 listed, UL60950-1, CB-scheme
Description
UF20.241
Buffer module 24 V DC Max. 20 A for 200 ms
Buffer module
TECHNICAL DATA
For 24 V DC with EDLC supercaps
Model
UC10.241
UC10.242
Input
24 V DC
Output voltage (buffer mode)
• • • •
EDLC supercaps Longer buffer times Long lifetime Maintenance free
Current consumption charging max
15 A (360 W)
Charging time
Buffer time
16 min
32 min
5A
39 s
78 s
10 A
16.5 s
33 s
15 A
9s
18 s
Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Module ready, module active, external shutdown 126 x 124 x 117
198 x 124 x 117
UL 508 listed, UL60950-1 recognised, CB-scheme
Description
UC10.241
Buffer module 6 kWs. 15 A
UC10.242
Buffer module 12 kWs. 15 A
0116 284 9900
Max. 1.3 A
Load current max
Status outputs
Part number
22.25 V DC at 10 A / 22.12 V DC at 15 A
POWER SUPPLIES
| 177
Power supplies Redundancy module 10 A
TECHNICAL DATA Input voltage DC
10-48 V DC
Max. current
• • • •
45 mm wide Double diodes Increase system reliablity Large screw terminals
Operating temperature
Approvals
Description
MLY10.241
Redundancy module 10 A 10 - 60 V DC
20 A
• • • •
32 mm wide Double diodes Relay status output Increase system reliability
Model
YR2.DIODE 12-48 V DC
24-48 V DC
2x10 A or 1x20 A
2x10 A or 1x20 A
Max. current per channel Max. current Operating temperature Dimensions W x H x D (mm) Approvals
Description Redundancy module 20 A 10-60 V DC
YRM2.DIODE
20 A
20 A
-40 to +60 °C
-40 to +60 °C
32 x 124 x 102
32 x 124 x 117
UL508 listed, UL60950, GL, ABS, CB-scheme
Redundancy module with relay output 20 A 10-60 V DC
Redundancy module 40 A & 80 A
• • • •
Compact size Mosfet technology Minimal power loss Increase system reliability
TECHNICAL DATA Model
YR40.241
YR80.241
Supply voltage DC
12-28 V DC
12-28 V DC
Max current per channel
20 A
40 A
Max current
40 A
80 A
2 x 32.5 A
2 x 65 A
1 000 A for 1 ms
1 500 A for 1 ms
Short circuit current max 5 seconds Peak current max Voltage drop at max load
140 mV
95 mV
Dimensions W x H x D
36 x 124 x 127 mm
46 x 124 x 127 mm
Approvals
UL508 listed, UL60950, CSA, GL, CB-scheme, Atex (113G EX nAC II T3)
Description
YR40.241
Redundancy module 40 A 16.8 - 36.4 V DC
YR80.241
Redundancy module 80 A 16.8 - 36.4 V DC
178 | POWER SUPPLIES
UL508 listed, UL60950, GL
Input voltage
YR2.DIODE
Part number
45 x 75 x 91 mm
TECHNICAL DATA
Part number
YRM2.DIODE
-40 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
Part number
Redundancy module
2 x 5 A or 1 x 10 A
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies DC-DC converter
TECHNICAL DATA
24/24 & 24/12 V DC
Model
CD5.241
CD5.121
18-32 V DC
18-32 V DC
5.5 A
4.6 A
Output voltage
23-28 V DC
12-15 V DC
Output current at Unom
5 A (120 W)
8 A (96 W)
Supply voltage Current consumption at max load/ Unom
• • • •
32 mm wide Isolated output voltage Wide range input voltage 20 % power reserve
Power reserve up to 45 °C Efficiency
9.6 A
90.3 %
88.2 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
32 x 124 x 102
32 x 124 x 102
UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, Class 1 Div 2, GL, ATEX II 3G Ex nAC II T4 (Atex only 24/24 VDC)
Approvals
Part number
6A
Description
Input
Output
CD5.241
DC-DC converter
24 V DC
24 V DC/5 A
CD5.121
DC-DC converter
24 V DC
12 V DC/8 A
DC-DC converter
TECHNICAL DATA
48/24 & 12/24 V DC
Model
CD5.242
CD5.243
36-60 V DC
8.4-16.2 V DC
2.75 A
9.2 A
Output voltage
23-28 V DC
23-28 V DC
Output current at Unom
5 A (120 W)
4 A (96 W)
Supply voltage Current consumption at max load/ Unom
• • • •
32 mm wide Isolated output voltage Wide range input voltage 20 % power reserve
Power reserve up to 45 °C Efficiency
6A
4.8 A
90.3 %
87.7 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
32 x 124 x 102
32 x 124 x 102
Approvals
UL 508 listed, UL 60950-1, Class 1 Div 2
Description
Input
Output
CD5.242
DC-DC converter
48 V DC
24 V DC/5 A
CD5.243
DC-DC converter
12 V DC
24 V DC/4 A
Part number
DC-DC converter
TECHNICAL DATA
24 V DC/20 A
Supply voltage
480-840 V DC
Max voltage between input & Earth Primary fuse
600 V R.M.S. Integral 4 A not user replaceable
Input current at 600 V DC/20 A
• Designed for connection to be DC-bus • 600 V DC input voltage • Integral primary fuses • Efficiency 95 %
0.85 A
Output voltage
24-28 V DC
Output current at Unom
20 A
Efficiency
95 %
Operating temperature
-25 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
65 x 124 x 127
Approvals
UL 508 listed, UL60950-1, CB-scheme
Part number
Input
Output
QTD20.241
480-840 V DC
24 V DC/20 A
0116 284 9900
POWER SUPPLIES
| 179
Power supplies 1-phase AS-interface 30.6 V DC Output current 2.8 A. 4 A & 8 A
TECHNICAL DATA Model Supply voltage AC* Input current 115/230 V AC
• 115/230 V AC • DIN rail mount • Overload protection with electronic fuse (SLA8) • Ground fault monitor (SLA4)
Output voltage V DC Output current Efficiency
SLA3.100
SLA4.100
SLA8.100
85-132/184-264 V
85-132/184-264 V
85-132/184-264 V
2/0.9 A
2.7/1.3 A
6/2.8 A
30.55 V ±3 %
30.55 V ±3 %
30.55 V ±3 %
2.8 A
4A
8A
90.5 %
90 %
92 %
Operating temperature**
-10 to +60 °C
-10 to +60 °C
-10 to +60 °C
Dimensions W x H x D (mm)
49 x 124 x 102
73 x 124 x 102
91 x 124 x 102
Approvals
UL508 listed, UL 60950
* Selectable on front face with switch ** Up to 70 °C with reduced load current
Description
Input
Output
SLA3.100
Part number
Power supply for ASI
115/230 V AC
30.55 V DC/2.8 A
SLA4.100
Power supply for ASI
115/230 V AC
30.55 V DC/4 A
SLA8.100
Power supply for ASI
115/230 V AC
30.55 V DC/8 A
Mounting brackets Mounting brackets for a direct wall or panel mounting without DIN rail. Other brackets for sideways installation of the power supplies with or without DIN rail for control cabinets which don’t have the required installation depth.
Wall mount
Side mount
Part number
Description
ZM1.WALL
Wall mounting bracket for light DIMENSION units
ZM2.WALL
Wall mounting bracket for QS20, QS40, QT40, CPS20…
ZM3.WALL
Wall mounting bracket for ML60, PISA11 and MLY (VPE 25 peices0
ZM1.UBC10
Wall mounting bracket for UBC10
ZM11.SIDE
Side mounting bracket for CS3, CS5, QS3, YR2 YRM2
ZM12.SIDE
Side mounting bracket for CT5, QS5
ZM13.SIDE
Side mounting bracket for CS10, CT10, QS10, CPS20…
ZM14.SIDE
Side mounting bracket for QT20, QTD20, UF20
ZM15.SIDE
Side mounting bracket for QS20 (except QS20.244)
180 | POWER SUPPLIES
www.oem.co.uk
Power supplies NEC-Class 2 protection module
• • • •
NEC-Class 2 compliant outputs Electronically protected outputs 45 mm wide Remote monitoring & control functions
The protection module PISA11.CLASS 2 fulfills two basic functions. First it distributes the current of a large (non NEC Class 2) power source to four NEC Class 2 output channels and therefore allows for a simpler wiring method and easier approval process of the entire machine. The second function is to permit only so much current on the outputs that the input voltage of this unit (which corresponds to the output voltage of the power supply) does not fall below 21V. This ensures a safe and uninterrupted supply voltage for sensitive equipments, such as PLCs, controls or sensors, when they are connected directly to the same power supply as the PISA module. Less critical loads that are not affected by short voltage interruptions or that could even be the cause of a fault on the 24V power supply are connected to one of the four NEC Class 2 output channels of the PISA module.
ATEX approval
• For zone 2 category 3G • From 5 to 40 A • DC-DC converter
Puls can offer a number of units with Atex approval that can be installed in Zone 2, Category 3G, group 11a, 11b and 11c applications. The Atex options include power supplies, DC-DC converters for 24/24 VDC and redundancy modules in the Mini Line and Dimension families. Please enquire for more details about models with ATEX approvals.
Low temperature operation -40 °C
• Operating temperature -40 to +60 °C • AC & DC supply voltage • Active inrush current limiter
0116 284 9900
The Mini Line 2 is a newly developed series of lower power units with very compact dimensions and low weight. The series includes ML60.242 (24 V DC) and ML60.122 (12VDC) that both have electronic inrush current protection which helps ensure the units always operate correctly even in extreme cold temperatures. Other power supplies typically use an NTC resistor to limit the inrush current but at low temperatures they have too high a resistance and prevent the unit from starting up. Electronic inrush current protection solves this problem and also ensures a stable output voltage even with dynamic loads where the power requirements can change rapidly.
POWER SUPPLIES
| 181
PUSHBUTTONS AND PILOT LIGHTS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Introduction
184
Pushbuttons
188
Mushroom heads
189
Selector & key switch heads
190
Twin/triple touch heads
192
Mechanical reset button
192
Contact/LED block & clips
194
Pilot lights
197
Legend plates & accessories
198
Control stations
200
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
A whole new range Baco was founded in 1919 in Strasbourg (France) and have since established themselves as a leading manufacturer in the world wide market of control & signalling devices. This offer has a modern ergonomic design that builds on the success of their previous range. Baco have implemented
many innovative improvements that include optimised dimensions, LED technology and a wider choice of connection possibilities. All of this results in a product that is reliable, looks great and is easier than ever to install and connect.
A simple concept
Head Insulating material ensures electrical safety Integrated anti rotation pins IP66 standard (IP67 with shroud) Modern ergonomic design Choice of bezels in chrome or black Wide range of functions
Locking Ring
Clip Enhanced rigidity Metal locking lever For 1, 3 & 5 blocks Contacts simply click in place
Contact/LED Block Simply snap in to place Cannot be pulled out Stackable LED blocks offer long life and economy (100,000 hours) Corrosion resistant Conforms to EN IEC 60947-5-1 RoHS compliant
Enkelt att montera ochconnection installera Easy installation & fast
2
1
Huvudet sitter på plats Head held firmly in the 22mm fixing hole by 4 integral Fyra antirotationskuddar håller anti rotation pins allowing easy huvudet säkert på plats vilket positioning. underlättar placeringen.
184 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
Silikonring Head tightened securely with the M22 locking ring huvudet thatSilikonringen can be fittedhåller with one hand. på plats vilket gör att man med ett enhandsgrepp enkelt monterar kontramuttern M22.
Snabbt Fast fixing montage of the contact assembly, simply Blocken med cliplock skjuts push on and then in place på the huvudet. Vrid sedan with metal lever. på metallåset.
Snabb anslutning Quick connection using spring terminal contact blocks, För snabb och vibrationssäker cables are simply pushed in. anslutning, använd fjäderklämma. Skjut bara in kabeln. Klart! www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
A commitment to quality Standard features such as IP66 ingress protection and IK05 impact rating mean that this range offers exceptional reliability and can be used with confidence in critical
applications. To reinforce this commitment to quality Baco are able to offer a 10 year guarantee on all new purchased products!
Resilient & robust
IK 05 IP 66 Twin touch and triple touch heads feature an ergonomic design and are available in both illuminated and non illuminated options.
Ø 22.5mm fixing hole Special hole cut out for anti rotation All heads mount in a Ø22mm hole and are IP66/IK05 rated as standard.
Mushroom heads are available in a wide range of sizes and turn to reset versions have a patented, ergonomic triangular design. EN418 snap action types have a visible yellow indicator ring and there is also a flag indicator option.
Control stations can be supplied equipped in many standard versions or empty for custom assembly. Special versions can be configured exactly to your requirements. Including custom markings to suit your application.
Flera anslutningsmöjligheter
Every connection possibility
Skruvmontage Ett traditionellt montagesätt med rejäla skruvar. Screw terminals for a traditional connection method.
0116 284 9900
Fjäderklämma Snabb och vibrationssäker installation. Push in connection using spring clamp terminals for a completely safe & time saving solution.
Flatstiftanslutning Monteras snabbt och säkert connection med 6,35 mm Faston hylsor &eller 2x2,8 mm.using quickly easilly made 6.35mm or 2 x 2.8mm faston terminals.
Kretskortmontage Med lödstift för direkt montage på kretskort. Pin terminals intended for direct soldered connection to PCB’s.
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 185
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Technical specification General characteristics
Data
Storage temperature
- 40°C to + 70°C
Normes
Operating temperature
- 25°C to + 70°C
Climatic resistance
Constant humid heat Cyclical damp heat Resistance to saline mist
IEC 60068-2-3 IEC 60068-2-30 IEC 60068-2-52
Degree of protection
IP66 for standard heads & equipped control stations IP67 for shrouded heads IP20 rear of panel on contact blocks & pilot lights
IEC 60529
Protection against mechanical shocks
IK05 non illuminated & illuminated heads IK07 empty control station
IEC 50102
Protection against electrical shocks
Class II
IEC 60947-5-1
Terminal marking
IEC 60947-1
Maximum tightening torque
M22 head locking ring 3N.m Screw terminals 1.2Nm
Vibration
Resistant to vibration on 3 axis
IEC 60068-2-6
Approvals
UL United States & Canada BV Bureau Veritas Certification OC/CB
UL 508 Settlement Marine IEC 60947-5-1 IEC 60947-5-5 IEC 60947-5-4
Contact block characteristics
Screw terminal Push in terminal
Faston connection
Pin terminals
Normes
Rated insulation voltage
690V AC
320V AC
250V AC
IEC/EN 60947-1
Degrees of pollution 3
600V AC
300V AC
250V AC
UL 508 IEC/EN 60947-5-1
NC contacts
Positive opening
Positive opening
Positive opening
Rated impulse withstand voltage
6kV
6kV
4kV
Thermal current
10A/AC15 2.5A/DC13
10A/AC15 2.5A/DC13
5A/AC15 1A/DC13
IEC 60947-5-1
Electrical performance AC15
120V/6A 240V/3A 380V/1.9A 480V/1.5A 500V/1.4A 600V/1.2A
120V/6A 240V/3A
120V/3A 240V/1.5A
IEC 60947-5-1
Electrical performance DC13
125V/0.55A 250V/0.27A 400V/0.15A 500V/0.13A 600V/0.1A
125V/0.55A 250V/0.27A
125V/0.22A 250V/0.1A
IEC 60947-5-1
24V DC/5mA 5V DC/1mA
24V DC/5mA
24V DC/5mA 5V DC/1mA
Minimum current
Standard contacts Gold contacts
Electrical durability
1 million operations (AC15 240V/1.5A) (DC13 250V/0.1A)
Connection capacity
Without ferrule With ferrule Faston size Pin diameter
0.5mm2 - 2 x 2.5mm2 0.5mm2 - 2 x 1.5mm2
6.35mm/2 x 2.8mm 1mm
LED block characteristics
Data
Normes
Rated insulation voltage
300V
IEC/EN 60947-5-1
Rated impulse withstand voltage
4kV (with filter block)
IEC/EN 60947-1
Operating voltage & current consumption
24V AC/DC 25mA ± 20% 48V AC/DC 15mA ± 5% 130V AC 50 or 60Hz 20mA ± 10% 230V AC 50 or 60Hz 16mA ± 30%
Lifetime at rated supply voltage
Red & Yellow 100,000 hours at 25°C Other colours 50,000 hours at 25°C
Selector/key switch working diagram of contacts
not actioned
actioned
Position and contact view from front
186 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Drill plans +0,4
Ø 22,3 -0
B
A
A B
Dimension (mm) = 30 = 33 = 40 > 40 > 45 = 38 = 50 = 45 = 54 = 77 = 50
Description With or without legend (standard) For IP67 silicon shroud With large legend plate For mushroom head Ø40 For selector switch with long handle For super flush button (Ø30 hole) If with 5 position clip With or without legend (standard) With twin touch With twin touch & legend plate Joystick
Hole for Anti rotation
Max panel thickness E = 1 to 6mm
E
Colour guidelines EN60204-1 Colour
Signalling
Control
Red
Indicates dangerous situation
Emergency stop
Green
Indicates normal situation
Black Yellow
Stop/Off Indicates abnormal situation
Blue
Indicates situation requiring defined action
Reset
White
No specific meaning
Start/On
Assembly examples Illuminated pushbuttons & pilot lights
Non illuminated pushbuttons
Pushbutton with 1 contact block on a single clip
Pushbutton with 1 or 2 contact blocks on 3 position clip
Pushbutton with 3 contact blocks on 3 position clip
Pushbutton with 4 or 5 contact blocks on 5 position clip
Pushbutton with 4, 5 or 6 contact blocks using second row on 3 position clip
0116 284 9900
43
Pilot light with LED block on a single clip
Illumintated pushbutton with LED & 1 or 2 contact blocks on 3 position clip
43
43
43
43
Illuminated pushbutton with LED block & 3 or 4 contact blocks using second row on 3 position clip
64,5
Illuminated pushbutton with LED block & transformer with 1 or 2 contact blocks on 3 position clip
50
64,5
Illuminated pushbutton with LED block & 3 or 4 contact blocks on 5 position clip
80,5
50
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 187
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Pushbuttons IP66 Non illuminated Red Green Spring return Part number
L21AA01
L21AA02
Black
Yellow
White
Blue
L21AA03
L21AA04
L21AA05
L21AA06
Red Green Black Spring return, mushroom, Ø32 mm Part number
L21AC01
L21AC02
L21AC03
Yellow
White
Blue
L21AC04
-
-
L21AD04
-
-
Spring return, with text/symbol, ***= 3 digit code L21AA31*** L21AA32*** L21AA33*** L21AA34*** L21AA35*** L21AA36*** Part number L21AA81 L21AA82 L21AA82 -
Spring return, mushroom, Ø40 mm Part number
L21AB01
L21AB02
L21AB03
L21AB04
L21AB05
L21AB06
Part number
L23AA04
L23AA05
L23AA06
Part number
Spring return, super flush Part number
L23AA01
L23AA02
L23AA82
L21AE01
-
L21AE03
-
-
-
L21CA01
L21CA02
L21CA03
L21CA04
L21CA05
L21CA06
L21CB03
L21CB04
L21CB05
L21CB06
Latching projecting
L23AA31*** L23AA32*** L23AA33*** L23AA34*** L23AA35*** L23AA36*** L23AA81
L21AD03
Latching
L23AA03
Spring return, super flush, with text/symbol, ***= 3 digit code Part number
L21AD02
Spring return, mushroom, Ø70 mm
Spring return, projecting Part number
L21AD01
L23AA83
Part number
L21CB01
L21CB02
For black plastic bezel instead of matt chrome bezel please change part numbers from L21xxxx to L22xxxx. For heads with a text or symbol please specify relevant 3 digit code further on in this section.
Illuminated
Part number
Red Spring return
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
L21AH10
L21AH20
L21AH40
L21AH50
L21AH60
Red Green Yellow White Blue Spring return, super flush, with text/symbol, ***= 3 digit code Part number
Spring return, with text/symbol, ***= 3 digit code Part number
Spring return, mushroom, Ø40 mm
L21AH31*** L21AH32*** L21AH34*** L21AH35*** L21AH36***
Part number
Spring return, projecting Part number
L21AK10
L21AK20
L23AH10
L23AH20
L21AL10
L21AL20
L21AL40
L21AL50
-
L21CH20
L21CH40
L21CH50
L21CH60
L21CK40
L21CK50
L21CK60
Latching L21AK40
L21AK50
L21AK60
Part number
L23AH60
Part number
Spring return, super flush Part number
L23AH31*** L23AH32*** L23AH34*** L23AH35*** L23AH36***
L21CH10
Latching projecting L23AH40
L23AH50
L21CK10
L21CK20
For black plastic bezel instead of matt chrome bezel please change part numbers from L21xxxx to L22xxxx. For heads with a text or symbol please specify relevant 3 digit code further on in this section.
188 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Mushroom heads IP66 The Machinery Directive distinguishes between stop and emergency stop. A stop button should be black but is allowed to be red. As a rule an emergency stop button locks in a set position before the contact breaks (snap action) and there is a need
to reset it manually. For mushroom heads complying with EN418/IEC 60947-5-5 see emergency stop mushroom heads.
Non illuminated
Red
Green
Black
Yellow
Part number
Red
Green
Black
Yellow
L22ED01
L22ED02
L22ED03
L22ED04
L22ED01B
-
-
-
L22DD01
-
L22DD03
-
L22GM01
-
-
-
Red
Green
Yellow
L22EM10
L22EM20
L22EM40
L22DM10
L22DM20
L22DM40
Turn reset, Ø40 mm
Turn reset, Ø32 mm L22EC01
L22EC02
L22EC03
L22EC04
Part number
With text “STOP-STOP-STOP” Part number
Pull reset, Ø32 mm Part number
Pull reset, Ø40 mm L22DC01
-
-
-
Part number
Key reset, Ø40 mm Part number
Illuminated
Red
Green
Yellow
Turn reset, Ø32 mm Part number
Turn reset, Ø40 mm L22EL10
-
-
Pull reset, Ø32 mm Part number
0116 284 9900
Part number
Pull reset, Ø40 mm L22DL10
-
-
Part number
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 189
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Emergency stop mushroom heads IP66 Baco’s ”Emergency Stop” mushroom heads comply with EN418/IEC 60947-5-5. They are available in 3 sizes Ø 32 mm, Ø 40 mm & Ø 54 mm and various options including turn reset, pull reset, key reset, illuminated & flag indication. To reinforce that these are
”Emergency Stop” mushroom heads there is a yellow ring around the bottom of the button that is only visible when the button is in the deactivated position.
Emergency stop mushrooom heads
Pull reset, Ø32 mm Part number
Turn reset, Ø40 mm L22DQ01
Key reset, Ø32 mm Part number
Part number
L22ER01
Key reset, Ø40 mm L22GQ01
Part number
Pull reset illuminated, Ø40 mm
Pull reset, Ø40 mm
Part number
Part number
L22DN10
L22DR01
Pull reset with flag indicator, Ø54mm L22GR01
Part number L22DU01J L22DU01A Green “1” Yellow “1” Red “0” Red “0”
Legend plate
Part number LWE16 LWE16-300 LWE00 LWE00-300
Description Ø60 mm, 22,5 mm, no text Ø60 mm, 22,5 mm, text: ”EMERGENCY STOP” Ø80 mm, 22,5 mm, no text Ø80 mm, 22,5 mm, text: ”EMERGENCY STOP”
Part number LWA0240
Description Padlockable shroud
Shroud
190 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Selector/key switch heads 2 position IP66 Non illuminated 0
1
0 1
0
0
1
1
0 1
Short handle
Stable 45°
Spring return 45°
Stable 45°
Spring return 45°
Stable 90°
Stable 90°
Part number
L21KA03
L21KB03
L21KC03
L21KD03
L21KE03
L21KF03
Part number
L21KP03
L21KQ03
L21KR03
L21KS03
L21KT03
L21KU03
Part number
L21LA00*
L21LB00*
L21LC00*
L21LD00*
L21LE00*
L21LF00*
Part number
-
-
-
-
L21LG00**
L21LH00**
Long handle
With key
* Key removeable ”0” only ** key removeable ”0” & ”1” Supplied with 2 keys profile 455 - other profiles available on request
Part number
L21TA03
L21TB03
-
-
-
L21TF03
Red Part number
L21KG10
L21KH10
L21KJ10
L21KK10
L21KL10
L21KM10
Green Part number
L21KG20
L21KH20
L21KJ20
L21KK20
L21KL20
L21KM20
Black Part number
L21KG30
L21KH30
L21KJ30
L21KK30
L21KL30
L21KM30
Part number
L21KV30
-
L21KX30
L21KY30
-
-
With knob
Illuminated
Short handle
Long handle
0116 284 9900
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 191
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Selector/key switch heads 3 position IP66 Non illuminated
Long handle
Spring return _0 1_>
Spring return _0 2_>
Spring return _0 2 1_>
Stable
Part number
L21MA03
L21MB03
L21MC03
L21MD03
L21MK03
Part number
-
L21MR03
L21MS03
L21MT03
L21MU03
Part number
L21NA00*
L21NB00*
L21NC00*
L21ND00*
L21NL00*
Part number
L21NE00**
-
-
-
L21NK00***
_> _
Short handle
Stable
With key *K ey removeable “0” only, ** Key removeable “1” & “2”, ***Key removeble ”1”, ”0” & ”2” Supplied with 2 keys profile 455 - other profiles available on request
With knob
Part number
L21UA03
L21UB03
L21UC03
L21UD03
L21UK03
Red Part number
L21ME10
L21MF10
L21MG10
L21MH10
L21MJ10
Green Part number
L21ME20
L21MF20
L21MG20
L21MH20
L21MJ20
Black Part number
L21ME30
L21MF30
L21MG30
L21MH30
L21MJ30
Part number
-
L21ML30
L21MM30
L21MN30
L21MP30
Illuminated
Short handle
Long handle
192 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Twin/triple touch heads IP66 Non illuminated
Illuminated
”START”/”STOP”
Part number
L61QA21
L61QA22K
L61QA33C
L61QA22
Part number
L61QH21
”START”/”STOP”
Part number
Part number
L61QB21
L61QB21B
”STOP”
”STOP”
L61BA22
L61BA22B
L61QH22V
L61QH21A
”START”/”STOP”
Part number
L61QK21
L61QK21A
L61QK53
Mechanical reset pushbutton adjustable IP65 Adjustable 26-63 mm with travel of 11mm
Red
Green
Black
Yellow
White
Blue
Part number
L21HA01
L21HA02
L21HA03
L21HA04
L21HA05
L21HA06
Part number
L21HB01
L21HB02
L21HB03
L21HB04
L21HB05
L21HB06
Flush
Projecting
Button for potentiometer Potentiometer For shaft Ø=6-6.35 mm L=46-51 mm Part number
0116 284 9900
L21RP03
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 193
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Contact blocks & clips Bacoâ&#x20AC;&#x2122;s contact blocks are available in four different connection options, standard screw, push to fit spring clamp, flat blade for faston terminals and with PCB pins. Use up to 6 contacts on one head by using
Contact
a 3 module clip and stacking a further 3 contacts directs on the back. For any illuminated heads the LED block is always mounted in the middle.
LED x1
NO NC
3
x2
4
1
2
Mounting clips 3 position clip
Single clip
Part number
Type
331E
Part number
5 position clip
333E
Part number
335E
Connection
Standard NO
Standard NC
Standard NO+NC
Gold plated NO
Gold plated NC
Screw
33E10
33E01
-
33E10Y7
33E01Y7
Screw
-
33E01C (delayed opening)
-
-
-
Screw
-
-
33E11
-
-
Push fit spring clamp
33R10
33R01
-
-
-
Faston 6.35 mm 2x2.8 mm
33D10
33D01
-
-
-
PCB pins
33P10
33P01
-
-
-
194 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
LED-block
Type
Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
Part number
Part number
Part number
Part number
Part number
Screw 24 V AC/DC
33EARL
33EAGL
33EAYL
33EAWL
33EABL
Screw 115 V AC
33EARM
33EAGM
33EAYM
33EAWM
33EABM
Screw 230 V AC
33EARH
33EAGH
33EAYH
33EAWH
33EABH
Push fit spring clamp 24 V AC/DC
33RARL
33RAGL
33RAYL
33RAWL
33RABL
Push fit spring clamp 115 V AC
33RARM
33RAGM
33RAYM
33RAWM
33RABM
Push fit spring clamp 230 V AC
33RARH
33RAGH
33RAYH
33RAWH
33RABH
Faston 24 V AC/DC
33DARL
33DAGL
33DAYL
33DAWL
33DABL
Faston 115 V AC
33DARM
33DAGM
33DAYM
33DAWM
33DABM
Faston 230 V AC
33DARH
33DAGH
33DAYH
33DAWH
33DABH
PCB pin 24 V AC/DC
33PARL
33PAGL
33PAYL
33PAWL
33PABL
Connection/ voltage
Contact block for mounting in base of LBX-control station
Part number 33S01
2
1
33S10
4
3
Screw
LED block for mounting in base of LBX control station
24 V AC/DC LED Part number
Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
33SARL
33SAGL
33SAYL
33SAWL
33SABL
33SARM
33SAGM
33SAYM
33SAWM
33SABM
33SARH
33SAGH
33SAYH
33SAWH
33SABH
130 VAC LED Part number
Screw
230 VAC LED Part number
0116 284 9900
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 195
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Contact block assemblies Contact blocks & clip
3
4
1
2
Screw terminal Part number
331E10
3
4
1
2
3
4
3
4
1
2
1
2
331E01
333E20
333E02
333E11
Contact blocks, LED & clip 2 NO+24 V AC/DC LED Part number
Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
333EARL20
333EAGL20
333EAYL20
333EAWL20
333EABL20
333EARH20
333EAGH20
333EAYH20
333EAWH20
333EABH20
333EARL11
333EAGL11
333EAYL11
333EAWL11
333EABL11
333EARH11
333EAGH11
333EAYH11
333EAWH11
333EABH11
334EAGL22
334EAYL22
334EAWL22
334EABL22
334EAGH22
334EAYH22
334EAWH22
334EABH22
2 NO+230 V AC LED 3
4
3
4
Part number
1 NO, 1 NC+24 V AC/DC LED Part number 1 NO, 1 NC+230 V AC LED 3
Part number
4 X2
X1 1
2
1 NO/1 NC, 1 NO/1 NC+LED 24 V AC/DC LED Part number
334EARL22
1 NO/1 NC, 1 NO/1 NC+LED 230 V AC 1
2
4
1
2
x1
x2 3
4
Part number
334EARH22
3
Contact block & LED accessories
Diode block
Part number
Transformer block
Filter block
Single
Double
230/24 V
400/24 V
130 V
230 V
33ET
33ETT
33EHC
33ELC
33EFM
33EFH
196 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
Junction block
Empty module
33EY
33EX
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Pilot lights One piece pilot light (excluding lamp)
Direct supply 0-400 V lamp type Ba9S (not included)
Part number
Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
L20SA10
L20SA20
L20SA40
L20SA50
L20SA60
One piece pilot light for LED The pilot light comes complete with a white diffuser cap under the lens which is used to spread the LED light across the entire lens. It is also possible to have a text or symbol, please enquire for further details. Without LED Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
L20SA31
L20SA32
L20SA34
L20SA35
L20SA36
L20SA10L
L20SA20L
L20SA40L
L20SA50L
L20SA60L
L20SA10M
L20SA20M
L20SA40M
L20SA50M
L20SA60M
Part number
L20SA10H
L20SA20H
L20SA40H
L20SA50H
L20SA60H
Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
Part number
L20SE10
L20SE20
L20SE40
L20SE50
L20SE60
Part number
L20SE31***
L20SE32***
L20SE34***
L20SE35***
L20SE36***
Part number Inc. 12-24 V AC/DC LED lamp Part number Inc. 115 V AC LED lamp Part number Inc. 230 V AC LED lamp
Pilot light head
With text or symbol *** = 3 digit code
LED block & clip for pilot light head
12-24 V AC/DC Part number
Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
331EARL
331EAGL
331EAYL
331EAWL
331EABL
331EARM
331EAGM
331EAYM
331EAWM
331EABM
331EARH
331EAGH
331EAYH
331EAWH
331EABH
115 V AC Part number 230 V AC Part number
0116 284 9900
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 197
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Legend plates & holders Standard round
Wide round
Standard square
For twin touch
For type LIAx
For type LIBx
For type LIAx
For type LIAx
LWP3
LWG3
LWP4
LWP2
Part number
Type
Description
Part number Aluminium
Part number White
Part number Red
Part number Black
Part number Transparent
2 line 13 characters per line
LIA9
LIA5
LIA1
LIA3
LIA7
2 line 18 characters per line
LIB9
LIB5
LIB1
LIB3
LIB7
Standard text/symbol codes Standard text Text Alarm Auto Close Down Fast Forward Hand
Code 521 513 314 336 310 305 524
Text Hand - 0 - Auto Hand - Auto Jog Lower Off On Open
Code 591 583 328 308 304 303 313
Text Power On Raise Reset Reverse Run Running Slow
Code 330 307 315 306 327 3326 309
Text Start Stop Tripped Up 0-I 0 - I - Start I - 0 - II
Code 301 302 3327 335 081 093 091
Standard symbols ISO /DIN Description
Symbol
Code
Description
Symbol
Code
Description
Symbol
Code
Continuous straight line movement A01 ISO 1
Unclamp, release ISO 64A
A64
Clutch A74 ISO 74/ DIN 46
Alternating straight line movement ISO 5
A05
Unclamp, release ISO 64D
B64
De-clutch ISO 75/ DIN 45
A75
Continuous rotating movement clockwise ISO 7A/DIN 100
A07
Brake ISO 65
A65
Warning <<Live>> (energised) ISO 92/DIN 45
A92
Continuous rotating mov. anti clockwise ISO 7B
B07
Release brake ISO 66
A66
Main switch ISO 94
A94
Forward A16 ISO 16
Automatic cycle (or semi automatic) ISO 67
A67
Lubrication jet ISO 101
C01
Increase in value ISO 28
A28
Manual control ISO 68
A68
Machine lighting ISO 102/ DIN 139
C02
Decrease in value ISO 29
A29
<<ON>> Close circuit ISO 69
A69
Greasing C07 ISO 107/DIN 175
Adjustable ISO 62
A62
<<STOP>> Open circuit ISO 70
A70
Blow ISO 108/ DIN 264
Clamp, block apply pressure ISO 63A
A63
ON/OFF close + open circuit ISO 71
A71
Suction C09 ISO 109/ DIN 264
Clamp, block apply pressure ISO 63B
B63
Close circuit manual impulse ISO 72/ DIN 168
A72
(Sound) Alarm DIN 155
C08
D01
Additional standard symbols B01
198 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
E01
F01
B62
E62
F62
003
004
005
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Accessories Silicon shroud for pushbutton gives IP67 protection
Part number
Silicon shroud for twin touch gives IP67 protection
Colour
Part number
Colour
LWA0251
Red
LWA0203
Red
LWA0252
Green
LWA0204
Green
LWA0253
Black
LWA0205
Black
LWA0255
Transparent
LWA0228
Transparent
Shroud
Part number
Colour
LWA0223
Padlockable shroud
Transparent
Blanking plug
Ø48 mm, L=29 mm
Ø22,5 mm
Part number
Part number
Part number
LWA0225
LWA0240
LWA0229
Black
LWA0215
Grey
Reduction ring
Colour
DIN rail adaptor
Padlockable cover for pushbutton
Part number
Part number
Part number
LWA0219
LWA0238
LWA0226
Ø30-22,5 mm
Fixing tool
Anti rotation plate
Terminal for LBX stations
Square bezel
Part number
Part number
Part number
Part number
LWA0234
LWA0237
LWA0216
LWA0230
0116 284 9900
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 199
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Control stations series LBX LBX is a series of compact push button stations that can be equipped with any of the heads available in the Baco range. The contact & LED blocks detailed on this page snap into the base of the station and remain there while the lid is removed. It is possible to use the standard contact blocks
and clips detailed elsewhere in this section if you want the contacts to remain on the back of the head while the lid is removed. Up to 3 contacts can be fitted per position or 2 contacts and 1 LED block for illuminated devices.
Contact block for control station (max. 3 per position)
Part number
Type
Contact
33S01
NC
2
33S10
NO
4
1 3
LED block for control station Red
Green
Yellow
White
Blue
33SARL
33SAGL
33SAYL
33SAWL
33SABL
33SARM
33SAGM
33SAYM
33SAWM
33SABM
33SARH
33SAGH
33SAYH
33SAWH
33SABH
24 V AC/DC LED Part number 130 V AC LED Part number 230 V AC LED x1
x2
Part number
Empty station Grey lid Part number
1 hole
2 hole
3 hole
4 hole
5 hole
LBX0100
LBX0200
LBX0300
LBX0400
LBX0500
LBX0100J
-
-
-
-
Yellow lid Part number
Start stop 1 NO contact LBX10110
Symbol
Contact
Colour
3
4
1
2
3
4
3
4
Green
1 NC contact LBX10610
Off on
Red
Selector switch LBX12510
Grey/black
Key switch LBX12610
200 | PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
Grey/black
www.oem.co.uk
Pushbuttons & pilot lights
Start stop up down Part number
Symbol
Contact 3
LBX20120
1
3
LBX308830
1
LBX30430
Colour Green
4
Red
2
Green
4
Red
2
3
4
Green
3
4
Green
1
3
Red
2
Green
4
Mushroom head Part number
Turn reset Ø40mm
Text
LBX10510
EMERGENCY STOP
LBX10520
EMERGENCY STOP
Contact 1
2
1
2
1
2
1 NC
2 NC
Emergency stop Conforms to EN418, IEC 60947-5-5 & ISO 13850 Part number
Text
LBX17301
EMERGENCY STOP
LBX17302
EMERGENCY STOP
”Snap-action” turn reset Ø40mm
LBX15301
EMERGENCY STOP
LBX15302
EMERGENCY STOP
”Snap-action” pull reset Ø40mm
LBX11301
EMERGENCY STOP
LBX11302
EMERGENCY STOP
”Snap-action” key reset Ø40mm
”Snap-action” pull reset with flag Ø54mm
0116 284 9900
LBX13101
-
LBX13102
-
Contact 1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1 NC
2 NC
1 NC
2 NC
1 NC
2 NC
1 NC
2 NC
PUSHBUTTONS & PILOT LIGHTS
| 201
RELAYS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
1-pole terminal relay 6 A
204
1-pole interface relay 10 A
206
2-pole interface relay 5 A
207
Solid state interface relay
207
2-pole miniature relay 10 A
208
4-pole miniature relay 5 A
209
2-pole 8 pin industrial relay 10A
210
3-pole 11 pin industrial relay 10A
211
4-pole industrial relay 10 A
212
3-pole industrial power relay 16 A
213
Time cube for 8 & 11 pin relay
214
Sockets
215
Relays Compact plug-in relay PRC/ZPRC • • • •
TS 35 DIN rail mount Compact 6.2 mm wide, plug-in relay Integrated EMC coil protection & LED Pluggable external cross connectors
Using the mount/dismount lever The mounting and dismounting mechanism forms a reliable connection by latching the relay with the socket base. The fitted relay can be removed, easily and without force, from the socket base by using the dismount function of the lever.
Pluggable relay Pluggable relays are also available with AgSNO and gold contacts, to fit with the many functions of your individual requirements.
Pluggable external cross-connections The AQI/PRC pluggable cross-connection system enables a time-saving distribution of potentials. The AQI/PRC is constructed so that it is protected against accidental touch. It is available as a 20-pole unit, in either yellow, blue or black. The cross-connection can be shortened to fewer poles in order to fit the required interface. Insulation plating can be used to insulate the ends.
Base options PRC – Screw terminal ZPRC – Tension spring terminal
Coil spec Part number
Coil voltage
Power rating AC/DC
Operating range
Holding current
Drop-out voltage
Dimensions
PRCU 1/12 V AC/DC
12 V AC/DC
0.2 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
87.3 x 6.2 x 79.9
PRCU 1/24 V AC/DC
24 V AC/DC
0.2 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
87.3 x 6.2 x 79.9
PRCU 1/125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
0.2 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
87.3 x 6.2 x 79.9
PRCU 1/240 V AC/DC
220-240 V AC
0.2 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
87.3 x 6.2 x 79.9
Contact spec Part number
No. of contacts
Max. continuous current/Max. inrush current
Rated voltage/ Max switching voltage
Min. switching load
PRCU 1/12 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
300 mW (5 V/5 mA)
PRCU 1/24 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
300 mW (5 V/5 mA)
PRCU 1/125 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
300 mW (5 V/5 mA)
PRCU 1/240 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
300 mW (5 V/5 mA)
204 | RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
Compact interface relay IRC PLUS • • • • •
TS 35 DIN rail mount 6.2 mm wide, plug-in relay Fuse module option LED indicator Plug-in cross connectors
• Timer relay • Multifunction • Time ranges 0.1 - 3 s 3-60 s, 1-20 m, 0.3- 6 h
The IRCPU fuse insert module can be used in all systems. It is unique in the way it meets the requirement that each coupling relay output must be protected by a replaceable 5 x 20 mm standard micro-fuse within the available 6.2 mm width.
It is delivered with a dummy plug inserted in the frame. The connections for the fuse are bridged internally, so that it can be used without a fuse module. The indicator pin is not visible when the product is delivered. When the fuse module is plugged in with an inserted fuse (dummy plug has been removed), the fuse is in series with the CO of the output connection (11).
The indicator pin is not visible when the product is delivered
When the fuse module is pulled out (e.g. due to a failed fuse), the output remains cut off so that the cause of the blown fuse can be found (security logistics).
Status of the indicator pin Status of the indicator pin Status of the indicator pin
In order to reactivate the output, either the fuse module must be fitted with a functional fuse and plugged in again, or the indicator pin must be moved gently in the direction of the arrow, as shown initially.
Moving the indicator pin
Coil spec Part number
Coil voltage
Power rating AC/DC
Operating range
Holding current
Drop-out voltage
Dimensions
IRCPU 1/12 V AC/DC
12 V AC/DC
0.2 VA / 0.2 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
94.3 x 6.2 x 95.4
IRCPU 1/24 V AC/DC
24 V AC/DC
0.25 VA / 0.25 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
94.3 x 6.2 x 95.4
IRCPU 1/125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
0.7 VA / 0.7 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
94.3 x 6.2 x 95.4
IRCPU 1/240 V AC/DC
220-240 V AC
1 VA / 0.4 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
94.3 x 6.2 x 95.4
24 V AC/DC
0.4 VA / 0.3 W
(0.8-1.1) Un
0.6 Un
0.1 Un
94.3 x 6.2 x 95.4
MFR IRCPU 1/24 V AC/DC Contact spec Part number
No. of contacts
Max. continuous current/Max. inrush current
Rated voltage/ Max switching voltage
Min. switching load
IRCPU 1/12 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
500 mW (12 V/10 mA)
IRCPU 1/24 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
500 mW (12 V/10 mA)
IRCPU 1/125 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
500 mW (12 V/10 mA)
IRCPU 1/240 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
500 mW (12 V/10 mA)
MFR IRCPU 1/24 V AC/DC
1 CO contact
6/10 A
250/400 V AC
500 mW (12 V/10 mA)
Timer relay MFR IRCPU 1/24 V AC/DC
Functions AI: ON delay; DI: ON pulse; SW: Blinker ON; BE: OFF delay with control contact; CE: ON and OFF delay with control contact; DE: Impulse-ON with control contact; EE: Impulse-OFF with control contact
Part number
Accessories
TW/IRC
Partition plate
AQI/IRC/16
External cross-connector, blue, black, red
FCA/IRC
Ribbon cable adpater
SM-IRC
Fuse module
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 205
Relays 1-pole interface relay 10 A
TECHNICAL DATA Type
• Robust flat pins for industrial applications • Mechanical flag & LED indication • Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Bifurcated contact option for low loads
C10A10…
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
1.1 VA
0.65 W
Min. activation UNx
0.75
0.75
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
Max. drop-out voltage UN
0.35
0.15
Surge current
30 A (10 ms)
Recommended min. load
10 mA / 10 V DC (C10T13 5 mA / 5 V DC)
Isolation class, EN60947
250 V (pollution 3, Group C)
Isolation, contact/coil
8 mm-4 kV
Screw socket
S-10. S-10M
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C10A10X24A
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X48A
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X115A
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X230A
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X12D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X24D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X48D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10X110D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S-10 / S-10M
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & bridge rectifier for AC/DC operation C10A10BX24AD
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC/DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10BX48AD
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC/DC
S-10 / S-10M
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C10A10FX12D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10FX24D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10FX48D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10A10FX110D
Standard AgNi
1 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S-10 / S-10M
Interface relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C10T13X24A
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S-10 / S-10M
C10T13X48A
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S-10 / S-10M S-10 / S-10M
C10T13X115A
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
115V AC
C10T13X230A
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S-10 / S-10M
C10T13X12D
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10T13X24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10T13X48D
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10T13X110D
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S-10 / S-10M
Interface relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & bridge rectifier for AC/DC operation C10T13BX24AD
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V AC/DC
S-10 / S-10M
C10T13BX48AD
Bifurcated AgNi + 3µAu
1 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
48V AC/DC
S-10 / S-10M
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
206 | RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
2-pole interface relay 5 A
TECHNICAL DATA Type
• Robust flat pins, for industrial applications • Mechanical flag & LED indication • Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Integrated suppression components
C12A21...
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
1.1 VA
0.65 W
Min. activation UNx
0.8
0.8
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.1
1.1
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
Max. drop-out voltage UN
0.35
0.10
Surge current
15 A (20 ms)
Recommended min. load
10 mA / 10 V (C12A22 5 mA / 5 V DC)
Isolation, contact/coil
5000 V
Isolation, pole/pole
3000 V
Safety class
IP40
Screw socket
S-12
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C12A21X24A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S-12
C12A21X48A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S-12
C12A21X115A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S-12
C12A21X230A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S-12
C12A21X12D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S-12
C12A21X24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S-12
C12A21X48D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S-12
C12A21X110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S-12
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & bridge rectifier for AC/DC operation C12A21BX24AD
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V AC/DC
S-12
C12A21BX48AD
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V AC/DC
S-12
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication with gold plate contacts C12A22X230A
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S-12
C12A22X24D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S-12
24V AC/DC
S-12
Interface relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & bridge rectifier for AC/DC operation with gold plate contacts C12A22BX24AD
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
2 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
1-pole solid state interface relay
TECHNICAL DATA Type Input voltage
• Robust flat pins • LED indication • Input 5-32 V DC
CSS DC
CSS AC/AZ
5-32 V DC
5-32 V DC
Drop-out voltage
2.5 V
2.5 V
Power consumption
3 mA
10 mA
Recommended min. load
1 mA
50 mA
1V
1.5 V
<10 mA
0.55 mA (230 V 50 Hz)
Max. voltage drop Leakage current Safety components
Varistor and diode
Isolation input/output
RC protection 4000 V
Screw socket
S-10. S-10M
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part number
Description
Control voltage
Load voltage
Solid state relay NPN 2A
5-32 V DC
5-50 V DC
CSSAC
Solid state relay NPN 3A
5-32 V DC
24-250 V AC
CSSAZ
Solid state relay 3A zero-voltage switching
5-32 V DC
24-250 V AC
CSSDC
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 207
Relays 2-pole miniature relay 10 A
Type
• Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Mechanical flag • Optional LED and suppression components • Special contact options
C7A20...
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
1.5V A
1W
Min. activation UNx
0.80
0.80
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
0.25
0.20
Max. drop-out voltage UN Recommended min. load
10 mA / 10 V DC (C7T21 5 mA / 5 V)
Surge current
30 A (20 ms)
Isolation class (EN60947)
250 V Pollution 3, Gr C
Isolation, contact/coil
2500 V
Isolation, pole/pole
2500 V
Screw socket
S7M, S7IO
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button C7A2024A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S7C
C7A2048A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S7C
C7A20115A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S7C
C7A20230A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S7C
C7A2012D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S7C
C7A2024D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S7C
C7A2048D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S7C
C7A20110D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S7C
Miniature relay with flange for direct mounting C7A20E230A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
N/A
C7A20E24D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
N/A
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C7A20X24A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S7C
C7A20X48A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S7C
C7A20X115A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S7C
C7A20X230A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S7C
C7A20X12D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S7C
C7A20X24D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S7C
C7A20X48D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S7C
C7A20X110D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S7C
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C7A20FX12D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S7C
C7A20FX24D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S7C
C7A20FX48D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S7C
C7A20FX110D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S7C
24V DC
S7C
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S7C
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with gold flashed contacts C7A29FX24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with gold plate contacts C7A28FX24D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
Miniature relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C7T21X230A
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S7C
C7T21X24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S7C
Miniature relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling protection diode C7T21DX24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S7C
C7T21DX110D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S7C
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling protection diode with double make contact for high DC switching C7X10DX24D
Double make AgNi
1 N/O
10A / 250V AC1
1A / 220V DC1
24V DC
S7C
C7X10DX110D
Double make AgNi
1 N/O
10A / 250V AC1
1A / 220V DC1
110V DC
S7C
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with contacts for high inrush current C7W10FX24D
High inrush AgNi/W
1 N/O
10A / 250V AC (500A 2.5mS)
N/A
24V DC
S7C
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
208 | RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
4-pole miniature relay 5 A
TECHNICAL DATA Type
• Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Mechanical flag • Optional LED and suppression components • Latching option
C9A41...
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
1.5 VA
1W
Min. activation UNx
0.80
0.80
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
Max. drop-out voltage UN
0.25
0.20
Recommended min. load
10 mA / 10 V (C9-A42 5 mA / 5 V)
Surge current (10 ms)
15 A
Isolation class (EN60947)
Order
150 V Pollution 2
Isolation, contact/coil
2500 V
Isolation pole/pole
2000 V
Screw socket
Miniat
C9A4
C9A4
S9M
C9A4 Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
C9A4
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button
C9A4
C9A4124A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S9M
C9A4148A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S9M
C9A41115A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S9M
C9A41230A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S9M
C9A4112D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S9M
C9A4124D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A4148D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A41110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S9M
C9A4
24V AC
S9M
C9A4
C9A4
C9A4
Miniat
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication
C9A4
C9A41X24A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
C9A41X48A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S9M
C9A41X115A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S9M
C9A4
C9A41X230A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S9M
C9A4
C9A41X12D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S9M
C9A41X24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S9M
C9A41X48D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S9M
C9A41X110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A4
Miniat
C9A4
C9A4
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C9A41FX12D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A41FX24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A41FX48D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S9M
Miniat
C9A41FX110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S9M
C9A4
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication with gold plate contacts
C9A4
C9A42X24A
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S9M
C9A42X48A
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S9M
C9A42X115A
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S9M
C9A42X230A
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S9M
C9A42X12D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S9M
C9A42X24D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S9M
C9A42X48D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S9M
C9A42X110D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A4
C9A4
C9A4
C9A4
C9A4
Miniat
C9A4
Miniature relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with gold plate contacts C9A42FX12D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A42FX24D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A42FX48D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S9M
C9A4
C9A42FX110D
Standard AgNi + 10µAu
4 C/O
5A / 250V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S9M
Miniat
Miniature relay with latching (remanence on/off) coil, mechanical flag & test button
C9R2
C9R2124A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S9M
C9R2148A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S9M
C9R21115A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S9M
C9R21230A
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S9M
C9R2112D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S9M
C9R2124D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S9M
C9R2
C9R2148D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
5A / 120V AC1
5A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S9M
C9R2
C9R2
C9R2
C9R2
C9R2
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 209
Relays 2-pole 8-pin industrial relay 10 A
TECHNICAL DATA Type
• Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Bifurcated contact option for low loads • Optional LED and suppression components
C2-A20...
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
2.2 VA
1.3 W
Min. activation UNx
0.80
0.80
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
Max. drop-out voltage UN
0.15
0.10
Recommended min. load
10 mA / 10 V DC (C2-T21 5mA / 5 V)
Surge current Isolation class (EN60947)
30 A (20 ms) 250 V, Pollution 3, Group C
Isolation, contact/coil
2500 V
Isolation, pole/pole
2500 V
Screw socket
S2B, S2S
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Industrial 8 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button C2-A2024A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A2048A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20115A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20230A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A2012D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A2024D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A2048D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20110D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S2B / S2S
Industrial 8 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C2-A20X24A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X48A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X115A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X230A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X12D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X24D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X48D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20X110D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S2B / S2S
Industrial 8 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C2-A20FX12D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20FX24D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20FX48D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A20FX110D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S2B / S2S
Industrial 8 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with gold flashed contacts C2-A29FX12D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A29FX24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A29FX48D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-A29FX110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S2B / S2S
Industrial 8 pin relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C2-T21X230A
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S2B / S2S
C2-T21X24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S2B / S2S
Industrial 8 pin relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling protection diode C2-T21FX24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S2B / S2S
C2-T21FX110D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
2 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S2B / S2S
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
210 | RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
3-pole 11-pin industrial relay 10 A
TECHNICAL DATA Type
• Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Optional LED and suppression components • Latching option
C3-A30...
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
2.2 VA
1.3 W
Min. activation UNx
0.80
0.80
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
0.15
0.10
Max. drop-out voltage UN Recommended min. load
10 mA / 10 V DC (C3-T31 5 mA / 5 V)
Surge current
30 A (20 ms)
Isolation class (EN60947)
250 V, Pollution 3, Group C
Isolation, contact/coil
2500 V
Isolation, pole/pole
2500 V
Screw socket
S3B, S3S
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Industrial 11 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button C3-A3024A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A3048A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30115A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30230A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A3012D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A3024D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A3048D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30110D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S3B / S3S
Industrial 11 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C3-A30X24A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X48A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X115A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X230A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X12D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X24D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X48D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30X110D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S3B / S3S
Industrial 11 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C3-A30FX12D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30FX24D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30FX48D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A30FX110D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S3B / S3S
Industrial 11 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with gold flashed contacts C3-A39FX12D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A39FX24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A39FX48D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-A39FX110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S3B / S3S
Industrial 11 pin relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C3-T31X230A
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-T31X24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
Industrial 11 pin relay with bifurcated contacts for low level switching with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling protection diode C3-T31FX24D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-T31FX110D
Bifurcated AgNi + 0.2µAu
3 C/O
6A / 250V AC1
6A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S3B / S3S
Industrial 11 pin relay with latching (remanence on/off) coil, mechanical flag & test button C3-R20115A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-R20230A
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S3B / S3S
C3-R2012D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S3B / S3S
C3-R2024D
Standard AgNi
2 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S3B / S3S
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 211
Relays TECHNICAL DATA
4-pole industrial relay 10 A
Type
• Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Optional LED and suppression components • Latching option
C4-A40...
Coil type
AC
DC
Coil load
2.4 VA
1.4 W
Min. activation UNx
0.80
0.80
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
Max. drop-out voltaage UNx
0.15
0.10
Recommended minimum load
10 mA / 10 V
Surge current (20 ms) Isolation class (EN60947)
30 A 250 V Pollution 3, Gr C
Isolation, contact/coil
2500 V
Isolation, pole/pole
2500 V
Screw socket
S4J
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Industrial 14 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button C4-A4024A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S4J
C4-A4048A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S4J
C4-A40115A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S4J
C4-A40230A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S4J
C4-A4012D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S4J
C4-A4024D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S4J
C4-A4048D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S4J
C4-A40110D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S4J
Industrial 14 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C4-A40X24A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S4J
C4-A40X48A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S4J
C4-A40X115A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S4J
C4-A40X230A
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S4J
C4-A40X12D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S4J
C4-A40X24D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S4J
C4-A40X48D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S4J
C4-A40X110D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S4J
Industrial 14 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C4-A40FX12D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S4J
C4-A40FX24D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S4J
C4-A40FX48D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S4J
C4-A40FX110D
Standard AgNi
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S4J
Industrial 14 pin relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes with gold flashed contacts C4-A49FX12D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S4J
C4-A49FX24D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S4J
C4-A49FX48D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S4J
C4-A49FX110D
Standard AgNi + 0.2µAu
4 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S4J
Industrial 14 pin relay with latching (remanence on/off) coil, mechanical flag & test button C4-R30115A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S4J
C4-R30230A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S4J
C4-R3012D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S4J
C4-R3024D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
10A / 250V AC1
10A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S4J
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
212 | RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
3-pole industrial power relay 16 A
TECHNICAL DATA Type
C5-A30...
Coil load
• Colour-coded test button lift to latch push to test • Mechanical indication flag • Optional LED and suppression components
2.4 VA
1.4 W
Min. activation UNx
0.80
0.80
Max. over-voltage UNx
1.10
1.10
Min. holding voltage UNx
0.60
0.35
Max. drop-out voltage UN
0.15
0.10
Recommended minimum load
10 mA / 5 V DC
Surge current (20 ms)
40 A
Isolation class (EN60947)
500 V, Pollution 3, Group C
Isolation, contact/coil
4000 V
Isolation, pole/pole
4000 V
Screw socket
S5S / S5M
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Contact type
Poles
AC rating max
DC rating max
Coil voltage
Socket
Industrial 11 pin power relay with mechanical flag & test button C5-A3024A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A3048A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30115A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30230A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A3012D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A3024D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A3048D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30110D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S5S / S5M
Industrial 11 pin power relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication C5-A30X24A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
24V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X48A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
48V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X115A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
115V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X230A
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
230V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X12D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X24D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X48D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30X110D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S5S / S5M
Industrial 11 pin power relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling / polarity protection diodes C5-A30FX12D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
12V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30FX24D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
24V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30FX48D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
48V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-A30FX110D
Standard AgNi
3 C/O
16A / 400V AC1
16A / 30V DC1
110V DC
S5S / S5M
Industrial power relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication with double make contact for high DC switching C5-X10X115A
Double make AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
1.2A / 220V DC1
115V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-X10X230A
Double make AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
1.2A / 220V DC1
230V AC
S5S / S5M
Industrial power relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling protection diode with double make contact for high DC switching C5-X10FX24D
Double make AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
1.2A / 220V DC1
24V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-X10FX48D
Double make AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
1.2A / 220V DC1
48V DC
S5S / S5M
Industrial power relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication with double make, magnetic blow out contact for high DC switching C5-M10X115A
Double make + mag AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
10A / 220V DC1
115V AC
S5S / S5M
C5-M10X230A
Double make + mag AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
10A / 220V DC1
230V AC
S5S / S5M
Industrial power relay with mechanical flag & test button + LED indication & free wheeling protection diode with double make, magnetic blow out contact for high DC switching C5-M10FX24D
Double make + mag AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
10A / 220V DC1
24V DC
S5S / S5M
C5-M10FX48D
Double make + mag AgNi
1 N/O
16A / 400V AC1
10A / 220V DC1
48V DC
S5S / S5M
Other types and voltages upon request.* All AC coils have a frequency of 50/60 Hz.
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 213
Relays Time cube for 8 & 11 pin relays
TECHNICAL DATA Repeater precision
• • • • •
Part Number CT2E30/S
Use with standard C2 / C3 relays Wide range supply voltage Multi-time range 0.2 sec–30 min. 5 timing function options Simply plug between relay & socket
± 0.5 % or 20 ms
Reset time, (type E, W, B)
<150 ms
Reset time, (type A, K)
<200 ms
Activation time, (V AC)
80 ms
Activation time, (V DC)
50 ms
Max. relay current
See relay data
Material
Cicoloy
Pins
Timer function
Activated by
Voltage range
Relay type
Socket
8
Delay on make
Supply voltage
9.5 - 18V DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2E30/L
8
Delay on make
Supply voltage
20 - 65V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2E30/H
8
Delay on make
Supply voltage
90 - 265V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2W30/S
8
Single pulse
Supply voltage
9.5 - 18V DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2W30/L
8
Single pulse
Supply voltage
20 - 65V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2W30/H
8
Single pulse
Supply voltage
90 - 265V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2B30/S
8
Symmetrical recycling
Supply voltage
9.5 - 18V DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2B30/L
8
Symmetrical recycling
Supply voltage
20 - 65V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2B30/H
8
Symmetrical recycling
Supply voltage
90 - 265V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2A30/S
8
Delay on break
Control input
9.5 - 18V DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2A30/L
8
Delay on break
Control input
20 - 65V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2A30/M
8
Delay on break
Control input
90 - 150V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2A30/U
8
Delay on break
Control input
180 - 265V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2K30/S
8
Single pulse
Control input
9.5 - 18V DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2K30/L
8
Single pulse
Control input
20 - 65V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2K30/M
8
Single pulse
Control input
90 - 150V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT2K30/U
8
Single pulse
Control input
180 - 265V AC/DC
C2
S2B / S2S
CT3E30/S
11
Delay on make
Supply voltage
9.5 - 18V DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3E30/L
11
Delay on make
Supply voltage
20 - 65V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3E30/H
11
Delay on make
Supply voltage
90 - 265V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3W30/S
11
Single pulse
Supply voltage
9.5 - 18V DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3W30/L
11
Single pulse
Supply voltage
20 - 65V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3W30/H
11
Single pulse
Supply voltage
90 - 265V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3B30/S
11
Symmetrical recycling
Supply voltage
9.5 - 18V DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3B30/L
11
Symmetrical recycling
Supply voltage
20 - 65V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3B30/H
11
Symmetrical recycling
Supply voltage
90 - 265V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3A30/S
11
Delay on break
Control input
9.5 - 18V DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3A30/L
11
Delay on break
Control input
20 - 65V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3A30/M
11
Delay on break
Control input
90 - 150V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3A30/U
11
Delay on break
Control input
180 - 265V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3K30/S
11
Single pulse
Control input
9.5 - 18V DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3K30/L
11
Single pulse
Control input
20 - 65V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3K30/M
11
Single pulse
Control input
90 - 150V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
CT3K30/U
11
Single pulse
Control input
180 - 265V AC/DC
C3
S3B / S3S
214 | RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
Sockets for C10 & C12 interface relays • • • •
TECHNICAL DATA Type Fits relay
DIN rail or PCB mount Integral retaining clip Bridge bar option for A2 terminal Bridge bar option for contact side (S-10M & S-12 only)
Nominal load
S-10
S-10M
S-12
C10...
C10...
C12... 6 A/250 A
10 A/250 A
16 A/250 A
Isolation conn./conn.
3000 V
3000 V
3000 V
Isolation conn./rail
5000 V
5000 V
5000 V
Material
Noryl/Celanex
Noryl/Celanex
Noryl/Celanex
Dimensions mm
15.6 x 75 x 26
16.9 x 75 x 26
16.9 x 75 x 26
S-10
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part Number
Description
For relay / socket
S-10
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C10 relay
C10
S10P
PCB socket for C10 relay
C10
S-10M
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C10 relay
C10
S-12
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C12 relay
C12
S12P
PCB socket for C12 relay
C12
S10BB
Bridge bar for A2 terminal (4 way in packs of 5)
S-10
B20-G
Bridge bar for A2 terminal (4 way in packs of 5)
S-10M / S-12
V10G
Bridge bar for contact side (1 way in packs of 5)
S-10M / S-12
V40G
Bridge bar for contact side (4 way in packs of 5)
S-10M / S-12
Sockets for C7 and C9 miniature relays
TECHNICAL DATA Type
S7C
Fits relay
C7...
C9...
10 A/250 V
6 A/250 V
Isolation conn./conn.
2500 V
2500 V
Isolation conn./raila
2500 V
2500 V
Cicoloy, Noryl
Cicoloy, Noryl
22.5x75x26 mm
22.5x75x26 mm
Nominal load
• DIN rail, panel or PCB mount • Integral retaining clip • Bridge bar options for S9M
S9M
Material Dimensions
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part Number
Description
For relay / socket
S7C
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C7 relay
C7
S7L
Panel mount socket with solder lugs for C7 relay
C7
S7P S7PO
PCB mount socket for C7 relay
C7
PCB mount socket with flange for C7 relay
C7
S9M
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C9 relay
C9
S9L
Panel mount socket with solder lugs for C9 relay
C9
S9P
PCB mount socket for C9 relay
C9
PCB mount socket with flange for C9 relay
C9
S9M-BX
Bridge bar for A2 terminal (4 way in packs of 5)
S9M
S9M-V1
Bridge bar for contact side (1 way in packs of 5)
S9M
S9M-V4
Bridge bar for contact side (4 way in packs of 5)
S9M
S9PO
* Technical data and dimensions for solder and circuit board sockets available upon request.
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 215
Relays Sockets for 8-pin C2 industrial relays • • • •
TECHNICAL DATA Type
S2B
S2S
Fits relay
C2...
C2...
C2...
10 A/250 V
10 A/250 V
10 A/250 V 2500 V
Nominal load
DIN rail, panel or PCB mount Marking label Coding ring option Integrated retaining clip
S2L, S2P, S2PO
Isolation
2500 V
2500 V
Material
Cicoloy
Cicoloy
-
38 x 68 x 24
38 x 80 x 25
-
Dimensions mm
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part Number
Description
For relay / socket
S2B
DIN rail socket with screw terminals on 1 level for C2 relay
C2
S2S
DIN rail socket with screw terminals on 2 levels for C2 relay
C2
S2L
Panel mount socket with solder lugs for C2 relay
C2
S2P S2PO
PCB mount socket for C2 relay
C2
PCB mount socket with flange for C2 relay
C2
S3C
Metal retaining clip for C2, C3 & C4 relays
S3CT
Metal retaining clip for C2 & C3 relays with time cube
S2BC
Coding ring (pack of 5) for S2B / S2S
S2B / S2S
SO-NP
Black (no function) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
SO-OP
Orange (push only) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
Sockets for 11-pin C3 industrial relays
TECHNICAL DATA Type
S3B
S3S
Fits relay
C3...
C3...
C3...
10 A/250 V
10 A/250 V
10 A/250 V 2500 V
Nominal load
• • • •
Part Number
DIN rail, panel or PCB mount Marking label Coding ring option Integrated retaining clip
Isolation
2500 V
2500 V
Material
Cicoloy
Cicoloy
-
38 x 68 x 24
38 x 80 x 25
-
Dimensions mm
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Description
For relay / socket
S3B
DIN rail socket with screw terminals on 1 level for C3 relay
C3
S3S
DIN rail socket with screw terminals on 2 levels for C3 relay
C3
S3L
Panel mount socket with solder lugs for C3 relay
C3
S3P S3PO
PCB mount socket for C3 relay
C3
PCB mount socket with flange for C3 relay
C3
S3C
Metal retaining clip for C2, C3 & C4 relays
S3CT
Metal retaining clip for C2 & C3 relays with time cube
S3BC
Coding ring (pack of 5) for S3B / S3S
S3B / S3S
SO-NP
Black (no function) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
SO-OP
Orange (push only) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
216 | RELAYS
S3L, S3P, S3PO
www.oem.co.uk
Relays
Sockets for C4 industrial relays
TECHNICAL DATA Type
S4J
Fits relay Nominal load
• DIN rail, panel or PCB mount • Marking label • Integrated retaining clip
S4L, S4P, S4PO
C4...
C4...
10 A / 250 V
10 A / 250 V
Isolation
2500 V
2500 V
Material
Cicoloy
Cicoloy
38 x 92 x 32
-
Dimensions mm
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part Number
Description
For relay / socket
S4J
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C4 relay
C4
S4L
Panel mount socket with solder lugs for C4 relay
C4
S4P
PCB mount socket for C4 relay
C4
PCB mount socket with flange for C4 relay
C4
SO-NP
Black (no function) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
SO-OP
Orange (push only) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
S4PO
Sockets for C5 industrial power relays
TECHNICAL DATA Type
S5S
Fits relay
C5...
C5...
16 A / 400 V
16 A / 400 V
Nominal load
• DIN rail, panel or PCB mount • Marking label • Integrated retaining clip
S5L, S5P, S5PO
Isolation
2500 V
2500 V
Material
Cicoloy
Cicoloy
38 x 80 x 29
-
Dimensions mm
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e : w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part Number
Description
For relay / socket
S5S
DIN rail socket with screw terminals for C5 relay
C5
S5L
Panel mount socket with solder lugs for C5 relay
C5
S5P
PCB mount socket for C5 relay
C5
PCB mount socket with flange for C5 relay
C5
SO-NP
Black (no function) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
SO-OP
Orange (push only) test button for C2, C3, C4 & C5 relays
C2 / C3 / C4 / C5
S5PO
0116 284 9900
RELAYS
| 217
RS-485 NETWORK MODULES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
SM1 - Analogue input converter - 2 channel
220
SM2 - Analogue input converter - 4 channel
220
SM3 - Digital/pulse input converter - 2 channel
220
SM4 - Digital output converter - 4/8 channel
221
SM5 - Digital input converter - 8 channel
221
SM7 - Radio transmission module
221
MR03 - High power radio transmission module
222
PD8 - Converter RS-485 to ethernet interfaces
222
PD8W - Converter RS-485 to ethernet wi-fi interfaces
222
PD10 - Converter USB to RS-485 module
223
SM9 - Converter power supply module
223
SMC - RS-485 programmable logic controller
223
RS-485 network modules
SM1 – Analogue input converter – 2 channel
• Conversion of standard signals and temperature • Programmable measurement characteristics • Mathmatical functions
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs fixed: Temperature: PT100 Current: 0/4…20mA Voltage: 0…10V Resistance: 0…400Ω Outputs: RS-485/RS-232: MODBUS ASCII/RTU Dimensions: 22.5 x 120 x 100mm Protection level: IP40 Front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/dc Supply voltage:
Input signal: 2 voltage inputs 2 current inputs 1 voltage input + 1 current input 2 resistance inputs or Pt100 Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…50 V a.c./d.c.01
SM2 – Analogue input converter – 4 channel
• • • •
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs fixed: Temperature: PT100 Current: 0/4…20mA Voltage: 0…10V Resistance: 0…400Ω Outputs: Logic: 2 x OC outputs RS-485/RS-232: MODBUS ASCII/RTU Dimensions: 45 x 120 x 100mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/dc
0…10 V 0/4…20 mA 0…10 V+0/4…20 mA Pt100 or resistance < 400Ω
00 01 02 03
SM2
Technical data
Part number key
8
XX
X
8
00 01 02 03 1 2
Conversion of logic states or impulses 2 programmable logic or counter inputs Auxiliary counters with reset function Counter states stored in non-volatile memory
SM3 0 logic 0…2.4V, 1 logic 3.4…24V 0…4 294 967 295 impluses @ min. 0.5ms, 800Hz max
X
1 2
Input signal: 4 voltage inputs 0…10 V 4 current inputs 0/4…20 mA 2 voltage inputs + 2 current inputs 0…10 V+0/4…20 mA 4 resistance inputs 0…400Ω or Pt100 Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…50 V a.c./d.c.01
• • • •
220 | RS-485 NETWORK MODULES
XX
Conversion of standard signals and temperature Programmable measurement characteristics Mathmatical functions 2 programmable OC outputs
SM3 – Digital/pulse input converter – 2 channel
Inputs: Logic: Counter: Outputs: RS-485/RS-232: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
SM1
Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…50 V a.c./d.c.
X
00
8
1 2
MODBUS ASCII/RTU 22.5 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/dc
www.oem.co.uk
RS-485 network modules
SM4 – Digital output converter – 4/8 channel
• Remote control of outputs steered through RS-485 • 4 relay or 8 OC outputs
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs: RS-485: Outputs: Relay: Logic: RS-485/RS-232: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
SM4 MODBUS ASCII/RTU 4 x relay, NO contacts 8 x OC MODBUS ASCII/RTU 45 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/dc
Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…50 V a.c./d.c. Kind of outputs: 8 outputs of OC type 4 relay outputs
Technical data
Part number key SM5
MODBUS ASCII/RTU 45x120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/dc
Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…50 V a.c./d.c.
• Data transmission by radio in non-licenced 433Mhz or 868 Mhz band • 10 Channels • up to 300m range • Module grouping with addressed links
Technical data
Part number key
0116 284 9900
SM7 Supply voltage: 85…230…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…24…50 V a.c./d.c. 7…35 V d.c. Radio transmission frequency: 433 MHz 868 MHz
8
X
00
8
1 2
SM7 – Radio transmission module
Inputs: RS-485, RS-232: MODBUS ASCII/RTU Coding: NRZ, Manchester Frequency: 433 Mhz, 868 Mhz Range direct line: 300m for 433Mhz unit Receiver sensitivity: -110dBm Outputs: -20… 5 dBm (10 dBm 433Mhz) Dimensions: 45 x 120 x 100mm Protection level: IP20 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/dc, 7…35V d.c
00
1 2
• 8 relay logic inputs read though RS-485 • Signalling of input state by LED’s
0 logic - open circuit, 1 logic - short circuit
X
1 2
SM5 – Digital input converter – 8 channel
Inputs: Logic: Output: RS-485/RS-232: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
X
X
X
8
1 2 3 1 2
RS-485 NETWORK MODULES
| 221
RS-485 network modules
MR03 – High power radio transmission module
• Data transmission by radio in non -licenced 869 Mhz band • 3 Channels • up to 2Km range • Point–to–Point or Broadcast mode operation
Technical data
Part number key MR03
Inputs fixed: RS-485/RS-232: MODBUS ASCII/RTU Frequency: 869.4 - 869.65 MHz Range direct line: up to 2000m Receiver sensitivity: >-103dBm Outputs: 20, 23, 27 dBm (500mW) Dimensions: 115 x 65 x 40mm Protection level: IP54 front Supply voltage: 12…30V a.c, 8…30V d.c
PD8 – Converter RS-485 to Ethernet interfaces
• Enables access to RS-485 devices via Ethernet • Configuration through any Web browser • Supports UDP serial bridge mode
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs fixed: RS-485/RS-232: Baud rate: Transmission range: Digital interface: Ethernet: Protocol: Baud rate: USB1.1/2.0: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply Voltage:
PD8 MODBUS ASCII/RTU up to 115200 bits/s up to 1200m at 9600 bit/s
Supply voltage: 85...253 V a.c./d.c. 20...50 V a.c./d.c.
X
00
00
E
8
0
1 2
10/100 base-T Digi Realport®, TCP/IP, HTTP, ICMP, DHCP,ARP 10/100 Mbit/s RCI (configuration port) 45 x 120 x 100mm IP30 front 85…253V a.c, 20…50V a.c /d.c
PD8W – Converter RS-485 to Ethernet wi-fi interfaces
• Enables access to RS-485 devices via Ethernet Wi-Fi • Configuration through any Web browser • Supports UDP serial bridge mode
Technical data Inputs: RS-485/RS-232: Baud rate: Transmission range: Digital interface: Ethernet Wi -Fi: Protocol: Baud rate: Supports: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
222 | RS-485 NETWORK MODULES
MODBUS ASCII/RTU up to 115200 bits/s up to 1200m at 9600 bit/s
Part number key PD8W
10/100 base-T Digi Realport®, TCP/IP, HTTP, ICMP, DHCP,ARP up to 11 Mbit/s WEP, WPA, WPA2, Cisco LEAP, EAP-FAST 45 x 120 x 100mm IP30 front 85…253V a.c, 20…50V a.c /d.c
Supply voltage: 85...253 V a.c./d.c. 20...50 V a.c./d.c.
X
00
E
0
1 2
www.oem.co.uk
RS-485 network modules
PD10 – Converter USB to RS-485 module
• Enables the connection to RS-485 networks to PC • Transparent for communication protocols • Galvanic seperation protects computer USB ports
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs: RS-485/RS-232: MODBUS ASCII/RTU Baud rate: up to 1 Mb/s Output: USB Supports: Windows 7, XP, 2000, Vista, Serever 2003, Server 2008 (x86 and X64) Dimensions: 52 x 44 x 24mm Protection level: IP40 front
PD10
• 24V dc feeder module • Matching module housing
Technical data
Part number key SM9
24V dc, ±0.5V, 1 A 52 x 44 x 100mm IP20 front 105…250V a.c
SMC – RS-485 programmable logic controller
• Creation of algorithms in ST language (CPDev Package) • On-line and off-line simulation • Rich libraries of function block • Steering with RTC usage
Technical data
Part number key
Interface: RS-485: Port 1: Port 2: Baud rate: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
0116 284 9900
SMC MODBUS ASCII/RTU RS-485, RS-232, USB 1.1. PC & HMI comms 2 x RS-485, IO comms up to 1152000 bit/s 45 x 120 x 100mm IP65 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…40V a.c/dc
0
8
1
with isolation
SM9 – Converter power supply module
Output: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
X
Galvanic isolation:
X
00
00
E
0
0
Supply: 85...253 V a.c./d.c.
1
20…40 V a.c./d.c.
2
RS-485 NETWORK MODULES
| 223
SIGNAL TOWERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
ECO40
226
ECO60
227
ECO70
228
Half DOME 90
229
Signal towers S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
ECO40 • • • • •
40 mm Signal tower Available with integrated LED technology Full range of colours Wide voltage range “Push-in” terminal for easy wiring
Light modules Order no. Description Steady light excl. bulb up to 250 V
Orange
Red
Clear
Blue
Green
Yellow
902 001 900
902 002 900
902 004 900
902 005 900
902 006 900
902 007 900
Steady light LED 24 V AC/DC
902 011 405
902 012 405
902 014 405
902 015 405
902 016 405
902 017 405
Steady light LED 230 V AC
902 011 313
902 012 313
902 014 313
902 015 313
902 016 313
902 017 313
Flashing light LED 24 V AC/DC
902 021 405
902 022 405
902 024 405
902 025 405
902 026 405
902 027 405
Flashing light LED 230 V AC
902 021 313
902 022 313
902 024 313
902 025 313
902 026 313
902 027 313
Strobe LED 24 V AC/DC
902 031 405
902 032 405
902 034 405
902 035 405
902 036 405
902 037 405
Strobe LED 230 V AC
902 031 313
902 032 313
902 034 313
902 035 313
902 036 313
902 037 313
Multi-Strobe LED 24 V AC/DC
902 041 405
902 042 405
902 044 405
902 045 405
902 046 405
902 047 405
Multi-Strobe LED230 V AC
902 041 313
902 042 313
902 0443 13
902 045 313
902 046 313
902 047 313
Bases Type
Description
Order number
Base for horizontal mounting
M20 with inside mounting holes
902 570 900
Base for horizontal mounting
With premounted fixation screws
902 571 900
Base for horizontal mounting
With external mounting lugs
902 572 900
Base for vertical mounting
Single side mounting
902 573 900
Base for vertical mounting
Double side mounting
902 574 900
Pole mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
902 582 900
Pole mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
902 583 900
Pole mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
902 584 900
NPT 1/2” thread
902 570 900
Pole mount base Bracket
For pole mount base with plastic foot
900 600 900
Pole mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
902 592 900
Pole mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
902 593 900
Pole mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
902 594 900
Metal bracket, adapter with cable gland
900 700 900
Quick mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
902 562 900
Quick mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
902 563 900
Quick mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
902 564 900
Suitable for all bases
902 800 900
Set for vertical mounting
Base extension, length 100 mm
Tone modules Type
Tone options Tone type
Piezo buzzer
Max. volume
Nominal voltage (V)
Continuous or pulsing
80 dB
110/120 V AC 230/2240 V AC
226 | SIGNAL TOWERS
Voltage range (V)
24 V AC/DC +/- 10%
Nominal current (A)
Order number
0.039
902 500 405
0.021
902 500 310
0.021
902 500 313
www.oem.co.uk
Signal towers S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
ECO60 • • • • •
60 mm Signal tower Available with integrated LED technology Full range of colours Wide voltage range “Clamping yolk” terminals for easy wiring
Light modules Order no. Description
Orange
Red
Clear
Blue
Green
Yellow
Steady light excl. bulb up to 250 V
901 001 900
901 002 900
901 004 900
901 005 900
901 006 900
901 007 900
Steady light LED 24 V AC/DC
901 011 405
901 012 405
901 014 405
901 015 405
901 016 405
901 017 405
Steady light LED 230 V AC
901 011 313
901 012 313
901 014 313
901 015 313
901 016 313
901 017 313
Flashing light LED 24 V AC/DC
901 021 405
901 022 405
901 024 405
901 025 405
901 026 405
901 027 405
Flashing light LED 230 V AC
901 021 313
901 022 313
901 024 313
901 025 313
901 026 313
901 027 313
Strobe LED 24 V AC/DC
901 031 405
901 032 405
901 034 405
901 035 405
901 036 405
901 037 405
Strobe LED 230 V AC
901 031 313
901 032 313
901 034 313
901 035 313
901 036 313
901 037 313
Steady light ”HighPerformance” 24 V AC/DC
901 051 405
901 052 405
901 054 405
901 055 405
901 056 405
901 057 405
Strobe ”HighPerformance” 24 V AC/DC
901 071 405
901 072 405
901 074 405
901 075 405
901 076 405
901 077 405
Bases Type
Description
Order number
Base for horizontal mounting
M20 with inside mounting holes
901 570 900
Base for horizontal mounting
With premounted fixation screws
901 571 900
Base for horizontal mounting
With external mounting lugs
901 572 900
Single side mounting
901 573 900
Base for vertical mounting
Double side mounting
901 574 900
Pole mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
901 582 900
Pole mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
901 583 900
Pole mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
901 584 900
Base for vertical mounting
Pole mount base
NPT 1/2” thread
901 570 900
For pole mount base with plastic foot
901 600 900
Pole mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
901 592 900
Pole mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
901 593 900
Pole mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
901 594 900
Bracket
Set for vertical mounting
Metal bracket, adapter with cable gland
900 700 900
Quick mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
901 562 900
Quick mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
901 563 900
Quick mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
901 564 900
Suitable for all bases
901 800 900
Base extension, length 100 mm
Tone modules Type
Piezo buzzer
0116 284 9900
Tone options Tone type
Max. volume
Continuous or pulsing
90 dB adjustable with potentiometer
Nominal voltage (V)
Voltage range (V)
24 V AC/DC 110/120 V AC
+/- 10%
230/2240 V AC
Nominal current (A)
Order number
0.065
901 500 405
0.031
901 500 310
0.032
901 500 313 SIGNAL TOWERS
| 227
Signal towers S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
ECO70 • • • • •
70 mm Signal tower Available with integrated LED technology Full range of colours Wide voltage range “Clamping yolk” terminals for easy wiring
Light modules Order no. Description
Orange
Red
Clear
Blue
Green
Yellow
Steady light excl. bulb up to 250 V
900 001 900
900 002 900
900 004 900
900 005 900
900 006 900
900 007 900
Steady light LED 24 V AC/DC
900 011 405
900 012 405
900 014 405
900 015 405
900 016 405
900 017 405
Steady light LED 230 V AC.
900 011 313
900 012 313
900 014 313
900 015 313
900 016 313
900 017 313
Flashing light LED 24 V AC/DC.
900 021 405
900 022 405
900 024 405
900 025 405
900 026 405
900 027 405
Flashing light LED 230 V AC.
900 021 313
900 022 313
900 024 313
900 025 313
900 026 313
900 027 313
Strobe LED 24 V AC/DC.
900 031 405
900 032 405
900 034 405
900 035 405
900 036 405
900 037 405
Strobe LED 230 V AC.
900 031 313
900 032 313
900 034 313
900 035 313
900 036 313
900 037 313
Steady LED ”High Performance” 24 V AC/DC
900 051 405
900 052 405
900 054 405
900 055 405
900 056 405
900 057 405
Strobe LED ”High Performance” 24 V AC/DC
900 061 405
900 062 405
900 064 405
900 065 405
900 066 405
900 067 405
Strobe LED ”High Performance” 24 V AC/DC
900 071 405
900 072 405
900 074 405
900 075 405
900 076 405
900 077 405
Bases Type
Description
Order number
Base for horizontal mounting
M20 with inside mounting holes
900 570 900
Base for horizontal mounting
With premounted fixation screws
900 571 900
Base for horizontal mounting
With external mounting lugs
900 572 900
Single side mounting
900 573 900
Base for vertical mounting
Double side mounting
900 574 900
Pole mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
900 582 900
Pole mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
900 583 900
Pole mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube with plastic foot
900 584 900
NPT 1/2” thread
900 570 900
For pole mount base with plastic foot
900 600 900
Pole mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
900 592 900
Pole mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
900 593 900
Pole mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube for direct mounting with screw
900 594 900
Metal bracket, adapter with cable gland
900 700 900
Quick mount base 100 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
900 562 900
Quick mount base 250 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
900 563 900
Quick mount base 400 mm
On aluminium tube with ”foot adapter“
900 564 900
Suitable for all bases
900 800 900
Base for vertical mounting
Pole mount base Bracket
Set for vertical mounting
Base extension, length 100 mm
Tone modules Type
Tone options Tone type
Piezo buzzer
Piezo buzzer 2 tones selectable
Mullti-tone siren 8 tones
228 | SIGNAL TOWERS
Continuous or pulsing
Continuous and pulsing
8 tones
Max. volume 100 dB adjustable with potentiometer
100 dB adjustable with potentiometer
100 dB adjustable with potentiometer
Nominal voltage (V)
Voltage range (V)
24 V AC/DC 110/120 V AC
Nominal current (A)
Order number
0.092
900 500 405
0.041
900 500 310
230/2240 V AC
0.043
900 500 313
24 V AC/DC
0.092
900 510 405
110/120 V AC
0.041
900 510 310
0.043
900 510 313
0.115
900 520 405
0.045
900 520 310
0.043
900 520 313
+/- 10%
+/- 10%
230/2240 V AC 24 V AC/DC 110/120 V AC 230/2240 V AC
+/- 10%
www.oem.co.uk
Signal towers S I G N A L G E R Ä T E
Half DOME 90 mm • • • • •
Visual-audible signal tower in half dome design 6 lens colours, 3 housing colours LED steady or flashing light for each position Optimal signalling effect and visibility from any viewing angle (180°) Optional piezo buzzer in upper housing area available (continuous and pulsing tone, 70-90 dB)
Ordering key To create the order number, enter the letter/number in the marked box. Position 1 symbolises the first light module closest to the connection hatch.
EXAMPLE
Location for the buzzer is always furthest away from the connection hatch. Only one buzzer can be fitted per lighting tower.
Housing colour
Nominal voltage
C
24
HD
Module Position A L
Module Position B
6
B
7
Module Position C L
2
Module Position D B
Module Position E
5
L
4
Tone module D
Z
HDC24L6B7L2B5L4Dz
Housing colour
Module
Nominal voltage
G = grey
L = HDL LED steady light
12 = 12 V AC/DC
C = chrome
B = HDB LED flashing light
24 = 24 V AC/DC
B = black
DZ = HDZ Buzzer coninuous/pulsing tone 70-90 dB
10 = 110/120 V AC 20 = 230/240 V AC
Lens colour
Amber
Red
Clear
Blue
Green
Yellow
1
2
3
4
5
6
How to order correctly a halfDome90 LED signal tower
Position E Position D Position C Position B Position A
Configuration
Type
New
Buzzer continuous/pulsing tone
HDZ
DZ
LED steady light, clear
HDL
L4
LED flashing light, blue
HDB
B5
LED steady light, red
HDL
L2
LED flashing light, yellow
HDB
B7
LED steady light, green
HDL
L6
Nominal voltage 24 V AC/DC
24
Housing colour chrome
C
Housing for 5 lights
Correct order no.
HDC24L6B7L2B5L4DZ
HD5
For design reasons light modules cannot be changed after despatch of product
0116 284 9900
SIGNAL TOWERS
| 229
SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Information
232
Selection guide
235
Input & output relays for AC
236
Input & output relays for DC
237
Mounting bases & cables
238
EX series relays
239
Solid state interface relays
Introduction Delcon of Finland was founded in 1975 as a specialist manufacturer of solid state interface relays. Their relay design utilizes pulse transformer technology which gives some unique advantages over traditional opto coupler based solid state relays and electro mechanical relays. This helps ensure a long lifetime and trouble free performance in harsh industrial applications where difficult loads, noise and interference can cause big problems. Delcon is market leader in Finland and Sweden where their relays are widely found in power plants and large factories working in the wood, pulp and paper industry. Other significant customers include Alstom Grid who use Delcon relays extensively in their HVDC power network control systems.
Changing relays is a costly business Compared to the total system cost a relay is a relatively inexpensive component. However, a relay that fails in a system runs the risk of becoming the most expensive component. Choosing a relay with a shorter life span than the entire system will probably result in costly unwanted system downtime! The life span of an industrial system is typically considered to be 15 years. If your application has any of the following requirements then select Delcon relays for a hassle free and safe operation that spans the entire system life.
• Frequent switching – relays operate at least once per minute • Inductive loads – fitting clamp diodes can help but increases switch off time • Inductive loads combined with high switching frequency • High dc voltages
Cost Cost of 3rd replacement
Cost of 2nd replacement Cost of 1st replacement
e Delcon Cost pric Lifetime
lay E-Mech re Cost price
9 year 6 year 3 year
Cost of Delcon Cost of E-Mech relay Cost of downtime
232 | SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state interface relays
Problems with interference?
Problems with signalling?
cables installed adjacent to signal cables, especially over long disturbances can cause the LED indicator of opto coupler/ ! Power ! Electrical cable runs, create a capacitive effect that can cause opto coupler or electromechanical relays to glow when the relay is switched off and no electro mechanical relays to switch on or remain on after the control signal switches off
input signal present. This makes it difficult to quickly diagnose faults and rectify problems
in the power supply causes damage to relay coils/opto ! Transients √ Solution: coupler relays
!
Interference from frequency inverters can provide false on/off switching
√ Solution:
The Delcon LED is synchronized with the output so it is impossible for it to glow without being on. The relays have good hysteresis with clearly defined on/off points for reliable operation in high noise environments.
Delcon relays have built in capacitive suppression to allow safe, reliable operation even with very long cable runs. An RC circuit protects the relays from transients and high frequency interference.
Problems with inductive loads?
Problems with high dc voltage?
and solenoid valves are commonly used throughout industry, ! Reduced switching capacity ! Contactors they are also problematic inductive loads for electromechanical relays ! Electromechanical relays are significantly derated at higher dc voltages to handle require special version electromechanical relays that are ! Usually ! Contacts weld physically bigger and take up more space ! Short lifetime
√ Solution: Delcon ac output relays are rated at 3A and can switch inductive loads without any derating. Delcon dc output relays have no derating up to 24 V dc and thereafter still offer significantly less derating compared to electromechanical relays.
0116 284 9900
√ Solution:
Delcon dc output relay types CRA & CRA4 can switch up to 300 V dc with no derating compared to electromechanical relay and in a smaller package. Example SLO24CRA4 switching 40mS inductive load at 3A/110Vdc will give service life of 15 years or more.
SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
| 233
Solid state interface relays
Installation techniques Delcon’s interface relays are installed in the same way as typical electro mechanical relays and are available in two different versions. Each relay can be ordered as either a plug-in type or pre soldered to a DIN-rail base with screw terminals. The part numbers for the plug in types are as per the selection guide and the pre soldered din rail base versions use the same number with a suffix “S” at the end e.g. SLO 24TR (plug in) SLO 24TRS (din rail base).
If the plug-in type is used there are DIN-rail sockets or 8 / 16 channel mounting bases available. The DIN-rail socket is either MIS1N or MOS1N for input or output. The 8 / 16 channel mounting bases prefixed MBS use a flat cable connector to the PLC and many PLC adapters are available.
Connection example
Typical output (load)
Bridge bar
Flat cable
PLC adapter card
Typical input (sensor)
PLC controller inputs & outputs
16 way base & relays
Dimensions
Output Relay
Input Relay 12
12
79
47
43
47
43
Din Rail Base Relay
6.35
6.35
Fusing
To protect SL series solid state relays against short circuit/overload a fast fuse with the correct rating for the load and the capacity of the relay should be chosen. For triac output relays (SLO…TR, SLO 24TRA and SLO 24TH) use for example a 3.15A fuse. 234 | SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
5
5.08 2.54
7.62
5.08 10.16
5 10.16
7.62
5.08 5.08
7.62
10.16
5.08
80
12.5
To protect DC output relays (SLO…CR, SLO…CRA, SLO…CRA4, SLO…CRX and also SLO…IRA) use a fast fuse with the lowest nominal value that is practically possible. Note that when the overload current is not large it is possible that a fuse will not protect the relay because of the tolerance on the fuse rating. www.oem.co.uk
Solid state interface relays
Selection guide Relay Plug- in relay colour AC applications/input relays
DIN- rail relay unit
Description
Control voltage
Load current
Load voltage
SLI 25CR
SLI 25CRS
regular
24 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 25CRI
–
normally closed
24 VAC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 49CR
SLI 49CRS
regular
48 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 49CRI
–
normally closed
48 VAC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
–
SLI 120CRCS
change-over
120 VAC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 120CRI
SLI 120 CRIS
normally closed
120 VAC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 120CH
SLI 120CHS
transient protection add.
120 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 120CR
SLI 120CRS
regular
120 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 120CRP
SLI 120CRPS
2-wire sensor
120 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
–
SLI 230CRCS
change-over
230 VAC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 230CH
SLI 230CHS
transient protection add.
230 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 230CR
SLI 230CRS
regular
230 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 230CRI
SLI 230CRIS
normally closed
230 VAC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 230CRP
SLI 230CRPS
2-wire sensor
230 VAC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLO 5IRA
SLO 5IRAS
fast AC switching
5 VDC
1.2 A
0 - 240 VAC/ DC
SLO 5TR
SLO 5TRS
regular
5 VDC
3A
0 - 240 VAC
–
SLO 24IRCS
change-over
24 VDC
0.15 A
0 - 240 VAC/ DC
SLO 24IRA
SLO 24IRAS
fast AC switching
24 VDC
1.2 A
0 - 240 VAC/ DC
SLO 24TH
SLO 24THS
transient protection add.
24 VDC
3A
0 - 240 VAC
SLO 24TR
SLO 24TRS
regular
24 VDC
3A
0 - 240 VAC
SLO 24TRA
SLO 24TRAS
motor
24 VDC
2.5 A
0 - 240 / 415 VAC
SLO A120TR
SLO A120TRS
regular
120 VAC
1A
0 - 240 VAC
SLO P120TR
SLO P120TRS
2-wire sensor
120 VAC
3A
0 - 240 VAC
SLO A230TR
SLO A230TRS
regular
230 VAC
1A
0 - 240 VAC
SLO P230TR
SLO P230TRS
2-wire sensor
230 VAC
1.5 A
0 - 240 VAC
SLI 12CR
SLI 12CRS
regular
12 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 12CRI
–
normally closed
12 VDC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 24CRI
–
normally closed
24 VDC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 24CR
SLI 24CRS
regular
24 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 24CRF
SLI 24CRFS
fast DC function
24 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 24CRL
SLI 24CRLS
min. input load 15 mA
24 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 48CRI
–
normally closed
48 VDC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 48CR
SLI 48CRS
regular
48 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 125CRI
–
normally closed
125 VDC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 125CH
SLI 125CHS
transient protection add.
125 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 125CR
SLI 125CRS
regular
125 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 250CRI
–
normally closed
250 VDC
30 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 250CH
SLI 250CHS
transient protection add.
250 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLI 250CR
SLI 250CRS
regular
250 VDC
50 mA
0 - 60 VDC
SLO 5CRA
SLO 5CRAS
100 ms inductive load*
5 VDC
1.8 A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 5CR
SLO 5CRS
regular
5 VDC
3A
0 - 60 VDC
SLO 5CRX
SLO 5CRXS
high current
5 VDC
10 A
0 - 24 VDC
SLO 12CRA
SLO 12CRAS
100 ms inductive load*
12 VDC
1.8 A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 12CR
SLO 12CRS
regular
12 VDC
3A
0 - 60 VDC
SLO 12CRX
SLO 12CRXS
high current
12 VDC
10 A
0 - 24 VDC
SLO 24CRA
SLO 24CRAS
100 ms inductive load*
24 VDC
1.8 A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 24CR
SLO 24CRS
regular
24 VDC
3A
0 - 60 VDC
SLO 24CRA4
–
50 ms inductive load*
24 VDC
4A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 24CRX
SLO 24CRXS
high current
24 VDC
10 A
0 - 24 VDC
SLO 48CRA
–
100 ms inductive load*
48 VDC
1.8 A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 48CRA4
–
50 ms inductive load*
48 VDC
4A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 120CRA
–
100 ms inductive load*
120 VDC
1.8 A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 120CRA4
–
50 ms inductive load*
120 VDC
4A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 220CRA
–
100 ms inductive load*
220 VDC
1.8 A
0 - 250 VDC
SLO 220CRA4
–
50 ms inductive load*
220 VDC
4A
0 - 250 VDC
AC applications/ output relays
DC applications/ input relays
DC applications/ output relays
* with max. current and 24 V voltage on load side
0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
| 235
Solid state interface relays
Input relays for AC • Galvanic isolation 4 kV, 8 mm creep distance • Effective interference elimination • Compatible with both NPN and PNP logic • LED indication
The relays are used as an interface between AC sensors and control systems. The integrated interference protection provides reliable operation even in very demanding electrical environments. Thanks to interference protection, signal cables can be run alongside power cables on, for example, cable racks for more than 1.5 km without capacitive cross-talk affecting relays. The relays have no mechanical parts, which provides very reliable application. The CRP models are especially designed for connecting to 2-wire sensors that generate leakage current. The CRP relays are blind to leakage currents up to 3.5 mA. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number SLI25CR
Description
Control voltage
Load
Mounting
Input relay
24 V AC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI120CR
Input relay
120 V AC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI230CR
Input relay
230 V AC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI120CRP
Input relay
120 V AC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI230CRP
Input relay
230 V AC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI380CRS
Input relay
400 V AC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
MIS1GN
Socket for input relays
JUMPER 16-13
DIN rail
Jumper bar for Delcon’s sockets, max. 16 way
Output relays for AC • Galvanic isolation 4 kV, 8 mm creep distance • 3 A inductive or resistive load • Effective interference elimination • LED indication
The relays are used as an interface between control systems and AC loads. The relays can handle inductive loads without load current reduction, which makes them very suitable for connection to, for example, solenoid valves and contactors. The relays have no mechanical parts, which means very reliable application. The integrated interference protection provides reliable operation even in very demanding electrical environments. Thanks to interference protection, signal cables can be run alongside power cables on, for example, cable racks for more than 1.5 km without capacitive cross-talk affecting relays. The SLOP models are especially designed for connection to 2-wire sensors that produce leakage current. The relays are immune to leakage currents up to 3.0 mA. For forward/reverse control of AC motors, the SLO24TRA is used. The relay has a higher operating voltage and withstands regenerated voltages from motors. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Control voltage
Load
Mounting
SLO5TR
Output relay
5 V DC
0-265 V AC/3 A
Plug-in
SLO24TR
Output relay
24 V DC
0-265 V AC/3 A
Plug-in
SLO24IRA
Output relay
24 V DC
0-300 DC or 0-265 V AC/1.2 A
Plug-in
SLOP120TR
Output relay
120 V AC
0-265 V AC/3 A
Plug-in
SLOP230TR
Output relay
230 V AC
0-265 V AC/1.5 A
Plug-in
SLO24TRA
Output relay
24 V DC
0-265 V AC Motor load 0-460 V AC Static load
Plug-in
MOS1GN JUMPER 16-13
Socket for output relays
DIN rail
Jumper bar for Delcon’s sockets, max. 16 way
236 | SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state interface relays
Input relays for DC • Galvanic isolation 4 kV, 8 mm creep distance • Effective interference elimination • Compatible with NPN/PNP logic • LED indication
The relays are used as an interface between DC sensors and control systems. The integrated interference protection provides reliable operation even in very demanding electrical environments. Thanks to interference protection, signal cables can be run alongside power cables on, for example, cable racks for more than 1.5 km without capacitive cross-talk affecting relays. The relays have no mechanical parts, which provides very reliable application. If high frequencies occur from sensors for counting inputs, for example, we recommend SLI24CRF. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oem . c o . u k
Description
Control voltage
Load
SLI12CR
Order number
Input relay
12 V DC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Mounting Plug-in
SLI24CR
Input relay
24 V DC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI24CRF
Input relay, high frequency 10 kHz.
24 V DC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI48CR
Input relay
48 V DC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI125CR
Input relay
125 V DC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
SLI250CR
Input relay
250 V DC
0-60 V DC/50 mA
Plug-in
MIS1GN JUMPER 16-13
Socket for input relay
DIN rail
Jumper bar for Delcon’s sockets, max. 16 way
N/C relays also available upon request.
Output relays for DC • Galvanic isolation 4 kV, 8 mm creep distance • Voltages up to 300 V DC • Up to 10 A load current • LED indication
The relays are used as interfaces between control systems and DC loads. The relays handle inductive loads and high DC voltages with low load reduction compared to mechanical relays, which provide a long lifetime. If a diode is mounted across a load, such as 1N4007, the nominal current applies, even with high inductive loads. (Keep in mind that the drop-out time increases when mounting a diode.) The relays have no mechanical parts, which means very reliable application. The integrated interference protection provides reliable operation even in very demanding electrical environments. Thanks to interference protection, signal cables can be run alongside power cables on, for example, cable racks for more than 1.5 km without capacitive cross-talk affecting relays. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Order number
Description
Control voltage
Load
Mounting
SLO5CR
Output relay
5 V DC
0-60 V DC/3 A
Plug-in
SLO24CR
Output relay
24 V DC
0-60 V DC/3 A
Plug-in
SLO24CRA4
Output relay
24 V DC
0-300 V DC/4 A
Plug-in
SLO24CRA
Output relay
24 V DC
0-300 V DC/1.8 A
Plug-in
SLO24CRX*
Output relay
24 V DC
0-32 V DC/10 A
Plug-in
SLO120CRA
Output relay
120 V DC
0-300 V DC/1.8 A
Plug-in
SLO120CRA4
Output relay
120 V DC
0-300 V DC/4 A
Plug-in
SLO220CRA
Output relay
120 V DC
0-300 V DC/1.8 A
Plug-in
SLO220CRA4
Output relay
220 V DC
0-300 V DC/4 A
MOS1GN JUMPER 16-13
Socket for output relay
Plug-in DIN rail
Jumper bar for Delcon’s sockets, max. 16 way
* For mounting in socket MOS1GN or MBS16, 6.3 A applies. For solder connection in socket 10 A Order no. SLO24CRXS .
0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
| 237
Solid state interface relays
Mounting base for adapter system, 16-channel • Simple and reliable installation • Test buttons for function simulation • PNP or NPN • Link for inputs or outputs Order number
Description
MBS16BDP
Mounting base for 16 relays. PNP, test button
MBS16ADP
Mounting base for 16 relays. NPN, test button
The MBS16 mounting base is connected to Delcon adapters as appropriate for the control system. The connection is made with a flat cable, which provides a reliable connection between control systems and interface relays. MBS16 can be connected for 16 inputs, 16 outputs or 8 inputs and 8 outputs. Change-over is accomplished with jumper link. There is a test button for each channel for activation of relays, which simplifies troubleshooting and commissioning. Input or output cable is connected via a 2-pole terminal block. For common bridging of zero, for example, use the 16-pole jumper bar, Jumper 16-13. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Mounting base for adapter system, 8-channel • Simple and reliable installation • Test buttons for function simulation • Expandable to 16 channels • 3-level terminal block Order number MB8BIP2 MB8BIPE2 MB8BOP2 MB8BOPE2
Description Mounting base for 8 input relays, base unit. PNP Mounting base for 8 input relays, expansion unit. PNP Mounting base for 8 output relays, base unit. PNP Mounting base for 8 output relays, expansion unit. PNP
Series MB8 mounting bases are for 8 channels but can be expanded to 16 channels with two 8-channel mounting bases connected together with a flat cable. This enables expansion from 8 channels to 16 channels at a later stage. MB8 is connected to Delcon’s PROFIBUS unit or Delcon’s adapters as appropriate for the control system. The connection is made with a flat cable, which provides a reliable connection between the control system and interface relays. There is a test button for each channel for activation of relays, which simplifies troubleshooting and commissioning. The terminal block is of the 3-level type and enables feed of 3-wire sensors. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Adapter cable for all PLC systems The cable is supplied with a connector for a 16-channel mounting base. The other end has open cables for PLC attachment, for example. The cable is colour coded per DIN 47100 and the wiring diagram is available at Delcon's website. www.delcon.fi. The cable is excellent for use in all applications in which there is no PLC adapter or when signals are to be taken from a terminal block, for example. Order number
Description
RC20X-100
1 m cable
RC20X-200
2 m cable
RC20X-300
3 m cable
238 | SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
The cable is supplied in standard lengths but can be supplied in other lengths upon request. For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state interface relays
EX series Relay type
Application
Control voltage
Load voltage
Max current
Ex-input relays DC control, AC load EXI 12CH
Limit switches
12 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 24CH
Limit switches
24 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 24CHF
Fast connection
24 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 24CHL
Increased input current
24 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 48CH
Limit switches
48 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 125CH
Limit switches
120 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 250CH
Limit switches
250 VDC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
Ex-input relays AC control, DC load EXI 25CH
Limit switches
24 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 49CH
Limit switches
48 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 120CH
Limit switches
120 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 120CHI
Normally closed operation
120 VAC
0...28 VDC
100 mA
EXI 120CHP
2-wire proximity switches
120 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 230CH
Limit switches
230 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 230CHI
Normally closed operation
230 VAC
0...28 VDC
100 mA
EXI 230CHP
2-wire proximity switches
230 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
EXI 230CHR
Output current limited
230 VAC
0...28 VDC
50 mA
Ex-output relays DC control, DC load EXO 5CH
Resistive loads
5 VDC
0...60 VDC
3A
EXO 5CHA
Inductive loads
5 VDC
0...250 VDC
1.8 A
EXO 5CHX
Resistive loads
5 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A*
EXO 5CHXSN
Resistive loads
5 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A
EXO 12CH
Resistive loads
12 VDC
0...60 VDC
3A
EXO 12CHA
Inductive loads
12 VDC
0...250 VDC
1.8 A
EXO 12CHX
Resistive loads
12 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A*
Resistive loads, DIN-rail
12 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A
EXO 24CH
Resistive loads
24 VDC
0...60 VDC
3A
EXO 24CHA
Inductive loads
24 VDC
0...250 VDC
1.8 A
EXO 24CHA4
Inductive loads
24 VDC
0...250 VDC
4A
EXO 24CHX
Resistive loads
24 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A*
EXO 12CHXSN
EXO 24CHXSN
Resistive loads, DIN-rail
24 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A
EXO 48CHA
Inductive loads
48 VDC
0...250 VDC
1.8 A
EXO 48CHA4
Inductive loads
48 VDC
0...250 VDC
4A
EXO 48CHX
Resistive loads
48 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A*
EXO 48CHXSN
Resistive loads, DIN-rail
48 VDC
0...28 VDC
10 A
EXO 120CHA
Inductive loads
120 VDC
0...250 VDC
1.8 A
EXO 120CHA4
Inductive loads
120 VDC
0...250 VDC
4A
EXO 220CHA
Inductive loads
220 VDC
0...250 VDC
1.8 A
EXO 220CHA4
Inductive loads
220 VDC
0...250 VDC
4A
* 6.3 A when used with a mounting base Ex-output relays DC control, AC load EXO 5IHA
Fast switch off
5 VDC
0…240 VAC/250 VDC
1.2 A
EXO 5TH
AC loads
5 VDC
0…240 VAC
3A
EXO 12TH
AC loads
12 VDC
0…240 VAC
3A
EXO 24IHA
Fast switch off
24 VDC
0…240 VAC/250 VDC
1.2 A
EXO 24TH
Wider operation temp range
24 VDC
0…240 VAC
3A
EXO 24TR
AC loads
24 VDC
0…240 VAC
3A
EXO P120TH
AC loads
120 VAC
0…240 VAC
3A
EXO P230TH
AC loads
230 VAC
0…240 VAC
1.5 A
Ex-output relays AC control, AC load
0116 284 9900
Mounting bases for EXl-relays:
Mounting bases for EXO-relays:
MIS 1GNEX (screw connectors) MIS 1CCNEX (spring connectors) MIS 1TNEX (screw connectors with test contacts)
MOS 1GNEX (screw connectors) MOS 1CCNEX (spring connectors) MOS 1TNEX (screw connectors with test contacts)
SOLID STATE INTERFACE RELAYS
| 239
SOLID STATE RELAYS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Introduction
242
Panel mount
244
DIN rail mount
246
Plug-in mount
248
Accessories
250
Solid state relays
Introduction Crydom, a market leading and global expert in Solid State Switching Technology, has a distinguished record of providing high quality, world class Solid State Relay and Control Products for a variety of heating, lighting and motion control applications. Utilising state of the art designs, materials and technology, Crydom offers a wide range of AC and DC output SSRs in industry standard Panel Mount, PCB Mount and DIN Rail packages, all meeting global safety and standards agency requirements such as CE, RoHS, UL, IEC, etc. Bolstered by four decades of Solid State Relay operations experience, Crydom specialises adapted and fully custom-designed SSR products for nearly any application where unique specifications and optimised performance are critical for success.
Applications Although there are literally thousands of individual uses for Solid State Relays and Contactors most can be categorised into the following applications: Heating Control This encompasses the largest segment of solid state relay customers. Applications include, but are not limited to, professional food equipment, plastic moulding/extrusion machinery, HVAC&R and soldering equipment. Benefits: Temperature accuracy, long life, no maintenance, safe product, easy to interface. Suitable for heater, fan, blower and valve control.
Lighting Control These applications are usually broken down into three categories: theatrical, warehouse and commercial. Many of the products used in this segment are designed for the specific application. Benefits: Dimming, silent operation, fast switching, long life, no maintenance, safe product, easy to interface, reduced parts count.
Motion Control Includes elevators, lifts, hoists, exercise equipment, conveyor systems, solar, fans, solenoid and valve control. Benefits: Endurance, shock & vibration resistance, Soft Start, reversing, no arcing, fast switching, long life, no maintenance, easy to interface, reduced parts count.
242 | SOLID STATE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state relays
What is a Solid State Relay/Contactor? A Solid State Relay or Contactor (SSR or SSC) is an electronic component that switches Power (AC or DC current) to a load circuit and provides electrical isolation between an applications control circuit and
load circuit. It is a competitive technology to Electromechanical Relays (EMRs) and other switching technologies such as Mercury Displacement Relays (MDRs).
Why use solid state switching technology? Long Life Solid state relays and contactors have no moving parts therefore there is no mechanical wear and tear on the output contacts. The typical life expectancy of a solid state relay may be more than 50 times that of an electromechanical relay. Ideal for repetitive applications.
Quiet Operation Solid state switching solutions make no acoustical noise when the output contacts change states. This is highly desirable in many commercial and medical applications.
Minimum Electrical Noise Zero voltage turn-on and zero current turn-off allows for minimum electrical disturbances generated by SSRs.
Lower Power Consumption Solid state relays and contactors require very little input power ‘coil current’ to switch large loads. Crydom solid state relays can switch up to 150A load current with less than 15mA current draw from the control input.
Shock & Vibration Resistant Solid state switching solutions are not susceptible to erratic or unreliable operation when operating under tough environments.
Ideal for Harsh Environments SSRs and SSCs do not generate sparks or electric arcs; do not bounce either electrically or mechanically. Designed as pollution degree 2 devices per IEC 60664-1. Isolation levels up to 4k V. Magnetic fields have little effect on SSR.
High Compatibility with Control Systems DC controlled SSRs can be switched ON or OFF by digital systems such as PLC and µC based systems. AC controlled SSRs can be driven by limit switches, thermal switches and sensors carrying AC control signals.
Fast Switching Random turn-on solid state relays and contactors respond to a control signal in less than 100 µs. Phase control and Burst control can be easily achieved to provide accurate AC power control.
Position Insensitive Suitable for mounting in either vertical or horizontal position, ‘dead bug’ position and adjacent mounting. 0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE RELAYS
| 243
Solid state relays
Panel mount – AC output – series 1
• • • • • •
Rated from 10 to 125A @24-280VAC Rated from 12 to 90A @ 80-230VAC 3-32VDC, 18-36 or 90-280VAC control voltage “Ultra-low” input current ( 2-4mA DC typical) Zero or random turn-on UL508 overload endurance rated
Dimensions
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
Line voltage range
A1210
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1210E
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1210T
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1225
90-280 VAC
25 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1225E
18-36 VAC
25 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1225T
90-280 VAC
25 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1240
90-280 VAC
40 Amps
24-140 VAC
A1240E
18-36 VAC
40 Amps
24-140 VAC
244 | SOLID STATE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state relays
Panel mount – AC output – CW series
• Heavy duty SSR with rating from 10 to 125A @12-280AC or 48-660VAC • EMC (Level 3) compliant • Flexible 3-32VDC, 18-36VAC or 90-280 VAC control voltage • Zero or random turn-on • IP20 “touch safe” cover • UL508 overload endurance rated
Dimensions
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
Line voltage range
CWA2410
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA2410E
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA4810
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA4810E
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWD2410
3-32 VDC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWD4810
4-32 VDC
10 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA2425
90-280 VAC
25 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA2425E
18-36 VAC
25 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA4825
90-280 VAC
25 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA4825E
18-36 VAC
25 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWD2425
3-32 VDC
25 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWD4825
4-32 VDC
25 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA2450
90-280 VAC
50 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA2450E
18-36 VAC
50 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA4850
90-280 VAC
50 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA4850E
18-36 VAC
50 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA2490
90-280 VAC
90 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA2490E
18-36 VAC
90 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA4890
90-280 VAC
90 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA4890E
18-36 VAC
90 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA24125
90-280 VAC
125 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA24125E
18-36 VAC
125 Amps
24-280 VAC
CWA48125
90-280 VAC
125 Amps
48-660 VAC
CWA48125E
18-36 VAC
125 Amps
48-660 VAC
0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE RELAYS
| 245
Solid state relays
DIN rail mount – AC output – DRA series
• Ready-to-use DIN rail mountable solid state relays assemblies using standard Crydom SIP SSRs • Ratings from 3 to 8 Amps • Operating voltage of 12-530 VAC • Fits standard 35 mm DIN rail profiles • AC & DC control voltage versions available depending upon selected SSR • Available with zero voltage turn-on (resistive loads) or random turn-on (inductive loads) output
Dimensions
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
Line voltage range
DRA1-MP120D3
3-32 VDC
3 Amps
12-120 VAC
DRA1-MP240D3
3-32 VDC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
DRA1-MP240D4
3-32 VDC
4 Amps
24-280 VAC
DRA1-CX240A5
90-140 VAC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-CX240D5
3-15 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-CXE240D5
15-32 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-CX380D5
4-15 VDC
5 Amps
48-380 VAC
DRA1-CXE380D5
15-32 VDC
5 Amps
48-380 VAC
DRA1-MCX240D5
3-15 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-MCXE240D5
15-32 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-MCX380D5
4-15 VDC
5 Amps
48-380 VAC
DRA1-MCXE380D5
15-32 VDC
5 Amps
48-380 VAC
DRA4-CX240D5
3-15 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA4-CXE240D5
15-32 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA4-MCX240D5
3-15 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA4-MCXE240D5
15-32 VDC
5 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-SPF240A25
90-140 VAC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
DRA1-SPFE240A25
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
DRA1-SPF240D25
3-15 VDC
10 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-SPFE240D25
15-32 VDC
10 Amps
12-280 VAC
DRA1-SPF380D25
4-15 VDC
10 Amps
48-380 VAC
246 | SOLID STATE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state relays
DIN rail mount – AC /DC output – series One DR
• 3, 6 & 12 Amps output power rating • 60 & 100 VDC, 24 to 600 VAC operating voltage ratings • 4-32 VDC, 24, 120 & 230 VAC control input options available • IP20 housing with unique integrated heat sink design • High power density for multiple units • UL & cUL listed • CE & RoHS compliant
Dimensions
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
Line voltage range
DR24D03
4-32 VDC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24E03
18-36 VAC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24B03
90-140 VAC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24A03
208-265 VAC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR48D03
4-32 VDC
3 Amps
48-600 VAC
DR06D03
4-32 VDC
3 Amps
1-60 VDC
DR10D03
4-32 VDC
3 Amps
1-100 VDC
DR24A06
208-265 VAC
6 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24B06
90-140 VAC
6 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24D06
4-32 VDC
6 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24E06
18-36 VAC
6 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR48D06
4-32 VDC
6 Amps
48-600 VAC
DRD24D06
4-32 VDC
6 Amps
24-280 VAC
DRD48D06
4-32 VDC
6 Amps
48-600 VAC
DR06D06
4-32 VDC
6 Amps
2-60 VDC
DR10D06
4-32 VDC
6 Amps
2-100 VDC
DR24B12
90-140 VAC
12 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24D12
4-32 VDC
12 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR24E12
18-36 VAC
12 Amps
24-280 VAC
DR48A12
208-265 VAC
12 Amps
48-600 VAC
DR48B12
90-140 VAC
12 Amps
48-600 VAC
DR48D12
4-32 VDC
12 Amps
48-600 VAC
DR48E12
18-36 VAC
12 Amps
48-600 VAC
DR06D12
4-32 VDC
12 Amps
2-60 VDC
DR10D12
4-32 VDC
12 Amps
2-100 VDC
0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE RELAYS
| 247
Solid state relays
Plug-In mount – AC output – ED series
Dimensions
• AC output solid state relay in an industry standard EMR plug-in package • Ratings of 3 & 5 Amps • Operating voltage of 24-280 VAC • Wide range of AC or DC control voltage options • Quick connect termination for easy installation in sockets or on boards • UL & IEC general use & motor controller ratings available
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
Line voltage range
ED24C3
18-32 VDC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24D3
3-15 VDC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24F3
48-72 VDC
3 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24B5
90-140 VAC
5 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24C5
18-32 VDC
5 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24D5
3-15 VDC
5 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24E5
18-36 VAC
5 Amps
24-280 VAC
ED24F5
48-72 VDC
5 Amps
24-280 VAC
248 | SOLID STATE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state relays
Plug-In Mount – DC Output – ED Series
• DC output solid state relay in an industry standard EMR plug in package • Ratings of 5 Amps • Load voltage range of 1-48 and 1-80 VDC • Fits standard DIN rail & PCB mountable sockets • LED input status indicator • AC or DC control • cUL recognized, IEC rated, CE & RoHS compliant • Motor controller rated
Dimensions
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
ED06B5
90-140 VAC
5 Amps
Line voltage range 1-48 VDC
ED06C5
18-32 VDC
5 Amps
1-48 VDC
ED06D5
5-15 VDC
5 Amps
1-48 VDC
ED06E5
18-36 VAC
5 Amps
1-48 VDC
ED06F5
48-72 VDC
5 Amps
1-48 VDC
ED10B5
90-140 VAC
5 Amps
1-80 VDC 1-80 VDC
ED10C5
18-32 VDC
5 Amps
ED10D5
5-15 VDC
5 Amps
1-80 VDC
ED10E5
18-36 VAC
5 Amps
1-80 VDC
0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE RELAYS
| 249
Solid state relays
DIN rail mount – AC output – CKR series
Dimensions
• Solid state relay with ratings from 10 to 30 Amps • Operating voltage of 24-660 VAC • Flexible control voltage of 4-32 VDC, 18-36 VAC, 90-280 VAC • Elective internal TVS (“P” suffix) eliminates the need for external overvoltage protection • Enhanced surge current ratings for the 30 Amps
Ordering template
Ordering guide Part number
Control voltage
Maximum load current
Line voltage range
CKRA2410
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRA2410E
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRD2410
4-32 VDC
10 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRA4810
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRA4810E
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRD4810
4-32 VDC
10 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRA6010
90-280 VAC
10 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRA6010E
18-36 VAC
10 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRD6010
4-32 VDC
10 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRA2420
90-280 VAC
20 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRA2420E
18-36 VAC
20 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRD2420
4-32 VDC
20 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRA4820
90-280 VAC
20 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRA4820E
18-36 VAC
20 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRD4820
4-32 VDC
20 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRA6020
90-280 VAC
20 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRA6020E
18-36 VAC
20 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRD6020
4-32 VDC
20 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRA2430
90-280 VAC
30 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRA2430E
18-36 VAC
30 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRD2430
4-32 VDC
30 Amps
24-280 VAC
CKRA4830
90-280 VAC
30 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRA4830E
18-36 VAC
30 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRD4830
4-32 VDC
30 Amps
48-530 VAC
CKRA6030
90-280 VAC
30 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRA6030E
18-36 VAC
30 Amps
48-660 VAC
CKRD6030
4-32 VDC
30 Amps
48-660 VAC
250 | SOLID STATE RELAYS
www.oem.co.uk
Solid state relays
Accessories
• Heat sinks • Thermal pads • Protective covers • Sockets
Ordering guide Heat sinks Part number HS351
Thermal resistance
Description
Mounting type
Dims (HxWxD)
3.5°C/W
Suitable for 1 single or dual SSR
3.20 x 1.78 x 1.78
HS301
3.0°C/W
Suitable for 1 single or dual SSR
HS251 HS201
2.5°C/W 2.0°C/W
Suitable for 1 single or dual SSR Suitable for 1 single or dual SSR
HS172 HS151
1.7°C/W 1.5°C/W
Suitable for 1 or 2 single or dual SSRs Suitable for 1 single or dual SSR
HS103
1.0°C/W
HS072
0.7°C/W 0.5°C/W
Suitable for 1, 2 or 3 single or dual SSRs; one 3 phase SSR Suitable for 1 or 2 single or dual SSRs Suitable for 1, 2 or 3 single or dual SSRs; one 3 phase SSR
Panel mountable or DIN Rail mountable version available as HS351DR Panel mountable or DIN Rail mountable version available as HS301DR Panel mountable Panel mountable or DIN Rail mountable version available as HS201DR Panel mountable Panel mountable or DIN Rail mountable version available as HS151DR Panel mountable or DIN Rail mountable version available as HS103DR Panel mountable Panel mountable
HS053
3.20 x 1.78 x 1.58 2.31 x 1.98 x 1.51 3.20 x 1.78 x 3.15 3.95 x 2.31 x 1.51 3.20 x 1.78 x 3.74 5.20 x 3 x 2.37 5.50 x 4.75 x 2.63 6 x 4.9 x 3.5
Thermal pads Part number
Description
HSP-1
25 pack of non-adhesive thermal pads for standard hockey puck package SSRs (2.25 x 1.75 in)
HSP-2
Thermal pad for standard hockey puck package SSRs (2.25 x 1.75 in)
HSP-3
Thermal pad for large puck panel mount SSRs (4 x 2.9 in)
HSP-5
Thermal pad for large puck panel mount SSRs (4 x 2.9 in)
HSP-6
Thermal pad for mini-puck panel mount SSRs
Covers Part number
Description
KS100
Clear plastic cover for standard 2.25 x 1.75 In hockey puck style SSR
KS100-SMR
Clear plastic cover for SMR-6 and MC series
KS300
Clear plastic cover for large 4 x 2.9 In hockey puck style SSR
Sockets Part number DRS1
Series
Description
DRS series
DRS4
DRS series
10 mm single channel DIN rail mountable socket to mount Crydom PCB mount relays onto standard 35 mm DIN Rail profiles 54 mm four channel DIN Rail mountable socket to mount Crydom PCB mount relays onto standard 35 mm DIN Rail profiles Finger safe IP10 DIN Rail mountable socket to mount ED Series relays onto standard 35 mm DIN Rail profiles PC Board mountable socket for ED series relays
DRSED
ED series
PCBSED
ED series
0116 284 9900
SOLID STATE RELAYS
| 251
SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Introduction & overview
254
Technical data
256
3-pole switch for panel & rear mount
257
3-pole switch for modular & enclosure
258
3-pole switch body & additional contacts
260
Auxilliary contacts & accessories
261
Switch disconnectors
Reverso 25A – 100A All the switch bodies, neutral poles and additional contacts have reversible terminals and can therefore be used in both rear mounting and front mounting applications. This is possible thanks to a patented system where by the terminals can be inverted by means of a sliding terminal block. When pushed down this also locks the switch body to the DIN rail in rear mounting applications.
• Same switch body can be rear or front mounted • Modular system with auxiliary contacts that can be snapped in place • Door interlocking with clutch drive option • 7+7 mm contact gap
Yellow/red presentation
1 0
254 | SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
Front mount with padlockable handle
Rear mount with clutch drive, door interlock & padlockable handle
Enclosure with integral padlockable handle IP66
Enclosure & padlockable handle
www.oem.co.uk
Switch disconnectors Standard versions Front mount with padlockable handle
Rear mount with clutch drive, door interlock & padlockable handle
Enclosure with integral padlockable handle IP66
Enclosure & padlockable handle
3 pole
0172001
0165009
0172061
—
3 pole + NC/NO
0172011
0165019
0172071
—
4 pole neutral L
0172021
0165029
0172081
—
4 pole neutral L + NC/NO
0172031
0165039
0172091
—
4 pole neutral R
0172041
0165049
—
—
4 pole neutral R + NC/NO
0172051
0165059
—
—
6 pole
—
—
—
0172009
6 pole + NC/NO
—
—
—
0172029
3 pole
0172101
0165109
0172161
—
3 pole + NC/NO
0172111
0165119
0172171
—
4 pole neutral L
0172121
0165129
0172181
—
4 pole neutral L + NC/NO
0172131
0165139
0172191
—
4 pole neutral R
0172141
0165149
—
—
4 pole neutral R + NC/NO
0172151
0165159
—
—
6 pole
—
—
—
0172109
6 pole + NC/NO
—
—
—
0172129
3 pole
0172201
0165209
—
0172261
3 pole + NC/NO
0172211
0165219
—
0172271
4 pole neutral L
0172221
0165229
—
0172281
4 pole neutral L + NC/NO
0172231
0165239
—
0172291
4 pole neutral R
0172241
0165249
—
—
4 pole neutral R + NC/NO
0172251
0165259
—
—
6 pole
—
—
—
0172209
6 pole + NC/NO
—
—
—
0172229
3 pole
0172301
0165309
—
0172361
3 pole + NC/NO
0172311
0165319
—
0172371
4 pole neutral L
0172321
0165329
—
0172381
4 pole neutral L + NC/NO
0172331
0165339
—
0172391
4 pole neutral R
0172341
0165349
—
—
4 pole neutral R + NC/NO
0172351
0165359
—
—
6 pole
—
—
—
0172309
6 pole + NC/NO
—
—
—
0172329
3 pole
0172401
0165409
—
0172461
3 pole + NC/NO
0172411
0165419
—
0172471
4 pole neutral L
0172421
0165429
—
0172481
4 pole neutral L + NC/NO
0172431
0165439
—
0172491
4 pole neutral R
0172441
0165449
—
—
4 pole neutral R + NC/NO
0172451
0165459
—
—
6 pole
—
—
—
0172409
6 pole + NC/NO
—
—
—
0172429
3 pole
0172501
0165509
—
0172561
3 pole + NC/NO
0172511
0165519
—
0172571
4 pole neutral L
0172521
0165529
—
0172581
4 pole neutral L + NC/NO
0172531
0165539
—
0172591
4 pole neutral R
0172541
0165549
—
—
4 pole neutral R + NC/NO
Type 25A
Type 32A
Type 50A
Type 63A
Type 80A
Type 100A
0172551
0165559
—
—
6 pole
—
—
—
0172509
6 pole + NC/NO
—
—
—
0172529
0116 284 9900
SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
| 255
Switch disconnectors
TECHNICAL DATA
Size 1 25 A
Size 1 32A
Size 2 50A
Size 2 63A
Size 3 80A
Size 3 100A
General Rated breaking current (Ie) AC 21
25
32
50
63
80
100
Thermal rated current (Ith) AC 20
25
32
50
63
80
100
Ith for enclosed circuit-breaker A
20
25
40
50
63
80
Nom. supply voltage (Ui) V AC
690
690
690
690
690
690
6
6
6
6
6
6
0.1
0.1
0.04
0.04
0.04
0.04
Surge withstand voltage (Uimp) kV 6 Mech. lifetime (without load) x 106
-30 °C to +70 °C
Operating temperature Cable area, multi-conductor mm
0.75-6
1.5-16
2.5-35
Cable area, single conductor max.
10 mm
25 mm
50 mm
UL, cUL File E57 817
Approval Enclosure class
IP40, (IP65 with extra sealing or in enclosure)
CE-marked per
IEC 947-3, EN 60 947-3
Closing and breaking characteristics Max. closing capacity Aeff/400 V
710
710
1270
1270
1970
1970
Max. breaking capacity Aeff/400 V
330
330
800
800
800
800
1500
Short-circuit characteristics 350
430
500
760
1100
Max. short-circuit current Aeff/400 V
1
1
1.8
1.8
2.8
2.8
With protection gl/gG A
25
32
50
63
80
100
Short-time current Icw A/400 V/1 s
Rated power AC23 (kW) 3x230 V
5.5
5.5
15
15
19
22
3x400 V
5.5
7.5
15
18.5
22
30
3x500 V
5.5
7.5
15
22
30
37
3x690 V
5.5
7.5
15
18.5
18.5
22
18.5
Rated power AC3 (kW) 3x230 V
4
4
7.5
11
15
3x400 V
5.5
7.5
15
18.5
22
30
3x500 V
5.5
7.5
15
22
30
37
3x690 V
5.5
7.5
15
18.5
18.5
22
14.8
21
35
42
57
69
Rated operating current AC23 400 V Electrical data for signal contact 10A
Thermal rated current Ith Rated breaking current AC15
Screw assembly switch size 1
256 | SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
230 V-6 A
Screw assembly switch size 2 & 3
400 V-4 A
One hole mount switch size 1
www.oem.co.uk
Switch disconnectors
3-pole switch body for panel mount with padlockable handle
3-pole switch body for panel mount with yellow/red handle
3-pole switch body for panel mount with grey handle
25A
0172001
25A
0174001
32A
0172101
32A
0174101
50A
0172201
50A
0174201
63A
0172301
63A
0174301
80A
0172401
80A
0174401
100A
0172501
100A
0174501
3-pole switch body for rear mount with clutch drive & padlockable handle
3-pole switch body for rear mount with clutch drive and yellow/red handle
3-pole switch body for rear mount with clutch drive and grey handle
25A
0165009
25A
0168009
32A
0165109
32A
0168109
50A
0165209
50A
0168209
63A
0165309
63A
0168309
80A
0165409
80A
0168409
100A
0165509
100A
0168509
0116 284 9900
SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
| 257
Switch disconnectors
3-pole switch body for modular housing with grey/black handle
3-pole switch body for modular housing with grey/black handle (red/yellow on request) 25A
0174005
32A
0174105
Size
A
B
C
D
25-32A
79
*43.5
14.5
53
50-63A
89
63
18
63
99
73
26.8
73
50A
0174205
80-100A
63A
0174305
80A
0174405
*On 25A and 32A switches there are no covers. the signal contact is normally hidden by the cabinet with DIN rail
100A
0174505
3-pole switch body in enclosure with integral padlockable handle IP66
3-pole switch body in enclosure 2 knockout openings (PG16, M25) on top & bottom Padlockable handle yellow/red 25A
0172061
32A
0172161
Self adhesive sign for enclosure Blank
0174599
Main switch
0174569
Padlockable handle grey 25A
0174061
32A
0174161
258 | SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
www.oem.co.uk
Switch disconnectors
3-pole switch body
3-pole switch body
Size
25A
0172000
32A
0172100
50A
0172200
63A
0172300
80A
0172400
100A
0172500
A
B
C
D
1
75.4
44
31.5
50
2
85
53.6
42.2
60
3
93
71.8
52.6
70
Additional contact, neutral pole & junction block
Size
Additional contact
Neutral pole
A
B
C
1
75.4
14.5
43.5
2
85
17.9
60
3
93
26.8
70
Junction block
25A
0172075
25A
0172065
25-32A Size 1
0172185
32A
0172175
32A
0172165
50-63A Size 2
0172385
50A
0172275
50A
0172265
80-100A Size 3
0172585
63A
0172375
63A
0172365
80A
0172475
80A
0172465
100A
0172575
100A
0172565
0116 284 9900
SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
| 259
Switch disconnectors
Auxilliary contacts & terminal covers
3 pole cover
4th pole or neutral contact
Cover block for delayed closing signal covers 1 side
Cover for 0172179 (NO & NC) (covers one side)
3 pole terminal cover
Signal contact 1NO & 1 NC max 400V lth 10A All sizes
25-32A Size 1
0172167
50-63A Size 2
0172367
80-100A Size 3
0172567
Cover for 4th pole or neutral contact (covers one side)
0172179
Late make contact max 400V, lth 10A 25-32A Size 1
0172195
50-63A Size 2
0172395
80-100A Size 3
0172595
25-32A Size 1
0172177
50-63A Size 2
0172377
80-100A Size 3
0172577
Cover block delayed closing signal contact (covers both sides) 0172199 Cover for 0172179 (NO & NC) (covers one side) 0172189
Padlockable handle, function label & IP65 kit
Padlockable handle
Function label
Yellow/red 66 x 66 size 1-2
0172601
Blank
0172629
Grey 66 x 66 size 1-2
0174601
Main switch
0172649
Yellow/red 86 x 86 size 2-3
0172621
IP65 seal kit for panel mount
Grey 86 x 86 size 2-3
0174621
25-63A
0172267
80-100A
0172277
Yellow/red 66 x 66 one hole size 1
260 | SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
0172603
IP65 seal kit for rear mount 25-63A
0172259
80-100A
0172269
www.oem.co.uk
Switch disconnectors
Engraved legend plate & handle
Rear mounting plate
Rear mounting plate
Legend plate & handle Yellow/red 64 x 64 mm
0172602
Size 1 (25-32A)
0172187
Grey 64 x 64 mm
0174602
Size 2 (50-63A)
0172387
Size 3 (80-100A)
0172587
Yellow/red 48 x 48 mm one hole mount
0172604
Grey 48 x 48 mm one hole mount
0174604
Clutch drive & door interlock kit
Clutch drive presentation from 25A to 100A Clutch drive kit & door interlock shroud Kit 1 (no shaft)
0174179
Kit 2 (short shaft)
0174189
Kit 3 (long shaft)
0174199
Interlock shroud Shroud
0174249
Rear mounting plate
X (mm)
No shaft
Short shaft
Long shaft
Size
A
B
25 - 32A
86 to 100
86 to 250
86 to 400
1
25
85
Size 1 (25-32 A)
0172187
50 - 63A
96 to 110
96 to 260
96 to 410
2
35
90
Size 2 (50-63 A)
0172387
80 - 100A
106 to 120
106 to 270
106 to 420
3
50
100
Size 3 (80-100 A)
0172587 Each kit contains all of the parts required to convert a standard switch body and padlockable handle for rear mount with clutch drive. Consult the table for each kits panel depth dimensions. The door interlock shroud is available separately
0116 284 9900
SWITCH DISCONNECTORS
| 261
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
CAL ET thermostats
264
West N series controllers N2300 1/32 Din indicators & controllers
264
CAL 3300,9400, 9500P fixed build PID controllers
264
CALGrafix monitoring software
268
Lumel analogue RE55 controller
270
Lumel compact RE series
270
West P series modular controllers P6100, P8100, P4100 P6170, P8170, P4170 valve motor controllers P6700, P8700, P4700 temperature alarm policeman P6010, P8010 indicators
271
Dual loop multifunction controllers Lumel RE92
275
West PRO-EC44
276
Advanced process & temperature controllers PMA KS20,West PRO16 1/16 Din PMA KS40, KS41, KS42 1/8, 1/4 Din PMA KS90, KS92 1/8, 1/4 Din PMA KS98 1/4 Din PMA/West Blue Control software
278
Din-Rail temperatrure & process controllers PMA Rail line converters and bus couplers PMA KS45 universal controller
282
Temperature Controllers
ET thermostats
• • • •
Digital thermostats PID or on-off control with digital display PT100, thermocouple or NTC sensor input Flexible outputs
Technical data Series:
Key features
ET2011
ET2411
ET2412
Selectable dual set point
Single NTC input
Single NTC input
Auto PID Tune
Adjustable setpoint limits
Independent Alarm types
Soft Start feature
Selectable Sensor fail state
Selectable Sensor fail state
Zero point input shift
Zero point input shift
Zero point input shift
Thermocouple (J,K,T,S,R) or PT100
NTCH (-60 to 150°C)
NTCH (-60 to 150°C)
Relay Outputs SSR Output
9-30 V DC, 7/24 V AC, 110 V AC, 230 V AC (see order no.) 1 (8A or 16A/P Version) 1 (20mA @12V)
12/24 V AC/DC, 230 V AC (see order no.) 1 ( xx = 5A, 8A or 16A) -
12/24 V AC/DC, 230 V AC (see order no.) 2 (8A) -
Control Type
On/Off, PID, Dual set point
On/Off
On/Off
Control strategy Hysteresis Accuracy Display Dimensions (wxhxd) Protection level
Heat or Cool Adjustable 1 - 50°C 0.5 % of full scale, ±1 digit 4 -digits , 12.5mm, Red 77 x 35 x 71mm IP65 front , IP20 Rear
Heat or Cool Adjustable 0.1 - 20°C ±1 °C 4 -digits , 12.5mm, Red 77 x 35 x 61mm IP65 front , IP20 Rear
Heat or Cool Adjustable 0.1 - 20°C ±1 °C 4 -digits , 12.5mm, Red 77 x 35 x 61mm IP65 front , IP20 Rear
Sensor Type Supply voltage
Ordering guide Order number
Description
Supply voltage
ET2011T-230
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, J, K, T, S, R type sensor
230VAC
ET2011T-110
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, J, K, T, S, R type sensor
110VAC
ET2011T-024
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, J, K, T, S, R type sensor
24VAC
ET2011T-012
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, J, K, T, S, R type sensor
12VAC
ET2011T-SM
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, J, K, T, S, R type sensor
9-30VDC/7-24VAC
ET2011RT-230
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, PT100 sensor
230VAC
ET2011RT-110
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, PT100 sensor
110VAC
ET2011RT-024
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, PT100 sensor
24VAC
ET2011RT-012
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, PT100 sensor
12VAC
ET2011RTSM
Digital thermostat, relay, SSR output, PT100 sensor
9-30VDC/7-24VAC
ET2411-230-xx
Digital thermostat, relay output, NTCH sensor
230VAC
ET2411-024-xx
Digital thermostat, relay output, NTCH sensor
24VAC/DC
Digital thermostat, relay output, NTCH sensor
12VAC/DC
ET2411-012-xx ET2412-230
Digital thermostat, two relay outputs, NTCH sensor
230VAC
ET2412-024
Digital thermostat, two relay outputs, NTCH sensor
24VAC/DC
Digital thermostat, two relay outputs, NTCH sensor
12VAC/DC
ET2412-012 ENTCH-APS-1.5S
Sensor, air probe, max. 150°C stainless steel shell, 1.5m silicone cable
-
ENTCH-LPS-1.5S
Sensor, liquid probe, max. 150°C stainless steel shell, 1.5m silicone cable
-
264 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
N2300 1/32 DIN indicator and controller
• • • •
Red or green display Two process alarms Manual or easy tune Setpoint lock
Overview The West 2300 is available as an indicator or controller. Small size does not come at the expense of features, they have large 10mm high displays, 2 amp
relays and full 3-wire PT100 inputs. The controller features our hands-free Easy Tune PID algorithm.
Specification Features: Functions: Control types: Setpoint lock: Output configuration: Alarm 1 & 2 types: Human interface: Input: Thermocouple: RTD: DC linear:
Three term PID controller, indicator with alarms or indicator only versions available Controller versions have PID with easy-tune, manual tuning plus pre-tune or on-off control Limits operator access to the controller setpoint value Up to 3 total. Max 1 for control, max 2 for alarms Process high, process low, setpoint deviation and band 3 button operation, 4 digit 10mm high LED display (available in either red or green), plus on-control, set-up, alarm and setpoint indicators J, K, R, S, T, B, & N 3 wire PT100, 50Ω per lead maximum (balanced) 0-20mA, 4-20mA, 0-50mV, 10-50mV. Scaleable -1999 to 9999, decimal point as required
Impedance: Accuracy: Sampling: Sensor break detection: Outputs & operations: Control & alarm relays: Control SSR outputs: Communications: Front panel protection: Dimensions:
>10MΩ for thermocouple and mV ranges, 4.7Ω for mA ranges +/- 0.1% of input span (0.25% for J & T T/C) +/- 1 LSD (T/C CJC better than 0.7°C) 4 per second, 14 bit resolution approximately <2 seconds (except on 0-20mA range), control O/P’s turn off, high alarms activate for T/C and mV ranges, low alarms activate for RTD, mA ranges Contacts SPDT 2 amp resistive at 240V AC, >500,000 operations (if comms or 2nd relay is fitted, all relay contacts become SPST) Drive capability >10V DC into 500Ω minimum 2 wire RS485, 1200 to 9600 Baud, Modbus IEC IP66 (behind panel protection is IP20) 49 x 25 x 100mm
Part number key N2300 Output type: Indicator only Indicator + alarm 1 (relay) Indicator + alarm 1 (SSR) Controller (relay) + alarm 1 (SSR) Controller (SSR) + alarm 1 (relay) Option: No option fitted Alarm 2 relay output RS485 comms Display colour & power supply: Green display/100-240V AC supply Red display/100-240V AC supply Green display/12-30VDC/24VAC supply Red display/12-30VDC 24VAC supply
0116 284 9900
XX
X
X
00 01 02 12 21 0 1 2 0 1 2 3
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 265
Temperature controllers 3300, 9400, 9500P
• • • •
Self-tuning of all PID parameters Clear display, intensive digits Well-arranged, easy-to-understand menu system Communication to PC for configuration/logging
Technical data Supply voltage: Sensor types: Temperature range: Display range for 9500P with linear input signal: Calibration accuracy: Sampling frequency: Temperature coefficient: Reference conditions: LED display: Display shows:
100-240 V 50-60 Hz ±10 %, 4-5 VA 12-24 V (AC/DC) ±20 %, 4 VA (9400 and 9500P only have 100-240 V) - PT100 - Thermocouples J, K, N, R, S, T, E, L, B - Linear signals 4-20 mA, 0-10 V -200 °C to +1800 °C, see applicable sensor type -199 to 9999 (scalable) ±0.25 % of full scale ±1 °C Input signal 10 Hz, CJC 2 sec 150 ppm/°C of sensor range Of supply voltage +22 °C ±2 °C, min. 15 minute connection Resolution 1/0.1 green light with high brightness Four digits, 10mm high, Models 9400 and 9500P also show the set point value in 9mm orange digits - Actual value, set point value - Output status flashing LEDs - Error messages, functions/values
Memory: Relay output: SSD output: Analogue output (9500P):
Protection class: Ambient temperature: Moisture stability: Approvals: CE-marked according to: Connection: Enclosure: Weight:
10 years without supply voltage (EEPROM) 2 A, 250 V AC, resistive load for models with two relay outputs, relay 1: 2 A, relay 2: 1 A, 250 V AC 9500: all relays are 2 A/250 V AC resistive load 5 V +0/-15 %, max. 15 mA, non-isolated non-isolated 9500P: 6 V +0/-15 %, max. 20 mA, 4-20 mA, ±0.1 % of full scale, max. 500 Ω 0-5 V ±0.1 % of full scales, max. 10 mA, 500 Ω min. 1000 Ω 0-10 V ±0.1 % of full scale, max. 10 mA, 500 Ω IP66 at front 0 °C to +50 °C (32 to +130 °F) Max. 80 % RH, non-condensing UL, CSA EN50081-1, EN50082-2, EN61010 Screw terminal, controller extendable from case Flame retardant polycarbonate 3300: 110g, 9400: 130g, 9500P: 180g
Program function, capacity 9500P Function/data • Up to 31 programs can be saved • The program can consist of max. 126 segments (program steps) • Outputs can be controlled by events in the program • Terms such as Copy, Paste, Edit, Delete are used on the display • Call underlying programs into a “running” program • Loop function; the program restarts • Hold back; the program “stops” before the next segment starts • In the event of a power outage; hold, continue or reset • Memory use indication during programming NOTE! The number of stored programs and the size per program is restricted by the controller’s total memory capacity (351 Bytes). Different segments take up different amounts of memory capacity. Used bytes per function added to give a total “bytes used” per program.
Function Program Ramp Ramp + “Hold back” Soak time Step (change set point value) Loops (1-3) Loop (4 -) Call up program Event output
Bytes 1 4 5 2 3 1 2 1 1
Dimensions 3300
9400/9500/9500P
Cut-outs Panel size 24 x 48mm Width 45mm + 0.6-0.0mm Height 22.2mm + 0.3mm-0.0mm Maximum panel thickness 9.5mm (3300 is not polarity dependent at 12-24 V DC supply voltage.)
Cut-outs Panel size 48 x 48mm Width 45mm + 0.6-0.0mm Height 45mm + 0.6mm-0.0mm Maximum panel thickness 9.5mm
266 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
Order number The following models are those normally stocked, other combinations with regard to e.g. outputs and interfaces are stocked in limited numbers or are ordered on request. Type Temperature controller 3300 24 x 48mm
Temperature controller 9400 48 x 48mm
Process/program controller 9500P 48 x 48mm
NOTE! All controllers in these series can be purchased with a communication card. Third digit from the end of the order number identifies the type. A dash signifies no communication.
Order number
Outputs
Input signal
Communication
CAL33000000
SSD/relay
standard*
-
Supply voltage 100-240 V AC
CAL33000003
SSD/relay
standard*
-
12-24 V AC/DC
CAL33000020
SSD/relay
standard*
RS232
100-240 V AC
CAL33000040
SSD/relay
standard*
RS485
100-240 V AC
CAL33110000
relay/relay
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL33110040
relay/relay
standard*
RS485
100-240 V AC
CAL94000000
SSD/relay
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL94000040
SSD/relay
standard*
RS485
100-240 V AC
CAL94110000
relay/relay
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL94220000
SSD/SSD
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL94220040
SSD/SSD
standard*
RS485
100-240 V AC
CAL95001PA00
SSD/relay/relay
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL95001PA40
SSD/relay/relay
standard*
RS485
100-240 V AC
CAL95111PA00
three relays
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL95111PA40
three relays
standard*
RS485
100-240 V AC
CAL95111PB00
three relays
4-20 mA
-
100-240 V AC
CAL95B11PA00
4-20 mA/2 x relay
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL95D11PA00
0-10 V/2 x relay
standard*
-
100-240 V AC
CAL95B11PB00
4-20 mA/2 x relay
4-20 mA
-
100-240 V AC
*With standard input signal means; PT100, thermocouple and mV-input. 3300, 9400 and 9500 always have this version. 9500P with analogue input signal (0-20/4-20 mA, 0-10 V) can only be used for the selected (ordered) signal, e.g. 0-10 V.
CAL1R
Resistor (1 Ω, 1 %) for linear input signal 4-20 mA (or 0-20 mA)
CAL681R
Resistor R1, (681 Ω, 1 %) for linear input signal 0-10 V
CAL340KR
Resistor R2, (340 kΩ, 1 %) for linear input signal 0-10 V
All controllers with “Standard” input signal can be adapted using the resistors below to receive 0-20 mA, 4-20 mA or 0-10 V. See the Connection tab above.
Accessories Plastic bezels for series 8000, 9900, 9300, 9400 and 9500P for other cut-outs 96 x 48mm hole cut-out
96 x 96mm hole cut-out
Bracket for mounting in cabinets or on DIN rails. Hole cut-out 45 x 45mm
NOTE! When the controllers are mounted in an adapter the stated protection class is not met. CAL 3300 can be mounted in a 48 x 48-hole by using adapter no. 26546830. Order number 904.200
Description Panel adapter, 48 x 48 to 48 x 96
904.400
Panel adapter, 48 x 48 to 96 x 96
1574009
Bracket for 48 x 48mm instrument
AX2-DL01
0116 284 9900
DIN rail adapter 44 x 65mm TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 267
Temperature controllers CALgrafix
• • • •
Process and monitoring software Charting and logging for PV, SP and % power Lower cost alternative to SCADA Simple set-up
Area of use CAL Controls software CALgrafix is for the controller series 3300, 9300, 9400, 9500 and 9500P. This can be used to program the controllers, but also as a freestanding program for general process monitoring. Here follows a brief presentation, contact OEM Automatic, product area Temperature for additional information.
Program control, series 9500P CALgrafix supports the program function in 9500P with very high user-friendliness (ramping, soak time, recipe handling etc.). Program profiles are created through “click-and-drag” and by doing so creating the required control profile. When this has been done values and times can be adjusted to the required function.
Example of functions • Click on the selected instrument to change set point values or configuration • Copy an instrument’s settings to another, e.g. when commissioning mould jets with several zones • Up to 128 instruments can be connected simultaneously • Save one or more controllers’ settings in files (recipe handling) • Printer function direct on the PC screen • Logging/screen dump in real time of temperature or other measurement values up to 12 measurement values per diagram • Storage of measured loggings in log files • Adjustable scale for measurement values/time, adjustable log frequency • Configuration, copying of settings • “Recipe handling” in files • Logging of selectable parameters as actual/set point values, output power in % alarm indications • Time controlled logging function • Simplified programming of ramps/soak times etc. for 9500P and CALogix (“drag and drop”) • List of settings per controller • OPC compatible, connection in network • Monitoring of non-CAL clients too (via OPC) • Audio files (.wav) can be imported for audible alarms • Interconnection of several networks • Digital photos (bitmap) can be imported and used as a background • Logging can be scaled to be able to show different units, e.g. pressure and temperature
The instrument is mounted on machines or other measurement position at the “factory site” where the machine operator can see process values or set point values and can directly via the buttons set another set point value or another configuration. CAL’s instruments are primarily designed for temperature control, but can also as here be used for measurement, control or monitoring of all applicable process signals where the signal source is 0-20/4-20 mA or 0-10 V. In addition to heating control via contactors or solid state relays there is also an analogue output on 9500P. This can control e.g. a frequency converter to control a speed, a pump or a proportional valve which in turn can control e.g. humidity level, pressure, etc.
Example of displays in CALgrafix
RS485/RS232 converter
°C Oil temperature
BAR
A
V
%RH
Hydraulic pressure
Current
Voltage
Humidity
Sensor
Order number
Analogue output ex.4-20 mA
Description: For communication
1003GB000
CALgrafix Professional, software for CAL’s controllers and other clients/servers, with OPC-server
3C25000K3
Adapter RS232 to RS485
268 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
Hz Speed
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers RE55 - Analogue set temperature controller
• • • • •
Large knob & pointer for easy setting of setpoint Relay or transistor control output Alarm output option Programming push button option Password protection
Part number key RE55
Technical data Inputs fixed: RTD: Pt100 Thermocouple: J, K, S type Control type: On/off or PID with autotune Outputs fixed: Relay control: 1 x CO contacts 2A , 230V a.c Binary: 1 x 0/5V SSR control Relay alarm: 1 x NO contact - 1A, 230VAC - optional Display: 4 x 10mm LED digits Dimensions: 96 x 96 x 65mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253V ac/dc, 40-440Hz
Input: Pt100/1.3850 -50..100°C 0..100°C 0..150°C 0..250°C 0..400°C 0..600°C Fe-CuNi (J) 0..250°C 0..400°C 0..600°C 0..900°C NiCr-NiAl (K) 0..600°C 0..900°C 0..1300°C PtRh10-Pt (S) 0..1600°C Option: On/Off controller PID controller configurable controller with push-buttons Control output: relay voltage 0/5 V
RE71 - Basic single output controller
• • • •
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs fixed: RTD: Pt100 Thermocouple: J, K, S type Control type: On/Off or PID with autotune Outputs fixed: Relay: 1x relay, NO contacts 5A , 230V a.c Binary output: 0/6V for SSR Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 93mm Protection level: IP65 front Supply voltage: 230V a.c ±10%, 50/60Hz
0116 284 9900
XX
X
X
00
8
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 1 2 3 1 2
Single output Simple operation Relay or binary output 230VAC - only
RE71 Input signal: RTD Pt100 (-50...100°C) RTD Pt100 (0...250°C) RTD Pt100 (0...600°C) Thermocouple J (Fe-CuNi)(0...250°C) Thermocouple J (Fe-CuNi)(0...600°C) Thermocouple J (Fe-CuNi)(0...900°C) Thermocouple K (NiCr-NiAl)(0...600°C) Thermocouple K (NiCr-NiAl)(0...900°C) Thermocouple K (NiCr-NiAl)(0...1300°C) Thermocouple S (PtRh10-Pt)(0...1600°C) Output: relay binary 0/6 V for SSR control
XX
X
00
E
0
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 1 2
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 269
Temperature controllers
RE22 – Compact single output controller
• • • •
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs programmable: RTD: Pt100, PT1000 Thermocouple: J, K, S, T, R, E, B, N, L-type Current: 0/4…20mA 0…5/10V dc Voltage: Control type: On/Off or PID with autotune Outputs fixed: 1x relay, NO contacts 5A , 230V a.c Relay: Binary output: 0/5V for SSR Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 93mm Protection level: IP65 front Supply voltage: 230VAC, 110VAC or 24VAC
RE72 - Compact 3 output controller
Universal input Simple operation Relay or binary output Soft start function
RE22 Input: universal for RTD and TC sensors
X
X
00
8
1 2
universal linear: - current: 0/4..20 mA - voltage: 0..5/10V Output: relay binary 0/5 V for SSR control Supply: 230 V 50/60 Hz 110 V 50/60 Hz 24 V 50/60 Hz
• • • • • •
X
1 2 1 2 3
Universal input Binary input control Timer function Remote setpoint input Simple profiler RS-485 Modbus as standard
Part number key RE72 X
Technical data Inputs programmable: RTD: Pt100, PT1000 Thermocouple: J, K, S, T, R, E, B, N, L-type Current: 0/4…20mA 0…5/10V dc Voltage: Control type: On/Off, PID with autotune, step valve control Outputs fixed: Relay: 2x NO contacts 2A , 230V a.c, O/P 1 & 2 1 x NO contact 1A, 230V a.c, O/P 3 Binary output: 0/5V for SSR Outputs programmable: Current: 0/4..20mA 0-10V d.c Voltage: Auxiliary supply output: 24V d.c/1W - optional Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU Display: 2 x 4 digit, 10mm, red & green Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 93mm Protection level: IP65 front Supply voltage: 85…253V ac/dc, 20…40V ac/dc
270 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
Output 1: relay voltage: 0/5 V continuous current: 0/4 .. 20 mA continuous voltage: 0 .. 10 V Output 2: relay voltage: 0/5 V continuous current: 0/4 .. 20 mA continuous voltage: 0 .. 10 V Options: none output 3 - relay binary input current transformer input additional current input: 0/4 .. 20 mA transducer supply: 24 V d.c. 1 W Supply: 85 .. 253 V a.c./ d.c. 20 .. 40 V a.c./ d.c.
X
X
X
00
E
0
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 0 1 2 3 4 5 1 2
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
P6100, P8100, P4100, temperature and process controllers
• • • •
Jumperless configuration Auto detected hardware Process and loop alarms Modbus and ASCII comms
Overview With their improved interface, technical functionality and field flexibility, the WEST 6100, 8100 and 4100 give you the best comprehensive control for most temperature and process control loops.
They have a universal input and are available with a red and green displays. Plug-in modules allow up to 2 alarm relays (latching or non-latching), PV retransmission, remtote set point (RSP) or transmitter PSU.
Specification Sensor break detection:
Control types:
Full PID with pre-tune, self-tune, manual tuning, or on-off control. Heat only or heat & cool. Selectable from front panel or via digital input, with Auto/manual: bumpless transfer. Output configuration: Up to 3 possible, for control, alarm, 24VDC transmitter power supply or retransmit of process value or setpoint. Alarm 1 & 2 types: Process high, process low, SP deviation, band, logical OR / AND. Also 1 loop alarm for process control security. Process alarms have adjustable hysteresis. 4 button operation, dual 4 digit 10mm & 8mm high Human interface: (6100+, 8100+) and 13mm & 10mm high (4100+) LED displays PC configuration: Off-line configuration from PC serial port to dedicated config socket Input: Thermocouple: J, K, C, R, S, T, B, L, N & PtRh20%vsPtRh40%. RTD: 3 Wire PT100, 50Ω per lead maximum (balanced) 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA, 0 to 50mV, 10 to 50mV, 0 to 5V, DC linear: 1 to 5V, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V. Scaleable -1999 to 9999, with adjustable decimal point Impedance: >10MΩ for Thermocouple and mV ranges, 47KΩ for V ranges and 5Ω for mA ranges Accuracy: ±0.1% of input range ±1 LSD (T/C CJC better than 1°C) Sampling: 4 per second, 14 bit resolution approximately
<2 seconds (except zero based DC ranges), control O/P’s turn off. High alarms activate for T/C and mV ranges, Low alarms activate for RTD, mA or V ranges Outputs & operations: Control & alarm relays: Contacts SPDT 2 Amp resistive at 240V AC Control SSR Drive capability >10V DC in 500 Ω minimum driver outputs: 0.01 to 1 Amp AC, 20 to 280Vrms, 47 to 63Hz Triac outputs: DC linear outputs: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA into 500Ω max, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V, 0 to 5V into 500Ω min. Control outputs have 2% over/under drive applied. Accuracy ±0.25% at 250Ω (degrades linearly to 0.5% for increasing burden to specified limits) Transmitter Output 24VDC (nominal) into 910Ω minimum to power power supply: external devices 2 Wire RS485, 1200 to 19200 Baud, Modbus and ASCII Communications: protocol (selectable) Digital input: Selects between 2 setpoints or auto/manual control. Volt free or TTL input Remote setpoint input: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA, 0 to 5V, 1 to 5V, 0 to 10V or 2 to 10V. Scaleable -1999 to 9999. Local/remote setpoint selected from front panel Front panel protection: IEC IP66 (behind panel protection is IP20) Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 110mm (P6100), 48 x 96 x 100mm (P8100), 96 x 96 x 100mm (P4100)
Part number key P6100/P4100/P8100 Input type: 3 wire RTD or DC mV Thermocouple DC mA DC Voltage Option slot 1: Not fitted Relay DC for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac Option slot 2: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac
0116 284 9900
X
X
X
X
X
X
1 2 3 4
X
X 0 R
0 1 2 3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
0 2 0 1 3 4 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Option slot B (not on 6100:) Not fitted Remote setpoint input (full) Display colour: Red upper & lower Green upper & lower Red upper, green lower Green upper, red lower Power supply: 100-240V AC 24-48V AC or DC Option slot A: Not fitted RS485 communications Digital input Remote setpoint input (basic) Option slot 3: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Transmitter power supply TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 271
Temperature controllers
P6170, P8170, P4170 valve motor controller
• • • •
Jumperless configuration Auto detected hardware Process and loop alarms Modbus comms
Overview The new Plus Series VMD Controllers (6170, 8170, 4170) have been specifically designed for open loop valve motor drive applications and feature the improved
Plus Series interface and greater field flexibility.
Specification Control types: Valve control: Auto/manual:
Full PID with pre-tune, self-tune and manual tuning modes Open loop valve motor drive Selectable from front panel or via digital input, with bumpless transfer Output configuration: Up to 4 possible, two required for valve control, additional outputs for alarm, 24VDC transmitter power supply or retransmit of process value or setpoint Alarm 1 & 2 types: Process high, process low, SP deviation, band, logical OR / AND. Also 1 loop alarm for process control security. Process alarms have adjustable hysteresis Human interface: 4 button operation, dual 4 digit 10mm & 8mm (6170+ and 8170+) and 13mm & 10mm (4170+) high LED displays PC configuration: Off-line configuration from PC serial port to dedicated configuration socket Input: Thermocouple: J, K, C, R, S, T, B, L, N & PtRh20%vsPtRh40% RTD: 3 Wire PT100, 50Ω per lead maximum (balanced) DC linear: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA, 0 to 50mV, 10 to 50mV, 0 to 5V, 1 to 5V, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V. Scaleable -1999 to 9999, with adjustable decimal point >10MΩ for Thermocouple and mV ranges, 47KΩ for V Impedance: ranges and 5Ω for mA ranges Accuracy: ±0.1% of input range ±1 LSD (T/C CJC better than 1°C) Sampling: 4 per second, 14 bit resolution approximately
Sensor break detection: Outputs & options: Control & & alarm relays: Control SSR driver outputs: Triac outputs: DC linear outputs:
<2 seconds (except zero based DC ranges), control O/P’s turn off, high alarms activate for T/C and mV ranges, low alarms activate for RTD, mA or V ranges Contacts SPDT 2 Amp resistive at 240V AC (120V AC max for direct VMD) Drive capability >10V DC in 500 Ωminimum 0.01 to 1 Amp AC, 20 to 280Vrms, 47 to 63Hz. 140V max for direct VMD 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA into 500Ω max, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V, 0 to 5V into 500Ω min. Accuracy ±0.25% at 250Ω (degrades linearly to 0.5% for increasing burden to specified limits) Retransmit of PV or SP only
Transmitter power supply:
Output 24VDC (nominal) into 910Ω minimum to power external devices Communications: 2 Wire RS485, 1200 to 19200 Baud, Modbus protocol Digital input: Selects between 2 setpoints or auto/manual control. Volt free or TTL input Remote setpoint: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA, 0 to 5V, 1 to 5V, 0 to 10V or 2 to 10V. Scaleable -1999 to 9999 Auxiliary input: For valve position indication or remote setpoint input Front panel protection: IEC IP66 (behind panel protection is IP20) Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 110mm (P6170), 48 x 96 x 100mm (P8170), 96 x 96 x 100mm (P4170)
Part number key P6170/P4170/P8170 Input type: 3 wire RTD or DC mV Thermocouple DC mA DC voltage Option slot 1: Not fitted Relay DC for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac Option slot 2: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac Dual relay
272 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
X
X
X
X
X
X
1 2 3 4
X
X 0 R
0 1 2 3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
0 2 0 1 3 4 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Option slot B (not on 6170): Not fitted Auxiliary input (full) Display colour: Red upper & lower Green upper & lower Red upper, green lower Green upper, red lower Power supply: 100-240V AC 24-48V AC or DC Option slot A: Not fitted RS485 communications Digital input Auxiliary input (basic) Option slot 3: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Transmitter power supply Dual relay
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
P6700, P8700, P4700 alarm unit (Policeman)
• • • •
High or low trip points 5 amp latching limit relay Remote reset option Exceed and relay indicators
Overview The West range of 6700, 4700 and 8700 have a programmable safety cut out with optional outputs for annunciators and alarms. A latched relay cuts power to your process if safe values are exceeded. These units must be reset before the
process can continue. They have the improved Plus Series hardware and user interface for optimal ease of use.
Specification Features: Output configuration: Up to 3 possible, for latching trip relays, alarm/annuncator relays, 24VDC transmitter power supply or retransmit of process value or limit trip setpoint Alarm 1 & 2 types: Process high, process low, Limit SP deviation, band, logical OR alarms or trip annunciator. Alarms have fully adjustable hysteresis Output reset action: Limit output can be reset only when exceed condition is absent. Local or remote reset options Annunciator reset action: Annunciator output can be reset at any time. Local or remote reset options Human interface: 4 button operation, dual 4 digit 10mm & 8mm (6700+ & 8700+), 13mm & 10mm (4700+) high LED displays PC configuration: Off-line configuration from PC serial port to dedicated config socket Input: Thermocouple: J, K, C, R, S, T, B, L, N & PtRh20%vsPtRh40% RTD: 3 wire PT100, 50Ω per lead maximum (balanced) DC linear: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA, 0 to 50mV, 10 to 50mV, 0 to 5V, 1 to 5V, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V. Scaleable -1999 to 9999, with adjustable decimal point Impedance: >10MΩ for thermocouple and mV ranges, 47KΩ for V ranges and 5Ω for mA ranges Accuracy: ±0.1% of input range ±1 LSD (T/C CJC better than 1°C) Sampling: 4 per second, 14 bit resolution approximately
Sensor break detection: Outputs & options: Limit trip relay outputs: Alarm relay outputs:
<2 secs (except zero based DC ranges), limit trip and annunciators activate. High alarms activate for temperature and mV ranges, low alarms activate for, mA or V ranges
Latching SPDT, contacts 5Amp resistive Non-latching SPDT, contacts 2Amp resistive at 240V AC, >500,000 operations
SSR driver alarm outputs: Drive capability >10V DC in 50Ω minimum Triac alarm outputs: 0.01 to 1 Amp AC, 20 to 280Vrms, 47 to 63Hz DC linear retransmit outputs: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA into 500Ω max, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V, 0 to 5V into 500Ω min. Accuracy ±0.25% at 250Ω (degrades linearly to 0.5% for increasing burden to specified limits) Transmitter power supply: Output 24VDC (nominal) into 910Ω minimum to power external devices Communications: 2 Wire RS485, 1200 to 19200 Baud, Modbus and ASCII protocol (selectable) Digital input: Volt free or TTL input. -0.6 to 0.8V or contact closure resets latched relays and annunciators Front panel protection: IEC IP66 (Behind panel protection is IP20) Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 110mm (P6700), 48 x 98 x 100mm (P8700), 98 x 98 x 100mm (P4700)
Part number key P6700/P4700/P8700 Input type: 3 wire RTD or DC mV Thermocouple DC mA DC voltage Option slot 1: Latching limit relay (fixed) Option slot 2: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac
0116 284 9900
X
X
X
X
X
X
1 2 3 4
X 0 1 2 3
1
0 2 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
0 1 3 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Display colour: Red upper & lower Green upper & lower Red upper, green lower Green upper, red lower Power supply: 100-240V AC 24-48V AC or DC Option slot A: Not fitted RS485 communications Digital input Option slot 3: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Transmitter power supply
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 273
Temperature controllers
P6010 and P8010 panel indicator
• • • •
Jumperless configuration Auto detected hardware Up to 4 alarm outputs Modbus and ASCII comms
Overview The 6010 and 8010 have multi-point scaling, tare function and improved flexibility. They have a universal input and are available with a red of green or colour change display (P8010 only).
Plug-in modules allow up to four alarm relays (latching or non-latching), PV retransmission or transmitter PSU.
Specification Features: Output configuration: Up to 4 total. Max 3 single/1 dual relay, max 1 retransmit of PV, max 1 transmitter power supply Up to 5. Process high low or logical OR (direct or reverse Alarms: acting). With adjustable hysteresis Viewable values: Process variable, maximum value, minimum value and alarm 1 elapsed time since reset Human interface: 3 button operation, 4 digit 10mm (6010) or 13mm (8010) high red or green display, plus 3 alarm 1 max and 1 min indicator PC configuration: Off-line configuration from PC serial port to dedicated config socket Input: Thermocouple: J, K, C, R, S, T, B, L, N & PtRh20%vsPtRh40%. RTD: 3 Wire PT100, 50Ω per lead maximum (balanced) DC linear: 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA, 0 to 50mV, 10 to 50mV, 0 to 5V, 1 to 5V, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V. Scaleable -1999 to 9999, with adjustable decimal point Impedance: >10MΩ for thermocouple and mV ranges, 47KΩ for V ranges and 5Ω for mA ranges Accuracy: ±0.1% of input range ±1 LSD (T/C CJC better than 1°C) 4 per second, 14 bit resolution approximately Sampling:
Outputs & options: Single alarm relays: Dual alarm relays: SSR driver outputs: Triac outputs: DC linear retransmit outputs:
Contacts SPDT 2 Amp resistive at 240V AC Two x SPST contacts with shared common. 2 Amp resistive at 240V AC Drive capability >10V DC in 500 Ω minimum 0.01 to 1 Amp AC, 20 to 280Vrms, 47 to 63Hz 0 to 20mA, 4 to 20mA into 500Ω max, 0 to 10V, 2 to 10V, 0 to 5V into 500Ω min. Accuracy ±0.25% at 250Ω (degrades linearly to 0.5% for increasing burden to specified limits)
Transmitter power supply:
Output 24VDC (nominal) into 910Ω minimum to power external devices Communications: 2 Wire RS485, 1200 to 19200 Baud, Modbus and ASCII protocol (selectable) Digital input: External reset of latched relay, stored alarm 1 elapsed time, stored min/max PV values or initiate tare function. Volt free or TTL input Front panel protection: IEC IP66 (behind panel protection is IP20) Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 110mm (P6010), 96 x 48 x 100mm (P8010)
Part number key P6010/P8010 Input type: 3 wire RTD or DC mV Thermocouple DC mA DC voltage Option slot 1: Not fitted Relay DC for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac Option slot 2: Not fitted Relay DC driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Triac Dual relay
274 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
X
X
X
X
X
X
1 2 3 4
X 0 1 4
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
0 2
0 1 3
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Display colour: Fixed red Fixed green Red/green colour change (P8010 only) Power supply: 100-240V AC 24-48V AC or DC Option slot A: Not fitted RS485 communications Digital input Option slot 3: Not fitted Relay DC Driver for SSR DC 0-10V DC 0-20mA DC 0-5V DC 2-10V DC 4-20mA Transmitter power supply Dual relay
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
RE92 dual loop controller
• • • •
Simple and user friendly Universal separated measuring inputs SMART PID algorithm Digital communication RS-485 (standard), Ethernet (option)
Description The RE92 is an advanced dual loop controller for industrial use. It was designed for demanding industrial applications. RE92 can control two controlled objects independently or control two physical values in one object (e.g. in the two-zone furnaces). Thanks to the universal measuring inputs, it can be used for controlling of temperature and other physical values (e.g. pressure, humidity). Every user can update controller’s software individually, thus getting access to the additional features added by the LUMEL development team.
Intuitive and user-friendly interface • 3.5” full-colour graphic screen with luminosity control • menu available in English • password-protected regulator access (4 users, 3 access levels) • signaling a state of binary inputs and two-state outputs Reliable control with fixed set-point • 4 set point values switchable by the binary inputs (for each loop) • soft-start function for set point values change, programmable increase/ decrease • also an additional input may serve as the source of set point value (input 3)
Modern control functions • independent dual loop control • PID control, on/off, three-step control of heating-cooling, and step-by--step control • innovative SMART PID algorithm with auto-tuning function (automatic selection of PID parameters) • the source of control signal is one of the two inputs or the sum/difference of the signal from two inputs combined • 4 sets of PID parameters and additional set for cooling (for each loop) • 6 types of alarm with programmable hysteresis and memory (latch function) • digital communication - RS-485 (standard), Ethernet (option) • Gain Scheduling feature - automatic PID set switching, depending on the set temperature (when the object behaves decidedly differently in various temperatures)
Advanced programming control • 20 internal programs (10 programs per loop) • 15 units per program • signaling up to 6 events per unit (two-state outputs) • selection of PID parameters for any unit • iterations number setting (up to 9999 repetitions)
Technical data Digital interface: Interface type, protocol: Mode Baud rate RS-485, MODBUS RTU: 8N2, 8E1, 8O1, 8N1 2400, 4800,9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 bit/s Ethernet, MODBUS TCP Slave: External features: Readout field: colour display 320 x 240 pixels TFT 3,5’’ Dimensions: 96 x 96 x 100mm Weight: < 0.5 kg Protection level: IP65 front Rated operating conditions: Supply voltage: 85...253 V a.c./d.c. frequency: 40...50...440 Hz
Inputs: Programmable: Universal main inputs 1 and 2 RTD: Pt100, Pt500, Pt1000 Thermocouple: Ni100, Cu100, J, K, S, T, R, B, E, N-type Current (I): 0/4 ... 20 mA Voltage (U): 0 ... 5/10 V DC linear: 0+20.0 mA 4-20mA, 0-5v, 0-10v Additional input: 0-20mA, 4-20mA, 0-5v, 0-10v 0-100Ω/1000Ω Outputs: Output type: Properties Remarks Relay: 6/4 outputs switching contacts, 2 A/ 230 V Voltage transistor: 0/2 outputs 0/5 V (Imax = 20 mA) Continuous voltage: 0...2 outputs 0...10 V, Rload > _1 k Ω Continuous current: 0...2 outputs 0/4...20 mA, Rload < _ 500 Ω
Part number key RE92 Input 3: none current: 0/4...20 mA voltage: 0...5/10 V potentiometer transmitter: 100/1000 Ω Output 1 and 2: 2 relays 2 binary outputs 0/5 V
0116 284 9900
X
X
X
0 1 2 3
X
X 0 1
0 1 1 2
0 1
00
E
0 Transducer supply: none 24 V d.c. Ethernet: none with Ethernet Analog outputs: none 2 continuous 0/4...20 mA and 0...10 V TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 275
Temperature controllers
PRO-EC44 Dual loop controller
• • • • •
One or two control loops Graphical/text LCD display Datalogger with RTC USB configuration and data access BlueControl software configurable
Description Pro-EC44 is a 1/4 DIN process controller with graphical text display, advanced control capability and modular I/O options providing flexibility to fit wide range of industrial manufacturing and process applications. Fast and easy front panel setup for both for simple and advanced control tasks Pro-EC44 simplifies user setup with a step by step wizard configuration saving working through several menus for initial setup. A Logical menu structure for intuitive navigation allows fast changes and updates to individual settings. Configure controllers without connecting to a PC Configuration files can be downloaded to a controller using a flash memory stick via the front USB port allowing for fast programming. Settings can also be read via the USB port to clone additional devices or configure a replacement. Datalog files can also be extracted locally via the USB for convenient access of process data. Easy access user operation The Pro-EC44 pages are formatted to show users important process information on a single page, minimising the steps to access data and settings. A colour change green/red LED backlight provides easily recognisable alarm indication to improve response times for corrective action. Comprehensive control… and much more. Pro-EC44 includes many features to ensure good control performance on a wide
range of applications. Single or dual loop capability in a single device, cascade, valve and ratio enhanced control with support features such as real time clock, timer, gain scheduling and profiler ensure Pro-EC44 has the flexibility for a process system needs. In addition datalogging, trending, USB, Ethernet options add even more capability to an already powerful device. Fast configuration via configuration interface. Direct access for programming is available via a top of controller connection port. The interface provides easy and fast access with Blue Control software to configure the controller or drilldown into process issues with minimal disruption. Key features: • ON/OFF, PID heat only & heat/cool, valve motor drive, ratio cascade control • 5 PID sets manual or automatic gain scheduling • 7 alarms – absolute, deviation, rate of change, sensor break, recorder memory, power • 255 segment profiler shared in 64 programs • Ethernet – Modbus TCP, RS485 - Modbus RTU (master/slave) • Up to to 2 analogue inputs, 9 outputs, remote setpoint input, 9 digital inputs
Technical data Supply voltage: 100-240V 50/60Hz, 20VA 24..48AC/DC (20-48V ac, 50/60Hz, 15VA, 22-65V dc, 12W) Input signal 1/2: Pt100 Thermocouples L, J, K, N, S, R, T, C, D, E, B-type Linear, 0/4…20mA, 0…5/10V, 0…50mV Digital inputs: Contact input 2…24V dc.-0.6…0.8V Logic/Inv Logic or Volt free Display: 160 x 80 pixel monochrome, green/Red backlight Outputs: CO, 2A@ 250VAC Relay option 1-3: Dual relay option 2-3: CO, 2A@250VAC (shared common) Base relay option 4-5: CO, 2A@250VAC
276 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
SSR option 1-3: >10V into 500Ω min. Dual SSR option 2-3: >10V into 500Ω min. 20..280Vrms (47…63Hz), 0.01…1A Triac 1-3: Linear DC option 1-3: 0/4…20mA, 0…5/10V Base linear DC option 6-7: 0/4…20mA, 0…5/10V Tranmitter supply 2-3: 24Vdc nominal, 910Ωmin (1 only) Comms RS485 A: Slave, Modbus RTU, up to 115200bps Comms Ethernet A: Slave, Modbus RTU, 10/100BaseT Data recorder: 1Mb nvfm, 1, 2, 5, 10, 15, 30 sec/min Profiler: max 255 segments, 64 profiles Protection Class: IP65 - front Dimensions: 96 x 96 x 117mm
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
Part number key EC440 Unit type: Controller Controller with USB Port Controller/recorder Controller/recorder with USB Port Profiler Not fitted Profiler Power supply: 100-240V AC 24-48V AC or DC (COMING SOON) Control loops: One control loop One loop + auxiliary input Two control loops Base option 1: Relay output Relay output + linear DC output Base option 2 Not fitted Relay output Relay output + linear DC output Plug-in module slot 1 Not fitted Relay output DC drive output for SSR Linear DC output Triac output
0116 284 9900
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
C U X R
X 1 2 3 4 5
0 P
0 1 0 2
0 1 3 4 5
1 A 2 1 M
0 1 2 8 9 Y T
0 1 M 0 1 2 L 8
0 1 2 8 9 Y T
Manual & HMI Language: English French German Italian Spanish Option C: Not fitted Multiple Digital Input Plug-in Module Slot A: Not fitted RS485 Serial Comms - Modbus RTU Digital Input Auxiliary Input A Ethernet Port - Modbus TCP Plug-in Module Slot 3: Not fitted Relay Output DC Drive Output for SSR Triac Output Dual relay Output Dual SSR Driver Output 24VDC transmitter power supply Plug-in module slot 2: Not fitted Relay output DC drive output for SSR Triac output Dual relay output Dual SSR Driver output 24VDC transmitter power supply
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 277
Temperature controllers
KS20-1/PRO16 Advanced controller
• • • • • •
Universal controller Two inputs, up to 6 outputs Four digital inputs Two switchable parameter sets 16 x 16 segment profiler PMA or West branded
General information Modbus Master function supports setpoint changes e.g. in extruder applications
KS20-1 (48 x 48mm) This is a universal temperature controller for advanced industrial applications. The unit can provide simple on/off control, continuous PID Control, or 3 point stepping control. The process value signal from the sensor is connected to the universal input. A second analogue input is available for current measurement or as an external setpoint signal. The KS20-1 has an optional transmitter supply, digital inputs and modbus RS-485. • Input 1 is a universal input (temperature, resistance and mA/V • Input 2 (input 0/4..20mA, dc, 0..30mA ac) can be used for external setpoint or input for current transformer • Outputs: relay, SSR and analogue Other functions • Digital inputs (switch off ouput, switch setpoint value, change parameter set etc) • Extra function button (switch off output, boost, manual control, program control etc) • Modbus master/slave • Maintenance manager and error list • BluePort® and BlueControl software configurable
Master KS 90-1
1
2
Slaves KS 90-1, KS 50-1, KS 40-1
3
4
1
1199
°C °F para func Ada Err
1200
SP.x
2
3
126 125
OK
1
run
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
1
run
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run Ada
Err
SP.E SP.2
F
KS 90-1
KS 40-1
advanced
180°C
KS 40-1
universal
185°C
KS 40-1
universal
190°C
190°C
KS 40-1
universal
195°C
195°C
200°C
KS 40-1
universal
200°C 205°C
KS 40-1
universal
200°C 205°C
KS 40-1
universal
210°C 215°C
universal
215°C 220°C
+5°C
Technical data Note that these technical data are not fully complete, but show the most significant for KS20. For more details see www.oem.co.uk Outputs: Supply voltage: 90-260V 48…62Hz, 7VA CO, 2A@ 250VAC, 500VA Relay option 1-3: 24VAC/DC Dual relay option 2: NO, 2A@250VAC, 500VA (21-26V ac, 48…62Hz, 7VA, 18-31V dc, 7W) SSR option 1-3: 10V into 500Ω min. Input signal 1: Pt100, PT1000, 0-4500Ω Dual SSR option 1-3: 10V into 500Ω min. Thermocouples L, J, K, N, S, R, T, C, D, E, B-Type 0/4…20mA, 0-10V Linear DC option 1-3: Linear, 0/4…20mA, 0…10V Tranmitter supply - option: 18V dc/22mA Input signal 2: 0/4…20mA, 0…30mA ac Communication - option: RS-485 master/slave, Modbus RTU, addresses 0-99, max 32 controlller/bus, Analogue inputs: Accuracy 0.1%, resloution >14 bit, 2400, 4800, 9600,19200 bits/s Scan time 100mS Protection Class: IP65 - front Digital inputs: Contact input; 3.3V/<10mA, DI1 & DI2 Dimensions: 48 x 48 x 118mm 24VDC, DI3 & DI4 Display: LED 4 digit 10/8mm
Part number key 1/16 Din Universal industrial controller Supply voltage 100-240V AC 24VAC 50/60Hz or 18 to 30VDC Heater current/transmitter power supply TPS HC / mA Option 1: Relay (switch over) Single SSR Dual SSR Linear mA/VDC Output Option 2: Not fitted Relay (switch over) Dual Relay Single SSR Dual SSR
278 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
KS20
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
0 1 0 C B
T H R A Y L 0 R D A Y
0 R A Y L C
2
0
-
XX 01 – West branded 03 – PMA branded Option A: Not fitted RS485 Dual isolated digital input Option 3: Not fitted Relay (switch over) Single SSR Dual SSR Linear mA/VDC output RS485
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
KS40-1/KS41-1/KS50-1 Advanced controller
• Universal controller • Panel size 48 x 96, 96 x 96mm • Two inputs, three outputs • Three digital inputs • BluePort® interface and BlueControl software configurable
General information KS40-1/KS50-1 (48 x 96mm), KS41-1 (96 x 48mm) and KS42-1 (96 x 96mm) This is a universal controller for industrial applications with PID control, two or three point control. KS40/42 also offers a basic program function with 4 ramp steps, transmitter supply, digital inputs, Modbus RS422/485, can be connected over for manual operation using the “hand” button. They also have a large number of alarm functions in different combinations. A number of functions can be “moved out” to be reached directly with the front buttons.
• Input 1 is a universal input (temperature, resistance and mA/V) • Input 2 (input signal 0/4-20 mA DC/0-50 mA AC) can be used for an external set point or input for current transformer • Outputs: three relays or two relays/one logic (13 V or analogue)
KS50-1is a version produced for the plastics industry and has certain special functions: • Two selectable sets of parameters • Two inputs, five outputs • Extra function button (switch off output, switch to set point value two, change parameter set, etc. • In the event of a fault control can continue automatically with average values • Boost-function - burn out material in the event of “freezing” • Master/slave function with multi-zone control
KS40-1 Burner is a version produced for burners and has certain special functions: • Quick configuration for burner applications • Two inputs, three outputs • Extra function button (switch off output, switch to set point value two, change parameter set, etc. • 2-step/3-step control modulating, for step motors
Technical data Note that these technical data are not fully complete, but show the most significant for KS40/42. For more details and for KS40 Burner/KS50 see www.west-cs.com Supply voltage: 90-260 V 48-62 Hz, approx. 8 VA Relay output OUT1/2: 2 A, 250 V AC, 500 VA 24 V AC/DC Relay output, OUT3: 2 A, 250 V AC, 500 VA (21-26 V AC, 48-62 Hz approx. Universal output, OUT3: logic output: 0/13 V, max. 20 mA, isolated from inputs 8 VA, 18-31 V DC, approx. 8 W) analogue output: 0/4-20 mA, resolution 0.1 %, Input signal INP1: PT100, PT1000, resistance 0-4500 Ω max. 500 Ω, 0-10 V, resolution 0.1 %, min. 2 kΩ Thermocouples L, J, K, N, S, R transmitter supply max13 V DC/22 mA Linear signal 0-20/4-20 mA, 0-10 V Transmitter supply (option): 18 V DC/22 mA Input signal INP2: Linear signal 0-20/4-20 mA, 0-50 mA AC Communication (option): RS422/485, Modbus RTU (galvanic isolated), Analogue inputs: Accuracy 0,1 %, resolution >14 bit, addresses 00-99, max. 32 controllers/bus scanning rate 100 ms (2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 bits/s) Digital inputs: Contact input: 2.5 V/50 µA Protection class: IP65 front Optocoupler input: “0” = -3 to 5 V DC, Dimensions: 48 x 96 x 118mm (KS40), “1” = 15 to 30 V DC, approx. 5 mA 96 x 48 x 118mm (KS41), 96 x 96 x118mm (KS42) Display: KS40-1: LED four digits, 10/8mm high KS42-1: LED four digits, 19/10mm high
Ordering guide See website for ordering codes
0116 284 9900
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 279
Temperature controllers
KS90-1/92-1 Advanced controller
• • • •
Universal process controller Panel size 48 x 96, 96 x 96mm Three inputs, up to six outputs Three digital inputs
General information Other functions: • Digital inputs (switch off output, switch to set point value two, change parameter set, etc) • Extra function button (switch off output, switch to set point value two, change parameter set, etc) • In the event of a fault control can continue automatically with average values • Master/slave function with multi-zone control • Version for program control, up to 16 programs with 16 segments
KS90-1 (48 x 98mm) and KS92-1 (96 x 96mm) This is a universal controller for advanced industrial applications with PID control, two or three point control. KS90-1/92-1 has transmitter supply, digital inputs. Modbus RS422/485 or Profibus, can be connected over for manual operation using the “hand” button. There are also a large number of alarm functions in different combinations. A number of functions can be “moved out” to be reached directly with the front buttons. • Input 1 is a universal input (temperature, resistance and mA/V) • Input 2 (input signal 0/4-20 mA DC/0-50 mA AC, potentiometer) can be used for an external set point or input for current transformer • Input 3 is a universal input (temperature, resistance and mA) • Outputs: relays, logics, analogue or optocoupler Example of Master/slave application with KS90-1/KS92-1
Master KS 90-1
1
2
Slaves KS 90-1, KS 50-1, KS 40-1
3
4
1199
°C °F para func Ada Err
1200
1
SP.x
2
3
126 125
OK
1
run
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run
1
SP.x
Ada
Err
2
3
126 125
OK
run Ada
Err
SP.E SP.2
F
KS 90-1
advanced
180°C
KS 40-1
KS 40-1
universal
185°C
universal
190°C
190°C
195°C
KS 40-1
KS 40-1
universal
195°C 200°C
KS 40-1
universal
200°C 205°C
KS 40-1
universal
200°C 205°C
KS 40-1
universal
210°C 215°C
universal
215°C 220°C
+5°C Note that these technical data are not fully complete, but show the most significant. For more details see www.west-cs.com
Technical data Supply voltage: Input signal INP1: Input signal INP2: Input signal INP3: Analogue inputs: Digital inputs:
90-260 V 48-62 Hz, approx. 8 VA 24 V AC/DC (21-26 V AC, 48-62 Hz approx. 8 VA, 18-31 V DC, approx. 8 W) PT100, PT1000, resistance 0-4500 Ω Thermocouples L, J, K, N, S, R, T, C, D, E, (B = over 100 °C) Linear signal 0-20/4-20 mA, 0-10 V (2.5-1150 mV) Linear signal 0-20/4-20 mA, 0-50 mA AC, potentiometer 0-4500 Ω As INP1 (not 0-10 V) Accuracy 0.1 %, resolution >14 bit, scanning rate 100 ms Contact input: 5 V/100 µA Optocoupler input: “0” = -3 to 5 V DC, “1” = 15 - 30 V DC, approx. 5 mA
Display: KS90-1: LED four digits, 10/8mm high Text display: 8-digit, numerical or bar graph Relay output, OUT1-4: 2 A, 250 V AC, 500 VA Universal output, OUT3-4: logic output: 0/13 V, max. 20 mA, isolated from inputs analogue output:0/4-20 mA, resolution 0.1 %, max. 500 Ω 0-10 V, resolution 0.1 %, min. 2 kΩ transmitter supply max. 13 V DC / 22 mA Optocoupler output OUT5-6: 18-32 V DC/70 mA, positive load control (galvanic isolated) Communication (option): RS422/485, Modbus RTU (galvanic isolated), addresses 00-99, max. 32 regulators/bus (2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 bits/s) Profibus DP Protection class: IP65 front
Ordering guide See website for ordering codes
280 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
KS98-1 Advanced process controller
Process controller - KS98-1 The KS 98-1 multiloop controller provides advanced functionality to its users. It benefits from having a large number of analog and digital inputs and outputs as standard. The KS98-1 offers a high resolution LCD display (160 x 80 pixels). Individual plain text lines can be displayed with the current function states. Setpoint, actual values or manipulated variables can be visualised in either bar graphs or trend curves. The instrument offers an extensive function library to support the engineering of individual solutions from analog signal conditioning to digital signal operations and cascade control systems to complex meshed control loops.
BlueControl
• • • •
All automation functions in one unit Controller, computing, sequencing and programmer Comprehensive function library IO expansion via module C or CANopen bus
PMA’s most advanced process controller, for demanding applications. “Mini-PLC” for mathematical calculations, a large number of digital inputs and outputs, master-slave applications etc. • Up to 8 inputs/8 control loops • Up to 6 control outputs, more via bus • Up to 12 digital inputs, 6 digital outputs • Multi-function display for e.g. actual/set point value, logging curves, bar graph, time, etc. • Library with 350 ready function blocks • Profibus, Interbus • Programmed in BlueControl For detailed information: www.west-cs.com
• • • • • • • •
Trend curves, logging function Offline simulation Customer optimise the display menu in the controller Customised text field Create “start-up logo” with e.g. the company name Save data to file Help text for all parameters Linearisation of customer specific input signal - 16 points
Overview BlueControl software for PMA’s controllers, ProVU & Pro series BlueControl software is a fully developed PC application for controllers, which is easily connected via a socket on the front (on ProVU & Pro 16 sockets are fitted
on underside). This facilitates all programming and has a simulation function where controller’s functions are shown in their entirety and all functions can be tested before the controller is used in its real application.
Ordering guide Order number 9407-998-00001
Description Programming adapter for PMA’s controllers
9407-999-11001
Software Blue Control Basic
9407-999-11011
Software Blue Control Expert
9407-999-12001
Software Blue Control Basic, Rail-line
9407-999-12011
Software BlueControl Expert (for Rail line, i.e. KS45 etc)
0116 284 9900
TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 281
Temperature controllers
Rail line controllers, converters and bus couplers
• • • •
Series Railline - for DIN rails with different functions Signal converter with limiting value relays Universal inputs; temperature and 4-20mA/0-10 V etc KSvario - control system, up to 30 control zones
Controllers, converters and bus couplers These products are stocked on a smaller scale, contact us if you have any questions. Railline - the same appearance for different features Railline is a series of DIN mounted modules with different functions as shown below. Most models have a display of values and indications. Railline are programmed in BlueControl, where files can be saved and printed, etc. For detailed information: www.pma-online.de
CI45: universal signal converter As CI35 but with more advanced functions, possibility of bus connection, digital input, two universal inputs, two relay outputs, frequency input and output, etc. SG45: for load cells/resistance bridges For accurate measurement and monitoring of loads, pressure sensors and other resistance bridges. Resolution 14 bits, output signal relay, logic or analogue signals.
KS45: digital PID controller Available in several combinations for different inputs and outputs - see product page under Controllers.
TB45: temperature limiter for critical processes For example, gas ovens which require a higher level of protection with an independent unit with its own sensor. Follows DIN standards for different applications (hot water, properties, oil burners, etc.) For detailed information: www.pma-online.de#
CI35: universal signal converter Converter with a universal input, a universal analogue output and one relay output: Resistance sensor (PT100, PT1000, potentiometer etc.) Thermocouple (L, J, K, N, S, R, T, C, D, E, (B = over 400 °C) Linear input signals: 0-10V, -10/+10 V, 0/4-20 mA, -200/+200 mV Output: relay and logic/analogue For detailed data sheet please call
RL400: Plug-in I/O system The input/output modules with fieldbus provide a high degree of flexibility
Ordering guide Order number
Description
CI4511200000000
Universal converter, logic + relay output, digital input, 90-260 VAC
CI4511201000000
Universal converter, logic + relay output, two inputs, count input etc, 90-260 VAC
CI4511320000000
Universal converter, logic + relay output, 24 VAC/DC
TB451000000000D
Temperature limiter, 2 x relay, 90-260 VAC
KS4511200000D00
Controller Railline, screw connection, two relay outputs and analogue/logic output, 90-260 VAC
Bus couplers/IO-modules for process signals etc. Railine also includes a complete series of bus couplers for signal collection to control systems. All modules has several input and/or outputs and are connected to a bus coupler; the left-hand module in the picture. This collects in all measurement values from the various modules and converts to the selected fieldbus. For detailed information: www.west-cs.com For Profibus (DPV1), Ethernet/Modbus TCP, ModBus RTU, CANopen Each fieldbus module can handle up to 16 measurement modules (with an extra amplifier up to 62 measurement modules can be handled). Temperature inputs; PT100, PT1000, thermocouple Analogue input signals: 0/4-20 mA/0-10 V Analogue output modules 0/4-20 mA/0-10 V 4 sensor inputs/unit
RL400 combination modules input/outputs 2 inputs/2 outputs/unit 4 inputs/ unit RL400 digital input/output modules Input: 2 x 4 (24 V DC), 2 x 4 contact input Output: 2 x 4 (24 V DC), 2 x analog, 2 x differential, 4 x relay 230 V
282 | TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
www.oem.co.uk
Temperature controllers
KS45 – Rail line
• • • •
Universal controller For DIN rail mounting Two inputs, three outputs Three digital inputs
General information This is a universal controller for standard industrial applications with PID control, two or three point control. KS45 also offers a basic program function with 4 ramp steps, transmitter supply, Modbus RS422/485, can be connected over for manual operation using the “hand” button. It also has a large number of alarm functions in different combinations. KS45 is a part of the Rail-line family, which includes e.g. fieldbus couplers, signal converters, temperature limiters, etc.
• Input 1 is a universal input (temperature, resistance and mA/V) • Input 2 can be a universal input (temperature, resistance and mA/V) or 0-50 mA AC • Outputs: two relays/one logic (13 V, analogue or transmitter supply) • Five different time functions, adjustable 0.1 to 9,999 min
Technical data Supply voltage:
Display:
90-260 V 48-62 Hz, approx. 8 VA 24 V AC/DC (21-26 V AC, 48-62 Hz approx. 8 VA, 18-31 V DC, approx. 8 W) PT100, PT1000, resistance 4500 Ω, KTY11-6 Thermocouples L, J, K, N, S, R, T, C, D, E, B Linear signal 0-20/4-20 mA, 0-10 V, -10 to 10 V, -200 to 200 mV PT100, PT1000, resistance 4500 Ω, KTY11-6 Thermocouples L, J, K, N, S, R, T, C, D, E, B Linear signal 0-20/4-20 mA, 0-10 V, 0-50 mA AC Accuracy 0,1 %, resolution >14 bit, scanning rate 100 ms Contact input: 5 V/1 mA Optocoupler input: “0” = -3 to 5 V DC, “1” = 15 - 30 V DC, approx. 6 mA
Input signal INP1:
Input signal INP2: Analogue inputs: Digital inputs:
5
6 7 K te lem 8 rm m in e 1 al / 2 3 4
5.5
Dimensions
Multifunction LCD-display, shows actual value, set point value, output status, error messages, functions/values Relay output OUT1/2/3: 2 A, 250 V AC, 500 VA Optocoupler output: OUT1/2 (option:) 18-32 V DC, max. 70 mA, internal voltage drop <1 mA at Imax Universal output, OUT3: logic output: 0/13 V, max. 23 mA, isolated from inputs analogue output:0/4-20 mA, resolution 0.1 %, max. 700 Ω, 0-10 V, resolution 0.1 %, min. 2 kΩ transmitter supply (option):18 V DC/22 mA RS422/485, Modbus RTU (galvanic isolated), Communication (option): addresses 00-99, max. 32 controllers/bus (2400, 4800, 9600, 19200 bits/s) Protection class: IP65 front
15 1
6 1 K 7 te lem 18 rm m in e 11 al / 12 13 14
99
2.3
22.5
111 117.5
Part number key KS451
X
1 universal input, 1 digital input with display and BluePort® interface 0 without plug-in connector terminals 1 with screw terminal connector 90...260V AC, 2 output relays, INP2 as current input (0...20mA) 18...30VAC/18...31VDC, 2 output relays, INP2 as current input (0...20mA) 90...260V AC, mA/V/logic + 2 relays, INP2 as current input (0...20mA) 18...30VAC/18...31VDC, mA/V/ logic + 2 relays, INP2 as current input (0...20mA) 90..260V AC, 2 optocoupler outputs,1 relay, INP2 as current input (0...20mA DC and 0...50 mA AC) 18...30VAC/18..31VDC, 2 optocoupler outputs., 1 relay, INP2 as current input (0...20mA DC and 0...50 mA AC) without options RS 485 / MODBUS - protocol System interface (only for 24V versions) * not on versions with optocoupler outputs (KS45-1x4... and KS45-1x5...)
0116 284 9900
X
X
X
0 1 2 3
0
X
00
0
Standard (CE-certification)
D U
DIN 3440 / EN 14597 Ul/cUL certified
0
Standard configuration
9
Customer-specific configuration di1 as contact input
1
di1 as optocoupler input
3*
5
X
0
2*
4
0
INP2 as universal input, 0 -measurement, di1 as contact input INP2 as universal input, 02-measurement di1 as optocoupler input
0 1 2 TEMPERATURE CONTROLLERS
| 283
TERMINALS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Introduction
286
Screw terminals 2.5mm – 120mm
288
Pick-off terminals 4mm – 120mm
290
Screw terminals 50mm – 240mm
292
Screw double-level terminals 2.5mm – 10mm
294
Screw three-level initiator terminals 2.5mm
296
Fuse disconnect terminals 2.5mm – 6mm
298
Disconnect terminals 2.5mm – 4mm
300
Test disconnect and CT-link terminals 10mm
302
RK-Safe-box
305
Thermocouple terminals
306
Terminal blocks spade connection 1mm – 2.5mm
307
Screw terminal direct mount 2.5mm – 10mm
308
High power stud terminals 35mm – 300mm
310
Distribution blocks 80 A – 400 A
312
Tension spring compact terminals 2.5mm
314
Tension spring terminals 2.5mm – 16mm
316
Tension spring double-level terminals 2.5mm
320
Tension spring three-level terminals 2.5mm
322
Tension spring disconnect and fuse terminals 2.5mm
324
Tension spring compact direct mount terminals 2.5mm
326
Pluggable tension-spring terminals 2.5mm
328
Tension spring initiator/actuator terminals 1.5mm
332
Shield-connection clips 3mm – 32mm Ø
334
Busbar support and clamping yokes 0.5mm – 35mm
336
Terminal interface break-out modules
338
Accessories
344
Markers
346
FMS colour printing system
350
Terminals The company Founded and kept in the family since 1977: CONTA-CLIP is an owneroperated company that is a mid-sized global player. Users of electrical and electronic connectivity components have come to trust us for our reliable products. They also trust in our wide-reaching competence within the market and industry which has evolved over many years. In the years since our company was founded, we have evolved from a manufacturer to an innovator.
Connection types CONTA-CLIP have continually evolved their systems starting with the ‘wire protection’ screw terminal. They can now offer up to seven different connection types. The most common of which are highlighted below.
Screw
• Maximum contact force • Resistant to vibration • The lowest voltage drop • Wire size from 0.08 – 240 mm2
Tension spring
Pressure spring
Stud
• High resistance to vibration • Fast connection • Reduces wiring time up to 50% • Wire size from 0.08mm – 16mm2
• ‘Push in’ technology • No tools required • High resistance to vibration • Reduces wiring time up to 80% • Wire size from 0.08mm – 10mm2
• Power connections • 1000 V up to 520 A • Excellent contact force • Wire size from 0.2mm – 300mm2
CONTA–CON
CONTA–ELECTRONICS
CONTA–INSTALL
Product offer CONTA–CONNECT
• DIN rail screw terminals • Push in terminals • Stud terminals • EX terminals • Labelling systems
286 | TERMINALS
• PCB • PCB • PCB • PCB
terminal blocks plug in terminals marking cards rail mounting system
• Relay systems • Converters • Power supplies • Interface modules • Diode modules
• Cable ducting • Cable glands • Ferrules • DIN rail • Crimp connectors
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals Innovative SRK screw terminal range A complete range The SRK range start at 2.5mm² through to 120mm² and the same pluggable cross connectors are also compatible with the SRKD double deck terminals and the SSIK range of fuse holders. Most of the range is available in up to 9 colours, including the 3 phase colours to make power connections easier to identify.
Fast assembly & connection The easy to operate screw connection makes it easy and safe to connect both solid and flexible wires with or without ferrules. The protective Earth terminals have rail connections on both sides of the foot, they simply snap onto the din-rail with no need for screws. The insulated cross connectors are pluggable and simply pushed in to place in one of two channels in the top of each terminal. These features dramatically speed up assembly time but still ensure maximum mechanical and electrical security.
• New design insulation housing with increased stability • PA 6.6 UL 94-VO self-extinguishing plastic. Temperature range: -40°C to +120°C • Shield feed-through connection versions available
0116 284 9900
• Four-way labelling channel • Generous cable entries. All sizes clamp at the same height • 2.5, 4, 6 and 10 mm2 sizes all have the same external dimensions
Features • Feed-through & protective Earth terminals • Compact design • Wide range of sophisticated accessories • Pluggable insulated cross connectors that can be easily modified to suit • Cross connectors can carry max rated current & voltage of the terminals • Large wire entry bay positioned at the same level across all terminal types • Global standards, worldwide approvals • Manufactured in Germany
• The SQIK cap system makes it possible to isolate neighbouring cut-off cross-connectors and potentials. No partition required • Poles are easy to break out • Two-way cross-connect channel for a wide variety of possible cross-connections
• SSL snap on Earth terminals have a double-sided rail contact for secure fixing to the DIN rail • Can be cross-connected
TERMINALS
| 287
Terminals Feed-through terminals SRK • • • •
High stability vibration resistant construction Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rail Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 Dual cross-connect channels
SRK 2.5/2A
SRK 4/2A
SRK 6/2A
SRK10/2A
48 x 5 x 47mm
48 x 5 x 47mm
48 x 8 x 47mm
48 x 5 x 47mm
2.5mm
4mm
6mm
10mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
2
2
IEC
UL/CSA
Voltage
1000V
Current
24A/32A
Cross connectors (push in)
2
IEC
UL/CSA
IEC
UL/CSA
600V
1000V
25A
32A/41A
600V
1000V
35A
41A/57A
IEC
UL/CSA
600V
1000V
600V
50A
57A/76A
65A
SQI 2.5/2 pole SQI 2.5/3 pole SQI 2.5/4 pole SQI 2.5/10 pole SQI 2.5/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SQI 4/2 pole SQI 4/3 pole SQI 4/4 pole SQI 4/10 pole SQI 4/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SQI 6/2 pole SQI 6/3 pole SQI 6/4 pole SQI 6/10 pole SQI 6/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SQI 10/2 pole SQI 10/3 pole SQI 10/4 pole SQI 10/10 pole SQI 10/30 pole SQIK – Cap
AP 2.5-10
AP 2.5-10
AP 2.5-10
AP 2.5-10
SRK 16/2A
SRK 35/2A
SRK 50/2A
SRK 70/2A
SRK 120/2A
53 x 12.1 x 47mm
59 x 16.1 x 66.1mm
72.5 x 18.5 x 72.5mm
76.5 x 20.5 x 82mm
91 x 27 x 90mm
16mm2
35mm2
50mm
70mm
120mm2
End plate
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
2
2
IEC
UL/CSA*
IEC
UL/CSA*
IEC
UL/CSA*
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
1000V
Current
76A/101A
85A
125A/150A
150A
150A/192A
150A
192A/232A
Cross connectors SQI 16/2 pole End plate
SQI 35/2 pole
SQ 50/2 pole SQ 50/3 pole SQ 50/4 pole
IEC
UL/CSA*
IEC
UL/CSA*
600V
1000V
1000V/1000V
205A
269A/290A
228A/220A
SQ 70/2 pole SQ 70/3 pole SQ 70/4 pole
SQ 120/2 pole SQ 120/3 pole SQ 120/4 pole
SAP 16
*Approval applied for
288 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals Feed-through Earth terminals SSL • • • •
High stability vibration resistant construction Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rail Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 2-Point contact on DIN rail
Part Number
SSL 2.5/2A
SSL 4/2A
SSL 6/2A
SSL 10/2A
SSL 16/2A
Snap-on
Snap-on
Snap-on
Snap-on
Snap-on
48 x 5 x 47mm
48 x 6 x 47mm
48 x 8 x 47mm
48 x 10 x 47mm
53 x 12.1 x 55mm
2.5mm2
4mm2
6mm2
10mm2
16mm2
SQI 2.5/2 pole SQI 2.5/3 pole SQI 2.5/4 pole SQI 2.5/10 pole SQI 2.5/30 pole
SQI 4/2 pole SQI 4/3 pole SQI 4/4 pole SQI 4/10 pole SQI 4/30 pole
SQI 6/2 pole SQI 6/3 pole SQI 6/4 pole SQI 6/10 pole SQI 6/30 pole
SQI 10/2 pole SQI 10/3 pole SQI 10/4 pole SQI 10/10 pole SQI 10/30 pole
SQI16/2
SQIK – Cap
SQIK – Cap
SQIK – Cap
SQIK – Cap
AP 2.5-10-GREEN
AP 2.5-10-GREEN
AP 2.5-10-GREEN
AP 2.5-10-GREEN
SSL 35/2A
SSL 50/2A*
SRK 70/2A*
Snap-on
Screw-on
Screw-on
59 x 16.1 x 65.5mm
72.5 x 18.5 x 72.5mm
76.5 x 20.5 x 82mm
35mm
50mm
70mm2
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Cross connectors (push in)
End plate
Part Number
SAP 16-GREEN
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Cross connectors (push in)
2
2
SQI 35/2 pole
*For Earth connections over 35 mm2 solid copper DIN rail is required to meet full specification
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 289
Terminals
Pick-off terminals SMAG | Test adapter STA Screw technology
Accessories for the SRK terminal blocks CONTA-CLIP offers specific and innovative accessories for the SRK I SSL screw connection system. Pick-off terminals SMAG The SMAG pick-off terminals make possible one or two additional extra wire connectors onto the SRK terminal blocks and therefore extend the standard feed-through terminal by up to four connectors. The SMAGs are mechanically snapped into the SRK terminal blocks. The SMAG busbar is connected via the corresponding base connection of the terminal block, the rated cross section is thereby reduced to the next lower size.
Test adapter STA The STA test adapter can be used to quickly and safely test pre-wired terminal blocks. A test plug block can be mounted with any number of poles using the locking pegs and the STA ZP intermediate plate with widths from 1 to 3 mm. The STA ZP intermediate plate allows the assembly of a test plug block, which can also be mounted on different block widths (SRK/SSL 2.5 | 4 | 6 | 10). Thanks to its innovative design the STA test adapter can be rotated through 180°. It can therefore also be mounted onto the SRK terminal block, whereby one of the cross-connection channels is already occupied by a cross-connector. 290 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Pick-off terminals SMAG | Test adapter STA
• Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 • SMAGs are compatible with SRK series 4-120 mm Pick-off terminals SMAG Part Number
SMAG 4/2.5
SMAG 6/4
SMAG 10/6
SMAG 16/6
Wire size
2.5mm
4mm
6mm
6mm
Approvals
IEC*
IEC*
IEC*
IEC*
Connection diagram
Voltage
800
800
800
800
Current
24A/32A
32A/41A
41A/57A
41A/57A
SRK 4/2A | SSL 4/2A
SRK 6/2A | SSL 6/2A
SRK 10/2A | SSL 10/2A
SRK 16/2A | SSL 16/2A
For terminal block Part Number
SMAG 35/6
SMAG 50-70/10
MAG 150/240
Wire size
6mm
10mm
10mm
Approvals
IEC*
IEC*
IEC*
Connection diagram
Voltage
1000
1000
1000
Current
41A/57A
57A/76A
57A
SRK 35/2A | SSL 35/2A
SRK 50/2A | SSL 50/2A SRK 70/2A | SSL 70/2A
SRK 120/2A
For terminal block *Approval applied for
Test adapter STA Part Number
Pitch mm Finely stranded mm
2
For terminal block
0116 284 9900
STA 5/1
STA ZP1
STA ZP3
5
1
3
SRK 4/2A | SSL 4/2A SRK 10/2A | SSL 10/2A
SRK 6/2A | SSL 6/2A SRK 10/2A | SSL 10/2A
0.5-1 SRK 2.5/2A | SSL 2.5/2A SRK 4/2A | SSL 4/2A SRK 6/2A | SSL 6/2A SRK 10/2A | SSL 10/2A
TERMINALS
| 291
Terminals
Feed-through terminals RK | RK-D | Measurement pick-off terminal MAG Screw technology
Feed-though terminals for DIN rail and direct mount The RK 50, RK 95, RK 150 and RK 240 terminal blocks are made of a double-layer insulation housing. The specialized construction of the clamping yoke minimizes the contact resistance between the wire and the busbar. The clamp is tightened using a hex-socket screw which creates the required torque together with the clamping yoke. Pegs are located on the plastic housings of the terminal blocks; these lock to adjacent terminals to increase the mechanical stability. A threaded M2.5 bolt can be attached to the injection-moulded pegs in order to further increase the mechanical stability. A diverse line of accessories offers a practical supplement to these products. Direct mount versions available RK...-D
MAG measurement pick-off terminals. The MAG measurement pick-off terminals allow you to tap into the voltage on the RK 50, RK 95, RK 150 and RK 240 terminal blocks when using wires with small cross-sections ranging from 0.2 to 10 mm2. A special socket slot in the RK 50 to RK 240 terminal blocks enables the MAG supplemental connections to be added retroactively. They can be independently snapped on to the base housing of the terminal blocks. MAG terminals are individually snapped into the housing of the main terminal above the wire entry. The electrical contact is then established using the connection screw on the main-wire terminal of the busbar. This technical solution is safe, clever, and simplifies the wiring significantly. The rated voltage is 1000 V because of the total insulation provided by the pick-off terminal. The PMC quick marking system can be used for labelling the terminals.
Inlay plate EP When connecting to rectangular conductors, you are required to attach an inlay plate in the clamping yoke. The EP inlay plates correct the V-shaped form of the clamping yoke to increase the contact area to a maximum on both sides of the conductor
292 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Feed-through terminals RK | RK-D • • • •
Foot can be snapped on TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rails Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2 Direct mount option Pick off terminal
RK 50
RK 95
RK 150
RK 240
79 x 20 x 76.5
84 x 25 x 88.5
93 x 31 x 112.8
93 x 6 x 126.3
50mm2
95mm2
150mm2
240mm2
RK 50-D
RK 95-D
RK 150-D
RK 240
109 x 20 x 65.75
109 x 25 x 77.5
109 x 31 x 99
109 x 36 x 112.8
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Part number
Other colours available Size (LWH) Approvals
IEC
UL/CSA
IEC
UL/CSA
IEC
UL/CSA
IEC
UL/CSA
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
Current
150A
150A
232A
230A
309A
275A
380A
370A
Pick off terminal
Inlay plate
MAG 50
MAG 95
MAG 150/240
MAG 150/240
EP 50
EP 95
EP 1150
EP 240
AQI 2/50 AQI 3/50
AQI 2/95 AQI 3/95
AQI 2/150 AQI 3/150
AQI 2/240 AQI 3/240
Cross connector (external)
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 293
Terminals
Double-level terminal blocks SRKD | PE terminal SSLD Screw technology
Double-level terminal blocks SRKD
The SRKD terminal blocks are available to suit wire sizes 2.5 mm², 4 mm² and 10 mm². The standard SRKD models have two potentials with 2 x 2 connections, further options include linked versions with four connections on one potential and as a protective earth terminal with a snap-on PE foot contact. The SRKD range is compatible with the ‘Plug in’ cross connectors used in the existing SRK range. Just like the established SRK series, the new SKRD units feature a compact housing and provide excellent stability, vibration resistance, and optimal attachment of the wires to the contact point. The terminals are equipped with a large wire entry bay that facilitates the insertion of wires. The connection of multiple wires is also possible. The terminal’s robust housing safely anchors all the metal parts on the inside. The foot construction of the snap-on units ensures a reliable, firm hold on the mounting rail.
Part Number
SRKD 2.5
SRKD 2.5/SV
SSLD 2.5
76 x 5.1 x 65
76 x 5.1 x 65
76 x 5.1 x 65
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC
UL/CSA*
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
Current
24A
20A
24A
20A
Cross connectors
End plate
294 | TERMINALS
IEC
UL/CSA*
SQI 2.5/2
SQI 2.5/2
SQI 2.5/2
SQI 2.5/3
SQI 2.5/3
SQI 2.5/3
SQI 2.5/4
SQI 2.5/4
SQI 2.5/4
SQI 2.5/30
SQI 2.5/30
SQI 2.5/30
SQIK-Cap
SQIK-Cap
SQIK-Cap
SAPD 2.5-4
SAPD 2.5-4
SAPD 2.5-4-GREEN
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Double-level terminal blocks SRKD | PE terminal SSLD • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 • Compatible with SRK cross connectors
Part Number
SRKD 4
SRKD 4/SV
SSLD 4
76 x 6.1 x 65
76 x 6.1 x 65
76 x 6.1 x 65
4mm2
4mm2
4mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
Current
32A | 41A
20A
32A | 41A
Cross connectors
IEC
UL/CSA*
20A
SQI 4/2
SQI 4/2
SQI 4/2
SQI 4/3
SQI 4/3
SQI 4/3
SQI 4/4
SQI 4/4
SQI 4/4
SQI 4/10
SQI 4/10
SQI 4/10
SQI 4/30
SQI 4/30
SQI 4/30
SQIK-Cap
SQIK-Cap
SQIK-Cap
SAPD 2.5-4
SAPD 2.5-4
SAPD 2.5-4-GREEN
SRKD 10
SRKD 10/SV
SSLD 10
76 x 10.1 x 68
76 x 10.1 x 68
76 x 10.1 x 68
10mm2
10mm2
10mm2
End plate
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
Current
57A | 76A
20A
57A | 76A
Cross connectors
End plate
0116 284 9900
IEC
UL/CSA*
20A
SQI 10/2
SQI 10/2
SQI 10/2
SQI 10/3
SQI 10/3
SQI 10/3
SQI 10/4
SQI 10/4
SQI 10/4
SQI 10/10
SQI 10/10
SQI 10/10
SQI 10/30
SQI 10/30
SQI 10/30
SQIK-Cap
SQIK-Cap
SQIK-Cap
SAPD 10
SAPD 10
SAPD 10-GREEN TERMINALS
| 295
Terminals
Three-level initiator terminals IKD | IK Screw technology
The features in detail
Features of the IK 2.5
The IKD 2.5 can be positioned anywhere in the terminal strip combination. If it is positioned at the start or in the middle of a terminal strip, the remaining exposed part of the IKD 2.5 should be fitted with the short AP/IKD (catalogue no. 2714.2). The cross-distribution of the power supply takes place at the lower and middle levels using the QS, VH and BS accessory products or the pre-assembled Q cross-connector. The pre-assembled Q cross-connections are available with 2 to 10 poles or 100 poles.
• Thin design (5 mm)
The IK 2.5 and IKD 2.5 base terminals are also available with LED status displays. The display speeds up troubleshooting and signals the switching status. This product line covers all standard control voltages, divided into the switching types “positive switching” or “negative switching”.
• Closed wire entry • One terminal per initiator for quick and precise signal assignment • Touch-safe protection (VBG4) without an additional cover • Colour-coding of plus (red) and minus (blue) connections • Additional colour-coded labelling is possible Features of the IKD 2.5 • Thin design (5 mm) • Closed wire entry • Switch signal and power supply can be connected • Touch-safe protection (VBG4) without an additional cover
The IKD base terminals come in four variants: IKD 2.5
IKD 2.5/Q
Raised-up rear wall, so cross-connection only possible on open side of terminal. Different supply voltages can be fed within one terminal combination.
Cross-connection is possible on open and closed sides of the terminal.
IKD 2.5/F
IKD 2.5/F/Q Cross-connection is possible on open and closed sides of the terminal. The lower level is labelled red and the middle level is labelled blue.
Raised-up rear wall, so cross-connection only possible on open side of terminal. Different supply voltages can be fed within one terminal combination. The lower level is labelled red and the middle level is labelled blue.
296 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Three-level initiator terminals IKD | IK • Foot can be snapped on TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2 • Colour coded options
IKD 2.5
IKD 2.5/Q
IKD 2.5/F
IKD 2.5/F/Q
IK 2.5
84.8 x 5 x 58.3
84.8 x 5 x 58.3
84.8 x 5 x 58.3
84.8 x 5 x 58.3
62.8 x 5 x 58.3
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA*
IEC
CSAus/CSA*
IEC
CSAus/CSA*
IEC
CSAus/CSA*
IEC
CSAus/CSA*
Voltage
250V
300V
250V
300V
250V
300V
250V
300V
250V
300V
Current
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
Cross connectors (external)
End plate
AP 2.5/ID
Q2-SRK-IKD
Q2-SRK-IKD
Q2-SRK-IKD
Q2-SRK-IKD
Q3-SRK-IKD
Q3-SRK-IKD
Q3-SRK-IKD
Q3-SRK-IKD
Q4-IKD
Q4-IKD
Q4-IKD
Q4-IKD
Q10-IKD
Q10-IKD
Q10-IKD
Q10-IKD
Q0.5M (98) IKD
Q0.5M (98) IKD
Q0.5M (98) IKD
Q0.5M (98) IKD
AP 2.5/ID
AP 2.5/ID
AP 2.5/ID
AP 2.5/I
*Approval applied for
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 297
Terminals
Fuse-disconnect terminals SSIK | STK | SK Screw technoloogy
Fuse-disconnect terminals SSIK 4 | SSIK 6 The fused terminals feature an extraction lever that locks into its end position and allows a spare fuse to be attached from the side. The following micro-fuses can be attached: SSIK 4 (5x20/5x25/5x30) and SSIK 6 (6.3x25/6.3x32) Two cross-connection channels within the fused terminals allow for potentials to be distributed to adjacent fused and feed-through terminals from the SRK series. For multiplying the potentials, we offer the SQI standard accessory, available with from 2 to 30 poles. An additional connection (SMAG) can also be attached to the outlet side.
Fuse-disconnect terminal STK 2
Fused terminal SK 1
The STK 2 fuse-disconnect terminals feature a compact shape so they take up minimal space. The hinged lever is used to hold the fuse and locks into its open position. LED status displays are available for a variety of voltage ranges.
The SK 1 fused terminals with screw cap are designed for micro-fuses that are 5 x 20-sized (without indicator) and 5 x 25-sized (with indicator). Fuses are screwed into the fused terminal via the screw cap. Status displays using LEDs, neon indicator lamps or glow lamps are available for a wide variety of voltage ranges.
The STKD 1 has the benefit of an additional feed-through terminal.
Fuse-disconnect terminals STK | STKD • •
Foot can be snapped on TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rail Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL94-V2
STK 2
Part Number
VBS…/10
STKD 1
Lever links for STK series
Other colours available Connection diagram
2 way VBS 2/10 3 way VBS 3/10
Size (LWH)
51.4 x 8 x 39
Wire size Voltage | Current
Fuse size mm Cross connectors (external)
End plate
298 | TERMINALS
67 x 8 x 55.5
4mm2
4mm2
IEC
CSAus
IEC
CSAus
500V | 6.3A
600V |16A
500V | 6.3A
600V |16A
5 x 20 / 5 x 25
5 x 20 / 5 x 25
AQI 2/8/11 poles AQI 3/8/11 poles AQI 4/8/11 poles
AQI 2/8/11 poles AQI 3/8/11 poles AQI 4/8/11 poles
APSI - 2
AP/SID 1
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Fuse-disconnect terminals SSIK | SIK10-PA | SK • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rail • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 V0, glass fibre reinforced • Temperature resistance to 140ºC (RTI elec.) Part Number
SSIK 4/2A/LED
SSIK 4/2A
SSIK 6/2A
SSIK 6/2A/LED
Connection diagram
LED Module
Size (LWH)
58 x 6.1 x 70
58 x 6.1 x 70
59 x 8.1 x 70
59 x 8.1 x 70
4mm
4mm
6mm
6mm
Wire size Approvals
SST/SSIK/LED
2
2
UL/CSA*
Voltage
500V
600V
Current
10A
16A
Fuse size mm
5 x 20 / 5 x 25 / 5 x 30
5 x 20 / 5 x 25 / 5 x 30
6.3 x 25 / 6.3 x 32
6.3 x 25 / 6.3 x 32
SQI 4/2 pole SQI 4/3 pole SQI 4/4 pole SQI 4/10 pole SQI 4/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SQI 4/2 pole SQI 4/3 pole SQI 4/4 pole SQI 4/10 pole SQI 4/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SQI 6/2 pole SQI 6/3 pole SQI 6/4 pole SQI 6/10 pole SQI 6/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SQI 6/2 pole SQI 6/3 pole SQI 6/4 pole SQI 6/10 pole SQI 6/30 pole SQIK – Cap
SAP-SSIK
SAP-SSIK
SAP-SSIK
SAP-SSIK
SIK 10 PA-G
SIK 10/Z PA-G
SK 1/35 PA-G
VBS…/10
VBS…/10/Z
Lever links for SSIK
Lever links for SIK10 series
2 way VBS 2/10
2 way VBS 2/10/Z
3 way VBS 3/10
3 way VBS 3/10/Z
End plate
Part Number
UL/CSA*
30 x 6.1 x 14
2
IEC
Cross connectors (push in)
IEC
2
See LED module 10A
16A
IEC
UL/CSA*
500V
600V
10A
16A
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
60 x 8 x 69
60 x 10 x 69
52 x 12.2 x 62
10mm2
10mm2
10mm2
IEC
UL/CSA
IEC
UL/CSA
IEC
500V
600V
500V
600V
400V
Current
10A
16A
10A
16A
Fuse size
5 x 20 / 5 x 25 / 5 x 30
Voltage
Cross connectors
End plate
6.3 x 32/6.3 x 25
AQI 2/18/8
AQI 2/10/18
AQI 3/18/8
AQI 3/10/18
AQI 4/18/8
AQI 4/10/18
AQI10/18/8
AQI10/10/18
AQI 60/18/8
AQI 50/10/18
AP10-BLACK
IEC
UL/CSA*
See LED module 10A
12-30V AC/DC 30-60V AC/DC 110-250V AC/DC 500V AC/DC
16A
10A 5 x 20 QS 2-SK1 QS 3 -SK1 QS 4 -SK1 QS 10 -SK1
AP/SK1KRG-BLACK
*Approval applied for
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 299
Terminals
Disconnect terminals TRK | STK 2 Screw technology
Different versions | Features The TRK 1.5 (disconnect-blade terminal) and the TRK 1.5/DS (disconnect plug) variants are both available.
The STK 2…/K series feature a hinged lever for disconnecting. The lever comes with a contact sleeve.
Features of the TRK 1.5/TRK 1.5 DS
Features of the STK 2…/K
•
Same construction as the standard terminal blocks
•
Same construction as the standard terminal blocks
•
A sturdy, closed insulation housing
•
Hinged lever latches into fully open position.
•
The established disconnect-blade with high-quality surfaces
•
•
Minimal and stable level ofcontact resistance
isconnect terminals can be used as fuse-disconnect terminals by D removing the contact ferrules.
•
Touch-safe protection also during the disconnect process
The TRK 1.5/STB and TRK 1.5/ 15/STB versions offer the advantage of pre-assembled socket plugs instead of terminal screws. Without any additional accessories, these disconnect terminals feature a test pick-off to be used for speedier troubleshooting or as a measurement pick-off for comparing standardized signals.
Disconnect plugs and diode plugs for the TRK 1.5/DS disconnect terminals are available separately in four versions. Disconnect plug without circuitry •
DS 1-TRK 1.5 (Cat. no. 1403.2)
Disconnect-plug with wire jumper •
DS 1-TRK 1.5 (Cat. no. 1400.2)
Disconnect plug with diode in blocking direction •
DS 1-TRK 1.5 (Cat. no. 1401.2)
Disconnect plug with diode in pass-though direction •
300 | TERMINALS
DS 1-TRK 1.5 (Cat. no. 1402.2)
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Disconnect terminals TRK | STK | STKD • Foot can be snapped on TS 15, TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2
TRK 1.5
TRK 1.5/DS
TRK 1.5
STK 2/K
STKD 1/K
48 x 6 x 48.3
48 x 6 x 65
48 x 6 x 65
49 x 8 x 39
67 x 8 x 55.5
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
4mm2
4mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approval
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
IEC
Voltage
400V
600V
400V
600V
400V
600V
500V
500V
Current
10A
15A
10A
15A
10V
15A
6.3A
6.3A
AQI 2/8/11 2 pole AQI 3/8/11 3 pole AQI 4/8/11 4 pole
AQI 2/8/11 2 pole AQI 3/8/11 3 pole AQI 4/8/11 4 pole
APSI-2
AP/SID
Cross connectors
End plate
0116 284 9900
AQI 4/6/11 2 pole AQI 3/6/17 3 pole AQI 4/6/17 4 pole
AQI 4/6/11 2 pole AQI 3/6/17 3 pole AQI 4/6/17 4 pole
AQI 4/6/11 2 pole AQI 3/6/17 3 pole AQI 4/6/17 4 pole
TERMINALS
| 301
Terminals
Test disconnect terminals PTK | CT-links
Screw technology
Test-disconnect terminals are mostly used in the sectors of electricity generation and supply. They are tailored to the variety of switching demands for current-converter secondary circuits that predominate in these sectors. Current transformers must always have a secondary circuit when electricity meters and measuring instruments are being replaced, or when making comparative measurements. CONTA-CLIP test-disconnect terminals are available in four basic versions, each with or without a pre-assembled socket plug. All versions provide touch-safe protection according to wVBG 4. A captive sliding partition is used to separate the current and voltage paths. The switch position is always easy to detect since the disconnect screw has a yellow insulating sleeve. The STB 14/4 sockets plugs for a test pick-off can be attached to all versions using the PS 4 test plug.
The features in detail Cross-switches QVS
Socket plugs STB 35
Socket plugs STB 14/4
Test plug PS 4
The VH 19 connecting sleeves and the BS 25 screws or the STB 35 socket plugs are required for fastening the QVS cross-switch bridge. The screws and socket plugs are available with or without coloured labelling.
The STB 35 socket plugs are used in the test-disconnect terminals for holding the PS 4 test plug or the KSS 2-8 short-circuit plug. The STB 35 socket plugs can also be used when you need to test at the same time that a QVS is attached.
The STB 14/4 socket plugs can be screwed into the cross-connection channel. The are used to hold the PS 4 test plugs or the KSS 2-8 short-circuit plugs.
The PS 4 test plugs are used for the final testing of already-wired test circuits.
302 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Test disconnect terminals PTK | Pre-assembled CT-links
CONTA-CLIP test-disconnect terminals are available in the following four basic versions, each with or without pre-assembled STB socket plugs PTK 10/LT/HB can be separated lengthwise
PTK 10/LT can be separated lengthwise
PTK 10/QT can be separated perpendicularly
PTK 10/DU Feed through terminal
PTK 10/LT/STB/HB can be separated lengthwise
PTK 10/LT/STB can be separated lengthwise with STB
PTK 10/QT/STB can be separated perpendicularly with STB
PTK 10/DU/STB Feed through terminal with STB
Examples of basic circuits using PTK disconnect terminals Current transformers must always have a secondary circuit when electricity meters and measuring instruments are being replaced, or when making comparative measurements. Otherwise they could be destroyed by â&#x20AC;&#x153;ramping upâ&#x20AC;?. The following circuits are available pre-aasembled. Pre-assembled CT LINK assembly
0116 284 9900
CT LINKASSY1
CT LINKASSY2
CT LINKASSY3
Single phase
3-phase
3-phase with voltage disconnects
TERMINALS
| 303
Terminals
Test disconnect terminals PTK | CT-links • Foot can be snapped on TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2
Part Number
PTK 10/LT
PTK 10/LT/STB
PTK 10/QT
PTK 10/QT/STB
72 x 8 x 47
72 x 8 x 47
72 x 8 x 47
72 x 8 x 47
10mm
10mm
10mm
10mm2
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) inc covers Wire size Approvals
2
2
2
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
400V
600V
400V
600V
400V
600V
400V
600V
Current
10A
45A
10A
45A
10A
45A
10A
45A
Cross connectors QI 2 - 8mm QI 3 - 8mm QI 4 - 8mm QI 10 - 8mm
End plate
Part Number
QI 2 - 8mm QI 3 - 8mm QI 4 - 8mm QI 10 - 8mm
AP/L/Q/D
AP/L/Q/D
AP/L/Q/D
AP/L/Q/D
PTK 10/DU
PTK 10/DU/STB
PTK 10/LT/HB
PTK 10/LT/STB/HB
72 x 8 x 47
72 x 8 x 47
72 x 8 x 63
72 x 8 x 63
10mm2
10mm2
10mm2
10mm2
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) inc covers Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
400V
600V
400V
600V
400V
600V
400V
600V
Current
10A
45A
10A
45A
10A
45A
10A
45A
Cross connectors QI 2 - 8mm QI 3 - 8mm QI 4 - 8mm QI 10 - 8mm
End plate
304 | TERMINALS
AP/L/Q/D
QI 2 - 8mm QI 3 - 8mm QI 4 - 8mm QI 10 - 8mm
AP/L/Q/D
AP/L/Q/D
AP/L/Q/D
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
RK-Safe-box TS 35 | 100 • • • • •
Mounts on TS 35 rail Material of box: Polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 Material of lid: Polycarbonate UL 94-V2 3-way sealing options Slide mechanism for maintenance
RK-Safe-Box TS 35 | 100 mm Terminal block enclosure CONTA-CLIP's innovative RK-Safe-Box terminal block enclosure is a quick, simply way to protect the terminals blocks that you've installed on DIN rails (such as converter circuits) from being tampered with. Especially when used in front of the electrical meter for power distribution applications, the RK-Safe-Box is very effective at preventing unauthorized re-wiring or access to converter terminals. The side walls border the mounting plate directly. They thus completely surround the protected components. Feed-through guides lead wires though the walls of the RK-Safe-Box. This simplifies wiring and makes it impossible to manipulate the terminals after the RK-Safe-Box is closed. When the transparent lid is removed, the integrated slide mechanism permits you to extend the interior of the RK-Safe-Box by 16 mm. This makes it easy to perform maintenance and to replace terminals or components. Features • Easy and fast mounting to the TS 35 DIN rail • Optimal mechanical attachment to the DIN rail • Cannot be unlocked or snapped out of the DIN rail after it is mounted • Triple seal option • Transparent lid • Tampering is immediately recognizable • Slide mechanism on the two enclosure halves provides improved access for internal component maintenance.
Part Number
Max installation size (LWH) with TS 35 Protection
RK-SAFEBOX-10CM
73 x 94 x 55 IP 20
* Terminal assembly for illustration only
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 305
Terminals
Thermocouple terminals TSK • Busbar materials in compliance with DIN 43713/43714 • Foot can be snapped on TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2
The TSK series can be used to extend thermocouple measurement circuits without introducing errors caused by incompatible junction materials. The CONTA-CLIP TSK terminals can be used to clearly label the thermocouple terminal pair in use. The busbars on the thermocouple terminals are made of the same materials as the compensating lines, in compliance with DIN 43713/DIN 43714. This ensures thermocouple signals are transmitted accurately on the junction between the thermocouple, thermocouple terminal and compensating line. Thus the base value maintained in accordance with DIN/IEC 584. Features of the TSK 2.5 • Two-pole blocks per thermal pair • Thermal pair is clearly labelled on the terminal block • Terminal width of a thermal pair is 10 mm • Material of busbars corresponds to material of compensating lines.
Part Number
TSK 2.5/T/J/E/K/S/R
Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
Thermocouple probe
48 x 10 x 47
Wire size
2.5mm2
End plate
AP 2.5-10
Thermocouple terminals Compensating line
Part no.
Type
Material
TSK 2.5/T
T-Type
Copper/Constantan Cu/CuNi 44
TSK 2.5/J
J-Type
Iron / Constantan Fe/CuNi 44
TSK 2.5/E
E-Type
Nickel-chrome Constantan NiCr/CuNi 44
TSK 2.5/K
K-Type
Nickel-chrome/Nickel NiCr/Ni
TSK 2.5/S
S-Type
E-copper/A-copper E-Cu/A-Cu
TSK 2.5/R
R-Type
E-copper/A-copper E-Cu/A-Cu
Reference junction Supply line, deliver-/return-wire
Measuring instrument
306 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Terminal blocks with spade connection FF | SF • Busbar materials in compliance with DIN 43713/43714 • Foot can be snapped on TS 32 and TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2
The spade connection is a widely standardized connection method. A spade ferrule corresponding to the crosssection is crimped on to the wire end. The spade ferrule then pushes onto the spade terminal so that the wire contacts the terminal. These terminals can be used for interfaces between electronics and electrical systems or for applications where assembled cables are being used.
Features of the FF 2.5 and SF 2.5-4 • Terminal width of only 6 mm • Connects standard spade plugs of sizes 0.8 x 2.8 mm or 0.8 x 6.3 mm • Spade to screw connection with SF 2.5-4 • Up to 4 spade plugs can be joined wto a single potential in one terminal: FF 2.5 • Can be cross-connected
Part Number
FF 2.5
SF 2.5-4
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) TS35
48 x 6 x 47
48 x 6 x 47
Wire size
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Approvals
IEC
IEC
Voltage
500V
500V
Current
15A
15A
Q2-6mm
Q2-6mm
Q3-6mm
Q3-6mm
Cross connectors
End plate
0116 284 9900
Q4-6mm
Q4-6mm
Q10-6mm
Q10-6mm
AP 2.5-10
AP 2.5-10
TERMINALS
| 307
Terminals
Feed-through terminals for direct mounting RKB | BKA | KBL Screw technology
The RKB, BKA and KBL...-D block terminals are a cost effective connection system which can be snapped together using their pegs to match you required number of poles. An EH end support is snapped onto each end of the block terminals. It provides a 3.5mm hole for a mounting screw. If you are using more poles than available in the Conta-clip product line, we recommend using additional EH end supports at interval in order to maintain the stability. We recommend our MV2/BKA assemble fixture if you would like to link self-contained BKA terminal strips.
BKA 2.5/BKA 4 and BKA 10
Block terminals RKB and KBL...-D
The housings of the BKA 2.5/BKA 4 and BKA 10 block terminals offer touch-safe protection in compliance with VBG 4. The clamping-yoke screw connection system establishes a secure mechanical and electrical contact.
The RKB and KBL...-D block terminals also provide all of the advantages of rail-mounted terminal blocks (such as the interior cross-connection system). Individual covers, test plugs, cross-connectors, etc. are compatible with the standard RK terminal blocks.
The compact design allows you to use the BKA blocks within the most confined spaces. For the BKA 2.5 and BKA 4 variants, the EH 2-Z with snap-in pegs can be attached instead of the EH 2. When using the EH 2-Z, the screw and the thread cutting is not necessary. If you need to use a cross-connection, you can make use of the external crossconnections available in our accessories.
308 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Feed-through terminals for direct mounting RKB | BKA | KBL • Modular assembly • Direct mount • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2
Part Number
BKA 2.5
RKB 4
Pre-assembled
BKA 4
Pre-assembled
Other colours available Connection diagram
BKA 2.5/2
BKA 4/2
BKA 2.5/3 Size (LWH)
27 x 6 x 27.5
22 x 5 x 23
4mm2
2.5mm2
Wire size Approvals
IEC
UL
IEC
500V
300V
400V
300CV
Current
32A
20A
24A
20A
Q 2-1.5*
AQI 2/5/11
Q 3-1.5*
AQI 3/5/11
Q 4-1.5*
AQI 4/5/11
Q 10-1.5*
AQI 10/5/11
BKA 4/5
4mm2
BKA 2.5/6 BKA 2.5/8
UL/cUL
BKA 4/4
22 x 6 x 23
BKA 2.5/5
Voltage
Cross connectors
BKA 4/3
BKA 2.5/4
IEC
BKA 2.5/10 BKA 2.5/12 BKA 2.5/13
BKA 4/6 BKA 4/8
UL/CSA
400V
300V
32A
30A/25A
BKA 2.5/14
BKA 4/10 BKA 4/11 BKA 4/12
AQI 2/6/11
BKA 2.5/15
AQI 3/6/11
BKA 2.5/16
AQI 4/6/11
BKA 2.5/18
AQI 10/6/11
BKA 2.5/20 End support
EH1
EH2
BKA 2.5/24
EH2
Part Number
BKA 10
Pre-assembled
KBL 2.5-D
KBL 2.5-4-D
KBL 6-10-D
Other colours available Connection diagram
BKA 10/2 BKA 10/3 BKA 10/4
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals Voltage Current
30 x 8 x 31
BKA 10/5
48 x 5 x 36.5
48 x 6 x 36.5
48 x 8 x 36.5
10mm
BKA 10/6
2.5mm
4mm2
10mm2
2
IEC
CSAus/CSA
400V
300V
57A
57A
Cross connectors
End support
0116 284 9900
EH3
AQI 2/8/11 AQI 3/8/11 AQI 4/8/11
BKA 10/8 BKA 10/10 BKA 10/12 BKA 10/13 BKA 10/14
2
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
300V
300V
700V
600V
300V
600V
20A
32A
32A
55A
20A
65A
BKA 10/15
Q 2-5mm*
Q 2-6mm*
Q 2-8mm*
BKA 10/18
Q 3-5mm*
Q 3-6mm*
Q 3-8mm*
BKA 10/20
Q 4-5mm*
Q 4-6mm*
Q 4-8mm*
BKA 10/24
Q 10-5mm*
Q10-6mm*
Q10-8mm*
EH4
EH4
EH4
TERMINALS
| 309
Terminals
High-power stud terminals HSKG
Stud technology
Stud connection • Stud sizes: M6, M8, M10, M12 to M16 • Wire with cable lug acc. to DIN 46234: up to 300 mm² • Two cable lugs can be connected per stud
Easy to use • Place cable lugs on the stud • By tightening the steel nut, the cable lugs forms a contact with the other cable lug or with the busbar • Secure contacts • Maintenance-free; subsequent tightening of the nut is not needed • High contact strength and vibration resistance provided by the safety/ spring washer and combi-nut • Direct contact of cable lugs, or contact via copper busbar The newest generation of stud terminals from CONTA-CLIP offers secure connections for all energy-transmitting applications. Depending on the wire cross-section, the HSKG stud terminals can be used with M6, M8, M10, M12 and M16 threaded studs. The rated current is from 125 A to 520 A with a rated voltage of 1000 V. The wire connection range is from 2.5 mm² to 300 mm². Wires with crimped cable lugs are applied to threaded bolts and then connected securely to the busbar by tightening the hex nut. Optimal security is guaranteed by the low voltage drop and by the use of self-extinguishing material with a V0 (UL94) flammability rating.
Mounting options • Sliding lock on both sides: can be attached to TS 35 DIN rail • Direct mount possible using the integrated slots in the housing base
Labelling and testing • Receptacles for standard markers • Openings in the ADH covers for measuring voltage
When used together with the ADH hinged covers, the HSKG stud terminals provide outstanding finger and touch protection. The ADH cover is easy to mount; it simply snaps into the side walls of the stud terminals as it is closed. In this quick and reliable way, touch-safe protection of the terminal points is always guaranteed. Terminal holders and covers made from Polyamide 6.6 V0 • Self-extinguishing, UL94-V0 flammability class • Creepage-current protected, CTI = 600 • Temperature resistance: -40° to +120°C • Spec. contact resistance: 1013 Ohm/cm • Spec. surface resistance: 1015 Ohm/cm • Temp. index, mechanical: 120°C (at 0.8 mm) • Temp. index, electrical: 120°C (at 0.8 mm) • Relative temperature index, electrical: 130°C (at 0.8 mm) • Pollutant-free Standards The following standard terminal block requirements are fulfilled:
• EN 60947-7-1 • EN 50124-1 • DIN EN 61373
310 | TERMINALS
Using the ADH covers Individual ADH… covers are available for each width of stud terminal. They are designed for the different sizes and the corresponding clearance and creepage distances. It is also possible to shorten the covers along precreased breakage points. The ADH cover is attached by pressing the cover down onto the base terminal so that the cover snaps onto the terminal.
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
High-power stud terminals HSKG • • • •
Part Number
TS 35 DIN rail or direct mount Integrated washers - ‘Combi-nut’ Stud connection Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
HSKG 35/M6/B/B
HSKG 70/M8/B/B
HSKG 120/M10/B/B
HSKG 185/M12/B/B
HSKG 300/M16/B/B
M6
M8
M10
M12
M16
Stud size Connection diagram
Size (LWH) inc covers
131 x 27 x 60
180 x 32 x 70
226 x 42 x 80
288 x 55 x 90
288 x 55 x 90
35mm
70mm
120mm
185mm
300mm2
Wire size Approvals
2
2
2
2
IEC
UL/cUL*
IEC
UL/cUL*
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
UL/cUL
Voltage
1000V
1000V/600V
1000V
1000V/600V
1000V
1000V/600V
1000V
1000V/600V
1000V
1000V/600V
Current
125A
115A/130A
192A
175A/170A
269A
310/310A
353A
380A/360A
520A
500A/510A
Cross connection rail
Cover profile
QS2/35/6
QS2/70/8
QS2/120/10
QS2/185/12
QS2/300/16
QS3/35/6
QS3/70/8
QS3/120/10
QS3/185/12
QS3/300/16
ADH35
ADH70
ADH120
ADH185/300
ADH185/300
Cover colours *Approval applied for
Test probe opening
Cross connection plate
Flexible marking options Additional bolting options
TS mount / direct mount
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 311
Terminals
Distribution blocks SVB Screw technology
The SVB screw-type distributor block makes it possible to distribute potential and power in a compact space without any additional accessories. You can use the distributor block to establish an electromechanical connection between a wire with a large cross-section and one or more wires with small cross-sections. They can be used in installation and distribution board construction and also in controller construction for machinery. The SVB blocks are mounted by snapping them on to TS 35 DIN rails. They can also be attached directly to a mounting plate using the screw flange located on the side of the housing.
312 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Distribution blocks SVB • High short-circuit resistance rating • IP20-class protection • Foot base can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rail or suitable for direct mounting • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 SVB 80
SVB 125
SVB 175
SVB 250
SVB 400
66 x 27 x 47
75 x 27 x 47
71 x 45 x 43
96 x 44 x 50
96 x 44 x 50
Part Number
Dimensions (L x W x H) Directly installed Size with TS 35 x 7.5 mm Connection data – Inputs Number of connections Clampable Wire size mm2 Connection data – Outputs Number of connections Clampable Wire size mm2
66 x 27 x 50 A
75 x 27 x 50
B
C
A
B
71 x 45 x 46 C
A
96 x 44 x 55
B
C
A
96 x 44 x 53
B
C
A
1
1
1
1
1
1
2.5 - 16
10 - 35
2.5 - 16
16 - 70
35 - 120
95 - 185
A
B
A
B
C
C
A
B
C
A
B
C
A
B
C
B
C
2
4
6
10
2
5
4
2
5
4
2.5 - 16
2.5 - 6
2.5 - 16
2.5 - 16
6 - 35
1.5 - 16
1.5 - 10
6 - 35
1.5 - 16
1.5 - 10
Approvals
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
Voltage
1000V
600V
Current
80A
80A
UL/cUL
IEC
1000V
600V
125A
115A
1000V
600V
175A
115A
Rated cross section for input and output mm2
16 | 16 - 6
35 - 16 |16
70 | 16
Part Number
SVB 160
SVB 175/3
SVB 125/4
92 x 35 x 50
71 x 80 x 50
74 x 98 x 43
UL
IEC
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
250A
230A
400A
310A
120 | 35 - 16 - 10
UL
185 | 35 - 16 - 10
Dimensions (L x W x H) Directly installed Size with TS 35 x 7.5 mm
92 x 35 x 54
Connection data – Inputs
A
Number of connections
1
Clampable Wire size mm
2
71 x 80 x 46
B
C
A
Number of connections
6
B
74 x 98 x 53 C
3x1
10 - 70
Connection data – Outputs
A
16 - 70 B
C
A
A
B
C
3x1
3x5
3x2
1.5 - 6
4 - 16
6 - 35 B
C
Neutral in/out
Busbar
3x6
2.5 - 16
16 x 5mm max
2.5 - 16
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
UL/cUL
IEC
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
600V
690V
Current
160A
160A
175A
115/175A
125A
Clampable Wire size mm Approvals
Rated cross section for input and output mm2
0116 284 9900
2
70 | 126
1
4
6 - 35
70 | 16
1.5 - 6
6 4 - 16 UL/cUL
35 | 16
TERMINALS
| 313
Terminals
Feed-through terminals ZRK | ZSL Proven – Safe – Reliable Tension spring technology
The connection | secure contact
Pluggable cross-connection options
The tension-spring at the wire connection is held securely by the positioned busbar. • The stainless steel spring provides permanent contact force between the wire and the busbar
Distributing potentials with the pluggable ZQI cross-connection system is quick and easy. Two cross-connection channels allow two voltages to be fed across when working with the standard terminals with rated crosssections of 2.5 mm2 and 4 mm2
• Clear separation of electrical and mechanical functions
• Available in 2 – 10 and 99 poles (for custom assemblies)
• The busbars are made from copper with surface coating (tin)
• Simple to insert and thus quicker to install
• Resistant to vibration and maintenance-free
• No insCSAusation plate or partition plate is required between a neighbouring cross-connection, since the ZQI has a touch-safe protective design
• Corrosion-free • Space-saving design • Foot base can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rail
• Cross-connection can carry the fCSAusl rated current and voltage of the corresponding terminal block • Individual terminals can be skipped over by breaking out contact pins in the cross-connector
314 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Feed-through terminals compact ZSRK | ZSLN • Foot can be snapped on TS 15 or TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
Part Number
ZSRK 2.5/2A/15
ZSRK 2.5/3A/15
ZSRK 2.5/2A
ZSRK 2.5/3A
40 x 5.1 x 34
52.5 x 5.1 x 34 (44)
43.5 x 5.1 x 36.5
55 x 5.1 x 36.5 (46.5)
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
800V
300V
800V
300V
800V
300V
800V
200V
Current
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
Cross connectors
End plate
Part Number
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
ZAP-SR
ZAP-SR3/15
ZAP-SR3
ZAP-SR3
ZSLN2.5/2A/15
ZSLN 2.5/3A/15
ZSLN 2.5/2A
ZSLN 2.5/3A
Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
40 x 5.1 x 34
52.5 x 5.1 x 34 (44)
43.5 x 5.1 x 36.5
55 x 5.1 x 36.5 (46.5)
Wire size
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
End plate
ZAP-SR-GREEN
ZAP-SR3/15-GREEN
ZAP-SR-GREEN
ZAP-SR3/GREEN
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 315
Terminals
Feed-through terminals ZRK | ZSL • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
Part Number
ZRK 2.5/2A
ZRK 2.5/3A
ZRK 2.5/4A
ZRK 2.5/2 x 2A
59 x 5.1 x 39
71.3 x 5.1 x 39
83.6 x 5.1 x 39
83.6 x 5.1 x 39
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
800V
600V
800V
600V
800V
600V
800V
600V
Current
24A
27A
24A
27A
24A
27A
24A
27A
Cross connectors
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
ZQI 2.5/0.5 m/99
End plate
ZAP 2.5/2A
ZAP 2.5/3A
ZAP 2.5/4A
Part Number
ZSL 2.5/2A
ZSL 2.5/3A
ZSL 2.5/4A
ZAP 2.5/4A
Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
59 x 5.1 x 39
71.3 x 5.1 x 39
83.6 x 5.1 x 39
Wire size
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
End plate
ZAP 2.5/2A-GREEN
ZAP 2.5/3A-GREEN
ZAP 2.5/4A-GREEN
316 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Feed-through terminals ZRK | ZSL • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
ZRK 4/2A
ZRK 4/3A
ZRK 4/4A
ZRK 4/2 x 2A
64 x 6.1 x 42
78.5 x 6.1 x 42
93 x 6.1 x 42
64 x 6.1 x 42
4mm2
4mm2
4mm2
4mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
800V
600V
800V
600V
800V
600V
800V
600V
Current
32A
35A
32A
35A
32A
35A
32A
35A
Cross connectors
ZQI 4/2
ZQI 4/2
ZQI 4/2
ZQI 4/3
ZQI 4/3
ZQI 4/3
ZQI 4/4
ZQI 4/4
ZQI 4/4
ZQI 4/10
ZQI 4/10
ZQI 4/10
End plate
ZAP 4/2A
ZAP 4/3A
ZAP 4/4A
Part Number
ZSL 4/2A
ZSL 4/3A
ZSL 4/4A
ZAP 4/4A
Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
64 x 6.1 x 42
78.5 x 6.1 x 42
93 x 6.1 x 42
Wire size
4mm2
4mm2
4mm2
End plate
ZAP 4/2A-GREEN
ZAP 4/3A-GREEN
ZAP 4/4A-GREEN
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 317
Terminals
Feed-through terminals ZRK | ZSL • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
ZRK 6/2A
ZRK 10/2A
ZRK 16/2A
64 x 8.1 x 47.5
73.5 x 10.1 x 50.5
81.5 x 12.1 x 51.5
6mm2
10mm2
16mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
1000V
600V
1000V
500V
1000V
1000V
Current
41A
50A
57A
55A
76A
Cross connectors
ZQI 6/2
65A
ZQI 10/2
ZQI 16/2
ZQI 6/3 ZQI 6/4 ZQI 6/10
End plate
ZAP 6/2A
ZAP 10/2A
ZAP 16/2A
Part Number
ZSL 6/2A
ZSL 10/2A
ZSL 16/A
64 x 8.1 x 47.5
73.5 x 10.1 x 50.5
81.5 x 12.1 x 51.5
Wire size
6mm2
10mm2
16mm2
End plate
ZAP 6/2A-GREEN
ZAP 10/2A-GREEN
ZAP 16/2A-GREEN
Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
318 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
ZSRK | SRK accessories Warning signs and shrouds VDE regulations require that the mains terminals be covered. The yellow ZAD covers (labelled with a lightning flash) are used to cover the operational channel, thus they discourage operation of the terminal while live voltage is present.
Part number
Pitch Material For terminal
ZAD 2.5/4/B
ZAD 4/4/B
ZAD 6/4/B
ZAD 10/4/B
5.1 mm
6.1 mm
8.1 mm
10.1 mm
12 mm
PA 6.6 V0
PA 6.6 V0
PA 6.6 V0
PA 6.6 V0
PA 6.6 V0
ZSRK 2.5… ZSLN 2.5… ZRK 2.5… ZSL 2.5… ZRKD 2.5… ZSLD 2.5… ZIKD 2.5… ZTRK 2.5… ZVMAK 2.5… ZIZA 1.5…
ZRK 4… ZSL 4…
ZRK 10… ZSL 10…
ZRK 10… ZSL 10…
ZRK 16… ZSL 16…
ZAD 16/4/B
Actuating tools BWMA/BW The ZSRK/ZRK spring terminals with 2.5 mm2 cross-section can be operated using the BW 1 to BW 10 tools and the BWMA metallic tool. The special BW tools allow you to open multiple terminal points simultaneously. The plastic actuating tool features improved safety when working on running facility sections.
0116 284 9900
BWMA 1 (0.5 X 3.5)
BW…(ZRK)
BW (ZRK)
Metal actuating tool
Plastic actuating tool
Plastic actuating tool
BWMA 1 (0.5 X 3.5)
BW 1 (ZRK)
BW 6 (ZRK)
-
BW 2 (ZRK)
BW 7 (ZRK)
-
BW 3 (ZRK)
BW 8 (ZRK)
-
BW 4 (ZRK)
BW 9 (ZRK)
-
BW 5 (ZRK)
BW 10 (ZRK)
TERMINALS
| 319
Terminals
Double-level terminal blocks ZRKD 2.5 | ZSLD 2.5 Tension spring technology
With a width of just 5 mm, the new ZRKD series is available in thirteen versions and connects with stranded or solid wires up to 24 mm² with a rated current of up to 24A. Solid and stranded wires with wire-end ferrules can be inserted into the connection system with a tool or standard screwdriver. Inserting the tool opens the tension spring for easy conductor insertion. When closed, the conductor is securely clamped against the internal busbar. The PE foot from CONTA-CLIP that contacts the PE potential to the DIN rail is designed to contact on both sides. This means that more material is required; however this offers more safety in the area around the protective earth contact. In all the ZSL series, the foot construction and busbar are made of a single piece of copper. This solid, contiguous construction guarantees low contact resistance as well as the high security of the internal-spring PE contact foot.
Cross-connection system The upper and lower levels can be cross-connected using the ZQI 2,5/â&#x20AC;Ś standard cross-connections. The ZQI insulated cross-connections have a pluggable design and are available with from 2 to 10 poles. They cross connect up to the rated current of the relevant ZRKD terminals.
Vertical connection ZVQI
Colour coding
The upper and lower levels can be connected to each other using the ZVQI vertical cross-connector.
The upper and lower levels can be supplied with colour splash to indicate /N blue and /PE Green/Yellow (for example, ZRKD 2,5 N-PE)
320 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Double-level terminal blocks ZRKD 2.5 | ZSLD 2.5 • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
ZRKD 2.5
ZRKD 2.5 SV
ZRKD 2.5 N-DU
ZRKD 2.5 DU-PE
ZRKD 2.5 N-PE
83.6 x 5.1 x 64
83.6 x 5.1 x 64
83.6 x 5.1 x 64
83.6 x 5.1 x 64
83.6 x 5.1 x 64
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
Current
24A
10A
24A
10A
24A
10A
24A
10A
24A
Cross connectors
End plate
10A
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAPD 2.5
ZAPD 2.5
ZAPD 2.5
ZAPD 2.5
ZAPD 2.5
ZSLD 2.5
ZBA Labelling Adapter for ZRKD 2.5
83.6 x 5.1 x 64
22 x 5 x 11
Part Number
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size
2.5mm2
End plate
ZAPD 2.5-GREEN
Connecting the PE foot onto the DIN rail As with all CONTA-CLIP PE terminals, the ZSLD terminals also implement a two-sided contact with the DIN rail. In all the ZRK series, the foot construction and busbar are made of a single piece of copper. This solid, contiguous construction guarantees low contact resistance as well as the high security of the internal-spring PE contact foot.
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 321
Terminals
Three-level terminals ZIKD 2.5 | Motor-connection terminal ZVMAK Tension spring technology
Three-level terminal blocks ZIKD 2.5 The ZIKD 2.5 terminal blocks have a width of 5 mm and are available in a variety of designs. They have three levels with six connection points and can handle solid or stranded wires up to 2.5 mm2 with a rated current up to 24A. The lower level is designed as a feed-through or PE connection. All levels can be cross-connected to neighbouring terminal blocks. You can also use a vertical connector to bridge them within a terminal block.
PE foot on both sides
Vertical connection ZVQI
Cross-connection ZQI on 3 levels
Four-level terminal blocks ZVMAK 2,5 The ZVMAK 2.5 has a width of 5mm. It has four levels with seven connection points and can handle solid or stranded wires up to 2.5 mm² with a rated current up to 24A. The lower level is designed as a PE connection. The PE foot contacts both sides of the DIN rail, thus ensuring optimal electrical security. The ZVMAK motor-connection terminals can be cross-connected using the AQI external cross connection.
PE foot on both sides
322 | TERMINALS
External cross-connection AQI
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Three-level terminals ZIKD 2.5 | Motor-connection terminal ZVMAK • Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
ZIKD 2.5
ZIKD 2.5 SV
ZIKD 2.5 L/L/N
ZIKD 2.5 PE/L/N
ZIKD 2.5 PE/L/L
116.2 x 5.1 x 68
116.2 x 5.1 x 68V
116.2 x 5.1 x 68
116.2 x 5.1 x 68
116.2 x 5.1 x 68
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
Current
24A
15A
24A
15A
24A
15A
24A
15A
24A
Cross connectors
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAP/ID 2.5
ZAP/ID 2.5
ZAP/ID 2.5
ZAP/ID 2.5
ZAP/ID 2.5
ZIKD 2.5 PE/N/N
ZIKD 2.5 SV/PE
ZVMAK 2.5
116.2 x 5.1 x 68
116.2 x 5.1 x 68V
103.5 x 5.1 x 73
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
End plate
Part Number
15A
ZQI 2.5/2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
500V
300V
400V
300V
Current
24A
15A
24A
Cross connectors
15A
ZQI 2.5/2
AQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
AQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4 ZQI 2.5/9 ZQI 2.5/10 ZQI 2.5/99 End plate
0116 284 9900
ZAP/IK 2.5-BLUE
(External) ZAP/IK 2.5-GREEN
ZAP-MA TERMINALS
| 323
Terminals
Disconnect and fuse terminals ZTRK Tension spring technology
The ZTRK base terminal line can be combined in different ways with the product-related line of accessories as two-wire, three-wire and four-wire variants. Without any assembly, the three base terminals can receive auto-fuses or diode plugs. Alternatively, the base terminals are available equipped with a disconnect blade or a fuse holder for G fuses. The functions of all versions can be changed by removing or adding the disconnect blade, the fuse holder, or the diode plug. The plug-in fuse holders are available as models with or without a status display. They offer great flexibility, easy handling and a wide selection of 5x 20 G fuses. Solid and stranded wires with or without wire-end ferrules can be inserted into the connection system with the use of an actuating tool. The tension spring establishes a secure contact between the conductive wire and the busbar.
ZDS/ZTR
Disconnect/Diode plug
ZS/H…./ZTR
For the fuse and disconnect terminals with tension-spring connections, there are many terminals blocks with disconnect blade and disconnect plug available, as well as a fuse holder for auto-fuses and micro-fuses. Each of the tension-spring terminal blocks can be equipped with the standard accessories: the ZQI 2.5 (cross connector) and the PMC SB 5 (quick marking system).
Disconnect terminals ZTRK 2.5/…/MT and ZTRK 2.5/…/ST Disconnect terminals are often used in measurement, regulation and control technology in order to simplify troubleshooting and in order to be able to commission new systems or carry out revisions on older systems. In the tension-spring system, two models (disconnect-plug/disconnect-blade) are available in the base terminal variations of 2-, 3- and 4- wire systems The proven ZDS|ZTR disconnect-plug and ZTRK 2.5…/MT disconnectblade systems with high surface quality and, therefore, low and stable transitional resistance, ensures accurate measurement results. They distinguish themselves by their narrow construction of only 5 mm and a high current capacity of 18A. In addition to the ZTR disconnect-plug models (feed-through connection), ZDS diode plugs (I N 4007) are also available. It is easy to distribute potential voltages in combination with the pluggable ZQI cross connectors.
Fuse plug for 5 x 20 fuses
ZS/H…./ZTR
Plug for fuses with LED
Fuse holder for micro-fuse/auto-fuse ZTRK 2.5/…/OT with auto-fuse and ZTRK 2.5/…/ZS The base terminals can hold auto-fuses without needing any accessories. With the fuse plug ZS/H, available in five variations, 5 x 20 fuses can be accommodated. Due to the special construction of the base terminal/fuse holder, the fuse plugs can be inserted in alternate directions on a pitch of only 5mm. The fuse plugs are available in variations with or without status display (different voltage ranges). With a rated voltage of 400V, the rated current of the fuse plug is 6.3A. In combination with the pluggable ZQI cross connectors, it is easy to distribute voltage potentials. A measurement pick-off can be made on each individual terminal block using the test channel and the ZTA 2.5 test adapter of the PS 2.3 test plug.
Cross-connector ZQI The ZQI insulated cross-connections have a pluggable design and are available with from 2 to 10 and 99 poles. They cross connect up to the rated current of the relevant ZTRK terminals.
324 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Disconnect and fuse terminals ZTRK | FSIK • •
Part Number
Foot can be snapped on TS 35 DIN rails Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
ZTRK 2.5/2A/MT
ZTRK 2.5/3A/MT
ZTRK 2.5/4A/MT
ZTRK 2.5/2A/ST
ZTRK 2.5 3A/ST
68 x 5.1 x 42.3
80.2 x 5.1 x 42.3
92.4 x 5.1 x 42.3
68 x 5.1 x 57.1
80.2 x 5.1 x 57.1
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals Voltage Current
IEC
IEC
IEC
IEC
IEC
400V
400V
400V
400V
400V
18A
18A
18A
18A
18A
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAPT 2.5/2A
ZAPT 2.5/3A
ZAPT 2.5/4A
ZAPT 2.5/2A
ZAPT 2.5/3A
ZTRK 2.5/4A/ST
ZTRK 2.5/2A/ZS
ZTRK 2.5/3A/ZS
ZTRK 2.5/4A/ZS
FSIK 4/2A
92.4 x 5.1 x 57.1
68 x 5.1 x 78.7
80.2 x 5.1 x 78.7
92.4 x 5.1 x 78.7
67.5 x 6.1 x 70
Wire size
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm
Approvals
IEC
IEC
IEC
IEC
IEC*
Voltage
400V
400V
400V
400V
250V
300
Current
18A
18A
18A
18A
6.3A
6.3A
5 x 20
5 x 20
5 x 20
5 x 20
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
FQI 4/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
FQI 4/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
FQI 4/4
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
FQI 4/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAPT 2.5/4A
ZAPT 2.5/2A
ZAPT 2.5/3A
ZAPT 2.5/4A
FAPSI 4
Cross connectors
End plate
Part Number
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
2
Fuse size mm Cross connectors
End plate
0116 284 9900
2
2
2
UL/cUL*
TERMINALS
| 325
Terminals
Compact terminal series for direct mounting ZSRK | ZSLN Tension spring technology
The ZSRK 2.5/2A/D/F and ZSRK 2.5/2A/RC are direct-mount tensionspring terminals with interior cross-connection channels. The have a compact, modular design with a clamping range of 0.08 - 2.5 mm² and a rated voltage of 800 V. They allow you to mount a terminal block with the number of poles you need. This block can then be directly screwed on to the mounting plate (with the ZSRK 2.5/2A/D/F) or directly snapped on (with the ZSRK 2.5/2A/RC).
It is possible to label with the SB or PMC quick marking systems at each clamping point. If a cross-connection is not being used, that crossconnection channel can be used instead as a labelling channel. Clarity for wiring is ensured with a terminal width of only 5 mm and the tension-spring TOP connection.
These direct-mount terminals can be used for series production and for installations in cramped working conditions. Individual connection groupings or circuits can be visually separated from one other by the different housing colours. Potentials can be multiplied via the interior cross-connection channel with the ZQI 2.5 standard crossconnections (available in 2 â&#x20AC;&#x201C; 10 poles and 99 poles).
ZSRK 2.5 direct-mount with screw flange
326 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Compact terminal series for direct mounting ZSRK | ZSLN • Direct mounting – snap-in or screw flange • Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0
Part Number
ZSRK 2.5/2A/D
ZSLN 2.5/2A/D
ZSRK 2.5/2A-RC
ZSLN 2.5/2A/RC
ZSRK 2.5/2A-D/F
40 x 5.1 x 24
40 x 5.1 x 24
40 x 5.1 x 24
40 x 5.1 x 24
40 x 11.1 x 24
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
800V
300V
Current
24A
Cross connectors
IEC
CSAus/CSA
20A
CSAus/CSA 300V
24A
IEC
CSAus/CSA
20A
IEC
CSAus/CSA
800V
300V
24A
20A
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAP-SR-RC
ZAP-SR-RC
End plate
Part Number
IEC 800V
ZSLN 2.5/2A-D/F
ZEH 1
40 x 11.1 x 24
40 x 11.1 x 24
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage Current Cross connectors
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/9
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
End plate
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 327
Terminals
Pluggable tension-spring connection system ZST Tension spring pluggable technology
Conta-Clip's modular and flexible ZST connectivity solutions are in demand wherever off-the-shelf functional units need to be connected or replaced. Using the ZST tension-spring connection system, pluggable wiring is possible up to a rated current of 24 A, a rated voltage of 500 V, and a cross-section range of 0.5 mm² to 4 mm². Advantages of the ZST connection: • Quick installation and mounting • Flexible and modular building block principle • High level of wiring safety due to unique coding option • Highest mechanical stability of the pluggable elements in the base terminals The connection | Contact security The tension spring for the wire connection is held securely by the busbar. • The stainless steel spring provides permanent contact force between the wire and the busbar
Pluggable cross-connection options • Available in 2 – 10 and 99 poles (for custom assemblies) • Simple to insert and thus quicker to install • No insulation plates or partition plates required between neighbouring cross-connections, since the ZQIs have a touchsafe protective design • Cross-connection can carry the full rated current and voltage of the corresponding terminal block • Individual terminals can be skipped over by breaking out contact pins in the cross-connector Housing insulation material • Polyamide PA6.6 UL 94, flammability class V0, self-extinguishing without burning drops • Free of hazardous materials such as halogen or phosphor • Creepage resistance: CTI 600 • Temperature resistant -40˚C to +120˚C
• There is a clear separation of electrical and mechanical functions
Pluggable contact
• The busbars are made from copper with tin surface coating
• Rated current 24 A
• Resistant to vibration and maintenance-free
• Rated voltage 500 V
• Corrosion-free
• Vibration resistant
Quick and easy to wire
• Codable
The easy-to-operate tension-spring connection mechanism reduces your wiring times. • Easy to work with • Easy to operate, even under cramped working conditions, because of the TOP connection • Generous wire-entry geometry • Saves time and money • PE foot contact on both sides – can be snapped on (no screws) to TS 35 x 7.5 and TS 35 x 15 rails • Space-saving design
328 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Pluggable tension-spring connection system ZST • • • •
Part Number
Flexible mounts TS 15, TS 35 or as flying lead coupling Finger-touch safe construction Codable Freely configurable
ZSTK 2.5/1A/1S-H/B
ZSTK 2.5/1A/1S-H/15
ZSTK 2.5/1A/1S-H/35
ZST 2.5/1A
ZST 2.5/1A/Q
40 x 5.1 x 19
40 x 5.1 x 33
44 x 5.1 x 35
26 x 5.1 x 16.5
26 x 5.1 x 21
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size
2
2
2
2
Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
500V
300V
Current
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
20A
24A
Cross connectors
20A ZQI 2.5/2 ZQI 2.5/3 ZQI 2.5/4 ZQI 2.5/10 ZQI 2.5/99
End plate
Part Number
ZAPSK1A1S
ZAPSK1A1S
ZAPSK1A1S
ZAPST1A
ZAPST1AQ
ZRKS 2.5/1A/1S
ZSLS 2.5/1A/1S
ZRKS 2.5/1A/2S
ZSLS 2.5/1A/2S
ZRKS 2.5/2A/1S
54 x 5.1 x 39.5
54 x 5.1 x 39.5
72.5 x 5.1 x 39.5
72.5 x 5.1 x 39.5
64 x 5.1 x 39.5
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size
2
2
Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage
500V
Current
24A
Cross connectors
End plate
IEC*
2
UL/CSA*
2
IEC*
UL/CSA*
300V
500V
20A
24A
IEC*
UL/ CSA*
IEC*
UL/CSA*
300V
500V
300V
20A
24A
20A
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAPS1A2S
ZAPS1A2S-GRN
ZAPS2.5/2A/1S
ZAPS2.5/1A/1S
ZAPS2.5/1A/1SGN
*Approval applied for
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 329
Terminals
Pluggable tension-spring connection system ZST • • • •
Part Number
Flexible mounts TS 15, TS 35 or as flying lead coupling Finger-touch safe construction Codable Freely configurable
ZSLS 2.5/2A/1S
ZRKS 2.5/2A/2S
ZSLS 2.5/2A/2S
ZRKS 2.5/2S
ZSLS 2.5/2S
64 x 5.1 x 39.5
82 x 5.1 x 39.5
82 x 5.1 x 39.5
54 x 5.1 x 39.5
54 x 5.1 x 39.5
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Wire size Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage Current
Part Number
UL/CSA* 300V
24A
Cross connectors
End plate
IEC* 500V
IEC*
UL/CSA*
20A
IEC*
UL/CSA*
500V
300V
24A
IEC*
UL/CSA*
20A
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAPS2.5/2A/1SGN
ZAPS2A2S
ZAPS2A2S-GREEN
ZAPS2.52S
ZAPS2.52S-GREEN
ZRKS 2.5/4S
ZSLS 2.5/4S
ZST-V
ZST-Z
ZST-C
Locking clip
Strain relief
Coding pin
Other colours available Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
90 x 5.1 x 39.5
90 x 5.1 x 39.5
2.5mm2
2.5mm2
Wire size Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage
500V
300V
Current
24A
Cross connectors
End plate
IEC*
UL/CSA*
20A ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/2
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/3
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/4
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/10
ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/99
ZAP2.54S
ZAP2.54S-GREEN
*Approval applied for
330 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals Wall bushing for ZST • • • •
Versatile and easy installation Finger-touch safe construction Codable Freely configurable
Wall bushing for ZST
Advantages of wall bushings for the ZST:
CONTA-CLIP's modular and flexible ZST connection systems are in high demand wherever off-the-shelf units need to be connected or replaced. Pluggable wiring is thus permitted up to a rated current of 24A and a rated voltage of 500V. Effective panel feed-through bushings can be constructed simply by snapping the ZST-WA mounting adapter onto the ZSTK 2.5/.../B coupling element. These multi-pole units snap on sideways to the panel; the pressure on the inner slide mechanism ensures a secure attachment to the housing! The outer connector unit can be optionally fitted with locking elements.
• Quick installation and mounting • Flexible and modular building block principle • High level of wiring safety due to unique coding option • Outstanding mechanical attachment of the pluggable elements in the coupling element for the wall bushing
Creating the cut-out in the wall The height of the rectangular cut-out in the wall does not change. The length, however, varies depending on the number of aligned poles in the coupling/plug unit.
Part Number
ZSTK 2.5/1A/1S-H/B
Other colours available
ZST-WAV1
ZST-WA1
Locking pins
Wall adapter
Connection diagram
Size (LWH)
40 x 5.1 x 19
Wire size
44 x 14 x 19
2.5mm2
Approvals
IEC*
UL/CSA*
Voltage
500V
300V
Current
24A
End plate
20A ZAPSK
*Approval applied for
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 331
Terminals
Initiator / Actuator terminals ZIZA | ZMP distribution terminals Tension spring technology
In order to start-up electromechanical functions in machinery and facilities, a link must be established from signal emitters (sensors and limit switches), actuators (valves) and alerts (beacons and sounders) with the controller. These signals are consolidated in decentralized units in order to reduce the wiring overhead and speed up the troubleshooting process. Exacting demands are placed on the connection system that is used in the cramped, hard-to-reach installations for machinery and facilities. Our ZINI/ZAKTO – consisting of the ZIZA base terminals and the ZPL potential distribution strip – is perfectly suited for such exacting requirements. The ZIZA base terminal is designed to feed the sense/control signal level through. It enables the attachment of ZPL potential distribution strips (plus, minus and PE potentials). The potential distribution strip consists of a individual slice each having one electrical connection. Depending on the application, these individual slices can be linked to achieve the required number of poles. No additional cross-connector is needed since the potential distribution strip established its own electrical cross-connection using the base terminal. The ZMP 1.5 potential distribution system makes it possible for the encoder, input, and control voltages (required centrally) to distribute their voltage supplies. It is easy to work with because of the modular design. The number of poles required is determined by the user’s application. The ZMP consists of ZMP 1.5 base terminals with four slots for plugging in the ZPL potential distribution strips. The patented, integrated cross-connection system on the ZPL potential distribution strip results in reduced costs and less time spent with cross-connections. The potential distribution strips are colour-coded (beige, brown, blue, green-yellow, yellow, green, orange and red). Four potentials – together with the ZBA labelling adapters – can be led in parallel in addition to many adjacent potentials. The system is compact, modular, and easy to work with. It is designed for 400 V and a current of 17.5 A.
The ZINI/Zakto labelling adapter The ZBA labelling adapter is used to label the side-by-side ZPL potential distribution strips. The ZBA is also used to separate two different potentials within the ZPL slot on the base terminals. In contrast to the ZBA 2, the ZBA 2/Z has pegs which form a mechanical (but electrically-separated) connection within a receiving channel. The ZBA 2/Z/H features a larger labelling surface which also simplifies the task of separating the contact on the ZPL potential distribution strip from the base terminals.
332 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Initiator / Actuator terminals ZIZA | ZMP • • • •
Foot can be snapped on TS35 DIN rails Housing made from polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V0 Modular or pre-assembled options Pluggable cross connectors (ZQI)
Part Number
ZIZA 1.5/3
ZIZA 1.5/3/B
ZIZA 1.5/3/PE
ZIZA 1.5/4
ZIZA 1.5/4/B
ZIZA 1.5/4/PE
ZMP 1.5
Initiator/actuator terminals 4 connections
Initiator/actuator terminals 2 connections
Initiator/actuator terminals 5 connections
Initiator/actuator terminals 3 connections
Patch panel 4 connections
68.7 x 5.1 x 40.5
68.7 x 5.1 x 40.5
82 x 5.1 x 40.5
82 x 5.1 x 40.5
68.7 x 5.1 x 40.5
0.5-1.5 mm
0.5-1.5 mm
0.5-1.5 mm
0.5-1.5 mm
0.5-1.5 mm2
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) Contact wire range Approvals
2
2
2
2
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
Current
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
End plate
ZAP TW -ZIZA 1.5/3
ZAP TW -ZIZA 1.5/3
ZAP TW-ZIZA 1.5/4
ZAP TW-ZIZA 1.5/4
ZAP-ZMP
Part Number
ZIZA 1.5/3/…/POL
ZIZA 1.5/3/…/POL/PE
ZIZA 1.5/4/…/POL/PE
ZPL 1.5
ZBA 2
Other colours available Terminal block 4 connections per signal
Terminal block 4 connections per signal
Terminal block 4 connections per signal
ZIZA 1.5/3/8
ZIZA 1.5/3/8 PE
ZIZA 1.5/4/8 PE
ZIZA 1.5/3/9
-
-
Type
Size (LWH)
ZIZA 1.5/3/10 PE
ZIZA 1.5/4/10 PE
ZIZA 1.5/3/16 PE
ZIZA 1.5/4/16 PE
ZIZA 1.5/3/17
-
-
68.7 x *X x 40.5
68.7 x *X x 40.5
82 x *X x 40.5
0.5-1.5 mm2
0.5-1.5 mm2
0.5-1.5 mm2
Contact wire range Approvals
ZIZA 1.5/3/10 ZIZA 1.5/3/16
Potential distribution strip
ZBA 2/Z/H 0.5-1.5 mm2
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
IEC
CSAus/CSA
Voltage
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
400 V
300 V
Current
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
17.5 A
12.5 A
Cross connector
ZQI 2.5/2 to ZQI 2.5/10 ZQI 2.5/99
ZQI 2.5/2 to ZQI 2.5/10 ZQI 2.5/99
ZBA 2/Z
ZQI 2.5/2 to ZQI 2.5/10 ZQI 2.5/99
*X = number poles x 5.1mm plus ends
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 333
Terminals
Shield-connection clip SAB Spring clip technology
A high degree of interference immunity is demanded of the electrical equipment used in industrial processing applications. This is a critical factor that influences the availability of industrial measurement and control systems. When constructing low-interference systems, both the cable shielding and the shielded ground are very important. The juncture where the cable shielding connects to the housing ground is a critical point. The connection should be low-ohm and should also feature minimal inductive resistance. You should be certain that this connection can be established in a practical, simple and quick manner. The rich feature set of CONTA-CLIP's SAB/SSAB clip meets all of these requirements. Busbar mounting with the SAB The SAB can be mounted on a busbar. After connecting the wiring, the shield-connection clip is mounted by simply swivelling the SAB clip onto the busbar. The force on the cable comes from a spring-pressure piece. This regulated pressure ensures a constant optimal contact. This makes the SAB shield-connection clip very convenient to wire. Depending on the length of the terminal blocks, two or more SH/SAB busbar supports should be used. These mechanically connect the front busbar with the DIN rail (support).
The SH1 busbar supports are used where a shield-connection system must be mounted directly onto a panel rather than a DIN rail. The 10 x 3 busbars can be easily and quickly snapped on to these supports. In both cases, the contact with the earth or ground potential can be established with a ZB clamping yoke.
Direct mounting for the SAB…/D The SAB…/D can be mounted directly. The force on the cable comes from a spring-pressure piece. This regulated pressure ensures a constant optimal contact. The SAB… /D can be installed with an M4 screw (included in delivery) directly to the mounting plate. The SAB 8/D M5 shield-connection clip comes with a special feature; it is equipped with a self-cutting M5 SW3 metal screw. As a result, less time is required to mount the clip on the mounting plate, since you only need to drill one 4.2mm hole through the plate. The hole threads will then be cut into the plate by the screw.
DIN rail installation SAB.../MF/35 The SAB…/MF/35 can be installed on a DIN rail. The SAB…/MF/35 is snapped on directly via the internal-spring MF/35 foot without any tools. The force on the cable comes from a
334 | TERMINALS
spring-pressure piece. This regulated pressure ensures a constant optimal contact with the DIN rail.
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Shield-connection clip SAB • Quick snap-on or mounting of the shield-connection clip • Different cable cross-sections can be accommodated because of the elastic nature of the spring force clip • Standards – IEC/EN • Material – steel
SAB 8
SAB 13.5
SAB 20
SAB 32
Size
18.5 x 13 x 26.5
22 x 19.5 x 32.5
27 x 24.5 x 40.5
32 x 36 x 64
Type
SAB 8
SAB 13.5
SAB 20
SAB 32
Cable diameter
3–8
4 – 13.5
10 – 20
15 – 32
SAB 8/D
SAB 13.5/D
SAB 20/D
SAB 32/D
18.5 x 13 x 26.5
22 x 19.5 x 32.5
27 x 24.5 x 40.5
32 x 36 x 64
SAB 8/D
SAB 13.5/D
SAB 20/D
SAB 32/D
SAB 8/D/M5
SAB 13.5/D/M5
SAB 20/D/M5
SAB 32/D/M5
3–8
4 – 13.5
10 – 20
15 – 32
M4 x 10
M4 x 10
M4 x 10
M4 x 10
M5 x 10
M5 x 10
M5 x 10
M5 x 10
4.2
4.2
4.2
4.2
Product
SAB 8/MF/35/S
SAB 13.5/MF/35/S
SAB 20/MF/35/S
SAB 32/MF/35/S
Size
18.5 x 13 x 26.5
22 x 19.5 x 32.5
27 x 24.5 x 40.5
32 x 36 x 64
SAB 8/MF/35/S
SAB 13.5/MF/35/S
SAB 20/MF/35/S
SAB 32/MF/35/S
3–8
4 – 13.5
10 – 20
15 – 32
M4 x 8
M4 x 8
M4 x 8
M4 x 8
4.2
4.2
4.2
4.2
Product
Product
Size
Type Cable diameter mm Screw Drill hole diameter mm
Type Cable diameter mm Screw Drill hole diameter mm
0116 284 9900
Busbar mounting
A SAB application with the SH1
Direct mounting
SAB… /D
Din rail mounting
SAB/…/MF/35
TERMINALS
| 335
Terminals
Busbar support and clamping yoke ZB
Busbars and clamping yokes The ZB clamping yoke can be used in conjunction with the busbars in order to bring the neutral conductor or PE conductor together centrally. In order to help customize the facility wiring, the clamping yoke can be pushed onto the busbar. The SH and ES busbar supports are used for attachment. With longer rails, these can be positioned between the clamping yokes. The clamping yoke as a PE connection is available with green/yellow insulation caps. These caps signal the PE function together with the labelling tags and enable the PE wires to be clearly assigned. If you are using the clamping yoke to connection neutral conductors, then it can be marked with a blue insulation cap.
Mount with busbar support ES 335/K/ST
Mount with busbar support SH 1BG
Mount with busbar support SH SAB BG
Busbar Ssch Product
Ssch 10 x 3
Ssch 6 x 6
Type
Busbar 10 x 3
Busbar 6 x 6
Size
100 x 10 x 3
100 x 6 x 6
Non-insulated
Ssch 10 x 3 MS brass
Ssch 6 x 6 MS brass
Non-insulated
Ssch 10 x 3 CU copper
Ssch 6 x 6 CU copper
Load current
140A/100A
140A/100A
336 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Busbar support • Various mounting options • Material: polyamide 6.6
Product
SH 1
SH SAB
ES 35/K/ST
SES 35
Busbar support
Busbar support
Busbar support
Snap-on busbar support
Type
SH 1
SH SAB
ES 35/K/ST
SES 35 BG
-
-
-
SES 35 BK
Size
24 x 24 x 23.7
50 x 9.5 x 98
50 x 9.5 x 44
48 x 8 x 47.1
Clamping yoke ZB • • • •
Product
Type
Screw connection Material: steel Busbar support Material: polyamide 6.6
ZB 4/… 10 x 3
ZB 4/… 6 x 6
ZB 16/… 10 x 3
ZB 16/… 6 x 6
ZB 35/… 10 x 3
Clamping yoke 4mm2 for busbar 10 x 3
Clamping yoke 4mm2 for busbar 6 x 6
Clamping yoke 16mm2 for busbar 10 x 3
Clamping yoke 16mm2 for busbar 6 x 6
Clamping yoke 35mm2 for busbar 10 x 3
Colours available Non-insulated Insulated Screw connection Screw Rated conductor cross-section, mm2
0116 284 9900
ZB 4
ZB 4/6
ZB 16
ZB 16/6
ZB 35
ZB 4/K
ZB 4/6/K
ZB 16/K
ZB 16/6/K
ZB 35/K
15.5 x 5.3 x 11.7
12 x 5.5 x 15
15.5 x 10 x 16.5
12 x 9.5 x 19.9
18 x 14 x 21
M3 x 8
M3 x 8
M4 x 12
M4 x 12
M6 x 15
0.5-4
0.5-4
2.5-16
2.5-16
16-35
TERMINALS
| 337
Terminals
Interface modules Interface modules allow for a passive mechanical-electrical implementation of standard connectors onto screw or tension-spring PCB terminals.The individual signals of the multi-pole or high-pole connectors are implemented one-to-one to the PCB – from the individual wire via connectors to pre-assembled cables. Thus the assembly time and associated costs are reduced. Because of the compact design of the interface modules, their clear terminal labelling, and their simple assembly on TS32 or TS35 rails, this system represents an attractive alternative to a pure individual wire approach.
RJ 45 USB interface modules
Interface modules FBK…C
RJ 45 and USB modules implement the standardized RJ45 Ethernet and USB connectors from bus systems, computer components, laptops or modems on screw PCB terminals. They can be mounted with the compact RS-SP0 profile on the TS 35 rail.
The FBK modules enable the assembly of pre-assembled cables with connectors (from 10 to 64 poles) according to IEC 603-1/DIN 41651, for use with screw or tension-spring PCB terminals.
w
Interface modules SD…C and high density
Interface modules OE-E
Signal lines can be implemented with SD modules, using male or female connectors, according to IEC 807-2/DIN 41652, on screw or tensionspring PCB terminals. The interface modules are equipped with their respective counterparts, which are available with from 9 to 37 poles. The SD-LA modules also feature a LED status display.
The OE interface modules make use of the EDAC "hermaphrodite" multipole plug (Series 516) on screw connections. This results in excellent shock and vibration resistance. The offset arrangement of the connector means that the neighbouring modules will not be impaired. The EDAC connector is compatible with the ELCO 8016 connector series.
338 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
RJ 45 USB interface modules • Mounts on TS 35 • Unshielded RJ 11/12 modules • R J 45 module available in shielded and unshielded design
• USB modules features type A and type B connections • Width: 47mm • Housing UL94V-0
RJ 11-12
RJS 45 (shielded)
RJU 45 (unshielded)
RJS45-SH
47 x 26 x 61mm
47 x 31 x 61 mm
47 x 31 x 61 mm
87 x 26 x 63 mm
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
CAT 3
CAT 3
CAT 5
Voltage
125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
Current
1A
1A
1A
1A
Part Number
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Wire size Category
100 Ω
Cable impedance Transmission speed
Part Number
100 Mbps max.
RJS 45-RJS 45 (shielded)
RJS 45-3
USB-AB
47 x 27 x 44 mm
87 x 39 x 53
47 x 33 x 48 mm
0.14 to 1.0 mm²
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
Connection diagram
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Wire size Category Voltage Current Cable impedance Transmission speed
0116 284 9900
CAT 5
CAT 3
125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
30 V AC/DC
1A
1A
1A
100 Ω 100 Mbps max.
TERMINALS
| 339
Terminals
Compact interface modules SD…C | SD High Density • Mounts on TS 35 • D-sub on screw connection or on tension-spring connection (Z) • D-sub connection acc.o MIL-C-24308/ DIN 41652
Part Number
• Module versions from 9 to 37 connections • Male (S) / female (B) versions
SD…B
SD…S…C
C
SD-S15…-HD
SD-B15…-HD
HD-sub male plug
HD-sub female plug
-
-
-
-
Connection diagram
Type Part number
D-sub male plug
D-sub female plug
SD-S 9 C
SD-B 9 C
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
47 x 37 x 61 mm SD-S 9 CZ
47 x 37 x 38 mm – 9 way SD-S 15 C
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
SD-S 25 CZ
Part number
Wire size Connection
SD-B 15 CZ
SD-S15CZ-HD
SD-B 25 C
-
-
-
-
47 x 51 x 61 mm
SD-B 25 CZ
SD-B 37 C
SD-S 37 C 47 x 107 x 61 mm SD-S 37 CZ
SD-B 37 CZ 47 x 107 x 38 mm
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
0.2 to 2.5 mm2 Screw / tension-spring (Z types)
Voltage
125 V AC/DC
Current
1.5 A
340 | TERMINALS
SD-B15CZ-HD 47 x 51 x 38 mm
47 x 78 x 38 mm
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5
SD-B15C-HD
47 x 78 x 61 mm
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
-
SD-S15C-HD
47 x 51 x 38 mm SD-S 25 C
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
-
SD-B 15 C 47 x 51 x 61 mm
SD-S 15 CZ
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
SD-B 9 CZ
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Interface modules SD | SD-LA (with LED) • Mounts on TS 32/TS 35 • D-sub on screw connection • D-sub connection acc. to MIL-C-24308/DIN 41652
Part Number
• Module versions from 9 to 50 connections • Male (S) / female (B) versions • Width: 87 mm • LED indication (SD-LA only)
SD…S
SD…B
SD 2…S
SD 2…B
SD…LA S/B
D-sub male plug
D-sub female plug
Double D-sub male
Double D-sub female
D-sub male/female
SD-S 50
SD-B 50
SD 2-S 9
SD 2-B 9
SD-S/B 9 LA
SD-B 50/3
SD 2-S 15
-
SD 2-S 25
-
SD 2-S 37
Connection diagram
Type Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
87 x 140 x 72 mm SD-S 50/3
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Wire size
87 x 51 x 72 mm
-
87 x 77 x 72 mm
87 x 107 x 72 mm
SD-S/B 15 LA 87 x 56 x 72 mm
SD 2-B 25
-
87 x 41 x 72 mm SD 2-B 15
87 x 97 x 72 mm -
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
87 x 37 x 72 mm
SD-S/B 25 LA 87 x 83 x 72 mm
SD 2-B 37
SD-S/B 37 LA
87 x 107 x 72 mm
87 x 112 x 72 mm
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
Screw connection
Screw connection
Screw connection
Voltage
125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
24 V DC
Current
1.5 A
1.5 A
1A
Connection
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 341
Terminals
Interface modules FBK…C • Mounts on TS 35 • Flat ribbon cable on screw connection or on tension-spring connection (Z) • Male plug connection acc. to DIN 41651
Part Number
• Module versions from 10 to 64 connections • Ejector mechanism for socket block (female connectors) • Width: 47 mm
FBK…C
FBK…CZ
FBK 10C
FBK 10CZ
47 x 36 x 61 mm
47 x 36 x 38 mm
FBK 14C
FBK 14CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 46 x 38 mm
Connection diagram
Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Part number
FBK 16C
FBK 16CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 20C
FBK 20CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 26C
FBK 26CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 34C
FBK 34CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 40C
FBK 40CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 50C
FBK 50CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 60C
FBK 60CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
FBK 64C
FBK 64CZ
47 x 46 x 61 mm
47 x 51 x 38 mm
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
0.2 to 2.5 mm2
Screw connection
Tension-spring connection
Voltage
125 V AC/DC
125 V AC/DC
Current
1.5 A
1.5 A
Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Wire size Connection
342 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Interface modules OE-E • Mounts on TS 32/TS 35 • EDAC plug connector on screw connection • The EDAC series 516 is 100% compatible with the ELCO 8016
• Offset arrangement of plug connector • Does not influence the neighbouring modules • “Left” and “right” versions are available
Part Number
OE-E…
Connection diagram
Type Part number Size (LWH) with TS 35 x 7.5 Wire size Connection
36 way + shield OE-E 38/36 L
56 way + shield OE-E 38/36 R
OE-E 56 L
122 x 107 x 72 mm
OE-E 56 R 122 x 153 x 72 mm
0.2 to 2.5 mm
2
Screw connection
Voltage
250 V AC/DC
Current
2 A/per pole
Left version
Right version
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 343
Terminals
End stops End stops are required for attaching terminal blocks to DIN rails. They are put in at the beginning and end of the terminal rail assembly. Depending on the DIN rail, they differ in the dimensions of the mounting foot and their screw-on or snap-on design.
ES15
ES 35
ES35/2/K
ES 35/K/ST
ES 32/35
Screw-on
Screw-on
Screw-on
Screw-on
Screw-on
Size (L x W x H mm)
26 x 7.5 x 22
46 x 7.5 x 32
50 x 8 x 47
50 x 9.5 x 44
52 x 9.5 x 47
Terminal width mm
7.5
7.5
8
9.5
9.5
DIN rails
TS 15
TS 35
TS 35
TS 35
TS 35/TS 32
Type
SHES 35
ZES 35
ZES 35/2
SES 35
ZES 15
Screw-on
Snap-on
Snap-on
Snap-on
Snap-on
Size (L x W x H mm)
54 x 66 x 14
59 x 6 x 39
49 x 5 x 34
48 x 8 x 47.1
27 x 5 x 24
Terminal width mm
14
6
5
8
5
Material
PA 6.6 V0
DIN rails
TS 35
TS 35
TS 15
Type
PA 6.6 V2
Material
PA 6.6 V2 TS 35
TS 35
Partition plates Partition plates must normally be used between uninsulated cross-connectors. This is required to maintain the required creepage and clearance distances.
Type
344 | TERMINALS
Colour
Width
Material
TW 1.5-4
beige
1.5 mm
PA 6.6 V2
TW 1.5-4-BLUE
blue
1.5 mm
PA 6.6 V2
TW 2.5-10
beige
1.5 mm
PA 6.6 V2
TW 2.5-10-BLUE
blue
1.5 mm
PA 6.6 V2
TW 2.5-10-ORANGE
orange
1.5 mm
PA 6.6 V2
TW 2.5-10-GREEN
green
1.5 mm
PA 6.6 V2
For terminal RK 1.5-4|RK 1.5-4/15|KBL 1.5-4|KBL 1.5-4/15|RKB 4|FF 1/15
RK 2.5|KBL 2.5|RK 2.5-4|RK 6-10|KBL 2.5-4|KBL 6-10|SL 4| SL 4/32|SL 10|SL 10/32|FF 2.5| SF 2.5-4 SRK 2.5/2A | SSL 2.5/2A | SRK 4/2A | SSL 4/2A | SRK 6/2A | SSL 6/2A | SRK 10/2A | SSL 10/2A
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Marker holders for terminal blocks and end stops Marker holders provide a solution for marking a group of terminals or devices on the DIN rail.and are available for attaching to terminal blocks and end stops. Custom marking is possible with BS-1 pen or EMS-2 plotter.
SchT 7 short joint
SchT 7 long joint
SchT 2
SchT 9
SchT 10
Hinged marker holder for terminal block and end stop
Hinged marker holder for terminal block and end stop
Marker holders for end stops
Marker holders for end stops
Marker holders for end stops
Width
8.5 mm
8.5 mm
9.5 mm
8 mm
9.5 mm
Insert marker
ESO (1 sheet x 120 pcs)
ESO (1 sheet x 120 pcs)
ESO 2
Protective strips
STR 1
STR 1
Type
PA6.6, halogen-free
Material
Type
GT 1
GT 2
Group marker holder for TS35/32 DIN rail
Group marker holder for TS35/32 DIN rail
Width
9.5 mm
19.5 mm
Insert marker
ESO GT 1 (1 sheet x 140 pcs)
ESO GT 2 (1 sheet x 60 pcs)
Protective strips
STR GT 1
STR GT 2
Material
PA6.6, halogen-free
Terminal assembly covers
Colour
Width
Material
Length
Height
TWMF BG
beige
2 mm
PA 6.6 V2
88 mm
70 mm
TWMF BU
blue
2 mm
PA 6.6 V2
88 mm
70 mm
TWMF OG
orange
2 mm
PA 6.6 V2
88 mm
70 mm
Type
Type AD 3/1000mm
0116 284 9900
Colour
Width
Material
Length
Height
transparent
1 metre
Polycarbonate
90 mm
70 mm
TERMINALS
| 345
Terminals
Terminal markers Pocket-Maxicards PMC SB 4, SB 5, SB 6, SB 8 The PMC SB 4 – 8 Pocket-Maxicards are suitable for labelling all CONTA-CLIP terminal blocks that are wider than 4/6/8 mm respectively. They are available in a variety of pre-printed standard markers, in a blank version, or custom printed to any requirement. Material: Polyamide 6.6 UL 94-V2, halogen-free
Blank
Custom Print
FW
PMC SB 4 FW & SB 4 GW
PMC SB 5 FW & SB 5 GW
PMC SB 6 FW & SB 6 GW
PMC SB 8 FW
Length x width, 5 x 4 mm
Length x width, 5 x 5 mm
Length x width, 5 x 6 mm
Length x width, 5 x 8 mm
Style
GW
Terminal width ≥ 4.1 mm
Terminal width ≥ 5.1 mm
Terminal width ≥ 6 mm
Terminal width ≥ 8 mm
Number of markers per row 10
Number of markers per row 10
Number of markers per row 10
Number of markers per row 8
Number of markers per card 50
Number of markers per card 50
Number of markers per card 50
Number of markers per card 40
Number of markers per box 500
Number of markers per box 500
Number of markers per box 500
Number of markers per box 400
PMC SB 4/50 (Blank)
PMC SB 5/50 (Blank)
PMC SB 6/50 (Blank)
PMC SB 8/40 (Blank)
MC SB 4/200 - CUSTOM
MC SB 5/200 - CUSTOM
MC SB 6/200 - CUSTOM
MC SB 8/160 - CUSTOM
PMC SB 4/50 FW 1-10
PMC SB 5/50 FW 1-10
PMC SB 6/50 FW 1-10
PMC SB 8/40 FW 1-8
PMC SB 4/50 FW 11-20
PMC SB 5/50 FW 11-20
PMC SB 6/50 FW 11-20
PMC SB 8/40 FW 9-16
PMC SB 4/50 FW 21-30
PMC SB 5/50 FW 21-30
PMC SB 6/50 FW 21-30
PMC SB 8/40 FW 17-24
PMC SB 4/50 FW 31-40
PMC SB 5/50 FW 31-40
PMC SB 6/50 FW 31-40
PMC SB 8/40 FW 25-32
PMC SB 4/50 FW 41-50
PMC SB 5/50 FW 41-50
PMC SB 6/50 FW 41-50
PMC SB 8/40 FW 33-40
PMC SB 4/50 FW 51-60
PMC SB 5/50 FW 51-60
PMC SB 6/50 FW 51-60
PMC SB 8/40 FW 41-48
PMC SB 4/50 FW 61-70
PMC SB 5/50 FW 61-70
PMC SB 6/50 FW 61-70
PMC SB 8/40 FW 49-56
PMC SB 4/50 FW 71-80
PMC SB 5/50 FW 71-80
PMC SB 6/50 FW 71-80
PMC SB 8/40 FW 57-64
PMC SB 4/50 FW 81-90
PMC SB 5/50 FW 81-90
PMC SB 6/50 FW 81-90
PMC SB 8/40 FW 65-72
PMC SB 4/50 FW 91-100
PMC SB 5/50 FW 91-100
PMC SB 6/50 FW 91-100
PMC SB 8/40 FW 73-80
PMC SB 4/50 FW 1-50
PMC SB 5/50 FW 1-50
PMC SB 6/50 FW 1-50
PMC SB 8/40 FW 81-88
PMC SB 4/50 FW 51-100
PMC SB 5/50 FW 51-100
PMC SB 6/50 FW 51-100
PMC SB 8/40 FW 89-96
PMC SB 4/50 GW 1
PMC SB 5/50 GW 1
PMC SB 6/50 GW 1
PMC SB 8/40 FW 97-104
PMC SB 4/50 GW 2
PMC SB 5/50 GW 2
PMC SB 6/50 GW 2
PMC SB 8/40 FW 105-112
PMC SB 4/50 GW 3
PMC SB 5/50 GW 3
PMC SB 6/50 GW 3
PMC SB 8/40 FW 113-120
PMC SB 4/50 GW 4
PMC SB 5/50 GW 4
PMC SB 6/50 GW 4
PMC SB 8/40 FW 1-40
PMC SB 4/50 GW 5
PMC SB 5/50 GW 5
PMC SB 6/50 GW 5
PMC SB 8/40 FW 41-80 PMC SB 8/40 FW 81-120
PMC SB 4/50 GW 6
PMC SB 5/50 GW 6
PMC SB 6/50 GW 6
PMC SB 4/50 GW 7
PMC SB 5/50 GW 7
PMC SB 6/50 GW 7 PMC SB 6/50 GW 8
PMC SB 4/50 GW 8
PMC SB 5/50 GW 8
PMC SB 4/50 GW 9
PMC SB 5/50 GW 9
PMC SB 6/50 GW 9
PMC SB 4/50 GW 0
PMC SB 5/50 GW 0
PMC SB 6/50 GW 0
PMC SB 4/50 GW X
PMC SB 5/50 GW X
PMC SB 6/50 GW X
PMC SB 4/50 GW PE
PMC SB 5/50 GW PE
PMC SB 6/50 GW PE
PMC SB 4/50 GW L1
PMC SB 5/50 GW L1
PMC SB 6/50 GW L1
PMC SB 4/50 GW L2
PMC SB 5/50 GW L2
PMC SB 6/50 GW L2
PMC SB 4/50 GW L3
PMC SB 5/50 GW L3
PMC SB 6/50 GW L3
PMC SB 4/50 GW N
PMC SB 5/50 GW N
PMC SB 6/50 GW N
PMC SB 4/50 GW +
PMC SB 5/50 GW -
PMC SB 6/50 GW -
PMC SB 4/50 GW -
PMC SB 5/50 GW +
PMC SB 6/50 GW +
346 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Terminal markers Pocket-Maxicards PMC BSTR The PMC BSTR Pocket-Maxicards are suitable for labelling all CONTA-CLIP terminal blocks that are wider than 5 mm. These are particulary sauitable for longer sequences of characters. Material: Polyamide 6.6 V2, halogen-free
Style
Blank
Custom Print
FW
GW
PMC BSTR 5/10 & 5/10 custom
PMC BSTR 6/12 & 6/12 custom
PMC BSTR 8/12 & 8/12 custom
PMC BSTR 10/12 & 10/12 custom
Length x width, 10 x 5 mm
Length x width, 12 x 6 mm
Length x width, 12 x 8 mm
Length x width, 10 x 12 mm
Terminal width ≥ 5.1 mm
Terminal width ≥ 6 mm
Terminal width ≥ 8 mm
Terminal width ≥ 10 mm
Number of markers per row 12
Number of markers per row 10
Number of markers per row 7
Number of markers per row 5
Number of markers per card 36
Number of markers per card 30
Number of markers per card 21
Number of markers per card 10
Number of markers per box 360
Number of markers per box 300
Number of markers per box 210
Number of markers per box 100
PMC BSTR 5/36 (Blank)
PMC BSTR 6/30 (Blank)
PMC BSTR 8/21 (Blank)
PMC BSTR 10/10 (Blank)
MC BSTR 5/144 - CUSTOM
MC BSTR 6/120 - CUSTOM
MC BSTR 8/84 - CUSTOM
MC BSTR 10/40 - CUSTOM
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 1-12
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 1-10
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 1-21
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 1-10
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 13-24
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 11-20
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 22-42
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 11-20
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 25-36
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 21-30
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 43-63
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 21-30
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 37-48
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 31-40
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 64-84
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 31-40 PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 41-50
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 49-60
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 41-50
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 85-105
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 61-72
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 51-60
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 1-42
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 1-40
PMC BSTR 5/36 FW 73-108
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 61-70
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 43-84
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 41-80
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 71-80
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 1-105
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 81-120
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 81-90
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW 106-210
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW 1-100
PMC BSTR 6/30 FW 91-100
PMC BSTR 8/21 FW L1, L2, L3, N, PE
PMC BSTR 10/10 FW L1, L2, L3, N, PE
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 1
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 1
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 2
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 2
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 3
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 3
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 4
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 4
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 5
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 5
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 6
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 6
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 7
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 7
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 8
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 8
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 9
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 9
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW 0
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW 0
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW X
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW X
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW PE
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW PE
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW L1
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW L1
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW L2
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW L2
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW L3
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW L3
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW N
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW N
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW +
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW -
PMC BSTR 5/36 GW -
PMC BSTR 6/30 GW +
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 347
Terminals
Warning signs and shrouds VDE regulations require that the mains terminals be covered. The SAD and AD yellow covers (labelled with a lightning flash) are used to cover the operational channel and the cross-connection channel of the terminal. Thus they discourage operation of the terminal while live voltage is present. The SAD 1 covers can be used with the plug in cross connectors and are snapped down on the terminal blocks. The BS 1 marker pen or the EMS labelling system can be used to label the white variants. Width
Terminal type
SAD 1/5/B
Type
5 mm
SRK 2.5/2A
SAD 1/6/B
6 mm
SRK 4/2A
SAD 1/8/B
8 mm
SRK 6/2A
SAD 1/10/B
10 mm
SRK 10/2A
SAD 1/12/B
12 mm
SRK 16/2A
SAD 1/16/B
16 mm
SRK 35/2A
SAD 1/18/B
18 mm
SRK 50/2A
SAD 1/20/B
20 mm
SRK 70/2A
AD1/50/B
20 mm
RK 50
AD 1/95/B
25 mm
RK 95
SAD 1/27/B
27 mm
SRK 120/2A
AD 1/150/B
31 mm
RK 150
AD 1/240/B
36 mm
RK 240
Pre-cut DIN rail
TS 35 Solid-XXX
TS 35-XXX
TS 15 Solid-XXX
TS 15-XXX
TS 35 x 7.5
TS 35 x 7.5
TS 15 unslotted
TS 15 slotted
Unslotted
Slotted 5.2 x 18
Unslotted
Slotted 4.2 x 12
XXX = pre-cut lengths â&#x20AC;&#x201C; 100mm; 200mm; 300mm; 400mm, 500mm, 600mm, 700mm, 800mm, 900mm and 1000mm
DIN rail mounting brackets
TSTW/M6
TSTW/M5
TSTW/F/M6
TSTW/F/M5
TST/M6
TST/M5
Drill hole
M6
M5
M6
M5
M6
M5
Height mm
48
48
32
32
20
20
348 | TERMINALS
www.oem.co.uk
Terminals
Custom DIN rail assemblies Why not let OEM Automatic build complete DIN rail terminal assemblies to your individual specification? If you are building the same combination of DIN rail terminals on a regular basis it may save you time and money by purchasing as a ‘ready to fit’ assembly. Even simple assemblies can be time consuming to build, from cutting the DIN rail to length to creating custom marking of each terminal. OEM Automatic can offer this service and advise on ways to improve your existing profiles which could reduce wiring times and physical size even further. All assemblies can be ordered under a single part number and scheduled or called-off as required to meet planned production.
Benefits of complete DIN rail assemblies: • Reduce stock holding – only buy what you need, when you need it • Reduce purchasing cost – only order one part instead of multiple items
Bespoke markers
• Reduce labour cost – saves skilled work force time in cutting rail & assembly • Reduce material waste – eliminates unused components
Phase colours available for ease of identification
Miniature assemblies
0116 284 9900
TERMINALS
| 349
CONTA-CONNECT
Terminal markers The Maxicard system
Versatile colour printing on a wide variety of materials
Polyamide
Cable and wire markers The Maxicard system
Polyamide
Cable and wire markers The Maxicard system
Polyamide
Device and installation markers
Device and installation markers
The Maxicard system
The Maxicard system
Polyamide
Polyamide
1
Device and installation markers The ALUCARD system
Aluminium
Cable and wire markers The ALUCARD system
Aluminium
Foil markers THE POLYESTERCARD SYSTEM
Polyester
Custom applications
Dampf
Sauerstoff
Benzol
Sauerstoff Trinkwasser
Dampf 3 bar
Trinkwasser Betriebswasser
Dampf Kondensat Dampf Kondensat
2
NH3 flüssig
Emulsion Emulsion
Altöl
Schutzgas Schutzgas
Various
Prozessluft
FMScolour The FMScolor combines the open concept of a plotter with the convenience of an ink-jet printer. The printing method is not dependent on your individual card formats and can be adapted for use with a variety of different materials. Superior print quality, proven durability and versatility:
Impressively durable printing on certified materials
these are the features that make the FMScolor perfect for industrial applications. This printer satisfies technical requirements along the entire value-added chain â&#x20AC;&#x201C; thus helping to reduce both storage costs and delivery times.
8x
The thermal-set ink provides outstanding durability. An additive is used in the preprocessing stage to clean the markers and to ensure that the applied inks do not run. This pre-treatment provides a faster burn-in and improved adhesion for the ink. When stored in a dry, dust-free, grease-free environment, the pre-treated materials retain these optimal properties for months. The certified Maxicard, Polyestercard and Alucard materials are resistant to grease, dry cleaning, oils, acetone, hot-steam pressure washers, coolants, cleaning agents, detergents, and sparks. They are also UV-resistant over 2000Â hours (Central Europe), scratch-resistant and smudgeresistant.
Eight basic colours (C, M, Y, K, plus four light colours) ensure digital colour printing in photo-realistic quality. The high-pigment ink used for the printing provides excellent colour brilliance and extremely high image quality. Colour profiles for the FMScolor allow you to print using RAL and Pantone colour codes.
A wide variety of materials can be printed on Other materials and sizes are available on request in addition to the certified materials (Maxicard (polyamide), Alucard (aluminium) and Polyestercard (polyester)). Printing on brass, stainless steel, laminated panels and adhesive document laminates is also possible. Printable size of material: max. 300 x 500 mm; max. 30 mm height.
Average time for one Maxicard
One print job in only*
2. Insert
1. Select
* Times are approximate
352 | FMSCOLOUR
4. Print
3. Pre-treat
Start next print job
FMScolour Standard printing from Windows-based applications without special software Most programs can easily interface with this printer. Templates are already available for the certified materials which makes the printing process very convenient.
£
Inexpensive operating and printing costs This high-quality, versatile printing solution offers significantly improved usability and reduced complexity compared to the many other methods available for printing labels and markers. There are several cost-saving advantages when this printer is integrated into your work flow: • Easier handling,
Exceptional accuracy and precision The FMScolor also delivers high-quality professional results when printing high-precision scales and dial facings. The key to such precision is the printer's ultra-fine line print (0.01 mm) and high colour fidelity. Perfectly tuned modules throughout the printing process ensure these performance features.
• Just-in-time production without delivery delays, • No need for reserve stock.
Comparing the required times: in-house engraving vs. in-house FMScolor*
Efficient use of ink The water-based ink is environmentally friendly and also allows you to carry out test print-outs with no material loss. After a test print, the ink can simply be washed off with cold water from the carrier before the next printing test. The ink refill kit ensures an efficient use of ink: the 50-ml kit can be used for three or four refills. The water-soluble ink will not result in sticky printer heads or cartridges. There is no danger that the ink might dry out or flake because no heat is created in the printer.
6. Apply
A practical comparison: in-house engraving vs. in-house FMScolor* Printed object Cable markers: 12 x 60 mm, 50,000 pieces Labour costs per day: 8 hours x £ 30 = £ 240 Pieces per day 800 pieces: engraver | 6,000 pieces: FMScolor Labour costs per marker £ 0.30: engraver | £ 0.04: FMScolor
5. Harden
Working days needed 62.5 (3 months): engraver | 8.0: FMScolor Total labour costs £ 15,000: engraver | £ 2,000: FMScolor Your savings with the FMScolor: £13,000 total
* For one project with one label type
FMSCOLOUR
| 353
TIME SWITCHES
w w w. o e m . c o . u k www.oem.co.uk
0116 284 9900
AlphaRex 3
356
AstroRex 3
357
MicroRex D
358
MIcroRex
359
Maxi / EconoRex
360
MaxiRex digital time switches
361
Time switches
AlphaRex ³
TECHNICAL DATA AlphaRex3 D21 4126 31 Supply voltage
230 V ~
Frequency
50/60 Hz
Programme
24 hour or 7 day
No. of channels Effectiive power consumption
1
2
Approx 1 W
ca 1.5 W
Switching capacity cos ϕ =1 Contact
16 A 250 V ~ 1 changeover switch
Parallel compensation
2 changeover switches
600 W nax, 70μF
Switching step
1 minute
Min switching time
1 minute
Accuracy
+/- 0.1 seconds per day
Terminal capacity Programmes
Single strand 1.5 to 4mm2 56
Working reserve
• 24h / 7 day program time • Suited to irregular cycles (e.g security & industrial installations) • Text based programming • +- 0.1 second per day switching accuracy • -20 to +55 operating temperature
AlphaRex3 D22 4126 41
28 per channel 6 years (for time and date only)
Battery reserve
5 years
Programme memory
EEPROM
Summer/winter time
Auto
IP rating
IP20
No of 17.5mm modules
2
Operating temp.
-20ºC to +55ºC
Storage temp.
-20ºC to +60ºC
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
Part number
Range
Supply Voltage
No of Outputs
412631
AlphaRex3 D21
230Vac
Single Channel
412641
AlphaRex3 D22
230Vac
Dual Channel
412872
AlphaRex3 Universal Data Key
412873
AlphaRex3 USB Adapter
356 | TIME SWITCHES
www.oem.co.uk
Time switches
AstroRex ³
TECHNICAL DATA AlphaRex3 Astro D21 4126 54 Supply voltage
230 V ~
Frequency
50/60 Hz
Programme
24 hour or 7 day
No. of channels Effectiive power consumption
1
2
Approx 1 W
1.5 W
Switching capacity cos ϕ =1 Contact
16 A 250 V ~ 1 changeover switch
Min prog. setting
+/- 0.1 seconds per day
Terminal capacity Programmes
Single strand 1.5 to 4mm2 56
Control cable length Control signal
28 per channel
Max 50m 230 V AC/2 mA
Control pulse duration
24h / 7 day program time Suited to outdoor lighting and signage applications Automatic light switching according to sunrise / set times +- 0.1 second per day switching accuracy -20 to +55 operating temperature
2 changeover switches 1 second
Accuracy
• • • • •
AlphaRex3 Astro D22 4126 57
Delay time
100 to 200 ms 0 to 23 h 59 m 59 s
Local co-ordinates
Rsolution 1º/1’ in EXPERT-Mode
Working reserve
6 years (for time and date only)
Battery reserve
5 years
Programme memory
EEPROM
Summer/winter time
Auto
IP rating
IP20
No of 17.5mm modules
2
Operating temp.
-20ºC to +55ºC
Storage temp.
-20ºC to +60ºC
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m . c o . u k
Part number
Range
Supply Voltage
No of Outputs
412654
AstroRex D21
230Vac
Single Channel
412657
AstroRex D22
230Vac
Dual Channel
412872
AlphaRex3 Universal Data Key
412873
AlphaRex3 USB Adapter
0116 284 9900
TIME SWITCHES
| 357
Time switches
MicroRex D
TECHNICAL DATA MicroRex D21 6037 70 Supply voltage Programme
24 hour or 7 day
No. of channels
1
2
No of ON-OFF actions per day/week
28
2 x 14
16 A
16 A
Switching capacity cos ϕ =1 Incandescent lamp cos ϕ =0.6 Contact Terminal capacity
5A
4A
8A
10 A
1 changeover switch
2 changeover switches
1.5 to 4mm single/ 1.5 to 2.5 mm stranded
IP rating
IP20
Parallel compensation
600 W nax, 70μF
Switching step
1 minute
Min prog time
1 minute
Accuracy
• • • •
Digital Time switch LCD display 24 Hour / 7 Day programming 1 second precision
MicroRex D22 6037 71
220 V ~ 50 Hz
+/- 0.1 seconds per day
Terminal capacity Programmes
Single strand 1.5 to 4mm2 56
Working reserve
28 per channel 6 years (for time and date only)
Programme memory Manual switching No of 17.5mm modules
EEPROM Override and permanent 2
Operating temp.
-20ºC to +55ºC
Storage temp.
-20ºC to +60ºC
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
MicroRexD11
MicroRexD21 & MicroRexD21
MicroRexD11
Part number
Range
Supply Voltage
No of Outputs
6037 70
MIcroRex D21
220 V
Single channel
6037 71
MicroRex D22
220 V
Dual channel
0037.00
MicroRex D11
220 V
Single channel
358 | TIME SWITCHES
www.oem.co.uk
Time switches
MicroRex TECHNICAL DATA Type
T11
QT11
QW11
T31
QT31
QW31
Motor
Synchron
Quartz
Quartz
Synchron
Quartz
Quartz
24h
24h
7 d
24h
24h
7d
None
>100 h
>100 h
None
>100 h
>100 h
Switching step
15 min
15 min
2h
15 min
15 min
2h
Min switching step
15 min
15 min
2h
30 min
30 min
4h
Switching accuracy
+/- 5 min
+/-5 min
+/- 30 min
+/- 5 min
+/- 5 min
+/- 30 min
Accuracy
According to frequency
+/- 2.5 sec a day
+/- 2.5 sec a day
According to frequency
+/- 2.5 sec a day
+/- 2.5 sec a day
Switching dial Running reserve
• • • •
Switching capacity
Programmed via captive segment 230VAC 50/60Hz supply voltage 1 x 16A Output Manual changeover for summer / winter time
Resistive 230V ~ cos j = 1
16 A~
Incandescent lamp 230V ~
4 A~
Inductive 230V ~ cos j = 0.6
12 A~
Contact
1 SPST
Operating temperature
-10… +55 °C
Protection
IP 20
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oe m . c o . u k
N
L
16 A
MicroRexT11/QT11/QW11
Part number
MicroRexT11/QT11/QW11
Programme
Segment
MicroRexT11/QT11/QW11
Min switching time
Working reserve
MicroRexT31/QT31/QW31
16 A output via contact N/O Chang.S.
No of Modules
4128 12
24 h
15 min
30 min
without
-
1
3
4128 13
24 h
15 min
30 min
100 h
-
1
3
4127 80
24 h
15 min
15 min
without
1
-
1
4127 90
24 h
15 min
15 min
100 h
1
-
1
4127 94
7d
2h
2h
100 h
1
-
1
4127 95
7d
2h
2h
100 h
-
1
1
0116 284 9900
TIME SWITCHES
| 359
Time switches
Maxi / EconoRex
TECHNICAL DATA MaxiRex T
MaxiRex QT
Supply voltage
EconoRex MT
230 V ~ +10% -15% 16 A
16 A
Switching capacity cos ϕ =1 Incandescent lamp cos ϕ =0.6 Contact
10 A
8A
1000 W
1000 W
1 c/o SPDT
Working reserve
1 c/o
None
100 hrs
Min. switching time
30 mins
Interval
10 mins
IP rating
None 15 mins 15 mins
IP 330
Operating temp.
0ºC to +55ºC
Storage temp.
-10ºC to +60ºC
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w. o e m . c o . u k
• • • • •
24 Hour / 7 day time Working reserve of 6 years 3 position changeover switch Manual override Volt free contacts
MaxiRex panel mounting
MaxiRex & EconoRex wiring
MaxiRex
MaxiRex DIN rail mounting
EconoRex wall mounting
Part number 0497 50
EconoRex panel mounting
Range
Supply Voltage
Output
MaxiRex T
230 V
1 x SPDT 16 A contact
0497 54
MaxiRex QT
230 V
1 x SPDT 16 A contact
0499 83
EconoRex MT
230 V
1 x SPDT 16 A contact
360 | TIME SWITCHES
www.oem.co.uk
Time switches
MaxiRex digital time switches
TECHNICAL DATA MaxiRex D72/1 Plus Supply voltage
MaxiRex D72/2 Plus 220 V ~ 50 Hz
Programme
24 hour or 7 day
No. of channels
1
2
No of ON-OFF actions per day/week
28
2 x 14
16 A
16 A
Switching capacity cos ϕ =1 Incandescent lamp cos ϕ =0.6 Contact
5A
4A
8A
10 A
1 changeover switch
2 changeover switches
Switching step
1 minute
Min prog time
1 minute
Accuracy
+/- 1 second per day
Working reserve Programme memory
• • • •
24 Hour / 7 day time Working reserve of 6 years LCD digital display +/-1 second per day accuracy
MaxiRex D72_2plus
EEPROM
Manual switching
Override and permanent
Operating temp.
-20ºC to +55ºC
Storage temp.
-20ºC to +60ºC
For mor e i nfor ma t i on, vi si t our w e b si t e , w w w.oem . c o . u k
MaxiRex D72_1plus
MaxiRex D72_2plus
MaxiRex D72
Part number
6 years (for time and date only)
MaxiRex DIN mount
MaxiRex panel mount
Range
Supply Voltage
No of Outputs
0496 80
MaxiRex D72/1 Plus
230 V
Single channel
0496 82
MaxiRex D72/2 Plus
230 V
Dual channel
0116 284 9900
TIME SWITCHES
| 361
TIMERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
17.5mm wide DIN rail mount
364
22.5mm wide DIN rail mount
365
35mm wide plug in
366
48mm2 panel mount
367
48mm2 digital panel mount
368
21mm wide plug in
396
Timers
Chronos 2 – DIN rail timers 17.5mm wide
Dimensions
• Multi/mono function • 7 x time ranges (0.1s to 100 hrs) • Multi-voltage • 8A changeover relay or 0.7A solid state output • LED status indicator
Connections
Li L:
U
Functions: A/H/K
Functions: A - At/Ht/B/C/Di - D/ Ac/BW/N/O/P/T/W/ Pt/TL/Tt/Ad/Ah
Li L:
Ordering guide Type
Function
Output
Voltage
Part number
MUR1
Multi-function A-AT-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827105
MXR1
Multi-function N-O-P-W-Ad-Ah-T-Tt-Pt-Tc-Tl
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827185
MAR1
Mono-function A-At
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827115
MBR1
Mono-function B
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827125
MCR1
Mono-function C
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827135
MHR1
Mono-function H-Ht
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827145
MLR1
Mono-function Li-L
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827155
MUR4
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
1 relay (c/o)
12V AC/DC
88827100
MXR4
Multi-function N-O-P-W-Ad-Ah-T-Tt-Pt-Tc-Tl
1 relay (c/o)
12V AC/DC
88827180
MUR3
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
1 relay (c/o)
12…240V AC/DC
88827103
Cage clamp version of MUR3
1 relay (c/o)
12…240V AC/DC
88827503
MUS2
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
Solid state
24…240V AC
88827004
MAS5
Mono-function A
Solid state
24…240V AC/DC
88827014
MHS2
Mono-function H
Solid state
24…240V AC
88827044
MLS2
Mono-function Li-L
Solid state
24…240V AC
88827054
MURC3
364 | TIMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Timers
Chronos 2 – DIN rail timers 22.5mm wide
Dimensions
• Multi/mono function • 7 x time ranges (0.1s to 100 hrs) • Multi-voltage • 1 or 2 x changeover relay • 2 x LED status indicator
Connections
Functions Li L :
Functions : A - At/Ht/B/C/Di - D Ac/BW/N/O/P/T/ W/Pt/TL/Tt/Ad/Ah
Q
K/H
Ordering guide Type
Function
Output
Voltage
Part number
RQR1
Mono-function Q
1 relay (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88866175
RQR6
Mono-function Q
1 relay (c/o)
220 - 240/380 - 440V AC
88866176
RA2R1
Mono-function A-At
2 relays (c/o)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88866215
RU2R4
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht-Di-D-Ac-Bw
2 relays (1 inst.)
12V AC/DC
88866300
RU2R3
Mono-function U
2 relays
12V/240 AC/DC
88866303
RU2R1
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht-Di-D-Ac-Bw
2 relays (1 inst.)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88866305
RX2R1
Multi-function N-O-P-W-Ad-Ah-T-Tt-Pt-Tc-Tl
2 relays (1 inst.)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88866385
0116 284 9900
TIMERS
| 365
Timers
Chronos 2 – plug-in timers 35mm wide
Dimensions
• • • • •
Multi/mono function 7 x time ranges (0.1s to 100hrs) Multi voltage Either 1 or 2 x 8A changeover relay LED status indicator
Connections 8 pin 1 relay
Functions: A - At/H - Ht/B/C Di - D/Ac/BW
2 relay
A
Li L :
11 pin Functions: A - At/H Ht/B/C Di - D/Ac /BW
Li L:
Ordering guide Type
Function
Output
Connection
Voltage
Part number
OUR1
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
1 relay (c/o)
Plug-in (8 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867105
OA2R1
Mono-function A
2 relays (c/o)
Plug-in (8 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88827215
OCR1
Mono-function C
1 relay (c/o)
Plug-in (8 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867135
OLR1
Mono-function Li-L
1 relay (c/o)
Plug-in (8 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867155
OUR4
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
1 relay (c/o)
Plug-in (8 pin)
12V AC/DC
88867100
OUR3
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
1 relay (c/o)
Plug-in (8 pin)
12…240V AC/DC
88867103
PU2R1
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
2 relays (1 inst.)
Plug-in (11 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867305
PA2R1
Mono-function A-At
2 relays (c/o)
Plug-in (11 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867415
PC2R1
Mono-function C
2 relays (c/o)
Plug-in (11 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867435
PL2R1
Mono-function Li-L
2 relays (c/o)
Plug-in (11 pin)
24V DC/24…240V AC
88867455
PU2R4
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
2 relays (1 inst.)
Plug-in (11 pin)
12V AC/DC
88867300
PU2R3
Multi-function A-At-B-C-H-Ht, Di-D-Ac-Bw
2 relays (1 inst.)
Plug-in (11 pin)
12…240V AC/DC
88867303
S2B
Socket for 8 pin types
S2B
S3B
Socket for 11 pin types
S3B
366 | TIMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Timers
TMR48 – panel mount timers 48 x 48mm
Dimensions
• • • • • •
Multi/mono function Multi-range from 0.02 s to 300 h Multi-voltage 12 to 240 VDC/24 to 240 V AC Time setting displayed on dial 2 changeover relays 5 A/250 VAC Display of power and output states by 2 LEDs
Connections
Ordering guide Type TMR48L
Function
Voltage
Part number
Multi-Function A, B, C, W, G, AC, BW
12 - 240 VDC
88886516
24 – 240 VAC TMR48U
Mono-Function A
12 – 240 VDC
88886016
24 – 240 VAC TMR48A
Multi- function A1, A2, H1, H2, Q1, Q2, D-Di
12 – 240 VDC
88886106
24 –240 VAC TMR48X
0116 284 9900
L, Li, G, Gi
12 – 240 VDC
88886116 TIMERS
| 367
Timers
Digital – panel mount timers 48 x 48mm 812 – 814 – 815 – 815E
• LCD or LED (815E) • Multi-range • Multi-voltage • 1 or 2 relay outputs • Reset function on panel (Timers 815, 815E) • Data saved in the event of a break in supply (Timers 815, 815E) • Access to programming lockable (Timers 814, 815 and 815E) • Up or down timing mode • Internal power supply by battery (10 years/20°C) (Not 815E)
Dimensions
Connections M812
TIMER 814/815
G815 +~
U
Reset
5 6 7
4 3 2
1 11
8 9 10
(1)
~
M814
2 •—• 7 : 12 Vdc 24 Vac/dc G814
Panel thickness 1 to 3.5 mm
Clip for panel-mounting Positioning screw
2 •—• 11 : 12 Vdc 2 •—• 8 : 12 Vdc 24 Vac/dc 24 Vac/dc (1) Other loads may be connected in parallel
Panel cut-out: 45 square± 0.3
Ordering guide Type
Connections
Function
Output(s)
Voltage
Part number
812
Removable 8 pin base
Mono-function A
2 timed changeover - 2x 5A
24VAD
88857409
812
Removable 8 pin base
Mono-function A
2 timed changeover - 2x 5A
110VAC
88857406
812
Removable 8 pin base
Mono-function A
2 timed changeover - 2x 5A
220...240VAC
88857400
814
Removable 8 pin base
Multi-function A-B-C-D-Di-H
1 x 8A timed changeover
12VDC/24...48VAD
88857003
814
Removable 8 pin base
Multi-function A-B-C-D-Di-H
1 x 8A timed changeover
24VAD/110...240VAC
88857005
814
Removable 11 pin base
Multi-function A-B-C-D-Di-H
1 x 8A timed changeover
12VDC/24...48VDC
88857103
814
Removable 11 pin base
Multi-function A-B-C-D-Di-H
1 x 8A timed changeover
24VAD/110...240VAC
88857105
815
Removable 11 pin base
Multi-function A1-A2-AM-Amt
2 timed changeover or 1 timed + 1 instant (2 x 8A)
12VDC/42...48VAD
88857302
815
Removable 11 pin base
Multi-function A1-A2-AM-Amt
2 timed changeover or 1 timed + 1 instant (2 x 8A)
24VAD/110VAC
88857307
Multi-function A1-A2-AM-Amt
2 timed changeover or 1 timed + 1 instant (2 x 8A)
24VAD/220...240VAC
88857301
Multi-function A1, A1C, A2, AM, Amt, B, BM, C, CM, D, Di, DiM, Dpause, H, HM, T, TM, W, WM
2 timed changeover or 1 timed + 1 instant (2 x 5A)
12-24VAD/100...240VAC
88857311
815 815E
368 | TIMERS
Removable 11 pin base Removable 11 pin base
www.oem.co.uk
Timers
4 pole multi-range timer RTMA
• • • • • • •
Dimensions
Function diagram
4 pole changeover relay output Multi-time range (0.1s to 100hrs) Mounts on industry standard 14 pin socket 12Vdc, 24Vdc, 24Vac, 110Vac or 240Vac Small size (21mm x 27mm x 63mm) LED indication of relay status and power on Delay on energisation (‘A’ function)
Function A 1 relay
Terminal identification 13 - 14 :
Socket SD14
Supply
1-5-9 2 - 6 - 10 3 - 7 - 11
Timed relay outputs
4 - 8 - 12
Ordering guide Type
Voltage
Part number
RTMA412D
12Vdc
88896201
RTMA424D
24Vdc
88896202
RTMA424A
24Vac
88896203
RTMA4110A
110Vac
88896206
RTMA4240A
240Vac
88896207
Socket for above timers Part number = SD14, clip for sockets = RR - CLIP
0116 284 9900
TIMERS
| 369
Timers
Function diagram for timers U : Supply R : Output or load relay T: Timing
C (Y1) : Control contact â&#x2C6;&#x17E; : infinite
Function A
Delay on energisation Single timing cycle which begins on energisation.
1 relay
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous Timing after closing and opening of control contact After energisation, closure of the control contact causes the timing period T to commence and output relay R (or the load) changes state at the end of this interval. When contact C (Y1) opens, relay R resets after a second timing period T.
1 relay
Timing after closing of control contact
On short cycle after closing of control contact
Timing on energisation with memory
1 relay
Function D or Di
Symmetrical recycling
1 relay
1 relay
Repetitive cycle which switches the output alternately between the rest and operating position for equal time bases. T1 + T2 = T total D = Pause Start Di = Pulse Start
Function H
Timing on energisation Interval timer - one shot
1 relay
On energisation, the output changes state, remains in that state for the duration of timing and resets at the end of the single cycle. 1 relay
N.B. This is complementary to function A. 2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
Provides a cumulative time for contact opening. The output changes states at the end of the set time.
Function Ht
Delay on energisation with memory
1 relay
Provides a cumulative time for contact opening. On energisation, the output changes state, remains in that state for the duration of timing and resets at the end of the single cycle.
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
Function B
Timing on impulse one shot On pulse (with constant supply)
1 relay
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
After energisation, closure of the control contact causes the timing period T to commence and output relay R changes state at the end of this period. After a further period of time: T the relay returns to its original state.
Function At
Timing after impulse Delay OFF (with constant supply)
Relay R returns to its initial position at the end of the timing period.
After energisation, closure of the control contact causes the timing period T to commence and output relay R changes state at the end of this interval.
Function Ah
Function C
After energisation, once the control contact is closed the output state changes. Timing will only begin on the re-opening of this control contact (one shot).
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
Function Ad
Pulse output (adjustable) Output relay R (or the load) changes state, and remains in the changed-over state for the timing period, both when control contact C (Y1) closes and when it opens. 2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
The output changes state after timing.
Function Ac
1 relay
Function Bw
1 relay
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
After energisation; a pulse (â&#x2030;Ľ 50 ms) or a maintained control contact will cause the output to change state which reverts to the rest position at the end of timing. N.B. : this process enables shortening or lengthening of a signal. 2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
370 | TIMERS
www.oem.co.uk
Timers
Function diagram for timers Function K
Function Pt
Delayed fixed length pulse (with memory) As function P but with memory
1 relay
Delay on de-energisation - true delay OFF On energisation, the output changes state. On de–energisation timing commences and the output only returns to the reset condition after timing. 2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
Function Q Star-delta
Function L
At the end of timing, the output is not energised. It remains "open" (not conducting) and will only change state after the fixed time of Ti has elapsed. Dwell time selectable
1 relay Cyclic timing - Asymmetrical recycler Repetitive cycle comprising 2 independent adjustable time bases. Each time base corresponds alternately to a different output state. N.B. : The cycle starts with the output in the rest position.
1 relay
U C
R 2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
T
Function Li Cyclic timing - Asymmetrical recycler 1 relay Repetitive cycle comprising 2 independent adjustable time bases. Each time base corresponds alternately to a different output state. N.B. : The cycle starts with the output in the operating position. 2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
Function T Timing on energisation with memory a - energisation by control signal The timer sums the times for which the control contact is closed (C1). Reset is by the reset signal (C2) only.
b - energisation by supply voltage The timer sums the times for which the supply voltage (U) is on. Reset is by the reset signal (C2) only.
Function N
"Safe-guard"
At the first control pulse the output is energised. To complete the timing the interval between the two control pulses must be greater than the timing set.
Function O
"Delayed safe-guard" On energisation, a first timing sequence occurs and the output changes state. With the closing of the control contact, the output resets and the timing starts, with the output being activated after timing. For the timing to be completed, the interval between the closing of two control contacts must be greater than the timing set.
Function TL
1 relay
Latching relay by control contact (flip flop) After energisation, closure of the control contact causes output relay R to energise. A second closure of control contact de–energises the relay.
Function Tt
Timed latching relay by control contact
1 relay
As function TL but if second closure of control contact does not occur before end of time period, the relay will de–energise at the end of the time period.
Function W Function P
Delayed fixed-length pulse Timing begins on energisation. At the end of the timing period output relay R (or the load) changes state for a period of approx. 500 milliseconds.
Timing after pulse on control contact After energisation, if the control contact opens it causes output relay R (or the load) to change state and timing to start. At the end of the timing period, relay R resets to its original state.
U C R
T
Standards and approvals Our timers are designed according to international recommendations (IEC), American (UL), Canadian (CSA) and German (VDE) standards, European standards (EN), etc. Proof of compliance with these standards and recommendations is demonstrated by approval (a symbol or certificate of conformity granted by an accredited body) or by the manufacturer's declaration of conformity (drafted in accordance with ISO/IEC 22 guidelines). We have indicated the principal approvals so far obtained in the table below. Conformity to standards is indicated in the "technical characteristics". Machine safety Our products are compatible with standard EN 60204-1 (IEC 201-1) concerning the safety of electrical equipment for machinery. 0116 284 9900
TIMERS
| 371
Timers
Function diagram for dedicated 815E Function A2
Delay on energisation
Function AM
Delay on energisation
Function B
Timing on impulse (one shot)
Function C
Function A2c
Delay on energisation
Function AMt
Delay on energisation
Function B with latching
Timing on impulse (one shot)
Function B with latching
Timing after impulse
Timing after impulse
Function D
Function Di
Flip-flop
Function Di with latching
Flip-flop
Function D pause
Flip-flop
Flip-flop
Function H
Function H with latching
Function T
Function T with latching
Timing on energisation
Timing on energisation
Function W Off-delay
372 | TIMERS
Timing on energisation
Timing on energisation
Function W with latching
Off-delay timer
www.oem.co.uk
Timers
TMR48 dedicated functions
0116 284 9900
TIMERS
| 373
TRANSDUCERS
w w w. o e m . c o . u k
P17/P17G loop powered transducer and separator
376
P20/P20G programmable transducer and separator
377
P21Z/P20H programmable transducer for AC and high DC signals
378
P18/P19 surface mount temperature and humidity transducer
379
P30U temperature and standard signals transducer
380
P30O pulse and frequency transducer
380
P12H programmable transducer for high DC signals
381
P12P transducer of single phase network parameters
381
P41 1-phase network transducer
382
P43 programmable transducer for 3-phase power networks
382
Transducers
P17 loop powered separator
Technical data
• Input options for voltage, temperature (thermocouples and PT100) and resistance • Supplied by current loop • Only 6.2mm wide
Part number key
Inputs fixed: Temperature: Pt100, J, K, N, E type Voltage: 0…10V, 0…60mV d.c Resistance: 0…150, 0…250Ω Outputs fixed: 4…20mA Dimensions: 6.2 x 77.5 x 100mm Protection level: IP50 front Supply voltage: 9…30V d.c from Loop
P17 Input type and range: voltage thermocouple J (Fe-CuNi) thermocouple K (NiCr-NiAl) thermocouple N (NiCrSi-NiSi) thermocouple E (NiCr-CuNi) resistance thermometer Pt100 resistance thermometer Pt100 voltage
(0 … 10) V (-100 … 1200)ºC (-100 … 1370)ºC (-100 … 1300)ºC (-100 … 900)ºC (-50 … 100)ºC (-50 … 400)ºC (0 … 60) mV
XX
00
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 09
P17G loop powered passive separator
• Passive separator for 0-20mA signals • Supplied by current loop, no AUX supply required • Only 6.2mm wide
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs: Current: Outputs: Current: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
376 | PANEL TRANSDUCERS
8
P17G
00
8
0…20mA, 4…20mA d.c 0…20mA, 4…20mA d.c 6.2 x 77.5 x 100mm IP50 front Loop powered
www.oem.co.uk
Transducers
P20 programmable transducer
Technical data Inputs fixed: Temperature: Current: Voltage: Resistance: Outputs fixed: Current: Voltage: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
Part number key P20 Pt100, Pt250, Pt500, Pt1000 J, K, N, S Type 0…20mA, 4…20mA, 0…5mA d.c ±20mA d.c 0…10V, 0…5V, 0…60mV, 0…150mV d.c ±10V, ±5V, ±60mV, ±150mV d.c 0…400, 0…4000Ω 0…20mA, 4…20mA 0-10V d.c 22.5 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…65V a.c, 20…85V d.c
P20G programmable separator
Technical data Inputs programmable: Current: Voltage: Outputs programmable: Current: Voltage: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
0116 284 9900
• Programmable inputs for dc current, voltage, resistance and temperature (PT100 and thermocouples) • Analogue output 0-10V or 0/4-20mA • Scaleable individual characteristics
Analog output: current 0…20 mA current 4…20 mA voltage 0…10 V Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…85 V d.c., 20…65 V a.c. Kind of input: from table 1 see page 383
X
X
XX
00
8
1 2 3 1 2 XX
• Galvanic separation of analogue current and voltage signals • Linear conversion of input to output signal • Scaleable individual characteristics
Part number key P20G 0…20mA, 0…5mA, 4…20mA d.c ±20mA, ±5mA d.c 0…10V, 0…5V, 0…1V d.c ±10V, ±5V, ±1 d.c 0…20mA, 0…5mA, 4…20mA d.c ±20mA, ±5mA d.c 0…10V, 0…5V, 0…1V d.c ±10V, ±5V, ±1 d.c 22.5 x 120 x 100mm IP50 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…65V a.c, 20…85V d.c
Input: from table 2 see page 383 Output: from table 2 see page 383 Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…85 V d.c., 20…65 V a.c.
XX
XX
X
00
E
0
XX XX 1 2
PANEL TRANSDUCERS
| 377
Transducers
P21Z transducer for AC signals
• Inputs for AC current, voltage or frequency • Analogue output 0-10V, 0/4-20mA or RS-485 • 0.2 accuracy class
Part number key
Technical data Inputs fixed: Current: 1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) Voltage: 100, 130, 250, 325, 400, 600V a.c Frequency: 20…500Hz Outputs fixed: Current: 0…20mA, 0…5mA, 4…20mA d.c Voltage: 0…10V d.c Digital output: RS-485: Modbus RTU - optional Dimensions: 22.5 x 120 x 100mm Protection level: IP50 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…40V a.c,/d.c
P21Z Input range: 100 V a.c. 250 V a.c. 400 V a.c. 1 A a.c. 5 A a.c. frequency 20...500 Hz Output range: 0…20 mA 4…20 mA 0…10 V RS-485 Supply: 85…253 V a.c. 40…400 Hz; 90…300 V d.c. 20…40 V a.c. 40…400 Hz; 20…60 V d.c.
X
Part number key
378 | PANEL TRANSDUCERS
0…20mA, 4…20mA 0-10V d.c MODBUS RTU – optional 22.5 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…40V a.c/d.c
P20H
E
0
00
E
0
1 2
Technical data
Input signal: +/- 100 V +/- 250 V +/- 400 V +/- 1 A +/- 5 A 0…100 V 0…250 V 0…400 V Output: 0…20 mA 4…20 mA 0…10 V RS-485 Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…40 V a.c./d.c.
00
1 2 3 4
• Inputs for high DC current or voltage • Analogue output 0-10V or 0/4-20mA • 0.2 accuracy class
±1A, ±5A 100V d.c, 250V d.c, 400V d.c ±100V d.c, ±250V d.c, ±400V d.c
X
1 2 3 4 5 6
P20H programmable transducer for high DC signals
Inputs fixed: Current: Voltage: Outputs fixed: Current: Voltage: Digital output: RS-485: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
X
X
X
X
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 1 2
www.oem.co.uk
Transducers
P18, P18D, P18L temperature and humidity transducer
• Converts ambient temperature and humidity to a digital/analogue output • Option of 0-10V or 4-20mA output on P18 • Analogue loop powered 4-20mA pn P18L • Optional sensor protection shields - see page XX
Technical data
Part number keys
Inputs: Outputs: Current: Voltage: Digital interface: RS-485: Display: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
Temperature -30…85°C Humidity 0…100%
P18
2 x 4…20mA - optional 1 x 4…20mA (P18L only) 2 x 0…10V - optional
Analog outputs: without analog outputs current output 4…20 mA voltage output 0…10 V
MODBUS RTU (P18/P18D only) LCD 8 x 2 with backlight (P18D only) 35 x 58 x 118mm (inc sensor) IP65 9…24V d.c (P18/P18D) 19…30V d.c from loop (P18L)
Analog outputs: without outputs current 4…20 mA voltage 0…10 V
X
P18D
X
00
E
0
0 1 2
P19 wall mount temperature and humidity transducer
• Converts ambient temperature and humidity to a digital output • Built in sensor • Interface RS-485 MODBUS
Technical data
Part number keys
0116 284 9900
8
0 1 2
P18L
Inputs: Temperature -30…85°C Humidity 0…100% Digital output: RS-485: MODBUS RTU 120 x 80 x 25mm (wall mount) Dimensions: Protection level: IP65 Supply voltage: 9…24V d.c
00
P19
00
00
E
PANEL TRANSDUCERS
8
0
| 379
Transducers
P30U temperature and standard signals transducer
• • • •
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs programmable: Temperature: Pt100, Pt250, Pt500, Pt1000, Cu100, Ni100, Ni1000, J, K, N,E ,R, S, T, B Type Current: 0…4/20mA, ±20mA d.c Voltage: -5…20mV, ±75mV, ±200mV d.c, ±10V, ±24V d.c Resistance: 400, 2000, 5500Ω Outputs fixed: Relay output: 1 x relay, NO contacts 1 x relay, NO contacts - optional Current: 0/4…20mA 0-10V d.c Voltage: Auxiliary supply: 24V d.c/30mA - optional Data storage: Slot for SD/SDHC card - optional Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU master/slave Dimensions: 45 x 120 x 100mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…40V a.c, 20…50V d.c
Universal input Interface RS485 Modbus RTU slave Analogue and 1 or 2 alarm outputs Data recording in internal memory up to 4MB or 4GB in SD/SDHC card
P30U Analog output: current (range 0…4…20 mA) voltage (0…10 V) SD/SDHC card: without slot for SC card with slot for SD card Addition output: NO relay, 5 A 30 V d.c., 250 V a.c. supply 24 V d.c./30 mA Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…40 V a.c., 20…60 d.c.
X
XX
X
X
00
E
1 2 0 1 1 2 1 2
P30O pulse and frequency transducer
• 2 universal pulse inputs • Interface RS-485 Modbus/TCP and www server • Data recording in internal memory up to 4MB or 8GB on SD/SDHC card
Technical data
Part number keys
Inputs programmable: Main input 1: Number of pulses - ( -99999…99999) Frequncy < 10kHz - (0.05…10000Hz) Rotational speed - (0…60000/min Period t <20sec - (0.0001…20 sec) Period t <1.5h - (0.001…5400 sec) Frequncy <1MHz - (0.1…1000kHz) Operating time - (0…99999 h) Current time - (00:00…23:59) Counter INP1-INP 2 - (-99999…99999) Encoder (-99999…99999) - input 1 only Auxillary input 2: As main input Setting value - (-99999…99999) - input 2 only Outputs fixed: Relay output: 1 x relay, NO contacts 1 x relay, NO contacts - optional Current: 0/4…20mA Voltage: 0-10V d.c Auxiliary supply: 24V d.c/30mA - optional Data storage: Slot for SD/SDHC card - optional Digital interface: RS-485: MODBUS RTU master/slave Ethernet 10/100 Base-T: MODBUS TCP, HTTP, FTP - optional Dimensions: 45 x 120 x 100mm Protection level: IP40 front Supply voltage: 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…40V a.c, 20…50V d.c
380 | PANEL TRANSDUCERS
0
P30o
X
Analog output: 1 current (range 0/4…20 mA) 2 voltage (0…10 V) Additional equipment: without with external SD/SDHC slot with Ethernet interface and internal file system memory Additional output: relay (NO), 5 A 30 V d.c., 250 V a.c. supply 24 V d.c./30 mA Supply: 85…253 V a.c./d.c. 20…40 V a.c., 20…60 d.c.
XX
X
X
00
E
0
0 1 2 1 2 1 2
www.oem.co.uk
Transducers
P12H programmable transducer for high DC signals
• Universal programmable input • Interface RS-485 Modbus • Analogue and 2 relay alarm outputs
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs programmable: Voltage: Current: Outputs fixed: Relay output: Analog output: Current: Voltage: Digital interface: RS-485: Transducer memory: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
±100V d.c, ±600V d.c ±1A, ±5A 2 x relay, voltageless, NO contacts 0/4…20mA, 0…5mA 0-10V d.c MODBUS RTU 750 samples 45 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/d.c
P12H
X
XX
Kind of transducer: without display 1 with display 2 Input signal1): voltage -100 … 100 V 00 voltage -600 … 600 V 01 current -1 … 1 A 02 current -5 … 5 A 03 Output signal: voltage 0…10V current 0…20mA current 4…20mA current 0…5 mA Supply: 85…253 V d.c./a.c. 20…50 V d.c./a.c. 1) The transducer has an universal input. One must give the input signal which has to be programmed.
X
X
0
00
8
1 2 3 4 1 2 in the order, the code of
P12P transducer of single phase network parameters
• Measurement and conversion of single phase network parameters • Interface RS-485 Modbus • Analogue and 2 relay alarm outputs
Technical data
Part number keys
Inputs fixed: Measuring parameters:
Outputs fixed: Relay output: Current: Voltage: Digital interface: RS-485: Transducer memory: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
100V/1A, 100V/5A, 400V/1A, 400V/5A RMS voltage, RMS current, frequency, active power, reactive power, apparent power, 3-Ph active power, 3 -Ph reactive power, 3-Ph apparent power, cos φ. Tg φ, φ, active energy, reactive energy, 3-Ph active energy, 3-Ph reactive energy, 3-Ph apparent energy 2 x relay, NO contacts 0/4…20mA, 0…5mA 0-10V d.c MODBUS RTU 750 samples 45 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c/d.c, 20…50V a.c/d.c
P12P
X
Kind of transducer: 1 without display 2 with display Input range: 100 V, 1 A 100 V, 5 A 400 V, 1 A 400 V, 5 A Programmed converted parameter1): from table 3 see page 383 Output signal: voltage: 0…10 V current: 0…20 mA current: 4…20 mA current: 0…5 mA Supply: 85…253 V d.c./a.c. 20…50 V d.c./a.c.
X
XX
X
X
0
00
8
1 2 3 4 XX 1 2 3 4 1 2
1) The change of the converted parameters is possible from the keyboard (P12P-2) through PD14 or RS-485. One must give in the order, the code of converted parameter which has to be programmed.
0116 284 9900
PANEL TRANSDUCERS
| 381
Transducers
P41 1-phase network transducer
• • • •
Technical data
Part number key
Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement: Outputs: Current: Digital interface: RS-485: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 100, 400V a.c Current, voltage L-N, freq, active power, reactive power, power factor tangens φ, φ, active energy, reactive energy
Interface RS-485 Modbus RTU slave Programmable analogue output -20mA to +20mA Programmable current and voltage transformer ratios Logging of a selected value (9000 samples)
P41 Supply: 85…253 V a.c. 40…400 Hz; / 90…300 V d.c. 20…40 V a.c. 40…400 Hz; / 20…60 V d.c.
X
00
E
0
1 2
±20mA MODBUS RTU 45 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c, 40…400Hz, 90…300V d.c 20…40V a.c, 40…400Hz, 20…60V d.c
P43 programmable transducer for 3-phase power networks
• Measurement and conversion of power network parameter in 4 -wire balanced or unbalanced system • Programmable current and voltage transformer ratios • Interface RS-485 Modbus • 4 programmable analogue outputs
Technical data
Part number keys
Inputs: Current: Voltage: Measurement:
Outputs: Relay outputs: Current: Impulse energy output: Digital interface: RS-485: USB1.1/2.0: Dimensions: Protection level: Supply voltage:
382 | PANEL TRANSDUCERS
1A (x/1A a.c), 5A (x/5A a.c) 3 x 57.7/100V, 3 x 230/400V Current L1…L3, voltage L-N, voltage L-L, freq, active power, reactive power, apparent power, power factor tangens φ, input active energy, output active energy, inductive reactive energy, capacitive reactive energy, THD 0, 2 or 4 - relay, NO contacts 0, 2 or 4 - ±20mA OC passive, impulse 5000…20000 imp/kWh MODBUS RTU
P43 Current input in: 1 A (x/1) 5 A (x/5) Voltage input (phase/phase-to-phase) Un: 3 x 57.7/100 V 3 x 230/400 V Supply voltage: 85…253 V a.c., 90…320 V d.c. 20…40 V a.c., 20…60 V d.c. Output type: without analog outputs, 4 relays 2 analog outputs, 2 relays 4 analog outputs, without relays
X
X
X
X
00
E
0
1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 3
96 x 120 x 100mm IP40 front 85…253V a.c, 40…400Hz, 90…300V d.c 20…40V a.c, 40…400Hz, 20…60V d.c
www.oem.co.uk
Transducers
Table 1. input signals P20 Type of sensor/input [Unit]
Pt100 [°C]
Pt250 [°C]
Pt500 [°C]
Pt1000 [°C]
TC of J type [°C]
Range
-200…850 0…850 0…600 0…400 0…200 -200…200 -100…1001 -200…850 0…850 0…600 0…400 0…200 -200…200 -100…100 -200…850 0…850 0…600 0…400 0…200 -200…200 -100…100 -200…850 0…850 0…600 0…400 0…200 -200…200 -100…100 -200…1200 0…1200 0…1000 0…800 0…600 0…4001 -200…2001
Table 3. P12P transducer of single phase network parameters Code Type of sensor/input [Unit] 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35
TC of K type [°C]
TC of S type [°C]
TC of N type [°C]
Voltage d.c. [V]
Voltage d.c. [mV]
Current d.c. [mA] Resistance [Ω] Custom-made
Range
Code
-200…1370 0…1200 0…1000 0…800 0…600 0…4001 -200…2001 0…1760 0…1600 0…14001 0…12001 0…10001 -200…1200 0…1200 0…1000 0…800 0…6001 0…4001 -200…2001 0…10 0…5 -10…10 -5…5 0…60 -60…60 0…150 -150…150 0…20 4…20 0…5 -20…20 0…400 0…4000
36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 XX
Programmed converted parameter: voltage current frequency active power reactive power apparent power 3-phase active power 3-phase reactive power 3-phase apparent power cos ϕ tg ϕ ϕ active energy reactive energy apparent energy 3-phase active energy 3-phase reactive energy 3-phase apparent energy as per order2)
Code 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 XX
Table 2. Coding of the P20G separator kind of input and output Range 0…1 V 0…5 V 0…10 V ±1 V ±5 V ±10 V 0…5 mA 0…20 mA ±5 mA ±20 mA 4…20 mA Custom-made version*
Input code 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 XX
Output code 01** 02 03 04** 05 06 07** 08 09** 10 11 XX
* after agreeing with the manufacturer
P18, P18D, P18L temperature and humidity transducer shields Part number
0116 284 9900
Description
Construction
Features
Typical application
0874-490-016
Membrane filter
Casing made of PC membrane of teflon laminated by a film. Pore size:1 μm
Mean filtration effect. Maximal temp.: up to 80ºC Response time t10/90: 15 s
Building automation. For application in rooms with low pollution.
0874-490-015
Filter made in teflon
Sintered teflon Pore size 50 μm
High chemical resistance Maximal temp.: up to 180ºC Response time t10/90: 14 s
Drying process in chemical applications.
0874-490-014
Filter made of sintered bronze
Sintered bronze Pore size: 60 μm
High mechanical resistance. To co-operate with high pollution. Applied at small air humidity. Response time t10/90: 10 s
Agricultural applications
PANEL TRANSDUCERS
| 383
Notes
384 | NOTES
OEM-AUTOMATIC LIMITED (“OEM”) GENERAL CONDITIONS OF SALE (“the Conditions”) 1. DEFINITIONS In these Conditions: ”Buyer” means the party with whom OEM contracts; ”Contract” means the contract made between OEM and the Buyer for supply of the Goods which are subject to these Conditions; ”Goods” means all or any of the goods works and materials to be supplied by OEM; ”Act of Insolvency” means any one or more of the following namely the passing of a resolution or the presentation of a petition for winding-up, bankruptcy or for the appointment of an administrator, the appointment of a receiver and/or manager or administrative receiver over the whole or any part of the Buyer’s undertaking and assets, the making of a proposal for a voluntary arrangement within the Insolvency Act 1986 or of a proposal for any other composition scheme or arrangement with or the calling by the Buyer of any meeting of its creditors generally, the levying of execution or distress or diligence on any of its assets, the failure to pay its proper debts as and when due and anything analogous to any of the foregoing under the law of the jurisdiction where the Buyer is established. 2. CONSTRUCTION OF CONTRACT (1) These Conditions shall apply to all contracts of sale between OEM and the Buyer. (2) The terms of the Contract shall consist of the particulars set out in OEM’s Order Acknowledgement and these Conditions. Any term in OEM’s Order Acknowledgement which is at variance with these Conditions shall prevail over these Conditions, which shall be construed accordingly, except with regard to price in respect of which condition 5 (2) shall prevail. (3) No other terms (whether contained in any document issued by the Buyer or in any written or oral communication between the parties) shall apply to the Contract nor shall these Conditions or the particulars contained in OEM’s Order Acknowledgement be modified without OEM’s written agreement. OEM shall be entitled to amend technical specifications of the Goods without notice. (4) In order that these Conditions and the particulars in OEM’s Order Acknowledgement shall be a complete record of the agreement between the parties with regard to the sale of the Goods, the Buyer must ensure that any pre-contractual representation on which the Buyer wishes to rely has been specified in those particulars. In entering into the Contract, the Buyer does not rely upon any such representation made by or on behalf of OEM which has not been so specified. 3. OUOTATIONS AND ORDERS (1) Unless accepted before lapse or withdrawal, or renewed in writing by OEM, quotations shall lapse automatically after 30 days, but maybe withdrawn earlier. (2) Quotations are information only and are not firm offers. There shall be no binding contract until OEM has accepted the Buyer’s order by despatching OEM’s official Acknowledgement of Order or invoice 4. DELIVERY (1) Although OEM wiII endeavour to deliver Goods within any delivery time specified in OEM’s Acknowledgement of Order, that time is an estimate only and not a term of the Contract and as such, time shall not be of the essence. OEM shall not be liable for any failure to meet any such estimate, nor for any loss, of whatsoever nature resulting directly or indirectly therefrom. (2) Any such time specified shall be extended by any period during which the manufacture or delivery of the Goods or other work by OEM in connection with the Contract is delayed due to fire, explosion, flood, storm, tempest, sabotage, strikes (official and unofficial), riot, invasion, acts of war, shortage of labour, power or materials, civil commotion, accidents, plant breakdowns, compliance with an order of an apparently competent authority, and any other event beyond OEM’s control. (3) If any such delivery time is so extended by more than 90 days the Buyer shall be entitled to give written notice to OEM requiring the Goods to be delivered within 30 days of the date of such notice failing which the Buyer shall have the right to give further written notice terminating the contract forthwith. (4) OEM shall be entitled to deliver the Goods by instalments and/or in advance of the estimated date. Each delivery shall constitute a separate contract to which these Conditions shall apply. Failure by OEM to deliver any one or more of the instalments or any claim by the Buyer in respect of any one or more instalments shall not entitle the Buyer to treat the Contract as a whole as repudiated. (5) In the case of United Kingdom and Overseas customers, unless otherwise stated, OEM will deliver to the Buyer’s premises and will charge separately for packing, carriage and handling. (6) The delivery by OEM of a greater or lesser quantity provided for in the Contract, the delivery of other goods not provided for in the Contract, or the delivery of Goods only some of which are defective, shall not entitle the Buyer to reject all of the Goods delivered. In order that OEM can comply with its carrier’s conditions, a claim in respect of error in quantity or type of Goods in respect of the condition of the Goods delivered must be made in writing to OEM within 3 days or to the carrier and OEM within 5 days of receipt. Failure to make such claim shall constitute unqualified acceptance of the Goods and waiver by the Buyer of all claims relating to error in quantity or type of Goods delivered or relating to the condition of Goods delivered. Similarly, if any Goods invoiced by OEM are not received by the Buyer, the Buyer must notify OEM within 25 days or the carrier and OEM within 28 days of the date of invoice, failing which the Buyer will be liable to pay for the Goods in full. (7) OEM shall at its option make good any non-delivery short delivery or damage of Goods notified in accordance with Condition 4(6) by repair or replacement of such Goods and save as provided in this Condition shall not be liable for any such non-delivery short delivery or damage in transit nor for any loss, financial or otherwise resulting directly or indirectly therefrom. In no event shall OEM be liable to the Buyer in connection with any damage or loss in transit where delivery takes place at OEM’s premises. (8) If the Buyer fails to take delivery of or collect the Goods or fails to give OEM adequate delivery instructions after notification by OEM that the Goods are ready OEM may (without prejudice to its other rights and remedies): store the Goods (on its own or any third party’s premises) and charge the Buyer for its reasonable costs (including without limitation VAT costs of storage, carriage and insurance); and/or sell the Goods at any time and after deducting all costs and expenses account to the Buyer for any excess over the price already paid under the Contract or charge the Buyer for any shortfall between the Contract price and such costs and expenses. (9) All returnable containers and packing materials will be charged for, but credit will be given if these are returned in condition satisfactory to OEM, to OEM’s works carriage paid within thirty days following delivery of the relevant Goods. 5. PROPERTY AND RISK (1) The risk in the Goods shall pass to the Buyer upon despatch of the Goods from OEM’s warehouse. (2) Notwithstanding delivery and the passing of risk, property in and title to the Goods shall remain in OEM until OEM has received payment of all sums owing to OEM under the Contract and any other contract with the Buyer whatsoever. (3) Until property in and title to the Goods passes to the Buyer: the Buyer shall keep the Goods properly stored, protected and insured and separate from all or any other goods whether belonging to OEM, the Buyer, or any third party; OEM shall be entitled at any time forthwith to revoke the Buyer’s power to deal with the Goods; and it shall automatically cease if the Buyer shall commit or be subject to any Act of Insolvency; and the Buyer shall not make any modification to the Goods or their packaging or alter remove or tamper with any marks, numbers or other means of identification used on or in relation to the Goods. Upon termination of the Buyer’s power to deal with the Goods, the Buyer shall place the Goods at the disposal of OEM and OEM and its servants and agents are hereby irrevocably authorised without the need for consent of any third party but using only such force as may be necessary, to enter upon any premises of the Buyer or any third party for the purpose of removing the Goods. (4) If any of the foregoing provisions of this Condition shall be invalid or unenforceable such invalidity or unenforceability shall not affect the remaining provisions. 6. PRICES (1) Unless otherwise stated in OEM’s Order Acknowledgement, prices for the Goods shall be ex-works, and shall be exclusive of VAT, packing, carriage, insurance, and any other costs, all of which shall be the subject of additional charges. VAT shall be charged where appropriate at the rate prevailing at the relevant tax point. (2) Any price quoted by the Company is based upon costs current as the date of quotation. The price charged to the Customer under the Contract may be changed to take account of costs current at the date of invoice. Such changes may include, but are not limited to, fluctuations in rates of currency where the Goods or any part thereof, are sourced from third countries. 7. PAYMENT (1) Subject to prior written agreement to the contrary, OEM shall be entitled to invoice the Buyer for the price of the Goods on or at any time after OEM has notified the Buyer that the Goods are ready for collection or OEM has tendered delivery of the Goods. (2) If OEM has granted the Buyer monthly account credit facilities, then payment of the price must be made within 30 days of the date of Invoice. Otherwise payment must be in cash prior to delivery.
Payment shall be made direct to OEM in the currency invoiced. The Buyer shall not be entitled to exercise any right of set-off against payment due to OEM. (3) OEM shall be entitled to charge daily interest on any overdue sum at the rate of 5 per cent annum above the base lending rate for the time being of Lloyds TSB Bank plc from the due date for payment to the actual date of payment (both before and after judgment). (4) Where payment is agreed to be made by instalments, any delay or default by the Buyer in making payment in respect of any one instalment shall render all the remaining instalments due forthwith, and interest will be charged in accordance with condition 7(3) with immediate effect until the date of actual payment. (5) OEM may appropriate any payment made by the Buyer to such of the Goods (or the goods supplied under any other contract between OEM and the Buyer) as OEM may think fit (notwithstanding any purported appropriation by the Buyer). 8 WARRANTIES AND EXEMPTIONS (1) If under proper use the goods develop any defect during the warranty period due to defective articles or materials supplied OEM shall at its own expense and option replace or repair such goods as are defective so as to remedy the defects except where such defects are attributable to accident, fair wear and tear, or any act omission or neglect of the buyer or of its agents. The Buyer must give OEM notice of any alleged defects as soon as it becomes apparent, and shall (unless otherwise instructed by OEM) retain the goods at the Buyer’s premises for inspection by OEM and give OEM adequate facilities to investigate the complaint at the Buyer’s premises. The “warranty period” shall mean the period specified in OEM’S order acknowledgement as the warranty period and if no such period is specified, then a period of 12 months from the date of delivery of the goods. (2) Except as expressly stated above there shall be excluded from the contract any warranty, condition or statement, express or implied, statutory or otherwise, as to satisfactory quality, and/or fitness of the goods for any particular purpose. (3) OEM shall not be liable to the Buyer in contract tort (including without limitation negligence) and/ or breach of statutory duty for any loss or damage which the Buyer may suffer by reason of any act, omission, neglect or default (including negligence) in the performance of the Contract by OEM its servants or agents, [in a sum which is greater than the Contract price]. (4) OEM shall not be liable to the Buyer in contract tort (including without limitation negligence) and/ or breach of statutory duty for any loss of profits loss of goodwill loss of contracts and/or any indirect or consequential (including economic) loss of any kind including loss of profits and/or loss of production which the Buyer may suffer by reason of any act, omission, neglect or default (including negligence) in the performance of the Contract by OEM, its servants or agents. (5) Provided that nothing in this Condition shall operate so as to exclude OEM’s non-excludable liability in respect of death or personal injury caused by the negligence of OEM its servants or agents; to affect the statutory rights of the Buyer where Goods are sold to a Buyer dealing as a consumer within the meaning of Unfair Contract Terms Act; or to exclude the application of Section 12 of the Sale of Goods Act 1979 or to exclude liability for fraudulent misrepresentation. (6) OEM reserves the right not to accept goods for credit or replacement from the Buyer that are not accompanied and clearly marked with a returned materials authorisation (rma) number that has been previously agreed with and issued by OEM. An RMA number shall remain open and valid for 30 days from date of issue by OEM. If OEM have failed to receive the goods to which the rma number relate within this period then OEM reserve the right to cancel the rma. The risk and the property in the goods remains with the Buyer unless otherwise notified by OEM. OEM will not accept returned goods that clearly show signs of physical damage to external packaging where it is possible that damage to the goods may have occurred as a result. The Buyer shall be responsible for the carriage costs of the returned goods unless otherwise agreed in writing by OEM. 9. INSOLVENCY AND DEFAULT (1) Without prejudice to any rights and remedies available to it, OEM shall be entitled, forthwith on written notice to the Buyer either to terminate the Contract in whole or in part and/or any other contract with the Buyer or to withhold performance of all or any of its obligations under the Contract and/or any other contract with the Buyer (and on the giving of such notice all monies outstanding from the Buyer to OEM shall become immediately due and payable) if:- (i) any sum owing to OEM from the Buyer on any account whatsoever shall be unpaid after the due date for payment (in which event OEM shall have a general lien for any such sum on all and any property of the Buyer in its possession); or (ii) the Buyer shall commit or be subject to any Act of Insolvency; or (iii) the Buyer shall commit any breach of any contract (including without limitation the Contract) with OEM. (2) In the event of a suspension of performance OEM shall be entitled, as a condition of resuming performance, to require pre-payment, or such security as it may require. 10. EXPORT TERMS (1) Any term or expression which is defined in the provisions of Incoterms 2000 (or any subsequent revision thereof) shall import the respective obligations of Buyer and Seller into these Conditions, but in the event of conflict these Conditions shall prevail. (2) Where the Goods are supplied for export from the United Kingdom, the provisions of this clause 10 shall (subject to any special terms agreed in writing between OEM and the Buyer) apply not withstanding any other provision of these Conditions. (3) Unless otherwise agreed in writing between OEM and the Buyer, the Goods shall be delivered Ex-Works and OEM shall be under no obligation to give notice under section 32(3) of the Sale of Goods Act 1979. (4) The Buyer shall be responsible for arranging for testing and inspection of the Goods at OEM’s premises before shipment. OEM shall have no liability for any claim in respect of any defect in the Goods which would be apparent on testing or inspection and which is made after shipment, or in respect of any damage during transit. 11. CANCELLATION The Contract may be cancelled in whole or in part by the Buyer only with OEM’s written consent and upon the condition that the Buyer shall indemnify OEM in full against all loss, damages, costs expenses and other liabilities awarded against or incurred by OEM as a result of or in connection with the cancellation. 12. GENERAL (1) It shall be the responsibility of the Buyer to ensure that all requirements applicable to the Contract, whether statutory, regulatory, municipal and/or otherwise howsoever, (including without limitation any relating to the importation or use of the Goods in the country of destination and for the payment of duties thereon) are duly complied with. It shall be a condition precedent to the performance by OEM of its obligations under the Contract that all necessary licences, permits and consents shall have been obtained by the Buyer. (2) Neither party shall have any liability for any failure to perform or for any delay in the performance (other than as to payment) of any of its obligations under the Contract caused by any factor beyond its reasonable control. (3) No failure or delay on the part of OEM to exercise any of its rights under the Contract shall operate as a waiver of nor shall any waiver by OEM of any breach by the Buyer of any of its obligations under the Contract affect the rights of OEM in the event of any further or continuing breach. (4) The Contract is personal to the Buyer, who shall not assign or in any way part with the benefit without OEM’s prior written consent. (5) Each and every obligation contained in these Conditions shall be treated as a separate obligation and shall be severally enforceable as such notwithstanding the non- enforceability of any other such obligation. (6) The Conditions and the Contract shall not create or evidence, or be deemed to create or evidence, any agency or partnership between OEM on the one hand and the Buyer or any third party on the other. (7) Any notice required to be given in writing under the Contract shall be given, where possible, by facsimile transmission and otherwise by first class post addressed to the registered office of the party for which it is intended, or to such other address as may be notified in writing in accordance herewith for the purpose, and shall be deemed to have been received, in the case of a facsimile transmission, upon transmission and, in the case of a letter, forty-eight hours after posting. In proving service by letter, it shall be sufficient to show that the envelope containing the notice was properly addressed and stamped and duly posted. (8) The Contract shall be governed by English Law. (9) The parties irrevocably submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the English Courts, save in the case of a Buyer who has no assets within the jurisdiction of the English Courts and who is established in a country which will not enforce the judgement of the English Courts. In those circumstances OEM may if it chooses refer any disputes arising out of the Contract to arbitration under the Rules of Conciliation and Arbitration of the International Chamber of Commerce, such arbitration to take place in London. CARRIAGE AND HANDLING CHARGES Please enquire.
Whiteacres Cambridge Road Whetstone Leicester LE8 6ZG Tel +44 (0) 116 284 9900 Fax +44 (0) 116 284 1721 information@uk.oem.se www.oem.co.uk